670c36998eaf7d71483caa2b0d9eacec7827b6a0
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @c @item -xdb
1239 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1240 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1241 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1242 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1243 @c systems.
1244
1245 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1246 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1247 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1248 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1249 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1250 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1251
1252 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1253 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1254 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1255 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1256 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1257 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1258
1259 @item -write
1260 @cindex @code{--write}
1261 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1262 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1263 (@pxref{Patching}).
1264
1265 @item -statistics
1266 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1267 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1268 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1269
1270 @item -version
1271 @cindex @code{--version}
1272 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1273 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1274
1275 @item -configuration
1276 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1277 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1278 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1279 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1280
1281 @end table
1282
1283 @node Startup
1284 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1285 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1286
1287 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1288
1289 @enumerate
1290 @item
1291 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1292 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1293
1294 @item
1295 @cindex init file
1296 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1297 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1298 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1302 @item
1303 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1304 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1305 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1306 that file.
1307
1308 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1309 @item
1310 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1311 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1312 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1313 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1314 gets loaded.
1315
1316 @item
1317 Processes command line options and operands.
1318
1319 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1320 @item
1321 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1322 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1323 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1324 This is only done if the current directory is
1325 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1326 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1327 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1328 @value{GDBN}.
1329
1330 @item
1331 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1332 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1333 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1334 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1335
1336 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1337 you must do something like the following:
1338
1339 @smallexample
1340 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1341 @end smallexample
1342
1343 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1344 off too late.
1345
1346 @item
1347 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1348 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1349 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1350
1351 @item
1352 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1353 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1354 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1355 @end enumerate
1356
1357 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1358 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1359 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1360 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1361 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1362 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1363
1364 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1365 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1366
1367 @cindex init file name
1368 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1369 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1370 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1371 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1372 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1373 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1374 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1375 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1376
1377
1378 @node Quitting GDB
1379 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1380 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1381 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1382
1383 @table @code
1384 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1385 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1386 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1387 @itemx q
1388 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1389 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1390 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1391 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1392 error code.
1393 @end table
1394
1395 @cindex interrupt
1396 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1397 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1398 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1399 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1400 until a time when it is safe.
1401
1402 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1403 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1404 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1405
1406 @node Shell Commands
1407 @section Shell Commands
1408
1409 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1410 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1411 just use the @code{shell} command.
1412
1413 @table @code
1414 @kindex shell
1415 @kindex !
1416 @cindex shell escape
1417 @item shell @var{command-string}
1418 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1419 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1420 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1421 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1422 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1423 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1424 @end table
1425
1426 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1427 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1428 @value{GDBN}:
1429
1430 @table @code
1431 @kindex make
1432 @cindex calling make
1433 @item make @var{make-args}
1434 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1435 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1436 @end table
1437
1438 @node Logging Output
1439 @section Logging Output
1440 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1441 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1442
1443 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1444 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1445
1446 @table @code
1447 @kindex set logging
1448 @item set logging on
1449 Enable logging.
1450 @item set logging off
1451 Disable logging.
1452 @cindex logging file name
1453 @item set logging file @var{file}
1454 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1455 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1456 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1457 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1458 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1459 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1460 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1461 @kindex show logging
1462 @item show logging
1463 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1464 @end table
1465
1466 @node Commands
1467 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1468
1469 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1470 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1471 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1472 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1473 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1474
1475 @menu
1476 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1477 * Completion:: Command completion
1478 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1479 @end menu
1480
1481 @node Command Syntax
1482 @section Command Syntax
1483
1484 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1485 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1486 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1487 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1488 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1489 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1490
1491 @cindex abbreviation
1492 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1493 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1494 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1495 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1496 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1497 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1498 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1499
1500 @cindex repeating commands
1501 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1502 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1503 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1504 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1505 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1506 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1507 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1508
1509 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1510 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1511 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1512
1513 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1514 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1515 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1516 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1517 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1518
1519 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1520 @cindex comment
1521 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1522 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1523 Files,,Command Files}).
1524
1525 @cindex repeating command sequences
1526 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1527 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1528 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1529 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1530 for editing.
1531
1532 @node Completion
1533 @section Command Completion
1534
1535 @cindex completion
1536 @cindex word completion
1537 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1538 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1539 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1540 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1541
1542 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1543 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1544 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1545 enter it). For example, if you type
1546
1547 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1548 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1549 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1550 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1551 @smallexample
1552 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1553 @end smallexample
1554
1555 @noindent
1556 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1557 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1558
1559 @smallexample
1560 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1561 @end smallexample
1562
1563 @noindent
1564 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1565 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1566 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1567 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1568 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1569 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1570
1571 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1572 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1573 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1574 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1575 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1576 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1577 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1578 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1579 example:
1580
1581 @smallexample
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1583 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1584 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1585 make_abs_section make_function_type
1586 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1587 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1588 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1589 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1590 @end smallexample
1591
1592 @noindent
1593 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1594 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1595 command.
1596
1597 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1598 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1599 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1600 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1601 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1602
1603 @cindex quotes in commands
1604 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1605 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1606 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1607 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1608 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1609 @value{GDBN} commands.
1610
1611 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1612 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1613 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1614 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1615 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1616 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1617 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1618 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1619 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1620 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1621 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1622
1623 @smallexample
1624 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1625 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1626 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1627 @end smallexample
1628
1629 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1630 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1631 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1632 place:
1633
1634 @smallexample
1635 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1636 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1637 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1638 @end smallexample
1639
1640 @noindent
1641 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1642 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1643 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1644
1645 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1646 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1647 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1648 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1649
1650 @cindex completion of structure field names
1651 @cindex structure field name completion
1652 @cindex completion of union field names
1653 @cindex union field name completion
1654 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1655 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1656 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1657 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1658 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1659 left-hand-side:
1660
1661 @smallexample
1662 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1663 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1664 to_data to_isatty to_write
1665 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1666 to_flush to_read
1667 @end smallexample
1668
1669 @noindent
1670 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1671 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1672 follows:
1673
1674 @smallexample
1675 struct ui_file
1676 @{
1677 int *magic;
1678 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1679 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1680 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1681 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1682 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1683 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1684 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1685 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1686 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1687 void *to_data;
1688 @}
1689 @end smallexample
1690
1691
1692 @node Help
1693 @section Getting Help
1694 @cindex online documentation
1695 @kindex help
1696
1697 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1698 using the command @code{help}.
1699
1700 @table @code
1701 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1702 @item help
1703 @itemx h
1704 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1705 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1706
1707 @smallexample
1708 (@value{GDBP}) help
1709 List of classes of commands:
1710
1711 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1712 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1713 data -- Examining data
1714 files -- Specifying and examining files
1715 internals -- Maintenance commands
1716 obscure -- Obscure features
1717 running -- Running the program
1718 stack -- Examining the stack
1719 status -- Status inquiries
1720 support -- Support facilities
1721 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1722 stopping the program
1723 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1724
1725 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1726 commands in that class.
1727 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1728 documentation.
1729 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1730 (@value{GDBP})
1731 @end smallexample
1732 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1733
1734 @item help @var{class}
1735 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1736 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1737 help display for the class @code{status}:
1738
1739 @smallexample
1740 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1741 Status inquiries.
1742
1743 List of commands:
1744
1745 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1746 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1747 info -- Generic command for showing things
1748 about the program being debugged
1749 show -- Generic command for showing things
1750 about the debugger
1751
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757
1758 @item help @var{command}
1759 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1760 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1761
1762 @kindex apropos
1763 @item apropos @var{args}
1764 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1765 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1766 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1767
1768 @smallexample
1769 apropos alias
1770 @end smallexample
1771
1772 @noindent
1773 results in:
1774
1775 @smallexample
1776 @c @group
1777 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1778 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1779 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1780 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1781 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1782 @c @end group
1783 @end smallexample
1784
1785 @kindex complete
1786 @item complete @var{args}
1787 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1788 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1789 command you want completed. For example:
1790
1791 @smallexample
1792 complete i
1793 @end smallexample
1794
1795 @noindent results in:
1796
1797 @smallexample
1798 @group
1799 if
1800 ignore
1801 info
1802 inspect
1803 @end group
1804 @end smallexample
1805
1806 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1807 @end table
1808
1809 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1810 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1811 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1812 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1813 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1814 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1815 Index}.
1816
1817 @c @group
1818 @table @code
1819 @kindex info
1820 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1821 @item info
1822 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1823 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1824 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1825 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1826 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1827 @w{@code{help info}}.
1828
1829 @kindex set
1830 @item set
1831 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1832 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1833 @code{set prompt $}.
1834
1835 @kindex show
1836 @item show
1837 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1838 @value{GDBN} itself.
1839 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1840 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1841 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1842 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1843
1844 @kindex info set
1845 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1846 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1847 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1848 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1849 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1850 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1851 @end table
1852 @c @end group
1853
1854 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1855 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1856
1857 @table @code
1858 @kindex show version
1859 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1860 @item show version
1861 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1862 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1863 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1864 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1865 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1866 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1867 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1868 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1869 @value{GDBN}.
1870
1871 @kindex show copying
1872 @kindex info copying
1873 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1874 @item show copying
1875 @itemx info copying
1876 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1877
1878 @kindex show warranty
1879 @kindex info warranty
1880 @item show warranty
1881 @itemx info warranty
1882 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1883 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1884
1885 @kindex show configuration
1886 @item show configuration
1887 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1888 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1889 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1890 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1891 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1892 your report.
1893
1894 @end table
1895
1896 @node Running
1897 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1898
1899 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1900 debugging information when you compile it.
1901
1902 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1903 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1904 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1905 kill a child process.
1906
1907 @menu
1908 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1909 * Starting:: Starting your program
1910 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1911 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1912
1913 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1914 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1915 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1916 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1917
1918 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1919 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1920 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1921 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1922 @end menu
1923
1924 @node Compilation
1925 @section Compiling for Debugging
1926
1927 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1928 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1929 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1930 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1931 and addresses in the executable code.
1932
1933 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1934 the compiler.
1935
1936 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1937 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1938 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1939 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1940 executables containing debugging information.
1941
1942 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1943 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1944 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1945 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1946 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1947
1948 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1949 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1950 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1951
1952 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1953 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1954 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1955 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1956 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1957 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1958
1959 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1960 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1961 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1962
1963 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1964 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1965 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1966 format in @value{GDBN}.
1967
1968 @need 2000
1969 @node Starting
1970 @section Starting your Program
1971 @cindex starting
1972 @cindex running
1973
1974 @table @code
1975 @kindex run
1976 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1977 @item run
1978 @itemx r
1979 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1980 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
1981 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1982 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
1983 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1984
1985 @end table
1986
1987 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1988 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1989 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1990 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1991 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1992 message like this one:
1993
1994 @smallexample
1995 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1996 Try "help target" or "continue".
1997 @end smallexample
1998
1999 @noindent
2000 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2001 first (@pxref{load}).
2002
2003 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2004 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2005 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2006 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2007 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2008 divided into four categories:
2009
2010 @table @asis
2011 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2012 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2013 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2014 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2015 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2016 the arguments.
2017 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2018 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2019 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2020 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2021 below for details).
2022
2023 @item The @emph{environment.}
2024 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2025 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2026 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2027 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2028
2029 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2030 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2031 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2032 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2033
2034 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2035 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2036 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2037 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2038 set a different device for your program.
2039 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2040
2041 @cindex pipes
2042 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2043 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2044 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2045 wrong program.
2046 @end table
2047
2048 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2049 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2050 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2051 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2052 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2053
2054 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2055 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2056 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2057 your current breakpoints.
2058
2059 @table @code
2060 @kindex start
2061 @item start
2062 @cindex run to main procedure
2063 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2064 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2065 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2066 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2067 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2068 procedure, depending on the language used.
2069
2070 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2071 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2072 the @samp{run} command.
2073
2074 @cindex elaboration phase
2075 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2076 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2077 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2078 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2079 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2080 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2081 will remain to halt execution.
2082
2083 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2084 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2085 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2086 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2087 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2088
2089 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2090 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2091 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2092 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2093 elaboration code before running your program.
2094
2095 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2096 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2097 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2098 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2099 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2100 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2101 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2102 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2103 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2104 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2105 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2106 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2107
2108 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2109 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2110 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2111 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2112
2113 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2114 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2115 environment:
2116
2117 @smallexample
2118 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2119 (@value{GDBP}) run
2120 @end smallexample
2121
2122 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2123 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2124
2125 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2126 @item set startup-with-shell
2127 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2128 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2129 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2130 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2131 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2132 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2133 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2134 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2135 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2136 startup failures such as:
2137
2138 @smallexample
2139 (@value{GDBP}) run
2140 Starting program: ./a.out
2141 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2142 @end smallexample
2143
2144 @noindent
2145 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2146 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2147 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2148 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2149 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2150 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2151
2152 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2153 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2154 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2155 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2156 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2157 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2158
2159 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2160 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2161 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2162 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2163 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2164 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2165
2166 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2167 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2168 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2169
2170 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2171 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2172
2173 @smallexample
2174 (@value{GDBP}) run
2175 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2176 @end smallexample
2177
2178 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2179 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2180
2181 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2182 @code{target native} command. For example,
2183
2184 @smallexample
2185 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2186 (@value{GDBP}) run
2187 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2188 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2189 (@value{GDBP}) run
2190 Starting program: ./a.out
2191 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2192 @end smallexample
2193
2194 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2195 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2196 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2197 disconnect.
2198
2199 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2200 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2201 proc}, @code{info os}.
2202
2203 @kindex set disable-randomization
2204 @item set disable-randomization
2205 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2206 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2207 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2208 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2209 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2210
2211 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2212 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2213
2214 @smallexample
2215 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2216 @end smallexample
2217
2218 @item set disable-randomization off
2219 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2220 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2221 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2222 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2223 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2224 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2225
2226 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2227 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2228 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2229 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2230 a code at its expected addresses.
2231
2232 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2233 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2234 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2235 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2236 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2237 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2238 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2239 a randomly chosen address.
2240
2241 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2242 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2243 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2244 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2245 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2246
2247 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2248 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2249
2250 @item show disable-randomization
2251 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2252 the virtual address space of the started program.
2253
2254 @end table
2255
2256 @node Arguments
2257 @section Your Program's Arguments
2258
2259 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2260 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2261 @code{run} command.
2262 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2263 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2264 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2265 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2266 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2267
2268 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2269 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2270 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2271 the program, not by the shell.
2272
2273 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2274 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2275
2276 @table @code
2277 @kindex set args
2278 @item set args
2279 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2280 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2281 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2282 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2283 it again without arguments.
2284
2285 @kindex show args
2286 @item show args
2287 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2288 @end table
2289
2290 @node Environment
2291 @section Your Program's Environment
2292
2293 @cindex environment (of your program)
2294 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2295 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2296 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2297 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2298 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2299 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2300 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2301
2302 @table @code
2303 @kindex path
2304 @item path @var{directory}
2305 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2306 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2307 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2308 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2309 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2310 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2311 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2312
2313 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2314 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2315 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2316 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2317 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2318 @var{directory} to the search path.
2319 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2320 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2321
2322 @kindex show paths
2323 @item show paths
2324 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2325 environment variable).
2326
2327 @kindex show environment
2328 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2329 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2330 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2331 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2332 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2333
2334 @kindex set environment
2335 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2336 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2337 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2338 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2339 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2340 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2341 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2342 null value.
2343 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2344 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2345
2346 For example, this command:
2347
2348 @smallexample
2349 set env USER = foo
2350 @end smallexample
2351
2352 @noindent
2353 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2354 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2355 are not actually required.)
2356
2357 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2358 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2359 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2360 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2361 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2362
2363 @kindex unset environment
2364 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2365 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2366 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2367 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2368 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2369 @end table
2370
2371 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2372 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2373 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2374 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2375 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2376 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2377 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2378 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2379 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2380 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2381
2382 @node Working Directory
2383 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2384
2385 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2386 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2387 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2388 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2389 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2390 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2391
2392 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2393 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2394 Specify Files}.
2395
2396 @table @code
2397 @kindex cd
2398 @cindex change working directory
2399 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2400 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2401 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2402
2403 @kindex pwd
2404 @item pwd
2405 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2406 @end table
2407
2408 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2409 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2410 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2411 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2412 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2413 current working directory of the debuggee.
2414
2415 @node Input/Output
2416 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2417
2418 @cindex redirection
2419 @cindex i/o
2420 @cindex terminal
2421 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2422 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2423 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2424 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2425 running your program.
2426
2427 @table @code
2428 @kindex info terminal
2429 @item info terminal
2430 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2431 program is using.
2432 @end table
2433
2434 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2435 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2436
2437 @smallexample
2438 run > outfile
2439 @end smallexample
2440
2441 @noindent
2442 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2443
2444 @kindex tty
2445 @cindex controlling terminal
2446 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2447 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2448 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2449 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2450 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2451
2452 @smallexample
2453 tty /dev/ttyb
2454 @end smallexample
2455
2456 @noindent
2457 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2458 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2459 that as their controlling terminal.
2460
2461 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2462 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2463 terminal.
2464
2465 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2466 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2467 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2468 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2469
2470 @cindex inferior tty
2471 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2472 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2473 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2474 program.
2475
2476 @table @code
2477 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2478 @kindex set inferior-tty
2479 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2480
2481 @item show inferior-tty
2482 @kindex show inferior-tty
2483 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2484 @end table
2485
2486 @node Attach
2487 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2488 @kindex attach
2489 @cindex attach
2490
2491 @table @code
2492 @item attach @var{process-id}
2493 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2494 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2495 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2496 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2497 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2498
2499 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2500 executing the command.
2501 @end table
2502
2503 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2504 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2505 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2506 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2507
2508 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2509 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2510 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2511 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2512 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2513 Specify Files}.
2514
2515 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2516 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2517 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2518 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2519 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2520 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2521 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2522
2523 @table @code
2524 @kindex detach
2525 @item detach
2526 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2527 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2528 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2529 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2530 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2531 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2532 executing the command.
2533 @end table
2534
2535 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2536 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2537 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2538 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2539 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2540 Messages}).
2541
2542 @node Kill Process
2543 @section Killing the Child Process
2544
2545 @table @code
2546 @kindex kill
2547 @item kill
2548 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2549 @end table
2550
2551 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2552 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2553 is running.
2554
2555 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2556 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2557 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2558 outside the debugger.
2559
2560 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2561 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2562 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2563 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2564 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2565 breakpoint settings).
2566
2567 @node Inferiors and Programs
2568 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2569
2570 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2571 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2572 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2573 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2574 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2575 from multiple executables.
2576
2577 @cindex inferior
2578 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2579 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2580 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2581 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2582 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2583 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2584 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2585 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2586 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2587 threads running in it.
2588
2589 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2590 inferiors}}:
2591
2592 @table @code
2593 @kindex info inferiors
2594 @item info inferiors
2595 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2596
2597 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2598
2599 @enumerate
2600 @item
2601 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2602
2603 @item
2604 the target system's inferior identifier
2605
2606 @item
2607 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2608
2609 @end enumerate
2610
2611 @noindent
2612 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2613 indicates the current inferior.
2614
2615 For example,
2616 @end table
2617 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2618
2619 @smallexample
2620 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2621 Num Description Executable
2622 2 process 2307 hello
2623 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2624 @end smallexample
2625
2626 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2627
2628 @table @code
2629 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2630 @item inferior @var{infno}
2631 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2632 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2633 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2634 @end table
2635
2636
2637 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2638 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2639 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2640 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2641 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2642 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2643
2644 @table @code
2645 @kindex add-inferior
2646 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2647 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2648 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2649 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2650 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2651 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2652
2653 @kindex clone-inferior
2654 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2655 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2656 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2657 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2658 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2659
2660 @smallexample
2661 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2662 Num Description Executable
2663 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2664 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2665 Added inferior 2.
2666 1 inferiors added.
2667 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2668 Num Description Executable
2669 2 <null> helloworld
2670 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2671 @end smallexample
2672
2673 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2674
2675 @kindex remove-inferiors
2676 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2677 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2678 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2679 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2680
2681 @end table
2682
2683 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2684 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2685 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2686 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2687
2688 @table @code
2689 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2690 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2691 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2692 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2693 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2694 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2695
2696 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2697 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2698 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2699 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2700 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2701 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2702 @end table
2703
2704 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2705 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2706 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2707 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2708
2709
2710 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2711 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2712
2713 @table @code
2714 @kindex set print inferior-events
2715 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2716 @item set print inferior-events
2717 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2718 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2719 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2720 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2721 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2722 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2723
2724 @kindex show print inferior-events
2725 @item show print inferior-events
2726 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2727 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2728 @end table
2729
2730 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2731 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2732 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2733
2734
2735 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2736 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2737 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2738 info program-spaces}} command.
2739
2740 @table @code
2741 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2742 @item maint info program-spaces
2743 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2744 @value{GDBN}.
2745
2746 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2747
2748 @enumerate
2749 @item
2750 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2751
2752 @item
2753 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2754 the @code{file} command.
2755
2756 @end enumerate
2757
2758 @noindent
2759 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2760 indicates the current program space.
2761
2762 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2763 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2764 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2765
2766 @smallexample
2767 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2768 Id Executable
2769 2 goodbye
2770 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2771 * 1 hello
2772 @end smallexample
2773
2774 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2775 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2776 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2777 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2778 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2779
2780 @smallexample
2781 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2782 Id Executable
2783 * 1 vfork-test
2784 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2785 @end smallexample
2786
2787 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2788 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2789 @end table
2790
2791 @node Threads
2792 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2793
2794 @cindex threads of execution
2795 @cindex multiple threads
2796 @cindex switching threads
2797 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2798 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2799 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2800 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2801 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2802 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2803 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2804
2805 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2806 programs:
2807
2808 @itemize @bullet
2809 @item automatic notification of new threads
2810 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2811 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2812 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2813 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2814 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2815 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2816 messages on thread start and exit.
2817 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2818 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2819 isn't compatible with the program.
2820 @end itemize
2821
2822 @quotation
2823 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2824 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2825 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2826 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2827 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2828 like this:
2829
2830 @smallexample
2831 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2832 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2833 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2834 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2835 @end smallexample
2836 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2837 @c doesn't support threads"?
2838 @end quotation
2839
2840 @cindex focus of debugging
2841 @cindex current thread
2842 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2843 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2844 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2845 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2846 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2847
2848 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2849 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2850 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2851 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2852 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2853 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2854 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2855 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2856 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2857 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2858
2859 @smallexample
2860 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2861 @end smallexample
2862
2863 @noindent
2864 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2865 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2866 further qualifier.
2867
2868 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2869 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2870 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2871 @c program?
2872 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2873 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2874 @c threads ab initio?
2875
2876 @cindex thread number
2877 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2878 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2879 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2880
2881 @table @code
2882 @kindex info threads
2883 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2884 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2885 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2886 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2887 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2888
2889 @enumerate
2890 @item
2891 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2892
2893 @item
2894 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2895
2896 @item
2897 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2898 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2899 program itself.
2900
2901 @item
2902 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2903 @end enumerate
2904
2905 @noindent
2906 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2907 indicates the current thread.
2908
2909 For example,
2910 @end table
2911 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2912
2913 @smallexample
2914 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2915 Id Target Id Frame
2916 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2917 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2918 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2919 at threadtest.c:68
2920 @end smallexample
2921
2922 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2923 Solaris-specific command:
2924
2925 @table @code
2926 @item maint info sol-threads
2927 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2928 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2929 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2930 @end table
2931
2932 @table @code
2933 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2934 @item thread @var{threadno}
2935 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2936 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2937 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2938 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2939 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2940
2941 @smallexample
2942 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2943 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2944 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2945 8 printf ("hello\n");
2946 @end smallexample
2947
2948 @noindent
2949 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2950 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2951 threads.
2952
2953 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2954 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2955 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2956 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2957 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2958 information on convenience variables.
2959
2960 @kindex thread apply
2961 @cindex apply command to several threads
2962 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all] @var{command}
2963 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2964 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2965 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2966 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2967 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2968 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2969 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2970
2971 @kindex thread name
2972 @cindex name a thread
2973 @item thread name [@var{name}]
2974 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
2975 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
2976 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
2977
2978 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
2979 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
2980 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
2981 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
2982 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
2983
2984 @kindex thread find
2985 @cindex search for a thread
2986 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
2987 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
2988 matches the supplied regular expression.
2989
2990 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
2991 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
2992 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
2993 is the LWP id.
2994
2995 @smallexample
2996 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
2997 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
2998 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
2999 Id Target Id Frame
3000 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3001 @end smallexample
3002
3003 @kindex set print thread-events
3004 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3005 @item set print thread-events
3006 @itemx set print thread-events on
3007 @itemx set print thread-events off
3008 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3009 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3010 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3011 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3012 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3013
3014 @kindex show print thread-events
3015 @item show print thread-events
3016 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3017 have started and exited.
3018 @end table
3019
3020 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3021 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3022 programs with multiple threads.
3023
3024 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3025 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3026
3027 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3028 @table @code
3029 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3030 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3031 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3032 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3033 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3034 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3035 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3036 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3037 macro.
3038
3039 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3040 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3041 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3042 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3043 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3044 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3045
3046 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3047 refers to the default system directories that are
3048 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3049 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3050 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3051
3052 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3053 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3054 was loaded in the inferior process.
3055
3056 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3057 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3058 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3059 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3060 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3061 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3062 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3063
3064 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3065 only on some platforms.
3066
3067 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3068 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3069 Display current libthread_db search path.
3070
3071 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3072 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3073 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3074 @item set debug libthread-db
3075 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3076 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3077 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3078 @end table
3079
3080 @node Forks
3081 @section Debugging Forks
3082
3083 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3084 @cindex multiple processes
3085 @cindex processes, multiple
3086 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3087 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3088 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3089 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3090 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3091 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3092 will cause it to terminate.
3093
3094 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3095 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3096 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3097 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3098 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3099 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3100 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3101 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3102 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3103 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3104
3105 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3106 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3107 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3108 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3109
3110 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3111 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3112
3113 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3114 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3115
3116 @table @code
3117 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3118 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3119 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3120 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3121 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3122
3123 @table @code
3124 @item parent
3125 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3126 unimpeded. This is the default.
3127
3128 @item child
3129 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3130 unimpeded.
3131
3132 @end table
3133
3134 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3135 @item show follow-fork-mode
3136 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3137 @end table
3138
3139 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3140 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3141 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3142
3143 @table @code
3144 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3145 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3146 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3147 retain debugger control over them both.
3148
3149 @table @code
3150 @item on
3151 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3152 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3153 independently. This is the default.
3154
3155 @item off
3156 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3157 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3158 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3159 is held suspended.
3160
3161 @end table
3162
3163 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3164 @item show detach-on-fork
3165 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3166 @end table
3167
3168 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3169 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3170 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3171 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3172 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3173 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3174
3175 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3176 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3177 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3178 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3179 and Programs}.
3180
3181 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3182 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3183 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3184 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3185 the child process's @code{main}.
3186
3187 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3188 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3189
3190 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3191 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3192 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3193 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3194 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3195 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3196 command.
3197
3198 @table @code
3199 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3200 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3201
3202 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3203 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3204
3205 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3206
3207 @table @code
3208 @item new
3209 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3210 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3211 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3212 original inferior.
3213
3214 For example:
3215
3216 @smallexample
3217 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3218 (gdb) info inferior
3219 Id Description Executable
3220 * 1 <null> prog1
3221 (@value{GDBP}) run
3222 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3223 Program exited normally.
3224 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3225 Id Description Executable
3226 * 2 <null> prog2
3227 1 <null> prog1
3228 @end smallexample
3229
3230 @item same
3231 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3232 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3233 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3234 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3235 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3236
3237 For example:
3238
3239 @smallexample
3240 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3241 Id Description Executable
3242 * 1 <null> prog1
3243 (@value{GDBP}) run
3244 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3245 Program exited normally.
3246 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3247 Id Description Executable
3248 * 1 <null> prog2
3249 @end smallexample
3250
3251 @end table
3252 @end table
3253
3254 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3255 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3256 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3257
3258 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3259 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3260
3261 @cindex checkpoint
3262 @cindex restart
3263 @cindex bookmark
3264 @cindex snapshot of a process
3265 @cindex rewind program state
3266
3267 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3268 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3269 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3270 later.
3271
3272 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3273 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3274 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3275 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3276 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3277
3278 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3279 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3280 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3281 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3282 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3283 start again from there.
3284
3285 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3286 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3287
3288 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3289
3290 @table @code
3291 @kindex checkpoint
3292 @item checkpoint
3293 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3294 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3295 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3296
3297 @kindex info checkpoints
3298 @item info checkpoints
3299 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3300 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3301 listed:
3302
3303 @table @code
3304 @item Checkpoint ID
3305 @item Process ID
3306 @item Code Address
3307 @item Source line, or label
3308 @end table
3309
3310 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3311 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3312 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3313 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3314 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3315 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3316 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3317
3318 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3319 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3320 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3321 the debugger.
3322
3323 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3324 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3325 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3326
3327 @end table
3328
3329 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3330 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3331 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3332 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3333 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3334 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3335 previously read data can be read again.
3336
3337 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3338 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3339 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3340 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3341 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3342 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3343
3344 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3345 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3346 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3347 different execution path this time.
3348
3349 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3350 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3351 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3352 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3353 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3354 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3355 potentially pose a problem.
3356
3357 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3358
3359 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3360 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3361 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3362 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3363 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3364 next.
3365
3366 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3367 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3368 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3369 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3370 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3371
3372 @node Stopping
3373 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3374
3375 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3376 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3377 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3378
3379 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3380 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3381 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3382 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3383 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3384 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3385 explicitly request this information at any time.
3386
3387 @table @code
3388 @kindex info program
3389 @item info program
3390 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3391 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3392 @end table
3393
3394 @menu
3395 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3396 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3397 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3398 Skipping over functions and files
3399 * Signals:: Signals
3400 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3401 @end menu
3402
3403 @node Breakpoints
3404 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3405
3406 @cindex breakpoints
3407 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3408 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3409 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3410 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3411 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3412 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3413 program.
3414
3415 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3416 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3417 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3418 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3419 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3420 call).
3421
3422 @cindex watchpoints
3423 @cindex data breakpoints
3424 @cindex memory tracing
3425 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3426 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3427 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3428 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3429 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3430 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3431 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3432 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3433 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3434 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3435 same commands.
3436
3437 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3438 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3439 Automatic Display}.
3440
3441 @cindex catchpoints
3442 @cindex breakpoint on events
3443 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3444 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3445 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3446 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3447 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3448 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3449 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3450
3451 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3452 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3453 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3454 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3455 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3456 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3457 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3458 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3459 enable it again.
3460
3461 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3462 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3463 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3464 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3465 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3466 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3467 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3468
3469 @menu
3470 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3471 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3472 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3473 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3474 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3475 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3476 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3477 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3478 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3479 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3480 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3481 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3482 @end menu
3483
3484 @node Set Breaks
3485 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3486
3487 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3488 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3489 @c
3490 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3491
3492 @kindex break
3493 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3494 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3495 @cindex latest breakpoint
3496 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3497 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3498 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3499 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3500 convenience variables.
3501
3502 @table @code
3503 @item break @var{location}
3504 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3505 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3506 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3507 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3508 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3509
3510 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3511 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3512 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3513 that situation.
3514
3515 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3516 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3517 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3518
3519 @item break
3520 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3521 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3522 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3523 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3524 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3525 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3526 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3527 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3528 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3529 inside loops.
3530
3531 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3532 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3533 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3534 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3535 existed when your program stopped.
3536
3537 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3538 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3539 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3540 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3541 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3542 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3543 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3544
3545 @kindex tbreak
3546 @item tbreak @var{args}
3547 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3548 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3549 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3550 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3551
3552 @kindex hbreak
3553 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3554 @item hbreak @var{args}
3555 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3556 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3557 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3558 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3559 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3560 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3561 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3562 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3563 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3564 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3565 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3566 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3567 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3568 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3569 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3570 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3571 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3572 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3573
3574 @kindex thbreak
3575 @item thbreak @var{args}
3576 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3577 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3578 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3579 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3580 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3581 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3582 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3583 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3584
3585 @kindex rbreak
3586 @cindex regular expression
3587 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3588 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3589 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3590 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3591 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3592 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3593 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3594 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3595 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3596
3597 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3598 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3599 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3600 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3601 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3602 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3603
3604 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3605 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3606 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3607 classes.
3608
3609 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3610 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3611 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3612
3613 @smallexample
3614 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3615 @end smallexample
3616
3617 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3618 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3619 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3620 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3621 every function in a given file:
3622
3623 @smallexample
3624 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3625 @end smallexample
3626
3627 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3628 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3629
3630 @kindex info breakpoints
3631 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3632 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3633 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3634 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3635 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3636 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3637 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3638
3639 @table @emph
3640 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3641 @item Type
3642 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3643 @item Disposition
3644 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3645 @item Enabled or Disabled
3646 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3647 that are not enabled.
3648 @item Address
3649 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3650 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3651 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3652 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3653 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3654 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3655 @item What
3656 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3657 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3658 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3659 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3660 @end table
3661
3662 @noindent
3663 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3664 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3665 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3666 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3667 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3668 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3669
3670 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3671 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3672 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3673 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3674
3675 @noindent
3676 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3677 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3678 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3679 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3680 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3681
3682 @noindent
3683 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3684 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3685 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3686 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3687 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3688 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3689
3690 @noindent
3691 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3692 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3693
3694 @end table
3695
3696 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3697 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3698 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3699 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3700
3701 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3702 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3703 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3704 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3705
3706 @itemize @bullet
3707 @item
3708 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3709
3710 @item
3711 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3712 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3713
3714 @item
3715 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3716 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3717
3718 @item
3719 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3720 several places where that function is inlined.
3721 @end itemize
3722
3723 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3724 the relevant locations.
3725
3726 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3727 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3728 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3729 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3730 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3731 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3732 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3733
3734 For example:
3735
3736 @smallexample
3737 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3738 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3739 stop only if i==1
3740 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3741 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3742 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3743 @end smallexample
3744
3745 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3746 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3747 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3748 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3749 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3750 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3751 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3752 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3753 that belong to that breakpoint.
3754
3755 @cindex pending breakpoints
3756 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3757 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3758 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3759 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3760 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3761 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3762 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3763 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3764 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3765 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3766 is not yet resolved.
3767
3768 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3769 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3770 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3771 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3772 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3773 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3774
3775 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3776 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3777 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3778 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3779
3780 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3781 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3782 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3783
3784 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3785 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3786 address specification to an address:
3787
3788 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3789 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3790 @table @code
3791 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3792 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3793 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3794
3795 @item set breakpoint pending on
3796 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3797 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3798
3799 @item set breakpoint pending off
3800 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3801 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3802 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3803
3804 @item show breakpoint pending
3805 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3806 @end table
3807
3808 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3809 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3810 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3811
3812 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3813 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3814 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3815 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3816 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3817 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3818 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3819 breakpoints.
3820
3821 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3822
3823 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3824 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3825 @table @code
3826 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3827 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3828 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3829 breakpoint must be used.
3830
3831 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3832 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3833 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3834 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3835 @end table
3836
3837 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3838 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3839 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3840 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3841 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3842 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3843 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3844 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3845 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3846
3847 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3848 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3849 @table @code
3850 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3851 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3852 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3853 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3854
3855 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3856 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3857 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3858 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3859 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3860 @end table
3861
3862 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3863 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3864 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3865
3866 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3867 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3868
3869 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3870
3871 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3872 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3873 @table @code
3874 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3875 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3876 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3877 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3878 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3879
3880 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3881 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3882 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3883 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3884 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3885 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3886 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3887 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3888 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3889 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3890 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3891 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3892 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3893
3894 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3895 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3896 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3897 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3898 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3899 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3900 @end table
3901
3902
3903 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3904 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3905 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3906 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3907 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3908 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3909 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3910 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3911
3912
3913 @node Set Watchpoints
3914 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3915
3916 @cindex setting watchpoints
3917 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3918 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3919 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3920 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3921 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3922
3923 @itemize @bullet
3924 @item
3925 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3926
3927 @item
3928 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3929 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3930 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3931
3932 @item
3933 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3934 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3935 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3936 @end itemize
3937
3938 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3939 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3940 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3941 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3942 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3943 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3944 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3945 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3946 the expression changes.
3947
3948 @cindex software watchpoints
3949 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3950 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3951 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3952 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3953 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3954 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3955 culprit.)
3956
3957 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3958 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3959 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3960
3961 @table @code
3962 @kindex watch
3963 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3964 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3965 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3966 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3967 to watch the value of a single variable:
3968
3969 @smallexample
3970 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3971 @end smallexample
3972
3973 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3974 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3975 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3976 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3977 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3978 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3979
3980 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
3981 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
3982 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
3983 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
3984 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
3985 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
3986 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
3987 error.
3988
3989 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
3990 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
3991 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
3992 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
3993 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
3994 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
3995 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
3996 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
3997 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
3998 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
3999 Examples:
4000
4001 @smallexample
4002 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4003 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4004 @end smallexample
4005
4006 @kindex rwatch
4007 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4008 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4009 by the program.
4010
4011 @kindex awatch
4012 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4013 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4014 or written into by the program.
4015
4016 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4017 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4018 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4019 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4020 @end table
4021
4022 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4023 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4024 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4025 a never-changing value:
4026
4027 @smallexample
4028 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4029 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4030 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4031 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4032 @end smallexample
4033
4034 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4035 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4036 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4037 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4038 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4039 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4040
4041 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4042 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4043 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4044 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4045 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4046 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4047 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4048 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4049
4050 @table @code
4051 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4052 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4053 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4054
4055 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4056 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4057 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4058 @end table
4059
4060 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4061 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4062 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4063
4064 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4065
4066 @smallexample
4067 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4068 @end smallexample
4069
4070 @noindent
4071 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4072
4073 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4074 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4075 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4076 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4077 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4078 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4079 will print a message like this:
4080
4081 @smallexample
4082 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4083 @end smallexample
4084
4085 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4086 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4087 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4088 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4089 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4090 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4091 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4092 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4093
4094 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4095 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4096 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4097 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4098 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4099 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4100
4101 @smallexample
4102 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4103 @end smallexample
4104
4105 @noindent
4106 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4107
4108 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4109 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4110 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4111 expression with separately allocated resources.
4112
4113 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4114 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4115 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4116
4117 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4118 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4119 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4120 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4121 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4122 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4123 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4124 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4125 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4126
4127 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4128 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4129 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4130 watched expression from every thread.
4131
4132 @quotation
4133 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4134 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4135 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4136 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4137 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4138 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4139 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4140 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4141 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4142 @end quotation
4143
4144 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4145
4146 @node Set Catchpoints
4147 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4148 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4149 @cindex exception handlers
4150 @cindex event handling
4151
4152 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4153 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4154 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4155
4156 @table @code
4157 @kindex catch
4158 @item catch @var{event}
4159 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4160
4161 @table @code
4162 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4163 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4164 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4165 @kindex catch throw
4166 @kindex catch rethrow
4167 @kindex catch catch
4168 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4169 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4170
4171 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4172 regular expression will be caught.
4173
4174 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4175 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4176 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4177 exception being thrown.
4178
4179 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4180 @value{GDBN}:
4181
4182 @itemize @bullet
4183 @item
4184 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4185 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4186 supported.
4187
4188 @item
4189 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4190 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4191 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4192 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4193 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4194 built.
4195
4196 @item
4197 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4198 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4199
4200 @item
4201 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4202 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4203 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4204 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4205
4206 @item
4207 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4208 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4209 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4210 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4211 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4212 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4213 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4214 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4215 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4216
4217 @item
4218 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4219
4220 @item
4221 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4222 @end itemize
4223
4224 @item exception
4225 @kindex catch exception
4226 @cindex Ada exception catching
4227 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4228 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4229 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4230 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4231 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4232
4233 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4234 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4235 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4236 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4237 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4238 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4239 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4240 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4241
4242 @item exception unhandled
4243 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4244 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4245
4246 @item assert
4247 @kindex catch assert
4248 A failed Ada assertion.
4249
4250 @item exec
4251 @kindex catch exec
4252 @cindex break on fork/exec
4253 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4254 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4255
4256 @item syscall
4257 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4258 @kindex catch syscall
4259 @cindex break on a system call.
4260 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4261 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4262 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4263 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4264 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4265 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4266 will be caught.
4267
4268 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4269 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4270 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4271 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4272
4273 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4274 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4275 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4276 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4277
4278 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4279 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4280 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4281 available choices.
4282
4283 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4284 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4285 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4286 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4287 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4288 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4289 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4290 behind the OS upgrades).
4291
4292 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4293 arguments to it:
4294
4295 @smallexample
4296 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4297 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4298 (@value{GDBP}) r
4299 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4300
4301 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4302 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4303 (@value{GDBP}) c
4304 Continuing.
4305
4306 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4307 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4308 (@value{GDBP})
4309 @end smallexample
4310
4311 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4312
4313 @smallexample
4314 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4315 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4316 (@value{GDBP}) r
4317 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4318
4319 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4320 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4321 (@value{GDBP}) c
4322 Continuing.
4323
4324 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4325 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4326 (@value{GDBP})
4327 @end smallexample
4328
4329 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4330 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4331 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4332
4333 @smallexample
4334 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4335 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4336 (@value{GDBP}) r
4337 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4338
4339 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4340 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4341 (@value{GDBP}) c
4342 Continuing.
4343
4344 Program exited normally.
4345 (@value{GDBP})
4346 @end smallexample
4347
4348 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4349 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4350 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4351 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4352
4353 @smallexample
4354 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4355 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4356 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4357 (@value{GDBP})
4358 @end smallexample
4359
4360 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4361 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4362 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4363 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4364 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4365 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4366
4367 @smallexample
4368 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4369 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4370 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4371 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4372 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4373 (@value{GDBP})
4374 @end smallexample
4375
4376 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4377
4378 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4379 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4380
4381 @smallexample
4382 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4383 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4384 @end smallexample
4385
4386 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4387
4388 @item fork
4389 @kindex catch fork
4390 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4391 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4392
4393 @item vfork
4394 @kindex catch vfork
4395 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4396 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4397
4398 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4399 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4400 @kindex catch load
4401 @kindex catch unload
4402 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4403 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4404 matches one of the affected libraries.
4405
4406 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4407 @kindex catch signal
4408 The delivery of a signal.
4409
4410 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4411 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4412 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4413
4414 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4415 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4416 signal names.
4417
4418 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4419 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4420 will be caught.
4421
4422 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4423 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4424 catchpoint.
4425
4426 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4427 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4428 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4429 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4430 commands.
4431
4432 @end table
4433
4434 @item tcatch @var{event}
4435 @kindex tcatch
4436 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4437 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4438
4439 @end table
4440
4441 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4442
4443
4444 @node Delete Breaks
4445 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4446
4447 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4448 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4449 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4450 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4451 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4452 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4453
4454 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4455 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4456 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4457 their breakpoint numbers.
4458
4459 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4460 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4461 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4462
4463 @table @code
4464 @kindex clear
4465 @item clear
4466 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4467 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4468 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4469 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4470
4471 @item clear @var{location}
4472 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4473 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4474 most useful ones are listed below:
4475
4476 @table @code
4477 @item clear @var{function}
4478 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4479 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4480
4481 @item clear @var{linenum}
4482 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4483 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4484 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4485 @end table
4486
4487 @cindex delete breakpoints
4488 @kindex delete
4489 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4490 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4491 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4492 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4493 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4494 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4495 @end table
4496
4497 @node Disabling
4498 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4499
4500 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4501 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4502 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4503 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4504 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4505
4506 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4507 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4508 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4509 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4510 do not know which numbers to use.
4511
4512 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4513 affects all of its locations.
4514
4515 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4516 different states of enablement:
4517
4518 @itemize @bullet
4519 @item
4520 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4521 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4522 @item
4523 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4524 @item
4525 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4526 disabled.
4527 @item
4528 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4529 N times, then becomes disabled.
4530 @item
4531 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4532 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4533 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4534 @end itemize
4535
4536 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4537 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4538
4539 @table @code
4540 @kindex disable
4541 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4542 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4543 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4544 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4545 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4546 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4547 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4548
4549 @kindex enable
4550 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4551 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4552 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4553
4554 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4555 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4556 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4557
4558 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4559 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4560 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4561 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4562 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4563 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4564 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4565
4566 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4567 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4568 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4569 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4570 @end table
4571
4572 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4573 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4574 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4575 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4576 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4577 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4578 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4579 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4580 Stepping}.)
4581
4582 @node Conditions
4583 @subsection Break Conditions
4584 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4585 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4586
4587 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4588 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4589 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4590 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4591 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4592 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4593 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4594 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4595
4596 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4597 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4598 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4599 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4600 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4601
4602 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4603 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4604 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4605 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4606 one.
4607
4608 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4609 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4610 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4611 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4612 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4613 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4614 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4615 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4616 conditions for the
4617 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4618 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4619
4620 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4621 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4622 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4623 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4624 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4625 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4626
4627 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4628 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4629 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4630 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4631 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4632
4633 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4634 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4635 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4636 with the @code{condition} command.
4637
4638 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4639 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4640 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4641 catchpoint.
4642
4643 @table @code
4644 @kindex condition
4645 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4646 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4647 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4648 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4649 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4650 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4651 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4652 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4653 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4654 prints an error message:
4655
4656 @smallexample
4657 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4658 @end smallexample
4659
4660 @noindent
4661 @value{GDBN} does
4662 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4663 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4664 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4665
4666 @item condition @var{bnum}
4667 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4668 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4669 @end table
4670
4671 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4672 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4673 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4674 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4675 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4676 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4677 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4678 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4679 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4680 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4681 your program reaches it.
4682
4683 @table @code
4684 @kindex ignore
4685 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4686 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4687 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4688 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4689 takes no action.
4690
4691 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4692 a count of zero.
4693
4694 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4695 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4696 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4697 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4698
4699 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4700 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4701 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4702
4703 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4704 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4705 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4706 Variables}.
4707 @end table
4708
4709 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4710
4711
4712 @node Break Commands
4713 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4714
4715 @cindex breakpoint commands
4716 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4717 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4718 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4719 enable other breakpoints.
4720
4721 @table @code
4722 @kindex commands
4723 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4724 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4725 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4726 @itemx end
4727 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4728 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4729 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4730
4731 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4732 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4733
4734 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4735 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4736 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4737 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4738 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4739 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4740 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4741 Expressions}).
4742 @end table
4743
4744 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4745 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4746
4747 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4748 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4749 that resumes execution.
4750
4751 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4752 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4753 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4754 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4755 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4756
4757 @kindex silent
4758 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4759 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4760 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4761 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4762 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4763 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4764
4765 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4766 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4767 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4768
4769 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4770 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4771
4772 @smallexample
4773 break foo if x>0
4774 commands
4775 silent
4776 printf "x is %d\n",x
4777 cont
4778 end
4779 @end smallexample
4780
4781 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4782 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4783 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4784 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4785 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4786 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4787 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4788
4789 @smallexample
4790 break 403
4791 commands
4792 silent
4793 set x = y + 4
4794 cont
4795 end
4796 @end smallexample
4797
4798 @node Dynamic Printf
4799 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4800
4801 @cindex dynamic printf
4802 @cindex dprintf
4803 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4804 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4805 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4806 having to recompile it.
4807
4808 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4809 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4810 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4811 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4812 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4813 redirects to files and so forth.
4814
4815 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4816 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4817 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4818 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4819 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4820 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4821 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4822
4823 @table @code
4824 @kindex dprintf
4825 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4826 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4827 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4828 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4829
4830 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4831 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4832 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4833 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4834 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4835 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4836
4837 @item gdb
4838 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4839 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4840
4841 @item call
4842 @kindex dprintf-style call
4843 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4844 @code{printf}).
4845
4846 @item agent
4847 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4848 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4849 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4850 support running commands on the target.
4851
4852 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4853 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4854 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4855 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4856 command.
4857
4858 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4859 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4860 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4861 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4862 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4863 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4864
4865 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4866 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4867 you could do the following:
4868
4869 @example
4870 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4871 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4872 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4873 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4874 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4875 (gdb) info break
4876 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4877 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4878 continue
4879 (gdb)
4880 @end example
4881
4882 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4883 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4884 the variable settings.
4885
4886 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4887 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4888 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4889 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4890 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4891 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4892
4893 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4894 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4895 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4896
4897 @end table
4898
4899 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4900 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4901 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4902 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4903 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4904 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4905
4906 @node Save Breakpoints
4907 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4908
4909 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4910 breakpoints}} command.
4911
4912 @table @code
4913 @kindex save breakpoints
4914 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4915 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4916 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4917 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4918 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4919 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4920 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4921 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4922 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4923 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4924 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4925 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4926 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4927 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4928 that can no longer be recreated.
4929 @end table
4930
4931 @node Static Probe Points
4932 @subsection Static Probe Points
4933
4934 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4935 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4936 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4937 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations. They are
4938 usable from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages. See
4939 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4940 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.
4941
4942 Currently, @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4943 @acronym{SDT} probes are supported on ELF-compatible systems. See
4944 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4945 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT} probes
4946 in your applications.
4947
4948 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4949 Some probes have an associated semaphore variable; for instance, this
4950 happens automatically if you defined your probe using a DTrace-style
4951 @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore, @value{GDBN} will
4952 automatically enable it when you specify a breakpoint using the
4953 @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a breakpoint at a probe's
4954 location by some other method (e.g., @code{break file:line}), then
4955 @value{GDBN} will not automatically set the semaphore.
4956
4957 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
4958 probes}, with optional arguments:
4959
4960 @table @code
4961 @kindex info probes
4962 @item info probes stap @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
4963 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
4964 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
4965 probes from all providers are listed.
4966
4967 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
4968 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
4969 considered when deciding whether to display them.
4970
4971 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
4972 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
4973 given, all object files are considered.
4974
4975 @item info probes all
4976 List the available static probes, from all types.
4977 @end table
4978
4979 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
4980 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
4981 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
4982 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
4983 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
4984 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. Each probe argument is
4985 an integer of the appropriate size; types are not preserved. The
4986 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
4987 at the current probe point.
4988
4989 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
4990 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
4991 an error message.
4992
4993
4994 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4995 @node Error in Breakpoints
4996 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4997
4998 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4999 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5000
5001 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5002 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5003 @smallexample
5004 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5005 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5006 @end smallexample
5007
5008 @noindent
5009 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5010 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5011 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5012
5013 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5014 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5015
5016 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5017 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5018 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5019
5020 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5021 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5022 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5023 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5024
5025 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5026 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5027 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5028 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5029 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5030 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5031 first in the bundle.
5032
5033 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5034 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5035 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5036 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5037 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5038 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5039 is hit.
5040
5041 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5042 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5043
5044 @smallexample
5045 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5046 @end smallexample
5047
5048 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5049 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5050 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5051 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5052 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5053 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5054 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5055 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5056
5057 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5058 adjusted breakpoints:
5059
5060 @smallexample
5061 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5062 to 0x00010410.
5063 @end smallexample
5064
5065 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5066 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5067 frequently than expected.
5068
5069 @node Continuing and Stepping
5070 @section Continuing and Stepping
5071
5072 @cindex stepping
5073 @cindex continuing
5074 @cindex resuming execution
5075 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5076 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5077 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5078 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5079 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5080 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5081 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5082 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5083 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5084 handlers}).)
5085
5086 @table @code
5087 @kindex continue
5088 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5089 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5090 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5091 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5092 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5093 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5094 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5095 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5096 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5097 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5098
5099 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5100 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5101 @code{continue} is ignored.
5102
5103 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5104 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5105 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5106 @code{continue}.
5107 @end table
5108
5109 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5110 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5111 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5112 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5113
5114 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5115 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5116 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5117 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5118 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5119 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5120
5121 @table @code
5122 @kindex step
5123 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5124 @item step
5125 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5126 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5127 abbreviated @code{s}.
5128
5129 @quotation
5130 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5131 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5132 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5133 @c distinction here.
5134 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5135 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5136 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5137 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5138 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5139 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5140 below.
5141 @end quotation
5142
5143 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5144 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5145 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5146 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5147 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5148 called within the line.
5149
5150 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5151 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5152 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5153 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5154 was any debugging information about the routine.
5155
5156 @item step @var{count}
5157 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5158 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5159 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5160
5161 @kindex next
5162 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5163 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5164 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5165 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5166 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5167 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5168 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5169 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5170
5171 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5172
5173
5174 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5175 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5176 @c
5177 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5178 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5179 @c function are executed without stopping.
5180
5181 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5182 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5183 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5184
5185 @kindex set step-mode
5186 @item set step-mode
5187 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5188 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5189 @itemx set step-mode on
5190 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5191 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5192 information rather than stepping over it.
5193
5194 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5195 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5196 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5197
5198 @item set step-mode off
5199 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5200 debug information. This is the default.
5201
5202 @item show step-mode
5203 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5204 source line debug information.
5205
5206 @kindex finish
5207 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5208 @item finish
5209 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5210 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5211 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5212
5213 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5214 ,Returning from a Function}).
5215
5216 @kindex until
5217 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5218 @cindex run until specified location
5219 @item until
5220 @itemx u
5221 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5222 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5223 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5224 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5225 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5226 than the address of the jump.
5227
5228 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5229 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5230 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5231 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5232 through the next iteration.
5233
5234 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5235 stack frame.
5236
5237 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5238 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5239 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5240 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5241 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5242
5243 @smallexample
5244 (@value{GDBP}) f
5245 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5246 206 expand_input();
5247 (@value{GDBP}) until
5248 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5249 @end smallexample
5250
5251 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5252 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5253 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5254 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5255 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5256 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5257 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5258
5259 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5260 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5261 argument.
5262
5263 @item until @var{location}
5264 @itemx u @var{location}
5265 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5266 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5267 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5268 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5269 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5270 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5271 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5272 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5273 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5274 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5275 invocations have returned.
5276
5277 @smallexample
5278 94 int factorial (int value)
5279 95 @{
5280 96 if (value > 1) @{
5281 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5282 98 @}
5283 99 return (value);
5284 100 @}
5285 @end smallexample
5286
5287
5288 @kindex advance @var{location}
5289 @item advance @var{location}
5290 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5291 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5292 @ref{Specify Location}.
5293 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5294 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5295 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5296 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5297
5298
5299 @kindex stepi
5300 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5301 @item stepi
5302 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5303 @itemx si
5304 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5305
5306 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5307 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5308 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5309 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5310
5311 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5312
5313 @need 750
5314 @kindex nexti
5315 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5316 @item nexti
5317 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5318 @itemx ni
5319 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5320 proceed until the function returns.
5321
5322 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5323
5324 @end table
5325
5326 @anchor{range stepping}
5327 @cindex range stepping
5328 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5329 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5330 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5331 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5332 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5333 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5334 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5335 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5336 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5337 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5338 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5339 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5340 if necessary:
5341
5342 @table @code
5343 @kindex set range-stepping
5344 @kindex show range-stepping
5345 @item set range-stepping
5346 @itemx show range-stepping
5347 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5348
5349 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5350 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5351 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5352 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5353 default is @code{on}.
5354
5355 @end table
5356
5357 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5358 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5359 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5360
5361 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5362 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5363 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5364
5365 For example, consider the following C function:
5366
5367 @smallexample
5368 101 int func()
5369 102 @{
5370 103 foo(boring());
5371 104 bar(boring());
5372 105 @}
5373 @end smallexample
5374
5375 @noindent
5376 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5377 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5378 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5379 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5380
5381 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5382 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5383 is called from many places.
5384
5385 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5386 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5387 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5388 @code{foo}.
5389
5390 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5391 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5392
5393 @table @code
5394 @kindex skip function
5395 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5396 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5397 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5398 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5399 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5400
5401 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5402 will be skipped.
5403
5404 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5405 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5406
5407 @kindex skip file
5408 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5409 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5410 will be skipped over when stepping.
5411
5412 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5413 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5414 @end table
5415
5416 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5417 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5418
5419 @table @code
5420 @kindex info skip
5421 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5422 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5423 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5424 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5425
5426 @table @emph
5427 @item Identifier
5428 A number identifying this skip.
5429 @item Type
5430 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5431 @item Enabled or Disabled
5432 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5433 @item Address
5434 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5435 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5436 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5437 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5438 address here.
5439 @item What
5440 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5441 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5442 where it is defined.
5443 @end table
5444
5445 @kindex skip delete
5446 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5447 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5448 skips.
5449
5450 @kindex skip enable
5451 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5452 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5453 skips.
5454
5455 @kindex skip disable
5456 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5457 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5458 skips.
5459
5460 @end table
5461
5462 @node Signals
5463 @section Signals
5464 @cindex signals
5465
5466 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5467 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5468 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5469 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5470 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5471 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5472 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5473 requested an alarm).
5474
5475 @cindex fatal signals
5476 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5477 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5478 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5479 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5480 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5481 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5482
5483 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5484 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5485 signal.
5486
5487 @cindex handling signals
5488 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5489 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5490 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5491 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5492 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5493
5494 @table @code
5495 @kindex info signals
5496 @kindex info handle
5497 @item info signals
5498 @itemx info handle
5499 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5500 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5501 the defined types of signals.
5502
5503 @item info signals @var{sig}
5504 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5505
5506 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5507
5508 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5509 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5510 for details about this command.
5511
5512 @kindex handle
5513 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5514 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5515 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5516 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5517 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5518 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5519 say what change to make.
5520 @end table
5521
5522 @c @group
5523 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5524 Their full names are:
5525
5526 @table @code
5527 @item nostop
5528 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5529 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5530
5531 @item stop
5532 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5533 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5534
5535 @item print
5536 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5537
5538 @item noprint
5539 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5540 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5541
5542 @item pass
5543 @itemx noignore
5544 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5545 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5546 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5547
5548 @item nopass
5549 @itemx ignore
5550 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5551 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5552 @end table
5553 @c @end group
5554
5555 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5556 program until you
5557 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5558 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5559 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5560 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5561 program sees that signal when you continue.
5562
5563 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5564 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5565 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5566 erroneous signals.
5567
5568 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5569 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5570 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5571 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5572 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5573 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5574 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5575 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5576 Program a Signal}.
5577
5578 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5579 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5580
5581 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5582 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5583 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5584 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5585 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5586 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5587 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5588 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5589 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5590 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5591 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5592 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5593 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5594
5595 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5596
5597 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5598 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5599 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5600 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5601
5602 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5603 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5604 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5605 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5606
5607 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5608 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5609
5610 @smallexample
5611 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5612 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5613 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5614 (@value{GDBP}) c
5615 Continuing.
5616
5617 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5618 main () sigusr1.c:28
5619 28 p = 0;
5620 (@value{GDBP}) si
5621 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5622 9 @{
5623 @end smallexample
5624
5625 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5626 program to receive the signal first:
5627
5628 @smallexample
5629 (@value{GDBP}) n
5630 28 p = 0;
5631 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5632 (@value{GDBP}) si
5633 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5634 9 @{
5635 (@value{GDBP})
5636 @end smallexample
5637
5638 @cindex extra signal information
5639 @anchor{extra signal information}
5640
5641 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5642 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5643 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5644 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5645 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5646 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5647 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5648 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5649 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5650 system header.
5651
5652 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5653 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5654
5655 @smallexample
5656 @group
5657 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5658 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5659 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5660 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5661 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5662 type = struct @{
5663 int si_signo;
5664 int si_errno;
5665 int si_code;
5666 union @{
5667 int _pad[28];
5668 struct @{...@} _kill;
5669 struct @{...@} _timer;
5670 struct @{...@} _rt;
5671 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5672 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5673 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5674 @} _sifields;
5675 @}
5676 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5677 type = struct @{
5678 void *si_addr;
5679 @}
5680 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5681 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5682 @end group
5683 @end smallexample
5684
5685 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5686
5687 @node Thread Stops
5688 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5689
5690 @cindex stopped threads
5691 @cindex threads, stopped
5692
5693 @cindex continuing threads
5694 @cindex threads, continuing
5695
5696 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5697 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5698 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5699 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5700 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5701 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5702 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5703 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5704 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5705
5706 @menu
5707 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5708 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5709 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5710 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5711 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5712 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5713 @end menu
5714
5715 @node All-Stop Mode
5716 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5717
5718 @cindex all-stop mode
5719
5720 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5721 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5722 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5723 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5724 underfoot.
5725
5726 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5727 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5728 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5729
5730 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5731 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5732 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5733 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5734 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5735 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5736 stops.
5737
5738 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5739 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5740 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5741 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5742
5743 @cindex automatic thread selection
5744 @cindex switching threads automatically
5745 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5746 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5747 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5748 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5749 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5750 thread.
5751
5752 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5753 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5754
5755 @table @code
5756 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5757 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5758 @cindex lock scheduler
5759 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5760 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5761 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5762 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5763 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5764 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5765 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5766 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5767 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5768 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5769 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5770 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5771
5772 @item show scheduler-locking
5773 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5774 @end table
5775
5776 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5777 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5778 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5779 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5780 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5781 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5782 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5783 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5784 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5785 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5786 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5787 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5788 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5789 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5790
5791 @table @code
5792 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5793 @item set schedule-multiple
5794 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5795 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5796 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5797 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5798 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5799 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5800
5801 @item show schedule-multiple
5802 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5803 multiple processes.
5804 @end table
5805
5806 @node Non-Stop Mode
5807 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5808
5809 @cindex non-stop mode
5810
5811 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5812 @c with more details.
5813
5814 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5815 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5816 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5817 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5818 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5819 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5820
5821 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5822 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5823 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5824 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5825 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5826 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5827 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5828 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5829 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5830 independently and simultaneously.
5831
5832 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5833 or attach to your program:
5834
5835 @smallexample
5836 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5837 set pagination off
5838
5839 # Finally, turn it on!
5840 set non-stop on
5841 @end smallexample
5842
5843 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5844
5845 @table @code
5846 @kindex set non-stop
5847 @item set non-stop on
5848 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5849 @item set non-stop off
5850 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5851 @kindex show non-stop
5852 @item show non-stop
5853 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5854 @end table
5855
5856 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5857 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5858 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5859 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5860 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5861 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5862 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5863 default.
5864
5865 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5866 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5867 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5868
5869 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5870 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5871 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5872 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5873 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5874
5875 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5876 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5877 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5878 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5879 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5880
5881 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5882
5883 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5884 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5885 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5886 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5887 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5888 previously current thread.
5889
5890 @node Background Execution
5891 @subsection Background Execution
5892
5893 @cindex foreground execution
5894 @cindex background execution
5895 @cindex asynchronous execution
5896 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5897
5898 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5899 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5900 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5901 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5902 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5903 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5904
5905 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5906 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5907
5908 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5909 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5910 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5911 are:
5912
5913 @table @code
5914 @kindex run&
5915 @item run
5916 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5917
5918 @item attach
5919 @kindex attach&
5920 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5921
5922 @item step
5923 @kindex step&
5924 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5925
5926 @item stepi
5927 @kindex stepi&
5928 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5929
5930 @item next
5931 @kindex next&
5932 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5933
5934 @item nexti
5935 @kindex nexti&
5936 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5937
5938 @item continue
5939 @kindex continue&
5940 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5941
5942 @item finish
5943 @kindex finish&
5944 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5945
5946 @item until
5947 @kindex until&
5948 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5949
5950 @end table
5951
5952 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5953 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5954 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5955 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5956 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5957 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5958
5959 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5960 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5961
5962 @table @code
5963 @kindex interrupt
5964 @item interrupt
5965 @itemx interrupt -a
5966
5967 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5968 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5969 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5970 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5971 @end table
5972
5973 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5974 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5975
5976 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5977 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5978 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5979
5980 @table @code
5981 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5982 @cindex thread breakpoints
5983 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5984 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5985 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5986 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5987 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5988 specify some source line.
5989
5990 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5991 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5992 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{threadno} specifier
5993 is one of the numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
5994 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5995
5996 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5997 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5998 program.
5999
6000 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6001 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
6002 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6003
6004 @smallexample
6005 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6006 @end smallexample
6007
6008 @end table
6009
6010 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6011 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6012 thread list. For example:
6013
6014 @smallexample
6015 (@value{GDBP}) c
6016 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6017 @end smallexample
6018
6019 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6020 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6021 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6022 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6023 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6024 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6025 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6026 command.
6027
6028 @node Interrupted System Calls
6029 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6030
6031 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6032 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6033 @cindex premature return from system calls
6034 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6035 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6036 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6037 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6038 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6039 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6040 stop execution.
6041
6042 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6043 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6044 style anyways.
6045
6046 For example, do not write code like this:
6047
6048 @smallexample
6049 sleep (10);
6050 @end smallexample
6051
6052 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6053 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6054
6055 Instead, write this:
6056
6057 @smallexample
6058 int unslept = 10;
6059 while (unslept > 0)
6060 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6061 @end smallexample
6062
6063 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6064 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6065 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6066 @value{GDBN}.
6067
6068 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6069 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6070 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6071 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6072
6073 @node Observer Mode
6074 @subsection Observer Mode
6075
6076 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6077 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6078 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6079 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6080 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6081
6082 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6083 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6084 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6085 mode.
6086
6087 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6088 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6089 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6090 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6091 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6092
6093 @table @code
6094
6095 @kindex observer
6096 @item set observer on
6097 @itemx set observer off
6098 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6099 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6100 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6101 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6102
6103 @item show observer
6104 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6105
6106 @kindex may-write-registers
6107 @item set may-write-registers on
6108 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6109 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6110 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6111 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6112
6113 @item show may-write-registers
6114 Show the current permission to write registers.
6115
6116 @kindex may-write-memory
6117 @item set may-write-memory on
6118 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6119 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6120 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6121 defaults to @code{on}.
6122
6123 @item show may-write-memory
6124 Show the current permission to write memory.
6125
6126 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6127 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6128 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6129 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6130 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6131 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6132
6133 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6134 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6135
6136 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6137 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6138 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6139 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6140 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6141 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6142 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6143
6144 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6145 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6146
6147 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6148 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6149 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6150 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6151 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6152 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6153 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6154
6155 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6156 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6157
6158 @kindex may-interrupt
6159 @item set may-interrupt on
6160 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6161 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6162 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6163 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6164 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6165
6166 @item show may-interrupt
6167 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6168
6169 @end table
6170
6171 @node Reverse Execution
6172 @chapter Running programs backward
6173 @cindex reverse execution
6174 @cindex running programs backward
6175
6176 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6177 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6178 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6179 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6180
6181 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6182 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6183 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6184 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6185 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6186 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6187
6188 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6189 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6190 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6191 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6192 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6193 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6194 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6195 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6196 prior values@footnote{
6197 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6198 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6199 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6200
6201 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6202 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6203 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6204 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6205 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6206 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6207 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6208 }.
6209
6210 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6211 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6212
6213 @table @code
6214 @kindex reverse-continue
6215 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6216 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6217 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6218 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6219 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6220 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6221 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6222
6223 @kindex reverse-step
6224 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6225 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6226 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6227 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6228
6229 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6230 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6231 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6232 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6233 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6234 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6235
6236 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6237 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6238
6239 @kindex reverse-stepi
6240 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6241 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6242 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6243 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6244 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6245 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6246 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6247
6248 @kindex reverse-next
6249 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6250 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6251 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6252 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6253 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6254 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6255 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6256 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6257 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6258 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6259
6260 @kindex reverse-nexti
6261 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6262 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6263 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6264 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6265 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6266 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6267 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6268 frame) is reached.
6269
6270 @kindex reverse-finish
6271 @item reverse-finish
6272 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6273 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6274 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6275 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6276
6277 @kindex set exec-direction
6278 @item set exec-direction
6279 Set the direction of target execution.
6280 @item set exec-direction reverse
6281 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6282 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6283 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6284 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6285 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6286 @item set exec-direction forward
6287 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6288 This is the default.
6289 @end table
6290
6291
6292 @node Process Record and Replay
6293 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6294 @cindex process record and replay
6295 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6296
6297 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6298 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6299 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6300
6301 @cindex replay mode
6302 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6303 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6304 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6305 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6306 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6307 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6308 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6309 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6310 execution log.
6311
6312 @cindex record mode
6313 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6314 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6315 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6316 for future replay.
6317
6318 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6319 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6320 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6321 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6322 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6323 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6324
6325 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6326 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6327 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6328 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6329
6330 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6331 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6332
6333 @table @code
6334 @kindex target record
6335 @kindex target record-full
6336 @kindex target record-btrace
6337 @kindex record
6338 @kindex record full
6339 @kindex record btrace
6340 @kindex rec
6341 @kindex rec full
6342 @kindex rec btrace
6343 @item record @var{method}
6344 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6345 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6346 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6347 recording methods are available:
6348
6349 @table @code
6350 @item full
6351 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6352 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6353 execution.
6354
6355 @item btrace
6356 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6357 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6358 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited replay and
6359 reverse execution.
6360
6361 This recording method may not be available on all processors.
6362 @end table
6363
6364 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6365 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6366 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6367 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6368
6369 Both @code{record @var{method}} and @code{rec @var{method}} are
6370 aliases of @code{target record-@var{method}}.
6371
6372 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6373 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6374 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6375 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6376 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6377
6378 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6379 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6380 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6381 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6382 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6383 does not support these two modes.
6384
6385 @kindex record stop
6386 @kindex rec s
6387 @item record stop
6388 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6389 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6390 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6391
6392 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6393 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6394 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6395 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6396 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6397
6398 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6399 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6400 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6401 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6402 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6403
6404 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6405 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6406
6407 @kindex record goto
6408 @item record goto
6409 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6410 ways to specify the location to go to:
6411
6412 @table @code
6413 @item record goto begin
6414 @itemx record goto start
6415 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6416
6417 @item record goto end
6418 Go to the end of the execution log.
6419
6420 @item record goto @var{n}
6421 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6422 @end table
6423
6424 @kindex record save
6425 @item record save @var{filename}
6426 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6427 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6428 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6429
6430 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6431
6432 @kindex record restore
6433 @item record restore @var{filename}
6434 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6435 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6436
6437 @kindex set record full
6438 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6439 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6440 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6441 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6442
6443 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6444 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6445 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6446 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6447 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6448 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6449 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6450 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6451
6452 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6453 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6454 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6455
6456 @kindex show record full
6457 @item show record full insn-number-max
6458 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6459 recording method.
6460
6461 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6462 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6463 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6464 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6465 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6466 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6467 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6468 oldest one to be deleted.
6469
6470 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6471 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6472
6473 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6474 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6475
6476 @item set record full memory-query
6477 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6478 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6479 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6480 case.
6481
6482 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6483 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6484 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6485 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6486 results.
6487
6488 @item show record full memory-query
6489 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6490
6491 @kindex set record btrace
6492 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6493 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6494 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6495 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6496 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6497 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6498 You can use the following command for that:
6499
6500 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6501 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6502 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6503 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6504 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6505 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6506 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6507 position.
6508
6509 @kindex show record btrace
6510 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6511 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6512
6513 @kindex info record
6514 @item info record
6515 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6516 method:
6517
6518 @table @code
6519 @item full
6520 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6521 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6522
6523 @itemize @bullet
6524 @item
6525 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6526 @item
6527 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6528 @item
6529 Highest recorded instruction number.
6530 @item
6531 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6532 @item
6533 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6534 @item
6535 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6536 @end itemize
6537
6538 @item btrace
6539 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows the number of
6540 instructions that have been recorded and the number of blocks of
6541 sequential control-flow that is formed by the recorded instructions.
6542 @end table
6543
6544 @kindex record delete
6545 @kindex rec del
6546 @item record delete
6547 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6548 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6549 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6550 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6551
6552 @kindex record instruction-history
6553 @kindex rec instruction-history
6554 @item record instruction-history
6555 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6556 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6557 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6558 are printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify
6559 what part of the execution log to disassemble:
6560
6561 @table @code
6562 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6563 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6564 @var{insn}.
6565
6566 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6567 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6568 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6569 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6570 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6571 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6572
6573 @item record instruction-history
6574 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6575
6576 @item record instruction-history -
6577 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6578
6579 @item record instruction-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6580 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6581 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6582 number @var{end} is included.
6583 @end table
6584
6585 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6586
6587 @kindex set record
6588 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6589 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6590 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6591 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6592 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6593
6594 @kindex show record
6595 @item show record instruction-history-size
6596 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6597 instruction-history} command.
6598
6599 @kindex record function-call-history
6600 @kindex rec function-call-history
6601 @item record function-call-history
6602 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6603 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6604 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6605 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6606 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6607 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6608 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6609 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6610 given together.
6611
6612 @smallexample
6613 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6614 1 void foo (void)
6615 2 @{
6616 3 @}
6617 4
6618 5 void bar (void)
6619 6 @{
6620 7 ...
6621 8 foo ();
6622 9 ...
6623 10 @}
6624 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6625 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6626 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6627 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6628 @end smallexample
6629
6630 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6631 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6632 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6633 to print:
6634
6635 @table @code
6636 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6637 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6638
6639 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6640 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6641 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6642 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6643 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6644
6645 @item record function-call-history
6646 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6647
6648 @item record function-call-history -
6649 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6650
6651 @item record function-call-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6652 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6653 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6654 @end table
6655
6656 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6657
6658 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6659 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6660 Define how many lines to print in the
6661 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6662 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6663
6664 @item show record function-call-history-size
6665 Show how many lines to print in the
6666 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6667 @end table
6668
6669
6670 @node Stack
6671 @chapter Examining the Stack
6672
6673 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6674 stopped and how it got there.
6675
6676 @cindex call stack
6677 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6678 is generated.
6679 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6680 the arguments of the call,
6681 and the local variables of the function being called.
6682 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6683 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6684 stack}.
6685
6686 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6687 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6688
6689 @cindex selected frame
6690 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6691 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6692 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6693 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6694 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6695 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6696
6697 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6698 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6699 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6700
6701 @menu
6702 * Frames:: Stack frames
6703 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6704 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6705 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6706 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6707
6708 @end menu
6709
6710 @node Frames
6711 @section Stack Frames
6712
6713 @cindex frame, definition
6714 @cindex stack frame
6715 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6716 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6717 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6718 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6719 which the function is executing.
6720
6721 @cindex initial frame
6722 @cindex outermost frame
6723 @cindex innermost frame
6724 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6725 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6726 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6727 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6728 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6729 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6730 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6731 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6732
6733 @cindex frame pointer
6734 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6735 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6736 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6737 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6738 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6739 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6740
6741 @cindex frame number
6742 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6743 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6744 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6745 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6746 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6747
6748 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6749 @c underflow problems.
6750 @cindex frameless execution
6751 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6752 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6753 @smallexample
6754 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6755 @end smallexample
6756 generates functions without a frame.)
6757 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6758 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6759 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6760 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6761 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6762 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6763 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6764
6765 @table @code
6766 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6767 @cindex current stack frame
6768 @item frame @r{[}@var{framespec}@r{]}
6769 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6770 and to print the stack frame you select. The @var{framespec} may be either the
6771 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6772 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6773
6774 @kindex select-frame
6775 @cindex selecting frame silently
6776 @item select-frame
6777 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6778 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6779 @code{frame}.
6780 @end table
6781
6782 @node Backtrace
6783 @section Backtraces
6784
6785 @cindex traceback
6786 @cindex call stack traces
6787 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6788 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6789 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6790 stack.
6791
6792 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6793 @table @code
6794 @kindex backtrace
6795 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6796 @item backtrace
6797 @itemx bt
6798 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6799 frames in the stack.
6800
6801 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6802 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6803
6804 @item backtrace @var{n}
6805 @itemx bt @var{n}
6806 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6807
6808 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6809 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6810 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6811
6812 @item backtrace full
6813 @itemx bt full
6814 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6815 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6816 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
6817 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
6818
6819 @item backtrace no-filters
6820 @itemx bt no-filters
6821 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
6822 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
6823 @itemx bt no-filters full
6824 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
6825 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
6826 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
6827 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
6828 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
6829 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
6830 support.
6831 @end table
6832
6833 @kindex where
6834 @kindex info stack
6835 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
6836 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
6837
6838 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
6839 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
6840 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
6841 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
6842 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
6843 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
6844 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
6845 multi-threaded program.
6846
6847 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
6848 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
6849 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
6850 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
6851 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
6852 line number.
6853
6854 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
6855 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
6856
6857 @smallexample
6858 @group
6859 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6860 at builtin.c:993
6861 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
6862 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
6863 at macro.c:71
6864 (More stack frames follow...)
6865 @end group
6866 @end smallexample
6867
6868 @noindent
6869 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
6870 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
6871 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
6872
6873 @noindent
6874 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
6875 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
6876 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
6877 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
6878 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
6879
6880 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
6881 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
6882 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
6883 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
6884 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
6885 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
6886 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
6887 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
6888 such a backtrace might look like:
6889
6890 @smallexample
6891 @group
6892 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6893 at builtin.c:993
6894 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
6895 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
6896 at macro.c:71
6897 (More stack frames follow...)
6898 @end group
6899 @end smallexample
6900
6901 @noindent
6902 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
6903 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
6904
6905 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
6906 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
6907 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
6908
6909 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
6910 @cindex program entry point
6911 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
6912 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
6913 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
6914 @code{main}@footnote{
6915 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
6916 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
6917 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
6918 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
6919 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
6920 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
6921
6922 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
6923 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
6924
6925 @table @code
6926 @item set backtrace past-main
6927 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
6928 @kindex set backtrace
6929 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
6930
6931 @item set backtrace past-main off
6932 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
6933 default.
6934
6935 @item show backtrace past-main
6936 @kindex show backtrace
6937 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
6938
6939 @item set backtrace past-entry
6940 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
6941 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
6942 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
6943 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
6944
6945 @item set backtrace past-entry off
6946 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
6947 application. This is the default.
6948
6949 @item show backtrace past-entry
6950 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
6951
6952 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
6953 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
6954 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
6955 @cindex backtrace limit
6956 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
6957 or zero means unlimited levels.
6958
6959 @item show backtrace limit
6960 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
6961 @end table
6962
6963 You can control how file names are displayed.
6964
6965 @table @code
6966 @item set filename-display
6967 @itemx set filename-display relative
6968 @cindex filename-display
6969 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
6970
6971 @item set filename-display basename
6972 Display only basename of a filename.
6973
6974 @item set filename-display absolute
6975 Display an absolute filename.
6976
6977 @item show filename-display
6978 Show the current way to display filenames.
6979 @end table
6980
6981 @node Frame Filter Management
6982 @section Management of Frame Filters.
6983 @cindex managing frame filters
6984
6985 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
6986 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
6987
6988 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
6989 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
6990
6991 @table @code
6992 @kindex info frame-filter
6993 @item info frame-filter
6994 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
6995 their name, priority and enabled status.
6996
6997 @kindex disable frame-filter
6998 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
6999 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7000 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7001 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7002 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7003 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7004 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7005 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7006 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7007 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7008 may be enabled again later.
7009
7010 @kindex enable frame-filter
7011 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7012 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7013 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7014 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7015 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7016 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7017 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7018 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7019 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7020
7021 Example:
7022
7023 @smallexample
7024 (gdb) info frame-filter
7025
7026 global frame-filters:
7027 Priority Enabled Name
7028 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7029 100 Yes Reverse
7030
7031 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7032 Priority Enabled Name
7033 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7034
7035 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7036 Priority Enabled Name
7037 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7038
7039 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7040 (gdb) info frame-filter
7041
7042 global frame-filters:
7043 Priority Enabled Name
7044 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7045 100 Yes Reverse
7046
7047 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7048 Priority Enabled Name
7049 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7050
7051 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7052 Priority Enabled Name
7053 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7054
7055 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7056 (gdb) info frame-filter
7057
7058 global frame-filters:
7059 Priority Enabled Name
7060 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7061 100 Yes Reverse
7062
7063 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7064 Priority Enabled Name
7065 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7066
7067 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7068 Priority Enabled Name
7069 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7070 @end smallexample
7071
7072 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7073 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7074 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7075 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7076 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7077 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7078 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7079
7080 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7081 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7082 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7083 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7084 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7085 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7086 dictionary resides.
7087
7088 Example:
7089
7090 @smallexample
7091 (gdb) info frame-filter
7092
7093 global frame-filters:
7094 Priority Enabled Name
7095 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7096 100 Yes Reverse
7097
7098 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7099 Priority Enabled Name
7100 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7101
7102 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7103 Priority Enabled Name
7104 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7105
7106 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7107 (gdb) info frame-filter
7108
7109 global frame-filters:
7110 Priority Enabled Name
7111 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7112 50 Yes Reverse
7113
7114 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7115 Priority Enabled Name
7116 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7117
7118 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7119 Priority Enabled Name
7120 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7121 @end smallexample
7122 @end table
7123
7124 @node Selection
7125 @section Selecting a Frame
7126
7127 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7128 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7129 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7130 of the stack frame just selected.
7131
7132 @table @code
7133 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7134 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7135 @item frame @var{n}
7136 @itemx f @var{n}
7137 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7138 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7139 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7140 @code{main}.
7141
7142 @item frame @var{addr}
7143 @itemx f @var{addr}
7144 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7145 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7146 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7147 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7148 switches between them.
7149
7150 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
7151 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
7152
7153 On the @acronym{MIPS} and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
7154 pointer and a program counter.
7155
7156 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
7157 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
7158
7159 @kindex up
7160 @item up @var{n}
7161 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7162 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7163 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7164
7165 @kindex down
7166 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7167 @item down @var{n}
7168 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7169 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7170 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7171 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7172 @end table
7173
7174 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7175 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7176 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7177 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7178
7179 @need 1000
7180 For example:
7181
7182 @smallexample
7183 @group
7184 (@value{GDBP}) up
7185 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7186 at env.c:10
7187 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7188 @end group
7189 @end smallexample
7190
7191 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7192 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7193 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7194 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7195 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7196 for details.
7197
7198 @table @code
7199 @kindex down-silently
7200 @kindex up-silently
7201 @item up-silently @var{n}
7202 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7203 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7204 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7205 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7206 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7207 distracting.
7208 @end table
7209
7210 @node Frame Info
7211 @section Information About a Frame
7212
7213 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7214 stack frame.
7215
7216 @table @code
7217 @item frame
7218 @itemx f
7219 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7220 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7221 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7222 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7223 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7224
7225 @kindex info frame
7226 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7227 @item info frame
7228 @itemx info f
7229 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7230 including:
7231
7232 @itemize @bullet
7233 @item
7234 the address of the frame
7235 @item
7236 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7237 @item
7238 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7239 @item
7240 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7241 @item
7242 the address of the frame's arguments
7243 @item
7244 the address of the frame's local variables
7245 @item
7246 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7247 @item
7248 which registers were saved in the frame
7249 @end itemize
7250
7251 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7252 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7253 the usual conventions.
7254
7255 @item info frame @var{addr}
7256 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7257 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7258 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7259 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7260 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7261 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7262
7263 @kindex info args
7264 @item info args
7265 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7266
7267 @item info locals
7268 @kindex info locals
7269 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7270 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7271 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7272
7273 @end table
7274
7275
7276 @node Source
7277 @chapter Examining Source Files
7278
7279 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7280 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7281 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7282 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7283 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7284 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7285 source files by explicit command.
7286
7287 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7288 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7289 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7290
7291 @menu
7292 * List:: Printing source lines
7293 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7294 * Edit:: Editing source files
7295 * Search:: Searching source files
7296 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7297 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7298 @end menu
7299
7300 @node List
7301 @section Printing Source Lines
7302
7303 @kindex list
7304 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7305 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7306 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7307 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7308 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7309
7310 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7311
7312 @table @code
7313 @item list @var{linenum}
7314 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7315 current source file.
7316
7317 @item list @var{function}
7318 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7319 @var{function}.
7320
7321 @item list
7322 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7323 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7324 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7325 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7326 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7327
7328 @item list -
7329 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7330 @end table
7331
7332 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7333 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7334 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7335
7336 @table @code
7337 @kindex set listsize
7338 @item set listsize @var{count}
7339 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7340 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7341 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7342 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7343
7344 @kindex show listsize
7345 @item show listsize
7346 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7347 @end table
7348
7349 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7350 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7351 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7352 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7353 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7354
7355 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7356 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
7357 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7358 to specify some source line.
7359
7360 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7361
7362 @table @code
7363 @item list @var{linespec}
7364 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
7365
7366 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7367 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7368 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
7369 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
7370 the same source file as the first linespec.
7371
7372 @item list ,@var{last}
7373 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7374
7375 @item list @var{first},
7376 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7377
7378 @item list +
7379 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7380
7381 @item list -
7382 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7383
7384 @item list
7385 As described in the preceding table.
7386 @end table
7387
7388 @node Specify Location
7389 @section Specifying a Location
7390 @cindex specifying location
7391 @cindex linespec
7392
7393 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7394 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7395 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
7396 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
7397
7398 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
7399 @value{GDBN} understands:
7400
7401 @table @code
7402 @item @var{linenum}
7403 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7404
7405 @item -@var{offset}
7406 @itemx +@var{offset}
7407 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7408 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7409 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7410 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7411 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7412 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7413 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7414 linespec.
7415
7416 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7417 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7418 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7419 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7420 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7421 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7422 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7423
7424 @item @var{function}
7425 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7426 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7427
7428 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7429 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7430
7431 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7432 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7433 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7434 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7435 functions in different source files.
7436
7437 @item @var{label}
7438 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
7439 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
7440 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
7441 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
7442 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7443
7444 @item *@var{address}
7445 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
7446 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
7447 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
7448 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7449 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7450 source files.
7451
7452 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7453 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7454 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7455 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
7456 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
7457 of @var{address}:
7458
7459 @table @code
7460 @item @var{expression}
7461 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7462
7463 @item @var{funcaddr}
7464 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7465 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7466 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7467 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7468 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7469 (although the Pascal form also works).
7470
7471 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7472 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7473
7474 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
7475 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7476 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7477 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7478 functions with identical names in different source files.
7479 @end table
7480
7481 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7482 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7483 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7484 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7485 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7486 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7487
7488 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7489 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7490 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7491 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7492 each one of those probes.
7493
7494 @end table
7495
7496
7497 @node Edit
7498 @section Editing Source Files
7499 @cindex editing source files
7500
7501 @kindex edit
7502 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7503 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7504 The editing program of your choice
7505 is invoked with the current line set to
7506 the active line in the program.
7507 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7508 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7509
7510 @table @code
7511 @item edit @var{location}
7512 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7513 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7514 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7515 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7516 command most commonly used:
7517
7518 @table @code
7519 @item edit @var{number}
7520 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7521
7522 @item edit @var{function}
7523 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7524 @end table
7525
7526 @end table
7527
7528 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7529 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7530 @footnote{
7531 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7532 following command-line syntax:
7533 @smallexample
7534 ex +@var{number} file
7535 @end smallexample
7536 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7537 the file where to start editing.}.
7538 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7539 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7540 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7541 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7542 @smallexample
7543 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7544 export EDITOR
7545 gdb @dots{}
7546 @end smallexample
7547 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7548 @smallexample
7549 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7550 gdb @dots{}
7551 @end smallexample
7552
7553 @node Search
7554 @section Searching Source Files
7555 @cindex searching source files
7556
7557 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7558 regular expression.
7559
7560 @table @code
7561 @kindex search
7562 @kindex forward-search
7563 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7564 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7565 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7566 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7567 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7568 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7569 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7570 @code{fo}.
7571
7572 @kindex reverse-search
7573 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7574 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7575 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7576 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7577 this command as @code{rev}.
7578 @end table
7579
7580 @node Source Path
7581 @section Specifying Source Directories
7582
7583 @cindex source path
7584 @cindex directories for source files
7585 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7586 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7587 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7588 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7589 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7590 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7591 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7592
7593 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7594 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7595 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7596 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7597 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7598 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7599 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7600 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7601 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7602 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7603 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7604
7605 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7606 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7607 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7608 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7609 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7610 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7611
7612 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7613 source files.
7614
7615 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7616 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7617 each line is in the file.
7618
7619 @kindex directory
7620 @kindex dir
7621 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7622 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7623 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7624
7625 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7626 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7627
7628 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7629 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7630 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7631 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7632 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7633 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7634 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7635 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7636 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7637 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7638 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7639 name to look up the sources.
7640
7641 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7642 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7643 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7644 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7645 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7646 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7647 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7648 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7649
7650 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7651 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7652 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7653 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7654 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7655 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7656 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7657
7658 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7659 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7660 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7661 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7662 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7663 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7664 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7665 command.
7666
7667 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7668 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7669 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7670 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7671 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7672 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7673 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7674
7675 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7676 @cindex default source path substitution
7677 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7678 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7679 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7680 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7681 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7682 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7683 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7684 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7685 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7686 together.
7687
7688 @table @code
7689 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7690 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7691 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7692 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7693 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7694 part of absolute file names) or
7695 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7696 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7697
7698 @kindex cdir
7699 @kindex cwd
7700 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7701 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7702 @cindex compilation directory
7703 @cindex current directory
7704 @cindex working directory
7705 @cindex directory, current
7706 @cindex directory, compilation
7707 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7708 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7709 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7710 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7711 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7712 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7713
7714 @item directory
7715 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7716
7717 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7718 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7719
7720 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7721 @kindex set directories
7722 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7723 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7724
7725 @item show directories
7726 @kindex show directories
7727 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7728
7729 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7730 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7731 @kindex set substitute-path
7732 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7733 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7734 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7735
7736 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7737 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7738
7739 @smallexample
7740 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
7741 @end smallexample
7742
7743 @noindent
7744 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
7745 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7746 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7747
7748 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7749 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7750 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7751 the substitution.
7752
7753 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7754
7755 @smallexample
7756 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
7757 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
7758 @end smallexample
7759
7760 @noindent
7761 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
7762 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
7763 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
7764 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
7765
7766
7767 @item unset substitute-path [path]
7768 @kindex unset substitute-path
7769 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
7770 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
7771 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
7772
7773 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
7774
7775 @item show substitute-path [path]
7776 @kindex show substitute-path
7777 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
7778 which would rewrite that path, if any.
7779
7780 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
7781 rules.
7782
7783 @end table
7784
7785 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
7786 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
7787 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
7788
7789 @enumerate
7790 @item
7791 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
7792
7793 @item
7794 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
7795 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
7796 directories in one command.
7797 @end enumerate
7798
7799 @node Machine Code
7800 @section Source and Machine Code
7801 @cindex source line and its code address
7802
7803 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
7804 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
7805 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
7806 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
7807 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
7808 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
7809 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
7810 well as hex.
7811
7812 @table @code
7813 @kindex info line
7814 @item info line @var{linespec}
7815 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
7816 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
7817 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
7818 @end table
7819
7820 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
7821 the object code for the first line of function
7822 @code{m4_changequote}:
7823
7824 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
7825 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
7826 @smallexample
7827 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
7828 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
7829 @end smallexample
7830
7831 @noindent
7832 @cindex code address and its source line
7833 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
7834 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
7835 @smallexample
7836 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
7837 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
7838 @end smallexample
7839
7840 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
7841 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
7842 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
7843 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
7844 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
7845 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
7846 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
7847 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7848 Variables}).
7849
7850 @table @code
7851 @kindex disassemble
7852 @cindex assembly instructions
7853 @cindex instructions, assembly
7854 @cindex machine instructions
7855 @cindex listing machine instructions
7856 @item disassemble
7857 @itemx disassemble /m
7858 @itemx disassemble /r
7859 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
7860 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
7861 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
7862 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
7863 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
7864 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
7865 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
7866 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
7867 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
7868 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
7869
7870 @table @code
7871 @item @var{start},@var{end}
7872 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
7873 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
7874 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
7875 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
7876 @end table
7877
7878 @noindent
7879 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
7880 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
7881
7882 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
7883 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
7884
7885 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
7886 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
7887 @end table
7888
7889 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
7890 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
7891
7892 @smallexample
7893 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
7894 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
7895 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
7896 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
7897 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7898 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
7899 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
7900 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
7901 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
7902 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
7903 End of assembler dump.
7904 @end smallexample
7905
7906 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
7907 program is stopped just after function prologue:
7908
7909 @smallexample
7910 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
7911 Dump of assembler code for function main:
7912 5 @{
7913 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
7914 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
7915 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
7916 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
7917 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
7918
7919 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
7920 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
7921 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
7922
7923 7 return 0;
7924 8 @}
7925 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
7926 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
7927 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
7928
7929 End of assembler dump.
7930 @end smallexample
7931
7932 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
7933
7934 @smallexample
7935 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
7936 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
7937 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
7938 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
7939 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
7940 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
7941 End of assembler dump.
7942 @end smallexample
7943
7944 Addresses cannot be specified as a linespec (@pxref{Specify Location}).
7945 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
7946 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
7947 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
7948
7949 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
7950 mnemonics or other syntax.
7951
7952 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
7953 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
7954 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
7955 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
7956 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
7957
7958 @table @code
7959 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
7960 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
7961 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
7962 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
7963 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
7964 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
7965
7966 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
7967 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
7968 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
7969 assemblers for x86-based targets.
7970
7971 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
7972 @item show disassembly-flavor
7973 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
7974 @end table
7975
7976 @table @code
7977 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
7978 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
7979 @item set disassemble-next-line
7980 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
7981 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
7982 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
7983 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
7984 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
7985 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
7986 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
7987 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
7988 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
7989 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
7990 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
7991 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
7992 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
7993 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
7994 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
7995 instruction.
7996 @end table
7997
7998
7999 @node Data
8000 @chapter Examining Data
8001
8002 @cindex printing data
8003 @cindex examining data
8004 @kindex print
8005 @kindex inspect
8006 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8007 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8008 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8009 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8010 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8011 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8012
8013 @table @code
8014 @item print @var{expr}
8015 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8016 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8017 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8018 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8019 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8020 Formats}.
8021
8022 @item print
8023 @itemx print /@var{f}
8024 @cindex reprint the last value
8025 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8026 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8027 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8028 @end table
8029
8030 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8031 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8032 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8033
8034 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8035 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8036 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8037 Table}.
8038
8039 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8040 @kindex explore
8041 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8042 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8043 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8044 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8045 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8046 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8047 embedded in the higher level data types.
8048
8049 @table @code
8050 @item explore @var{arg}
8051 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8052 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8053 @end table
8054
8055 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8056 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8057 C program as
8058
8059 @smallexample
8060 struct SimpleStruct
8061 @{
8062 int i;
8063 double d;
8064 @};
8065
8066 struct ComplexStruct
8067 @{
8068 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8069 int arr[10];
8070 @};
8071 @end smallexample
8072
8073 @noindent
8074 followed by variable declarations as
8075
8076 @smallexample
8077 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8078 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8079 @end smallexample
8080
8081 @noindent
8082 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8083 @code{explore} command as follows.
8084
8085 @smallexample
8086 (gdb) explore cs
8087 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8088 the following fields:
8089
8090 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8091 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8092
8093 Enter the field number of choice:
8094 @end smallexample
8095
8096 @noindent
8097 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8098 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8099 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8100 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8101 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8102 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8103 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8104 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8105
8106 @smallexample
8107 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8108 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8109 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8110 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8111
8112 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8113 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8114
8115 Press enter to return to parent value:
8116 @end smallexample
8117
8118 @noindent
8119 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8120 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8121 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8122 to explore.
8123
8124 @smallexample
8125 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8126 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8127
8128 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8129
8130 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8131
8132 Press enter to return to parent value:
8133 @end smallexample
8134
8135 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8136 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8137 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8138 level data structure).
8139
8140 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8141 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8142 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8143 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8144 same example as above, your can explore the type
8145 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8146 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8147
8148 @smallexample
8149 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8150 @end smallexample
8151
8152 @noindent
8153 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8154 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8155 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8156 example.
8157
8158 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8159 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8160 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8161 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8162 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8163
8164 @table @code
8165 @item explore value @var{expr}
8166 @cindex explore value
8167 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8168 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8169 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8170 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8171 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8172
8173 @item explore type @var{arg}
8174 @cindex explore type
8175 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8176 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8177 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8178 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8179 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8180 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8181 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8182 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8183 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8184 @end table
8185
8186 @menu
8187 * Expressions:: Expressions
8188 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8189 * Variables:: Program variables
8190 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8191 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8192 * Memory:: Examining memory
8193 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8194 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8195 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8196 * Value History:: Value history
8197 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8198 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8199 * Registers:: Registers
8200 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8201 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8202 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8203 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8204 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8205 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8206 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8207 character set than GDB does
8208 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8209 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8210 @end menu
8211
8212 @node Expressions
8213 @section Expressions
8214
8215 @cindex expressions
8216 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8217 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8218 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8219 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8220 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8221 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8222 @ref{Compilation}.
8223
8224 @cindex arrays in expressions
8225 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8226 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8227 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8228 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8229 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8230 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8231
8232 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8233 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8234 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8235 languages.
8236
8237 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8238 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8239
8240 @cindex casts, in expressions
8241 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8242 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8243 at that address in memory.
8244 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8245
8246 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8247 to programming languages:
8248
8249 @table @code
8250 @item @@
8251 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8252 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8253
8254 @item ::
8255 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8256 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8257
8258 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8259 @cindex type casting memory
8260 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8261 @cindex casts, to view memory
8262 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8263 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8264 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8265 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8266 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8267 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8268 @end table
8269
8270 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8271 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8272 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8273
8274 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8275 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8276 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8277 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8278 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8279 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8280 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8281
8282 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8283 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8284 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8285 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8286 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8287 as well.
8288
8289 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8290 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8291 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8292 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8293 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8294 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8295 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8296 choices.
8297
8298 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8299 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8300 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8301
8302 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8303 @smallexample
8304 @group
8305 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8306 [0] cancel
8307 [1] all
8308 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8309 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8310 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8311 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8312 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8313 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8314 > 2 4 6
8315 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8316 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8317 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8318 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8319 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8320 breakpoints.
8321 (@value{GDBP})
8322 @end group
8323 @end smallexample
8324
8325 @table @code
8326 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8327 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8328 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8329
8330 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8331 is ambiguous.
8332
8333 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8334 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8335 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8336 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8337 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8338 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8339 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8340 in the use of the menu.
8341
8342 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8343 when an ambiguity is detected.
8344
8345 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8346 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8347
8348 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8349 @item show multiple-symbols
8350 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8351 @end table
8352
8353 @node Variables
8354 @section Program Variables
8355
8356 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8357 in your program.
8358
8359 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8360 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8361
8362 @itemize @bullet
8363 @item
8364 global (or file-static)
8365 @end itemize
8366
8367 @noindent or
8368
8369 @itemize @bullet
8370 @item
8371 visible according to the scope rules of the
8372 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8373 @end itemize
8374
8375 @noindent This means that in the function
8376
8377 @smallexample
8378 foo (a)
8379 int a;
8380 @{
8381 bar (a);
8382 @{
8383 int b = test ();
8384 bar (b);
8385 @}
8386 @}
8387 @end smallexample
8388
8389 @noindent
8390 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8391 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8392 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8393 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8394
8395 @cindex variable name conflict
8396 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8397 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8398 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8399 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8400 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8401 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8402 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8403
8404 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8405 @ifnotinfo
8406 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8407 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8408 @end ifnotinfo
8409 @smallexample
8410 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8411 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8412 @end smallexample
8413
8414 @noindent
8415 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8416 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8417 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8418 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8419
8420 @smallexample
8421 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8422 @end smallexample
8423
8424 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8425 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8426 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8427 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8428 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8429
8430 @smallexample
8431 void
8432 foo (int a)
8433 @{
8434 if (a < 10)
8435 bar (a);
8436 else
8437 process (a); /* Stop here */
8438 @}
8439
8440 int
8441 bar (int a)
8442 @{
8443 foo (a + 5);
8444 @}
8445 @end smallexample
8446
8447 @noindent
8448 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8449 here is what you might see
8450 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8451
8452 @smallexample
8453 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8454 $1 = 10
8455 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8456 $2 = 5
8457 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8458 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8459 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8460 $3 = 5
8461 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8462 $4 = 0
8463 @end smallexample
8464
8465 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8466 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8467 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8468 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8469 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8470
8471 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8472 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8473 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8474 @code{some_global}.
8475
8476 @smallexample
8477 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8478 $1 = 23
8479 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8480 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8481 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8482 $2 = 27
8483 @end smallexample
8484
8485 @cindex wrong values
8486 @cindex variable values, wrong
8487 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8488 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8489 @quotation
8490 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8491 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8492 scope, and just before exit.
8493 @end quotation
8494 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8495 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8496 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8497 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8498 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8499 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8500 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8501 variable definitions may be gone.
8502
8503 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8504 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8505 when compiling.
8506
8507 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8508 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8509 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8510 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8511 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8512 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8513 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8514
8515 @smallexample
8516 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8517 @end smallexample
8518
8519 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8520 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8521 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8522 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8523 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8524
8525 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8526 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8527 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8528 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8529
8530 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8531 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8532 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8533 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8534 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8535
8536 @smallexample
8537 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8538 29 i++;
8539 (gdb) next
8540 30 e (i);
8541 (gdb) print i
8542 $1 = 31
8543 (gdb) print i@@entry
8544 $2 = 30
8545 @end smallexample
8546
8547 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8548 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8549 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8550 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8551 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8552 For program code
8553
8554 @smallexample
8555 char var0[] = "A";
8556 signed char var1[] = "A";
8557 @end smallexample
8558
8559 You get during debugging
8560 @smallexample
8561 (gdb) print var0
8562 $1 = "A"
8563 (gdb) print var1
8564 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8565 @end smallexample
8566
8567 @node Arrays
8568 @section Artificial Arrays
8569
8570 @cindex artificial array
8571 @cindex arrays
8572 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8573 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8574 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8575 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8576 program.
8577
8578 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8579 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8580 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8581 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8582 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8583 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8584 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8585 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8586 example. If a program says
8587
8588 @smallexample
8589 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8590 @end smallexample
8591
8592 @noindent
8593 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8594
8595 @smallexample
8596 p *array@@len
8597 @end smallexample
8598
8599 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8600 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8601 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8602 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8603 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8604
8605 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8606 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8607 The value need not be in memory:
8608 @smallexample
8609 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8610 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8611 @end smallexample
8612
8613 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8614 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8615 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8616 @smallexample
8617 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8618 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8619 @end smallexample
8620
8621 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8622 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8623 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8624 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8625 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8626 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8627 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8628 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8629 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8630 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8631
8632 @smallexample
8633 set $i = 0
8634 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8635 @key{RET}
8636 @key{RET}
8637 @dots{}
8638 @end smallexample
8639
8640 @node Output Formats
8641 @section Output Formats
8642
8643 @cindex formatted output
8644 @cindex output formats
8645 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8646 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8647 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8648 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8649 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8650
8651 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8652 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8653 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8654 letters supported are:
8655
8656 @table @code
8657 @item x
8658 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8659 hexadecimal.
8660
8661 @item d
8662 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8663
8664 @item u
8665 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
8666
8667 @item o
8668 Print as integer in octal.
8669
8670 @item t
8671 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
8672 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
8673 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
8674 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
8675
8676 @item a
8677 @cindex unknown address, locating
8678 @cindex locate address
8679 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
8680 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
8681 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
8682
8683 @smallexample
8684 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
8685 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
8686 @end smallexample
8687
8688 @noindent
8689 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
8690 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
8691
8692 @item c
8693 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
8694 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
8695 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
8696 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
8697
8698 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
8699 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
8700 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
8701 data.
8702
8703 @item f
8704 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
8705 using typical floating point syntax.
8706
8707 @item s
8708 @cindex printing strings
8709 @cindex printing byte arrays
8710 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
8711 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
8712 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
8713 natural types.
8714
8715 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
8716 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
8717 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
8718 array.
8719
8720 @item z
8721 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
8722 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
8723 to the size of the integer type.
8724
8725 @item r
8726 @cindex raw printing
8727 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
8728 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
8729 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
8730 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
8731 pretty-printer which might exist.
8732 @end table
8733
8734 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
8735
8736 @smallexample
8737 p/x $pc
8738 @end smallexample
8739
8740 @noindent
8741 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
8742 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
8743
8744 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
8745 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
8746 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
8747
8748 @node Memory
8749 @section Examining Memory
8750
8751 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
8752 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
8753
8754 @cindex examining memory
8755 @table @code
8756 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
8757 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
8758 @itemx x @var{addr}
8759 @itemx x
8760 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
8761 @end table
8762
8763 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
8764 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
8765 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
8766 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
8767 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
8768
8769 @table @r
8770 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
8771 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
8772 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
8773 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
8774 @c 4.1.2.
8775
8776 @item @var{f}, the display format
8777 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
8778 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
8779 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
8780 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
8781 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
8782
8783 @item @var{u}, the unit size
8784 The unit size is any of
8785
8786 @table @code
8787 @item b
8788 Bytes.
8789 @item h
8790 Halfwords (two bytes).
8791 @item w
8792 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
8793 @item g
8794 Giant words (eight bytes).
8795 @end table
8796
8797 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
8798 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
8799 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
8800 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
8801 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
8802 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
8803 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
8804 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
8805 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
8806 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
8807 be altered.
8808
8809 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
8810 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
8811 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
8812 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
8813 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
8814 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
8815 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
8816 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
8817 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
8818 a value from memory).
8819 @end table
8820
8821 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
8822 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
8823 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
8824 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
8825 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
8826
8827 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
8828 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
8829 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
8830 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
8831 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
8832
8833 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
8834 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
8835 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
8836 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
8837 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
8838 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
8839 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
8840 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
8841 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
8842
8843 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
8844 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
8845 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
8846 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
8847 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
8848 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
8849 for successive uses of @code{x}.
8850
8851 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
8852 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
8853
8854 @smallexample
8855 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
8856 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
8857 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
8858 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
8859 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
8860 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
8861 @end smallexample
8862
8863 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
8864 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
8865 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
8866 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
8867 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
8868 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
8869 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
8870 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
8871 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
8872
8873 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
8874 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
8875 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
8876
8877 @cindex remote memory comparison
8878 @cindex target memory comparison
8879 @cindex verify remote memory image
8880 @cindex verify target memory image
8881 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
8882 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
8883 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
8884 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
8885 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
8886 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
8887
8888 @table @code
8889 @kindex compare-sections
8890 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
8891 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
8892 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
8893 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
8894 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
8895 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
8896
8897 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
8898 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
8899 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
8900 @end table
8901
8902 @node Auto Display
8903 @section Automatic Display
8904 @cindex automatic display
8905 @cindex display of expressions
8906
8907 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
8908 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
8909 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
8910 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
8911 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
8912 The automatic display looks like this:
8913
8914 @smallexample
8915 2: foo = 38
8916 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
8917 @end smallexample
8918
8919 @noindent
8920 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
8921 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
8922 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
8923 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
8924 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
8925 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
8926
8927 @table @code
8928 @kindex display
8929 @item display @var{expr}
8930 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
8931 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8932
8933 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8934
8935 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
8936 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
8937 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
8938 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
8939 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
8940
8941 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
8942 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
8943 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
8944 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
8945 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8946 @end table
8947
8948 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
8949 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
8950 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8951
8952 @table @code
8953 @kindex delete display
8954 @kindex undisplay
8955 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
8956 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8957 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
8958 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
8959 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
8960 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
8961 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8962
8963 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8964 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
8965
8966 @kindex disable display
8967 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8968 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
8969 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
8970 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
8971 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
8972 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
8973 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
8974 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8975
8976 @kindex enable display
8977 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
8978 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
8979 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
8980 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
8981 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
8982 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
8983 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
8984
8985 @item display
8986 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
8987 done when your program stops.
8988
8989 @kindex info display
8990 @item info display
8991 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
8992 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
8993 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
8994 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
8995 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
8996 @end table
8997
8998 @cindex display disabled out of scope
8999 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9000 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9001 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9002 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9003 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9004 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9005 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9006 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9007 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9008 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9009
9010 @node Print Settings
9011 @section Print Settings
9012
9013 @cindex format options
9014 @cindex print settings
9015 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9016 and symbols are printed.
9017
9018 @noindent
9019 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9020
9021 @table @code
9022 @kindex set print
9023 @item set print address
9024 @itemx set print address on
9025 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9026 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9027 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9028 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9029 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9030 @code{set print address on}:
9031
9032 @smallexample
9033 @group
9034 (@value{GDBP}) f
9035 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9036 at input.c:530
9037 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9038 @end group
9039 @end smallexample
9040
9041 @item set print address off
9042 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9043 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9044
9045 @smallexample
9046 @group
9047 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9048 (@value{GDBP}) f
9049 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9050 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9051 @end group
9052 @end smallexample
9053
9054 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9055 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9056 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9057 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9058
9059 @kindex show print
9060 @item show print address
9061 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9062 @end table
9063
9064 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9065 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9066 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9067 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9068 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9069 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9070 it prints a symbolic address:
9071
9072 @table @code
9073 @item set print symbol-filename on
9074 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9075 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9076 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9077 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9078
9079 @item set print symbol-filename off
9080 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9081 default.
9082
9083 @item show print symbol-filename
9084 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9085 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9086 @end table
9087
9088 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9089 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9090 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9091
9092 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9093 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9094
9095 @table @code
9096 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9097 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9098 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9099 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9100 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9101 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9102 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9103 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9104
9105 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9106 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9107 symbolic address.
9108 @end table
9109
9110 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9111 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9112 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9113 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9114 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9115 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9116 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9117 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9118
9119 @smallexample
9120 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9121 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9122 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9123 @end smallexample
9124
9125 @quotation
9126 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9127 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9128 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9129 @end quotation
9130
9131 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9132 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9133
9134 @table @code
9135 @item set print symbol on
9136 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9137 one exists.
9138
9139 @item set print symbol off
9140 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9141 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9142 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9143
9144 @item show print symbol
9145 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9146 address.
9147 @end table
9148
9149 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9150
9151 @table @code
9152 @item set print array
9153 @itemx set print array on
9154 @cindex pretty print arrays
9155 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9156 but uses more space. The default is off.
9157
9158 @item set print array off
9159 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9160
9161 @item show print array
9162 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9163 arrays.
9164
9165 @cindex print array indexes
9166 @item set print array-indexes
9167 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9168 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9169 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9170 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9171
9172 @item set print array-indexes off
9173 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9174
9175 @item show print array-indexes
9176 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9177 arrays.
9178
9179 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9180 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9181 @cindex number of array elements to print
9182 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9183 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9184 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9185 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9186 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9187 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9188 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9189 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9190
9191 @item show print elements
9192 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9193 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9194
9195 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9196 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9197 @cindex printing frame argument values
9198 @cindex print all frame argument values
9199 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9200 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9201 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9202 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9203 values are:
9204
9205 @table @code
9206 @item all
9207 The values of all arguments are printed.
9208
9209 @item scalars
9210 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9211 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9212 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9213 only scalar arguments are shown:
9214
9215 @smallexample
9216 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9217 at frame-args.c:23
9218 @end smallexample
9219
9220 @item none
9221 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9222 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9223
9224 @smallexample
9225 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9226 at frame-args.c:23
9227 @end smallexample
9228 @end table
9229
9230 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9231 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9232 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9233 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9234 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9235 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9236 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9237 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9238 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9239 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9240
9241 @item show print frame-arguments
9242 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9243
9244 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9245 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9246
9247 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9248 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9249 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9250 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9251 This is the default.
9252
9253 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9254 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9255
9256 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9257 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9258 @kindex set print entry-values
9259 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9260 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9261 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9262 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9263 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9264
9265 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9266 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9267 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9268 @code{no} setting.
9269
9270 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9271 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9272 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9273 this information.
9274
9275 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9276
9277 @table @code
9278 @item no
9279 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9280 point.
9281 @smallexample
9282 #0 equal (val=5)
9283 #0 different (val=6)
9284 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9285 #0 born (val=10)
9286 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9287 @end smallexample
9288
9289 @item only
9290 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9291 values are never printed.
9292 @smallexample
9293 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9294 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9295 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9296 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9297 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9298 @end smallexample
9299
9300 @item preferred
9301 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9302 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9303 value for such parameter.
9304 @smallexample
9305 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9306 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9307 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9308 #0 born (val=10)
9309 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9310 @end smallexample
9311
9312 @item if-needed
9313 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9314 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9315 parameter.
9316 @smallexample
9317 #0 equal (val=5)
9318 #0 different (val=6)
9319 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9320 #0 born (val=10)
9321 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9322 @end smallexample
9323
9324 @item both
9325 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9326 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9327 optimizations.
9328 @smallexample
9329 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9330 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9331 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9332 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9333 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9334 @end smallexample
9335
9336 @item compact
9337 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9338 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9339 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9340 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9341 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9342 @smallexample
9343 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9344 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9345 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9346 #0 born (val=10)
9347 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9348 @end smallexample
9349
9350 @item default
9351 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9352 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9353 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9354 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9355 @smallexample
9356 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9357 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9358 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9359 #0 born (val=10)
9360 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9361 @end smallexample
9362 @end table
9363
9364 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9365 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9366
9367 @item show print entry-values
9368 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9369 entry.
9370
9371 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9372 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9373 @cindex repeated array elements
9374 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9375 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9376 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9377 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9378 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9379 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9380 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9381 is 10.
9382
9383 @item show print repeats
9384 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9385 elements.
9386
9387 @item set print null-stop
9388 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9389 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9390 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9391 contain only short strings.
9392 The default is off.
9393
9394 @item show print null-stop
9395 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9396 @sc{null} character.
9397
9398 @item set print pretty on
9399 @cindex print structures in indented form
9400 @cindex indentation in structure display
9401 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9402 per line, like this:
9403
9404 @smallexample
9405 @group
9406 $1 = @{
9407 next = 0x0,
9408 flags = @{
9409 sweet = 1,
9410 sour = 1
9411 @},
9412 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9413 @}
9414 @end group
9415 @end smallexample
9416
9417 @item set print pretty off
9418 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9419
9420 @smallexample
9421 @group
9422 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9423 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9424 @end group
9425 @end smallexample
9426
9427 @noindent
9428 This is the default format.
9429
9430 @item show print pretty
9431 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9432
9433 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9434 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9435 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9436 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9437 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9438 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9439 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9440 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9441
9442 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9443 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9444 international character sets, and is the default.
9445
9446 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9447 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9448
9449 @item set print union on
9450 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9451 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9452 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9453
9454 @item set print union off
9455 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9456 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9457 instead.
9458
9459 @item show print union
9460 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9461 structures and other unions.
9462
9463 For example, given the declarations
9464
9465 @smallexample
9466 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9467 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9468 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9469 Bug_forms;
9470
9471 struct thing @{
9472 Species it;
9473 union @{
9474 Tree_forms tree;
9475 Bug_forms bug;
9476 @} form;
9477 @};
9478
9479 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9480 @end smallexample
9481
9482 @noindent
9483 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9484
9485 @smallexample
9486 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9487 @end smallexample
9488
9489 @noindent
9490 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9491
9492 @smallexample
9493 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9494 @end smallexample
9495
9496 @noindent
9497 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9498 and in Pascal.
9499 @end table
9500
9501 @need 1000
9502 @noindent
9503 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9504
9505 @table @code
9506 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9507 @item set print demangle
9508 @itemx set print demangle on
9509 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9510 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9511 linkage. The default is on.
9512
9513 @item show print demangle
9514 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9515
9516 @item set print asm-demangle
9517 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9518 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9519 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9520 The default is off.
9521
9522 @item show print asm-demangle
9523 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9524 or demangled form.
9525
9526 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9527 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9528 @kindex set demangle-style
9529 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9530 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9531 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9532
9533 @table @code
9534 @item auto
9535 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9536 This is the default.
9537
9538 @item gnu
9539 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9540
9541 @item hp
9542 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9543
9544 @item lucid
9545 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9546
9547 @item arm
9548 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9549 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9550 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9551 require further enhancement to permit that.
9552
9553 @end table
9554 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9555
9556 @item show demangle-style
9557 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9558
9559 @item set print object
9560 @itemx set print object on
9561 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9562 @cindex display derived types
9563 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9564 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9565 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9566 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9567 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9568 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9569 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9570
9571 @item set print object off
9572 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9573 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9574
9575 @item show print object
9576 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9577
9578 @item set print static-members
9579 @itemx set print static-members on
9580 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9581 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9582
9583 @item set print static-members off
9584 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9585
9586 @item show print static-members
9587 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9588
9589 @item set print pascal_static-members
9590 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9591 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9592 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9593 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9594
9595 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9596 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9597
9598 @item show print pascal_static-members
9599 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9600
9601 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9602 @item set print vtbl
9603 @itemx set print vtbl on
9604 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9605 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9606 @cindex VTBL display
9607 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9608 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9609 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9610
9611 @item set print vtbl off
9612 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9613
9614 @item show print vtbl
9615 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9616 @end table
9617
9618 @node Pretty Printing
9619 @section Pretty Printing
9620
9621 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9622 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9623 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9624
9625 @menu
9626 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9627 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9628 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9629 @end menu
9630
9631 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9632 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9633
9634 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9635 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9636 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9637
9638 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9639 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9640 pretty-printers with their names.
9641 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9642 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9643 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9644 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9645
9646 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
9647 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
9648 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9649 do anything special.
9650
9651 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9652
9653 @itemize @bullet
9654 @item
9655 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
9656 all inferiors.
9657
9658 @item
9659 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
9660 when debugging that program.
9661 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
9662
9663 @item
9664 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
9665 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
9666 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
9667 @end itemize
9668
9669 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
9670 pretty-printers are selected,
9671
9672 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
9673 for new types.
9674
9675 @node Pretty-Printer Example
9676 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
9677
9678 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
9679
9680 @smallexample
9681 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9682 $1 = @{
9683 static npos = 4294967295,
9684 _M_dataplus = @{
9685 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
9686 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
9687 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
9688 @},
9689 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
9690 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
9691 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
9692 @}
9693 @}
9694 @end smallexample
9695
9696 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
9697
9698 @smallexample
9699 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9700 $2 = "abcd"
9701 @end smallexample
9702
9703 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
9704 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
9705 @cindex pretty-printer commands
9706
9707 @table @code
9708 @kindex info pretty-printer
9709 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9710 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
9711 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
9712
9713 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
9714 whose pretty-printers to list.
9715 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
9716 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
9717 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
9718 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
9719 looks up a printer from these three objects.
9720
9721 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
9722 to list.
9723
9724 @kindex disable pretty-printer
9725 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9726 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9727 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
9728
9729 @kindex enable pretty-printer
9730 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9731 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9732 @end table
9733
9734 Example:
9735
9736 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
9737 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
9738 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
9739 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
9740
9741 @smallexample
9742 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9743 library1.so:
9744 foo
9745 library2.so:
9746 bar
9747 bar1
9748 bar2
9749 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9750 library2.so:
9751 bar
9752 bar1
9753 bar2
9754 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
9755 1 printer disabled
9756 2 of 3 printers enabled
9757 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9758 library1.so:
9759 foo [disabled]
9760 library2.so:
9761 bar
9762 bar1
9763 bar2
9764 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
9765 1 printer disabled
9766 1 of 3 printers enabled
9767 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9768 library1.so:
9769 foo [disabled]
9770 library2.so:
9771 bar
9772 bar1 [disabled]
9773 bar2
9774 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
9775 1 printer disabled
9776 0 of 3 printers enabled
9777 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9778 library1.so:
9779 foo [disabled]
9780 library2.so:
9781 bar [disabled]
9782 bar1 [disabled]
9783 bar2
9784 @end smallexample
9785
9786 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
9787 as can each individual subprinter.
9788
9789 @node Value History
9790 @section Value History
9791
9792 @cindex value history
9793 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
9794 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
9795 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
9796 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
9797 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
9798 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
9799 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
9800 symbol table.
9801
9802 @cindex @code{$}
9803 @cindex @code{$$}
9804 @cindex history number
9805 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
9806 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
9807 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
9808 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
9809 history number.
9810
9811 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
9812 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
9813 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
9814 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
9815 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
9816 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
9817 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
9818
9819 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
9820 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
9821
9822 @smallexample
9823 p *$
9824 @end smallexample
9825
9826 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
9827 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
9828
9829 @smallexample
9830 p *$.next
9831 @end smallexample
9832
9833 @noindent
9834 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
9835 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
9836
9837 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
9838 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
9839
9840 @smallexample
9841 print x
9842 set x=5
9843 @end smallexample
9844
9845 @noindent
9846 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
9847 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
9848
9849 @table @code
9850 @kindex show values
9851 @item show values
9852 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
9853 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
9854 values} does not change the history.
9855
9856 @item show values @var{n}
9857 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
9858
9859 @item show values +
9860 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
9861 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
9862 @end table
9863
9864 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
9865 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
9866
9867 @node Convenience Vars
9868 @section Convenience Variables
9869
9870 @cindex convenience variables
9871 @cindex user-defined variables
9872 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
9873 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
9874 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
9875 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
9876 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
9877
9878 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
9879 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
9880 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9881 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
9882 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
9883
9884 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
9885 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
9886 For example:
9887
9888 @smallexample
9889 set $foo = *object_ptr
9890 @end smallexample
9891
9892 @noindent
9893 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
9894 @code{object_ptr}.
9895
9896 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
9897 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
9898 value with another assignment at any time.
9899
9900 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
9901 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
9902 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
9903 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
9904
9905 @table @code
9906 @kindex show convenience
9907 @cindex show all user variables and functions
9908 @item show convenience
9909 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
9910 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
9911 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
9912
9913 @kindex init-if-undefined
9914 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
9915 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
9916 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
9917 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
9918 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
9919 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
9920 override default values used in a command script.
9921
9922 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
9923 any side-effects do not occur.
9924 @end table
9925
9926 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
9927 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
9928 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
9929
9930 @smallexample
9931 set $i = 0
9932 print bar[$i++]->contents
9933 @end smallexample
9934
9935 @noindent
9936 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
9937
9938 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
9939 values likely to be useful.
9940
9941 @table @code
9942 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
9943 @item $_
9944 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
9945 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
9946 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
9947 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
9948 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
9949 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
9950 to the type of @code{$__}.
9951
9952 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
9953 @item $__
9954 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
9955 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
9956 to match the format in which the data was printed.
9957
9958 @item $_exitcode
9959 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
9960 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
9961 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
9962 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
9963
9964 @item $_exitsignal
9965 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
9966 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
9967 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
9968 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
9969
9970 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
9971 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
9972 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
9973 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
9974 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
9975
9976 @smallexample
9977 #include <signal.h>
9978
9979 int
9980 main (int argc, char *argv[])
9981 @{
9982 raise (SIGALRM);
9983 return 0;
9984 @}
9985 @end smallexample
9986
9987 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
9988 or signalled would be:
9989
9990 @smallexample
9991 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
9992 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
9993 End with a line saying just ``end''.
9994 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
9995 >echo The program has exited\n
9996 >else
9997 >echo The program has signalled\n
9998 >end
9999 >end
10000 (@value{GDBP}) run
10001 Starting program:
10002
10003 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10004 The program no longer exists.
10005 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10006 The program has signalled
10007 @end smallexample
10008
10009 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10010 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10011 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10012 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10013
10014 @smallexample
10015 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10016 The program has exited
10017 @end smallexample
10018
10019 @item $_exception
10020 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10021 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10022
10023 @item $_probe_argc
10024 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10025 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10026
10027 @item $_sdata
10028 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10029 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10030 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10031 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10032 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10033
10034 @item $_siginfo
10035 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10036 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10037 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10038 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10039 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10040
10041 @item $_tlb
10042 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10043 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10044 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10045 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10046 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10047 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10048
10049 @end table
10050
10051 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10052 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10053 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10054
10055 @node Convenience Funs
10056 @section Convenience Functions
10057
10058 @cindex convenience functions
10059 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10060 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10061 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10062 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10063 @value{GDBN}.
10064
10065 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10066 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10067
10068 @table @code
10069
10070 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10071 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10072 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10073 returns zero.
10074
10075 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10076 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10077 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10078 it is @code{void}:
10079
10080 @smallexample
10081 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10082 $1 = void
10083 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10084 $2 = 1
10085 (@value{GDBP}) run
10086 Starting program: ./a.out
10087 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10088 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10089 $3 = 0
10090 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10091 $4 = 0
10092 @end smallexample
10093
10094 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10095 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10096 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10097 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10098 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10099 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10100 anymore.
10101
10102 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10103 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10104
10105 @smallexample
10106 void
10107 foo (void)
10108 @{
10109 @}
10110 @end smallexample
10111
10112 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10113
10114 @smallexample
10115 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10116 $1 = void
10117 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10118 $2 = 1
10119 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10120 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10121 $3 = void
10122 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10123 $4 = 1
10124 @end smallexample
10125
10126 @end table
10127
10128 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10129 @code{Python} support.
10130
10131 @table @code
10132
10133 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10134 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10135 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10136 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10137 Otherwise it returns zero.
10138
10139 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10140 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10141 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10142 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10143 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10144 regular expression support.
10145
10146 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10147 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10148 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10149 Otherwise it returns zero.
10150
10151 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10152 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10153 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10154
10155 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10156 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10157 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10158 Otherwise it returns zero.
10159
10160 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10161 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10162 The default is 1.
10163
10164 Example:
10165
10166 @smallexample
10167 (gdb) backtrace
10168 #0 bottom_func ()
10169 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10170 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10171 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10172 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10173 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10174 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10175 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10176 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10177 $1 = 1
10178 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10179 $1 = 1
10180 @end smallexample
10181
10182 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10183 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10184 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10185 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10186
10187 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10188 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10189 The default is 1.
10190
10191 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10192 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10193 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10194 Otherwise it returns zero.
10195
10196 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10197 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10198 The default is 1.
10199
10200 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10201 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10202 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10203 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10204
10205 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10206 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10207 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10208 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10209
10210 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10211 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10212 The default is 1.
10213
10214 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10215 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10216 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10217 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10218
10219 @end table
10220
10221 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10222 convenience functions.
10223
10224 @table @code
10225 @item help function
10226 @kindex help function
10227 @cindex show all convenience functions
10228 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10229 @end table
10230
10231 @node Registers
10232 @section Registers
10233
10234 @cindex registers
10235 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10236 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10237 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10238 your machine.
10239
10240 @table @code
10241 @kindex info registers
10242 @item info registers
10243 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10244 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10245
10246 @kindex info all-registers
10247 @cindex floating point registers
10248 @item info all-registers
10249 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10250 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10251
10252 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10253 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10254 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10255 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10256 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10257 @end table
10258
10259 @cindex stack pointer register
10260 @cindex program counter register
10261 @cindex process status register
10262 @cindex frame pointer register
10263 @cindex standard registers
10264 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10265 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10266 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10267 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10268 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10269 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10270 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10271 you could print the program counter in hex with
10272
10273 @smallexample
10274 p/x $pc
10275 @end smallexample
10276
10277 @noindent
10278 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10279
10280 @smallexample
10281 x/i $pc
10282 @end smallexample
10283
10284 @noindent
10285 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10286 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10287 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10288 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10289 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10290 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10291 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10292
10293 @smallexample
10294 set $sp += 4
10295 @end smallexample
10296
10297 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10298 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10299 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10300 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10301 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10302 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10303 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10304
10305 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10306 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10307 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10308 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10309 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10310 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10311 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10312
10313 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10314 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10315 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10316 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10317 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10318 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10319 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10320 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10321 prints the data in both formats.
10322
10323 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10324 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10325 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10326 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10327 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10328 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10329 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10330
10331 @smallexample
10332 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10333 $1 = @{
10334 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10335 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10336 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10337 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10338 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10339 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10340 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10341 @}
10342 @end smallexample
10343
10344 @noindent
10345 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10346 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10347 value to a @code{struct} member:
10348
10349 @smallexample
10350 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10351 @end smallexample
10352
10353 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10354 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10355 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10356 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10357 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10358 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10359
10360 @cindex caller-saved registers
10361 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10362 @cindex volatile registers
10363 @cindex <not saved> values
10364 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10365 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10366 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10367 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10368 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10369 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10370 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10371 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10372 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10373 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10374 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10375 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10376 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10377 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10378 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10379 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10380 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10381 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10382 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10383 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10384 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10385 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10386 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10387
10388 @node Floating Point Hardware
10389 @section Floating Point Hardware
10390 @cindex floating point
10391
10392 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10393 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10394
10395 @table @code
10396 @kindex info float
10397 @item info float
10398 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10399 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10400 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10401 the ARM and x86 machines.
10402 @end table
10403
10404 @node Vector Unit
10405 @section Vector Unit
10406 @cindex vector unit
10407
10408 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10409 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10410
10411 @table @code
10412 @kindex info vector
10413 @item info vector
10414 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10415 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10416 @end table
10417
10418 @node OS Information
10419 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10420 @cindex OS information
10421
10422 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10423 you debug your program.
10424
10425 @cindex auxiliary vector
10426 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10427 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10428 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10429 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10430 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10431 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10432 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10433 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10434 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10435 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10436 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10437 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10438
10439 @table @code
10440 @kindex info auxv
10441 @item info auxv
10442 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10443 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10444 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10445 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10446 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10447 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10448 an unrecognized tag.
10449 @end table
10450
10451 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10452 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10453 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10454 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10455 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10456 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10457 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10458
10459 @table @code
10460 @kindex info os
10461 @item info os @var{infotype}
10462
10463 Display OS information of the requested type.
10464
10465 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10466
10467 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10468 @table @code
10469 @kindex info os processes
10470 @item processes
10471 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10472 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10473 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10474 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10475 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10476 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10477
10478 @kindex info os procgroups
10479 @item procgroups
10480 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10481 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10482 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10483 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10484 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10485 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10486 and the process group leader is listed first.
10487
10488 @kindex info os threads
10489 @item threads
10490 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10491 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10492 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10493 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10494 process is not listed.
10495
10496 @kindex info os files
10497 @item files
10498 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10499 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10500 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10501 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10502
10503 @kindex info os sockets
10504 @item sockets
10505 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10506 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10507 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10508 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10509 connection.
10510
10511 @kindex info os shm
10512 @item shm
10513 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10514 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10515 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10516 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10517 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10518 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10519 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10520
10521 @kindex info os semaphores
10522 @item semaphores
10523 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10524 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10525 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10526 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10527 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10528
10529 @kindex info os msg
10530 @item msg
10531 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10532 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10533 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10534 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10535 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10536 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10537 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10538 the message queue was last changed.
10539
10540 @kindex info os modules
10541 @item modules
10542 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10543 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10544 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10545 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10546 in memory.
10547 @end table
10548
10549 @item info os
10550 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10551 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10552 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10553 types, this command will report an error.
10554 @end table
10555
10556 @node Memory Region Attributes
10557 @section Memory Region Attributes
10558 @cindex memory region attributes
10559
10560 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10561 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10562 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10563 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10564 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10565 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10566 user can override the fetched regions.
10567
10568 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10569 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10570 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10571 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10572 all memory.
10573
10574 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10575 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10576
10577 @table @code
10578 @kindex mem
10579 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10580 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10581 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10582 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10583 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10584 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10585
10586 @item mem auto
10587 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10588 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10589
10590 @kindex delete mem
10591 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10592 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10593 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10594
10595 @kindex disable mem
10596 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10597 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10598 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10599 It may be enabled again later.
10600
10601 @kindex enable mem
10602 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10603 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10604
10605 @kindex info mem
10606 @item info mem
10607 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10608 for each region:
10609
10610 @table @emph
10611 @item Memory Region Number
10612 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10613 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10614 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10615
10616 @item Lo Address
10617 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10618
10619 @item Hi Address
10620 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10621
10622 @item Attributes
10623 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10624 @end table
10625 @end table
10626
10627
10628 @subsection Attributes
10629
10630 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10631 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10632 write accesses to a memory region.
10633
10634 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10635 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10636 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10637
10638 @table @code
10639 @item ro
10640 Memory is read only.
10641 @item wo
10642 Memory is write only.
10643 @item rw
10644 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
10645 @end table
10646
10647 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
10648 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
10649 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
10650 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
10651 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
10652
10653 @table @code
10654 @item 8
10655 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
10656 @item 16
10657 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
10658 @item 32
10659 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
10660 @item 64
10661 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
10662 @end table
10663
10664 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
10665 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10666 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
10667 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
10668 @c
10669 @c @table @code
10670 @c @item hwbreak
10671 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
10672 @c @item swbreak (default)
10673 @c @end table
10674
10675 @subsubsection Data Cache
10676 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
10677 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
10678 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
10679 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
10680 registers.
10681
10682 @table @code
10683 @item cache
10684 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
10685 @item nocache
10686 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
10687 @end table
10688
10689 @subsection Memory Access Checking
10690 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
10691 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
10692 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
10693 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
10694
10695 @table @code
10696 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
10697 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
10698 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
10699 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
10700 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
10701 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
10702 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
10703 The default value is @code{on}.
10704 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
10705 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
10706 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
10707 @end table
10708
10709
10710 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
10711 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10712 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
10713 @c
10714 @c @table @code
10715 @c @item verify
10716 @c @item noverify (default)
10717 @c @end table
10718
10719 @node Dump/Restore Files
10720 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
10721 @cindex dump/restore files
10722 @cindex append data to a file
10723 @cindex dump data to a file
10724 @cindex restore data from a file
10725
10726 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
10727 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
10728 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
10729 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
10730 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
10731 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
10732 files.
10733
10734 @table @code
10735
10736 @kindex dump
10737 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10738 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10739 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10740 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
10741
10742 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
10743 @table @code
10744 @item binary
10745 Raw binary form.
10746 @item ihex
10747 Intel hex format.
10748 @item srec
10749 Motorola S-record format.
10750 @item tekhex
10751 Tektronix Hex format.
10752 @end table
10753
10754 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
10755 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
10756 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
10757 form.
10758
10759 @kindex append
10760 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10761 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10762 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10763 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
10764 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
10765
10766 @kindex restore
10767 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
10768 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
10769 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
10770 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
10771 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
10772
10773 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
10774 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
10775 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
10776 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
10777 from that location.
10778
10779 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
10780 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
10781 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
10782 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
10783
10784 @end table
10785
10786 @node Core File Generation
10787 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
10788 @cindex dump core from inferior
10789
10790 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
10791 image of a running process and its process status (register values
10792 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
10793 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
10794 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
10795 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
10796 the post-mortem debugging mode.
10797
10798 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
10799 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
10800 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
10801
10802 @table @code
10803 @kindex gcore
10804 @kindex generate-core-file
10805 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
10806 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
10807 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
10808 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
10809 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
10810 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
10811
10812 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
10813 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
10814 @end table
10815
10816 @node Character Sets
10817 @section Character Sets
10818 @cindex character sets
10819 @cindex charset
10820 @cindex translating between character sets
10821 @cindex host character set
10822 @cindex target character set
10823
10824 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
10825 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
10826 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
10827 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
10828 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
10829 @dfn{target character set}.
10830
10831 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
10832 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
10833 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
10834 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
10835 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
10836 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
10837 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
10838 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
10839 character and string literals in expressions.
10840
10841 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
10842 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
10843 target-charset} command, described below.
10844
10845 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
10846 support:
10847
10848 @table @code
10849 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
10850 @kindex set target-charset
10851 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
10852 list of supported target character sets, type
10853 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10854
10855 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
10856 @kindex set host-charset
10857 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
10858
10859 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
10860 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
10861 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
10862 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
10863 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
10864
10865 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
10866 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10867 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
10868
10869 @item set charset @var{charset}
10870 @kindex set charset
10871 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
10872 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
10873 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
10874 for both host and target.
10875
10876 @item show charset
10877 @kindex show charset
10878 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
10879
10880 @item show host-charset
10881 @kindex show host-charset
10882 Show the name of the current host character set.
10883
10884 @item show target-charset
10885 @kindex show target-charset
10886 Show the name of the current target character set.
10887
10888 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
10889 @kindex set target-wide-charset
10890 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
10891 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
10892 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
10893 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
10894
10895 @item show target-wide-charset
10896 @kindex show target-wide-charset
10897 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
10898 @end table
10899
10900 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
10901 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
10902 @file{charset-test.c}:
10903
10904 @smallexample
10905 #include <stdio.h>
10906
10907 char ascii_hello[]
10908 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
10909 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
10910 char ibm1047_hello[]
10911 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
10912 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
10913
10914 main ()
10915 @{
10916 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10917 @}
10918 @end smallexample
10919
10920 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
10921 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
10922 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
10923
10924 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
10925
10926 @smallexample
10927 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
10928 $ gdb -nw charset-test
10929 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
10930 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
10931 @dots{}
10932 (@value{GDBP})
10933 @end smallexample
10934
10935 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
10936 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
10937 strings:
10938
10939 @smallexample
10940 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10941 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
10942 (@value{GDBP})
10943 @end smallexample
10944
10945 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
10946 initial character set:
10947 @smallexample
10948 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
10949 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
10950 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
10951 (@value{GDBP})
10952 @end smallexample
10953
10954 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
10955 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
10956 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
10957 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
10958 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
10959
10960 @smallexample
10961 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
10962 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
10963 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
10964 $2 = 72 'H'
10965 (@value{GDBP})
10966 @end smallexample
10967
10968 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
10969 literals you use in expressions:
10970
10971 @smallexample
10972 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
10973 $3 = 43 '+'
10974 (@value{GDBP})
10975 @end smallexample
10976
10977 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
10978 character.
10979
10980 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
10981 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
10982 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
10983
10984 @smallexample
10985 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
10986 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
10987 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
10988 $5 = 200 '\310'
10989 (@value{GDBP})
10990 @end smallexample
10991
10992 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
10993 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
10994
10995 @smallexample
10996 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10997 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
10998 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
10999 @end smallexample
11000
11001 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11002 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11003 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11004 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11005 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11006
11007 @smallexample
11008 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11009 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11010 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11011 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11012 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11013 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11014 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11015 $7 = 72 '\110'
11016 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11017 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11018 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11019 $9 = 200 'H'
11020 (@value{GDBP})
11021 @end smallexample
11022
11023 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11024 string literals you use in expressions:
11025
11026 @smallexample
11027 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11028 $10 = 78 '+'
11029 (@value{GDBP})
11030 @end smallexample
11031
11032 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11033 character.
11034
11035 @node Caching Target Data
11036 @section Caching Data of Targets
11037 @cindex caching data of targets
11038
11039 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11040 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11041 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11042 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11043 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11044 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11045 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11046 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11047 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11048 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11049 is executing.
11050 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11051 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11052 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11053 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11054 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11055 in the code segment.
11056 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11057 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11058
11059 @table @code
11060 @kindex set remotecache
11061 @item set remotecache on
11062 @itemx set remotecache off
11063 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11064 with old scripts.
11065
11066 @kindex show remotecache
11067 @item show remotecache
11068 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11069
11070 @kindex set stack-cache
11071 @item set stack-cache on
11072 @itemx set stack-cache off
11073 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11074 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11075
11076 @kindex show stack-cache
11077 @item show stack-cache
11078 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11079
11080 @kindex set code-cache
11081 @item set code-cache on
11082 @itemx set code-cache off
11083 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11084 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11085 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11086
11087 @kindex show code-cache
11088 @item show code-cache
11089 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11090 accesses.
11091
11092 @kindex info dcache
11093 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11094 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11095 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11096 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11097 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11098 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11099
11100 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11101 printed in hex.
11102
11103 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11104 @cindex dcache size
11105 @kindex set dcache size
11106 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11107
11108 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11109 @cindex dcache line-size
11110 @kindex set dcache line-size
11111 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11112 Must be a power of 2.
11113
11114 @item show dcache size
11115 @kindex show dcache size
11116 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11117
11118 @item show dcache line-size
11119 @kindex show dcache line-size
11120 Show default size of dcache lines.
11121
11122 @end table
11123
11124 @node Searching Memory
11125 @section Search Memory
11126 @cindex searching memory
11127
11128 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11129 @code{find} command.
11130
11131 @table @code
11132 @kindex find
11133 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11134 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11135 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11136 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11137 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11138 @end table
11139
11140 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11141 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11142
11143 @table @r
11144 @item @var{s}, search query size
11145 The size of each search query value.
11146
11147 @table @code
11148 @item b
11149 bytes
11150 @item h
11151 halfwords (two bytes)
11152 @item w
11153 words (four bytes)
11154 @item g
11155 giant words (eight bytes)
11156 @end table
11157
11158 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11159 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11160 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11161
11162 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11163 value's type in the current language.
11164 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11165 pattern as a mixture of types.
11166 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11167 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11168 which is typically four bytes.
11169
11170 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11171 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11172 @end table
11173
11174 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11175 (@code{"}).
11176 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11177 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11178
11179 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11180 number of matches found.
11181
11182 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11183 @samp{$_}.
11184 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11185
11186 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11187
11188 @smallexample
11189 void
11190 hello ()
11191 @{
11192 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11193 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11194 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11195 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11196 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11197 @}
11198 @end smallexample
11199
11200 @noindent
11201 you get during debugging:
11202
11203 @smallexample
11204 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11205 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11206 1 pattern found
11207 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11208 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11209 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11210 2 patterns found
11211 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11212 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11213 1 pattern found
11214 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11215 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11216 1 pattern found
11217 (gdb) print $numfound
11218 $1 = 1
11219 (gdb) print $_
11220 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11221 @end smallexample
11222
11223 @node Optimized Code
11224 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11225 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11226 @cindex debugging optimized code
11227
11228 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11229 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11230 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11231 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11232 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11233 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11234 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11235
11236 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11237 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11238 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11239 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11240
11241 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11242 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11243 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11244 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11245 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11246 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11247
11248 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11249 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11250 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11251 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11252 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11253
11254 @menu
11255 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11256 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11257 @end menu
11258
11259 @node Inline Functions
11260 @section Inline Functions
11261 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11262
11263 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11264 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11265 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11266 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11267 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11268 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11269 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11270 @code{info frame} command.
11271
11272 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11273 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11274 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11275 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11276 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11277 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11278 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11279 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11280 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11281 local variables in the caller.
11282
11283 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11284 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11285 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11286 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11287 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11288 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11289 instructions are executed.
11290
11291 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11292 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11293 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11294 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11295
11296 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11297 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11298
11299 @itemize @bullet
11300 @item
11301 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11302 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11303 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11304 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11305 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11306 or inside the inlined function instead.
11307
11308 @item
11309 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11310 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11311 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11312 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11313
11314 @end itemize
11315
11316 @node Tail Call Frames
11317 @section Tail Call Frames
11318 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11319
11320 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11321 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11322 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11323 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11324 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11325
11326 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11327 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11328 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11329 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11330 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11331 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11332 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11333
11334 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11335 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11336 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11337 this information.
11338
11339 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11340 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11341
11342 @smallexample
11343 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11344 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11345 (gdb) info frame
11346 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11347 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11348 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11349 source language c++.
11350 Arglist at unknown address.
11351 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11352 @end smallexample
11353
11354 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11355 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11356 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11357 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11358 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11359 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11360
11361 @table @code
11362 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11363 @item set debug entry-values
11364 @kindex set debug entry-values
11365 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11366 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11367 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11368 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11369 result.
11370
11371 @item show debug entry-values
11372 @kindex show debug entry-values
11373 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11374 values at function entry and tail calls.
11375 @end table
11376
11377 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11378 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11379 reference by variable @code{x}):
11380
11381 @smallexample
11382 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11383 void (*x) (void) = c;
11384 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11385 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11386 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11387
11388 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11389 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11390 a () at t.c:3
11391 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11392 (gdb) bt
11393 #0 a () at t.c:3
11394 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11395 @end smallexample
11396
11397 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11398
11399 @smallexample
11400 int i;
11401 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11402 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11403 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11404 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11405 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11406 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11407 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11408 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11409
11410 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11411 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11412 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11413 (gdb) bt
11414 #0 f () at t.c:2
11415 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11416 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11417 @end smallexample
11418
11419 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11420 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11421
11422 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11423 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11424 @set ARROW @click{}
11425 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11426 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11427 @end ifset
11428 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11429 @set ARROW ->
11430 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11431 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11432 @end ifclear
11433
11434 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11435 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11436 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11437
11438 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11439 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11440 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11441 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11442 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11443 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11444
11445 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11446 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11447 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11448 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11449 omitted.
11450
11451 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11452 entry may fail:
11453
11454 @smallexample
11455 int v;
11456 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11457 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11458 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11459 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11460 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11461 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11462
11463 (gdb) bt
11464 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11465 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11466 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11467 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11468 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11469 @end smallexample
11470
11471 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11472 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11473 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11474 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11475 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11476
11477 @node Macros
11478 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11479
11480 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11481 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11482 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11483 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11484 where it was defined.
11485
11486 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11487 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11488 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11489 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11490
11491 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11492 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11493 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11494 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11495 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11496 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11497 see @ref{List}.
11498
11499 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11500 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11501 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11502
11503 @table @code
11504
11505 @kindex macro expand
11506 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11507 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11508 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11509 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11510 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11511 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11512 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11513 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11514 it can be any string of tokens.
11515
11516 @kindex macro exp1
11517 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11518 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11519 @cindex expand macro once
11520 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11521 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11522 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11523 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11524 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11525 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11526 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11527 can be any string of tokens.
11528
11529 @kindex info macro
11530 @cindex macro definition, showing
11531 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11532 @cindex macros, from debug info
11533 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11534 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11535 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11536 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11537 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11538 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11539
11540 @kindex info macros
11541 @item info macros @var{linespec}
11542 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11543 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
11544 command-line where those definitions were established.
11545
11546 @kindex macro define
11547 @cindex user-defined macros
11548 @cindex defining macros interactively
11549 @cindex macros, user-defined
11550 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11551 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11552 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11553 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11554 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11555 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11556 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11557 @var{arglist}.
11558
11559 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11560 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11561 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11562 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11563 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11564
11565 @kindex macro undef
11566 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11567 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11568 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11569 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11570 in the program being debugged.
11571
11572 @kindex macro list
11573 @item macro list
11574 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11575 @end table
11576
11577 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11578 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11579 show our source files:
11580
11581 @smallexample
11582 $ cat sample.c
11583 #include <stdio.h>
11584 #include "sample.h"
11585
11586 #define M 42
11587 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11588
11589 main ()
11590 @{
11591 #define N 28
11592 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11593 #undef N
11594 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11595 #define N 1729
11596 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11597 @}
11598 $ cat sample.h
11599 #define Q <
11600 $
11601 @end smallexample
11602
11603 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
11604 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
11605 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
11606 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
11607 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
11608 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
11609 information.
11610
11611 @smallexample
11612 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
11613 $
11614 @end smallexample
11615
11616 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
11617
11618 @smallexample
11619 $ gdb -nw sample
11620 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
11621 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11622 GDB is free software, @dots{}
11623 (@value{GDBP})
11624 @end smallexample
11625
11626 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
11627 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
11628 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
11629
11630 @smallexample
11631 (@value{GDBP}) list main
11632 3
11633 4 #define M 42
11634 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11635 6
11636 7 main ()
11637 8 @{
11638 9 #define N 28
11639 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11640 11 #undef N
11641 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11642 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
11643 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
11644 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11645 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
11646 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
11647 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
11648 #define Q <
11649 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
11650 expands to: (42 + 1)
11651 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
11652 expands to: once (M + 1)
11653 (@value{GDBP})
11654 @end smallexample
11655
11656 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
11657 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
11658 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
11659 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
11660
11661 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
11662 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
11663
11664 @smallexample
11665 (@value{GDBP}) break main
11666 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
11667 (@value{GDBP}) run
11668 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
11669
11670 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
11671 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11672 (@value{GDBP})
11673 @end smallexample
11674
11675 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
11676
11677 @smallexample
11678 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11679 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
11680 #define N 28
11681 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11682 expands to: 28 < 42
11683 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11684 $1 = 1
11685 (@value{GDBP})
11686 @end smallexample
11687
11688 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
11689 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
11690 thereof) in force at each point:
11691
11692 @smallexample
11693 (@value{GDBP}) next
11694 Hello, world!
11695 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11696 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11697 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
11698 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
11699 (@value{GDBP}) next
11700 We're so creative.
11701 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11702 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11703 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
11704 #define N 1729
11705 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11706 expands to: 1729 < 42
11707 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11708 $2 = 0
11709 (@value{GDBP})
11710 @end smallexample
11711
11712 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
11713 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
11714 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
11715 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
11716
11717 @smallexample
11718 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
11719 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
11720 -D__STDC__=1
11721 (@value{GDBP})
11722 @end smallexample
11723
11724
11725 @node Tracepoints
11726 @chapter Tracepoints
11727 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
11728 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
11729
11730 @cindex tracepoints
11731 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
11732 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
11733 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
11734 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
11735 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
11736 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
11737 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
11738
11739 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
11740 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
11741 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
11742 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
11743 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
11744 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
11745 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
11746 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
11747 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
11748 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
11749 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
11750
11751 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
11752 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
11753 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
11754 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
11755 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
11756 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
11757 Packets}.
11758
11759 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
11760 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
11761 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
11762
11763 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
11764
11765 @menu
11766 * Set Tracepoints::
11767 * Analyze Collected Data::
11768 * Tracepoint Variables::
11769 * Trace Files::
11770 @end menu
11771
11772 @node Set Tracepoints
11773 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
11774
11775 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
11776 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
11777 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
11778 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
11779 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
11780 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
11781 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
11782
11783 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
11784 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
11785 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
11786 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
11787 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
11788 tracepoint was hit.
11789
11790 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
11791 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
11792 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
11793 either.
11794
11795 @cindex fast tracepoints
11796 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
11797 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
11798 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
11799
11800 @cindex static tracepoints
11801 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
11802 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
11803 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
11804 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
11805 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
11806 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
11807 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
11808 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
11809 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
11810 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
11811 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
11812 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
11813 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
11814 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
11815 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
11816 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
11817 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
11818 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
11819 static tracepoint marker.
11820
11821 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
11822 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
11823
11824 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
11825 conditions and actions.
11826
11827 @menu
11828 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
11829 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
11830 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
11831 * Tracepoint Conditions::
11832 * Trace State Variables::
11833 * Tracepoint Actions::
11834 * Listing Tracepoints::
11835 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
11836 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
11837 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
11838 @end menu
11839
11840 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
11841 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
11842
11843 @table @code
11844 @cindex set tracepoint
11845 @kindex trace
11846 @item trace @var{location}
11847 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
11848 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
11849 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
11850 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
11851 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
11852 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
11853 changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
11854 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
11855 in tracing}).
11856 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
11857 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
11858 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
11859 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
11860 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
11861 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
11862 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
11863 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
11864 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
11865 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
11866 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
11867 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
11868
11869 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
11870
11871 @smallexample
11872 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
11873
11874 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
11875
11876 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
11877
11878 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
11879
11880 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
11881 @end smallexample
11882
11883 @noindent
11884 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
11885
11886 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
11887 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
11888 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
11889 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
11890 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
11891 information on tracepoint conditions.
11892
11893 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11894 @cindex set fast tracepoint
11895 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
11896 @kindex ftrace
11897 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
11898 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
11899 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
11900 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
11901 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
11902 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
11903 message.
11904
11905 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
11906 @code{trace}.
11907
11908 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
11909 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
11910 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
11911 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
11912 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
11913 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
11914 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
11915 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
11916
11917 @example
11918 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
11919 @end example
11920
11921 @noindent
11922 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
11923 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
11924
11925 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
11926 @cindex set static tracepoint
11927 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
11928 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
11929 @kindex strace
11930 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
11931 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
11932 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
11933 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
11934 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
11935
11936 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
11937 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
11938 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
11939 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
11940 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
11941 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
11942 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
11943 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
11944 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
11945 tracing engine:
11946
11947 @smallexample
11948 main ()
11949 @{
11950 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
11951 @}
11952 @end smallexample
11953
11954 @noindent
11955 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
11956 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
11957
11958 @smallexample
11959 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
11960 Cnt Enb ID Address What
11961 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
11962 Data: "str %s"
11963 [etc...]
11964 @end smallexample
11965
11966 @noindent
11967 so you may probe the marker above with:
11968
11969 @smallexample
11970 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
11971 @end smallexample
11972
11973 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
11974 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
11975 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
11976 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
11977 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
11978 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
11979 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
11980 the @samp{Data:} field.
11981
11982 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
11983 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
11984 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
11985
11986 @vindex $tpnum
11987 @cindex last tracepoint number
11988 @cindex recent tracepoint number
11989 @cindex tracepoint number
11990 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
11991 of the most recently set tracepoint.
11992
11993 @kindex delete tracepoint
11994 @cindex tracepoint deletion
11995 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
11996 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
11997 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
11998 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
11999
12000 Examples:
12001
12002 @smallexample
12003 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12004
12005 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12006 @end smallexample
12007
12008 @noindent
12009 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12010 @end table
12011
12012 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12013 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12014
12015 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12016
12017 @table @code
12018 @kindex disable tracepoint
12019 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12020 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12021 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12022 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12023 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12024 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12025 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12026 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12027 next trace experiment.
12028
12029 @kindex enable tracepoint
12030 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12031 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12032 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12033 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12034 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12035 next time a trace experiment is run.
12036 @end table
12037
12038 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12039 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12040
12041 @table @code
12042 @kindex passcount
12043 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12044 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12045 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12046 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12047 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12048 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12049 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12050 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12051 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12052 user.
12053
12054 Examples:
12055
12056 @smallexample
12057 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12058 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12059
12060 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12061 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12062 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12063 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12064 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12065 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12066 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12067 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12068 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12069 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12070 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12071 @end smallexample
12072 @end table
12073
12074 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12075 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12076 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12077 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12078
12079 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12080 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12081 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12082 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12083 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12084 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12085 is true.
12086
12087 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12088 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12089 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12090 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12091 just as with breakpoints.
12092
12093 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12094 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12095 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12096 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12097 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12098 accesses, and so forth.
12099
12100 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12101 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12102 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12103 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12104 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12105 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12106 search through.
12107
12108 @smallexample
12109 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12110 @end smallexample
12111
12112 @node Trace State Variables
12113 @subsection Trace State Variables
12114 @cindex trace state variables
12115
12116 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12117 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12118 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12119 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12120 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12121 integers.
12122
12123 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12124 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12125 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12126 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12127
12128 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12129 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12130 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12131 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12132 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12133 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12134 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12135 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12136 variable with the same name.
12137
12138 @table @code
12139
12140 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12141 @kindex tvariable
12142 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12143 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12144 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12145 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12146 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12147 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12148 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12149 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12150 value. The default initial value is 0.
12151
12152 @item info tvariables
12153 @kindex info tvariables
12154 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12155 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12156 currently running.
12157
12158 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12159 @kindex delete tvariable
12160 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12161 are specified.
12162
12163 @end table
12164
12165 @node Tracepoint Actions
12166 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12167
12168 @table @code
12169 @kindex actions
12170 @cindex tracepoint actions
12171 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12172 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12173 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12174 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12175 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12176 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12177 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12178 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12179 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12180 @code{while-stepping}.
12181
12182 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12183 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12184 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12185
12186 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12187 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12188 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12189
12190 @smallexample
12191 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12192
12193 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12194
12195 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12196 @end smallexample
12197
12198 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12199 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12200 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12201 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12202 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12203 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12204 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12205 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12206
12207 @smallexample
12208 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12209 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12210 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12211 > collect bar,baz
12212 > collect $regs
12213 > while-stepping 12
12214 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12215 > end
12216 end
12217 @end smallexample
12218
12219 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12220 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12221 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12222 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12223 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12224 special arguments are supported:
12225
12226 @table @code
12227 @item $regs
12228 Collect all registers.
12229
12230 @item $args
12231 Collect all function arguments.
12232
12233 @item $locals
12234 Collect all local variables.
12235
12236 @item $_ret
12237 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12238 of a backtrace.
12239
12240 @item $_probe_argc
12241 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12242 tracepoint is located.
12243 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12244
12245 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12246 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12247 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12248 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12249
12250 @item $_sdata
12251 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12252 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12253 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12254 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12255 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12256 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12257 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12258 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12259 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12260
12261 @smallexample
12262 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12263 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12264 @end smallexample
12265
12266 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12267 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12268 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12269 @value{GDBN}.
12270 @end table
12271
12272 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12273 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12274 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12275
12276 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12277 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12278 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12279 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12280 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12281 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12282 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12283 @samp{mystr}.
12284
12285 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12286 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12287
12288 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12289 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12290 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12291 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12292 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12293 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12294 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12295 action were used.
12296
12297 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12298 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12299 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12300 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12301 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12302 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12303
12304 @smallexample
12305 > while-stepping 12
12306 > collect $regs, myglobal
12307 > end
12308 >
12309 @end smallexample
12310
12311 @noindent
12312 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12313 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12314 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12315 @code{stepping}.
12316
12317 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12318 @kindex set default-collect
12319 @cindex default collection action
12320 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12321 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12322 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12323 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12324 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12325 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12326
12327 @item show default-collect
12328 @kindex show default-collect
12329 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12330 tracepoint hit.
12331
12332 @end table
12333
12334 @node Listing Tracepoints
12335 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12336
12337 @table @code
12338 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12339 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12340 @cindex information about tracepoints
12341 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12342 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12343 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12344 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12345 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12346 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12347
12348 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12349 tracing:
12350
12351 @itemize @bullet
12352 @item
12353 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12354
12355 @item
12356 the state about installed on target of each location
12357 @end itemize
12358
12359 @smallexample
12360 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12361 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12362 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12363 while-stepping 20
12364 collect globfoo, $regs
12365 end
12366 collect globfoo2
12367 end
12368 pass count 1200
12369 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12370 collect $eip
12371 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12372 installed on target
12373 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12374 installed on target
12375 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12376 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12377 not installed on target
12378 (@value{GDBP})
12379 @end smallexample
12380
12381 @noindent
12382 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12383 @end table
12384
12385 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12386 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12387
12388 @table @code
12389 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12390 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12391 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12392 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12393 program.
12394
12395 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12396
12397 @table @emph
12398 @item Count
12399 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12400 stable identifier.
12401 @item ID
12402 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12403 @item Enabled or Disabled
12404 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12405 that are not enabled.
12406 @item Address
12407 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12408 @item What
12409 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12410 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12411 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12412 will be left blank.
12413 @end table
12414
12415 @noindent
12416 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12417
12418 @table @emph
12419 @item Data
12420 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12421 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12422 marker call.
12423 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12424 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12425 @end table
12426
12427 @smallexample
12428 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12429 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12430 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12431 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12432 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12433 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12434 Data: str %s
12435 (@value{GDBP})
12436 @end smallexample
12437 @end table
12438
12439 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12440 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12441
12442 @table @code
12443 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12444 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12445 @cindex collected data discarded
12446 @item tstart
12447 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12448 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12449 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12450 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12451 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12452 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12453 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12454 information, and so forth.
12455
12456 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12457 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12458 @item tstop
12459 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12460 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12461 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12462 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12463 needs to be stopped quickly.
12464
12465 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12466 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12467 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12468
12469 @kindex tstatus
12470 @cindex status of trace data collection
12471 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12472 @item tstatus
12473 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12474 collection.
12475 @end table
12476
12477 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12478
12479 @smallexample
12480 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12481 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12482 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12483 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12484 > while-stepping 11
12485 > collect $regs
12486 > end
12487 > end
12488 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12489 [time passes @dots{}]
12490 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12491 @end smallexample
12492
12493 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12494 @cindex disconnected tracing
12495 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12496 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12497 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12498 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12499 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12500 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12501 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12502 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12503
12504 @table @code
12505 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12506 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12507 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12508 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12509 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12510 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12511 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12512 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12513
12514 @item show disconnected-tracing
12515 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12516 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12517
12518 @end table
12519
12520 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12521 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12522 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12523 it will continue after reconnection.
12524
12525 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12526 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12527 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12528 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12529 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12530 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12531 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12532 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12533 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12534 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12535
12536 @cindex circular trace buffer
12537 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12538 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12539 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12540 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12541 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12542 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12543 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12544 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12545 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12546 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12547 the next run.
12548
12549 @table @code
12550 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12551 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12552 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12553 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12554 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12555 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12556 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12557
12558 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12559 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12560 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12561 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12562 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12563 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12564
12565 @end table
12566
12567 @table @code
12568 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12569 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12570 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12571 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12572 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12573 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12574 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12575 likes. This is also the default.
12576
12577 @item show trace-buffer-size
12578 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12579 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12580 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12581 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12582 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12583 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12584 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12585 @end table
12586
12587 @table @code
12588 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12589 @kindex set trace-user
12590
12591 @item show trace-user
12592 @kindex show trace-user
12593
12594 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12595 @kindex set trace-notes
12596 Set the trace run's notes.
12597
12598 @item show trace-notes
12599 @kindex show trace-notes
12600 Show the trace run's notes.
12601
12602 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12603 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
12604 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
12605 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
12606 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
12607
12608 @item show trace-stop-notes
12609 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
12610 Show the trace run's stop notes.
12611
12612 @end table
12613
12614 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
12615 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
12616
12617 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
12618 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
12619 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
12620 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
12621 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
12622 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
12623 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
12624 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
12625 mentioned here.
12626
12627 @itemize @bullet
12628
12629 @item
12630 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
12631 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
12632 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
12633 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
12634 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
12635 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
12636 cannot be collected either.
12637
12638 @item
12639 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
12640 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
12641 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
12642 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
12643 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
12644 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
12645 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
12646 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
12647 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
12648 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
12649
12650 @item
12651 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
12652 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
12653 in a misleading way.
12654
12655 @item
12656 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
12657 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
12658 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
12659 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
12660 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
12661 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
12662 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
12663 by @code{ptr}.
12664
12665 @item
12666 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
12667 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
12668 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
12669 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
12670 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
12671 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
12672 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
12673 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
12674 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
12675 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
12676 invalid address.
12677
12678 @item
12679 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
12680 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
12681 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
12682 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
12683 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
12684 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
12685 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
12686 it to zero.
12687
12688 @end itemize
12689
12690 @node Analyze Collected Data
12691 @section Using the Collected Data
12692
12693 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
12694 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
12695 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
12696 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
12697 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
12698 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
12699 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
12700 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
12701 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
12702 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
12703 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
12704 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
12705 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
12706 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
12707 the buffer will fail.
12708
12709 @menu
12710 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
12711 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
12712 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
12713 @end menu
12714
12715 @node tfind
12716 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
12717
12718 @kindex tfind
12719 @cindex select trace snapshot
12720 @cindex find trace snapshot
12721 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
12722 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
12723 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
12724 snapshot is selected.
12725
12726 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
12727
12728 @table @code
12729 @item tfind start
12730 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
12731 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
12732
12733 @item tfind none
12734 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
12735
12736 @item tfind end
12737 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
12738
12739 @item tfind
12740 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
12741
12742 @item tfind -
12743 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
12744 retracing earlier steps.
12745
12746 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
12747 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
12748 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
12749 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
12750 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
12751
12752 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
12753 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
12754 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
12755 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
12756 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
12757
12758 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12759 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
12760 addresses (exclusive).
12761
12762 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12763 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
12764 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
12765
12766 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
12767 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
12768 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
12769 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
12770 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
12771 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
12772 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
12773 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
12774 @end table
12775
12776 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
12777 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
12778 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
12779 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
12780 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
12781 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
12782 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
12783 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
12784 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
12785 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
12786 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
12787 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
12788 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
12789 tracepoint as the current one.
12790
12791 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
12792 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
12793 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
12794 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
12795 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
12796
12797 @smallexample
12798 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12799 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12800 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
12801 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
12802 > tfind
12803 > end
12804
12805 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
12806 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
12807 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
12808 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
12809 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
12810 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
12811 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
12812 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
12813 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
12814 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
12815 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
12816 @end smallexample
12817
12818 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
12819 the buffer:
12820
12821 @smallexample
12822 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12823 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12824 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
12825 > tfind line
12826 > end
12827
12828 Frame 0, X = 1
12829 Frame 7, X = 2
12830 Frame 13, X = 255
12831 @end smallexample
12832
12833 @node tdump
12834 @subsection @code{tdump}
12835 @kindex tdump
12836 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
12837 @cindex tracepoint data, display
12838
12839 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
12840 the current trace snapshot.
12841
12842 @smallexample
12843 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
12844 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12845 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
12846 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
12847 > end
12848
12849 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12850
12851 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
12852 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
12853 at gdb_test.c:444
12854 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
12855
12856 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
12857 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
12858 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
12859 d1 0x18 24
12860 d2 0x80 128
12861 d3 0x33 51
12862 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
12863 d5 0x22 34
12864 d6 0xe0 224
12865 d7 0x380035 3670069
12866 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
12867 a1 0x3000668 50333288
12868 a2 0x100 256
12869 a3 0x322000 3284992
12870 a4 0x3000698 50333336
12871 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
12872 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
12873 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
12874 ps 0x0 0
12875 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
12876 fpcontrol 0x0 0
12877 fpstatus 0x0 0
12878 fpiaddr 0x0 0
12879 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
12880 p1 = (void *) 0x11
12881 p2 = (void *) 0x22
12882 p3 = (void *) 0x33
12883 p4 = (void *) 0x44
12884 p5 = (void *) 0x55
12885 p6 = (void *) 0x66
12886 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
12887
12888 (@value{GDBP})
12889 @end smallexample
12890
12891 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
12892 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
12893 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
12894 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
12895
12896 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
12897 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
12898 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
12899 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
12900 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
12901 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
12902 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
12903 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
12904 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
12905 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
12906
12907 @node save tracepoints
12908 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
12909 @kindex save tracepoints
12910 @kindex save-tracepoints
12911 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
12912
12913 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
12914 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
12915 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
12916 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
12917 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
12918 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
12919
12920 @node Tracepoint Variables
12921 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
12922 @cindex tracepoint variables
12923 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
12924
12925 @table @code
12926 @vindex $trace_frame
12927 @item (int) $trace_frame
12928 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
12929 snapshot is selected.
12930
12931 @vindex $tracepoint
12932 @item (int) $tracepoint
12933 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
12934
12935 @vindex $trace_line
12936 @item (int) $trace_line
12937 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
12938
12939 @vindex $trace_file
12940 @item (char []) $trace_file
12941 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
12942
12943 @vindex $trace_func
12944 @item (char []) $trace_func
12945 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
12946 @end table
12947
12948 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
12949 use @code{output} instead.
12950
12951 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
12952 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
12953 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
12954 which are managed by the target.
12955
12956 @smallexample
12957 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12958
12959 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
12960 > output $trace_file
12961 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
12962 > tfind
12963 > end
12964 @end smallexample
12965
12966 @node Trace Files
12967 @section Using Trace Files
12968 @cindex trace files
12969
12970 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
12971 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
12972 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
12973 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
12974 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
12975
12976 @table @code
12977
12978 @kindex tsave
12979 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
12980 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
12981 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
12982 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
12983 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
12984 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
12985 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
12986 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
12987 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
12988 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
12989 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
12990 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
12991 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
12992 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
12993 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
12994
12995 @kindex target tfile
12996 @kindex tfile
12997 @kindex target ctf
12998 @kindex ctf
12999 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13000 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13001 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13002 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13003 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13004 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13005 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13006 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13007 the host.
13008
13009 @smallexample
13010 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13011 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13012 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13013 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13014 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13015 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13016 i = 0
13017 a = 0
13018 b = 1 '\001'
13019 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13020 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13021 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13022 $1 = 1
13023 @end smallexample
13024
13025 @end table
13026
13027 @node Overlays
13028 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13029 @cindex overlays
13030
13031 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13032 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13033 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13034 use overlays.
13035
13036 @menu
13037 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13038 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13039 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13040 mapped by asking the inferior.
13041 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13042 @end menu
13043
13044 @node How Overlays Work
13045 @section How Overlays Work
13046 @cindex mapped overlays
13047 @cindex unmapped overlays
13048 @cindex load address, overlay's
13049 @cindex mapped address
13050 @cindex overlay area
13051
13052 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13053 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13054 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13055 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13056 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13057
13058 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13059 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13060 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13061 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13062 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13063 largest overlay as well.
13064
13065 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13066 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13067 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13068 there.
13069
13070 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13071 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13072 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13073
13074 @smallexample
13075 @group
13076 Data Instruction Larger
13077 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13078 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13079 | | | | | |
13080 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13081 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13082 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13083 | and heap | | | | | |
13084 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13085 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13086 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13087 | | | | | |
13088 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13089 address | | | | | |
13090 | overlay | <-' | | |
13091 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13092 | | <---. | | load address
13093 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13094 | | | |
13095 +-----------+ | |
13096 +-----------+
13097 | |
13098 +-----------+
13099
13100 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13101 @end group
13102 @end smallexample
13103
13104 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13105 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13106 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13107 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13108 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13109 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13110 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13111 program and the overlay area.
13112
13113 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13114 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13115 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13116 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13117 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13118 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13119 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13120
13121 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13122 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13123 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13124
13125 @itemize @bullet
13126
13127 @item
13128 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13129 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13130 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13131 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13132
13133 @item
13134 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13135 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13136 your program's performance.
13137
13138 @item
13139 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13140 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13141 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13142 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13143 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13144 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13145 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13146
13147 @item
13148 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13149 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13150 instruction and data spaces.
13151
13152 @end itemize
13153
13154 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13155 improved in many ways:
13156
13157 @itemize @bullet
13158
13159 @item
13160 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13161 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13162 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13163 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13164 area in the usual way.
13165
13166 @item
13167 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13168 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13169
13170 @item
13171 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13172 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13173 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13174 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13175 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13176 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13177 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13178
13179 @end itemize
13180
13181
13182 @node Overlay Commands
13183 @section Overlay Commands
13184
13185 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13186 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13187 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13188 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13189 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13190 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13191
13192 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13193 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13194
13195 @table @code
13196 @item overlay off
13197 @kindex overlay
13198 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13199 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13200 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13201 overlay support is disabled.
13202
13203 @item overlay manual
13204 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13205 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13206 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13207 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13208 commands described below.
13209
13210 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13211 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13212 @cindex map an overlay
13213 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13214 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13215 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13216 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13217 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13218 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13219
13220 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13221 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13222 @cindex unmap an overlay
13223 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13224 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13225 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13226 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13227
13228 @item overlay auto
13229 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13230 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13231 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13232 Overlay Debugging}.
13233
13234 @item overlay load-target
13235 @itemx overlay load
13236 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13237 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13238 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13239 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13240 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13241 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13242
13243 @item overlay list-overlays
13244 @itemx overlay list
13245 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13246 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13247 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13248
13249 @end table
13250
13251 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13252 of the function the address falls in:
13253
13254 @smallexample
13255 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13256 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13257 @end smallexample
13258 @noindent
13259 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13260 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13261 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13262 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13263
13264 @smallexample
13265 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13266 No sections are mapped.
13267 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13268 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13269 @end smallexample
13270 @noindent
13271 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13272 name normally:
13273
13274 @smallexample
13275 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13276 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13277 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13278 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13279 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13280 @end smallexample
13281
13282 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13283 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13284 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13285 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13286 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13287
13288 @itemize @bullet
13289 @item
13290 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13291 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13292 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13293 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13294 @item
13295 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13296 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13297 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13298 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13299 breakpoints properly.
13300 @end itemize
13301
13302
13303 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13304 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13305 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13306
13307 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13308 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13309 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13310 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13311 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13312 current state of the overlays.
13313
13314 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13315 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13316
13317 @table @asis
13318
13319 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13320 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13321
13322 @smallexample
13323 struct
13324 @{
13325 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13326 unsigned long vma;
13327
13328 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13329 unsigned long size;
13330
13331 /* The overlay's load address. */
13332 unsigned long lma;
13333
13334 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13335 zero otherwise. */
13336 unsigned long mapped;
13337 @}
13338 @end smallexample
13339
13340 @item @code{_novlys}:
13341 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13342 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13343
13344 @end table
13345
13346 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13347 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13348 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13349 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13350 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13351 currently mapped.
13352
13353 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13354 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13355 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13356 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13357 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13358 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13359 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13360 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13361 are not being executed.
13362
13363 @node Overlay Sample Program
13364 @section Overlay Sample Program
13365 @cindex overlay example program
13366
13367 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13368 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13369 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13370 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13371 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13372 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13373 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13374
13375 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13376 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13377 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13378 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13379
13380 @table @file
13381 @item overlays.c
13382 The main program file.
13383 @item ovlymgr.c
13384 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13385 @item foo.c
13386 @itemx bar.c
13387 @itemx baz.c
13388 @itemx grbx.c
13389 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13390 @item d10v.ld
13391 @itemx m32r.ld
13392 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13393 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13394 @end table
13395
13396 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13397 cross-compiler like this:
13398
13399 @smallexample
13400 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13401 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13402 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13403 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13404 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13405 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13406 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13407 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13408 @end smallexample
13409
13410 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13411 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13412 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13413
13414
13415 @node Languages
13416 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13417 @cindex languages
13418
13419 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13420 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13421 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13422 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13423 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13424 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13425
13426 @cindex working language
13427 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13428 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13429 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13430 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13431 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13432 language}.
13433
13434 @menu
13435 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13436 * Show:: Displaying the language
13437 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13438 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13439 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13440 @end menu
13441
13442 @node Setting
13443 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13444
13445 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13446 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13447 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13448 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13449 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13450 are printed, etc.
13451
13452 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13453 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13454 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13455 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13456 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13457 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13458 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13459 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13460 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13461 Displaying the Language}.
13462
13463 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13464 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13465 another language. In that case, make the
13466 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13467 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13468 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13469
13470 @menu
13471 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13472 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13473 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13474 @end menu
13475
13476 @node Filenames
13477 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13478
13479 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13480 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13481
13482 @table @file
13483 @item .ada
13484 @itemx .ads
13485 @itemx .adb
13486 @itemx .a
13487 Ada source file.
13488
13489 @item .c
13490 C source file
13491
13492 @item .C
13493 @itemx .cc
13494 @itemx .cp
13495 @itemx .cpp
13496 @itemx .cxx
13497 @itemx .c++
13498 C@t{++} source file
13499
13500 @item .d
13501 D source file
13502
13503 @item .m
13504 Objective-C source file
13505
13506 @item .f
13507 @itemx .F
13508 Fortran source file
13509
13510 @item .mod
13511 Modula-2 source file
13512
13513 @item .s
13514 @itemx .S
13515 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13516 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13517 @end table
13518
13519 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13520 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13521
13522 @node Manually
13523 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13524
13525 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13526 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13527 your program.
13528
13529 @kindex set language
13530 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13531 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13532 a language, such as
13533 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13534 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13535
13536 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13537 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13538 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13539 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13540 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13541 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13542 command such as:
13543
13544 @smallexample
13545 print a = b + c
13546 @end smallexample
13547
13548 @noindent
13549 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13550 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13551 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13552 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13553
13554 @node Automatically
13555 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13556
13557 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13558 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13559 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13560 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13561 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13562 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13563 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13564 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13565 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13566
13567 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13568 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13569 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13570 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13571 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13572
13573 @node Show
13574 @section Displaying the Language
13575
13576 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13577 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13578
13579 @table @code
13580 @item show language
13581 @anchor{show language}
13582 @kindex show language
13583 Display the current working language. This is the
13584 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13585 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13586
13587 @item info frame
13588 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13589 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13590 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13591 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13592 information listed here.
13593
13594 @item info source
13595 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13596 Display the source language of this source file.
13597 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13598 information listed here.
13599 @end table
13600
13601 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13602 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13603 with a language explicitly:
13604
13605 @table @code
13606 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
13607 @kindex set extension-language
13608 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
13609 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
13610
13611 @item info extensions
13612 @kindex info extensions
13613 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
13614 @end table
13615
13616 @node Checks
13617 @section Type and Range Checking
13618
13619 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
13620 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
13621 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
13622 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
13623 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
13624 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
13625 errors when your program is running.
13626
13627 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
13628 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
13629 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
13630 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
13631
13632 @menu
13633 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
13634 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
13635 @end menu
13636
13637 @cindex type checking
13638 @cindex checks, type
13639 @node Type Checking
13640 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
13641
13642 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
13643 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
13644 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
13645 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
13646
13647 @smallexample
13648 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
13649
13650 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
13651 $1 = 2
13652 @exdent but
13653 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
13654 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
13655 @end smallexample
13656
13657 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
13658 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
13659
13660 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13661 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
13662 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
13663 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
13664 expressions like the second example above.
13665
13666 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
13667 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
13668 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
13669 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
13670 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
13671 little sense to evaluate anyway.
13672
13673 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
13674
13675 @kindex set check type
13676 @kindex show check type
13677 @table @code
13678 @item set check type on
13679 @itemx set check type off
13680 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
13681 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
13682 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
13683
13684 @item show check type
13685 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
13686 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
13687 @end table
13688
13689 @cindex range checking
13690 @cindex checks, range
13691 @node Range Checking
13692 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
13693
13694 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
13695 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
13696 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
13697 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
13698 not exceed the bounds of the array.
13699
13700 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13701 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
13702 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
13703 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
13704
13705 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
13706 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
13707 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
13708 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
13709 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
13710 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
13711
13712 @smallexample
13713 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
13714 @end smallexample
13715
13716 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
13717 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
13718 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
13719
13720 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
13721
13722 @kindex set check range
13723 @kindex show check range
13724 @table @code
13725 @item set check range auto
13726 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
13727 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
13728 each language.
13729
13730 @item set check range on
13731 @itemx set check range off
13732 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
13733 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
13734 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
13735 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
13736
13737 @item set check range warn
13738 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
13739 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
13740 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
13741 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
13742 systems).
13743
13744 @item show range
13745 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
13746 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
13747 @end table
13748
13749 @node Supported Languages
13750 @section Supported Languages
13751
13752 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
13753 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
13754 @c This is false ...
13755 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
13756 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
13757 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
13758 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
13759 language.
13760
13761 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
13762 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
13763 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
13764 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
13765 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
13766 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
13767 language reference or tutorial.
13768
13769 @menu
13770 * C:: C and C@t{++}
13771 * D:: D
13772 * Go:: Go
13773 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
13774 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
13775 * Fortran:: Fortran
13776 * Pascal:: Pascal
13777 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
13778 * Ada:: Ada
13779 @end menu
13780
13781 @node C
13782 @subsection C and C@t{++}
13783
13784 @cindex C and C@t{++}
13785 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
13786
13787 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
13788 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
13789 together.
13790
13791 @cindex C@t{++}
13792 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
13793 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
13794 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
13795 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
13796 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
13797 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
13798 compiler (@code{aCC}).
13799
13800 @menu
13801 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
13802 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
13803 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
13804 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
13805 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
13806 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
13807 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
13808 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
13809 @end menu
13810
13811 @node C Operators
13812 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
13813
13814 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
13815
13816 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
13817 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
13818 often defined on groups of types.
13819
13820 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
13821
13822 @itemize @bullet
13823
13824 @item
13825 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
13826 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
13827
13828 @item
13829 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
13830 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
13831
13832 @item
13833 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
13834
13835 @item
13836 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
13837
13838 @end itemize
13839
13840 @noindent
13841 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
13842 in order of increasing precedence:
13843
13844 @table @code
13845 @item ,
13846 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
13847 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
13848 expression being the last expression evaluated.
13849
13850 @item =
13851 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
13852 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
13853
13854 @item @var{op}=
13855 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
13856 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
13857 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
13858 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
13859 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
13860
13861 @item ?:
13862 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
13863 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
13864 should be of an integral type.
13865
13866 @item ||
13867 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13868
13869 @item &&
13870 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13871
13872 @item |
13873 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13874
13875 @item ^
13876 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
13877
13878 @item &
13879 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
13880
13881 @item ==@r{, }!=
13882 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
13883 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
13884
13885 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
13886 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
13887 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
13888 and non-zero for true.
13889
13890 @item <<@r{, }>>
13891 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
13892
13893 @item @@
13894 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
13895
13896 @item +@r{, }-
13897 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
13898 pointer types.
13899
13900 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
13901 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
13902 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
13903 integral types.
13904
13905 @item ++@r{, }--
13906 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
13907 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
13908 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
13909 operation takes place.
13910
13911 @item *
13912 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
13913 @code{++}.
13914
13915 @item &
13916 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
13917
13918 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
13919 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
13920 to examine the address
13921 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
13922 stored.
13923
13924 @item -
13925 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
13926 precedence as @code{++}.
13927
13928 @item !
13929 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13930 @code{++}.
13931
13932 @item ~
13933 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
13934 @code{++}.
13935
13936
13937 @item .@r{, }->
13938 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
13939 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
13940 pointer based on the stored type information.
13941 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
13942
13943 @item .*@r{, }->*
13944 Dereferences of pointers to members.
13945
13946 @item []
13947 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
13948 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13949
13950 @item ()
13951 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
13952
13953 @item ::
13954 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
13955 and @code{class} types.
13956
13957 @item ::
13958 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
13959 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
13960 above.
13961 @end table
13962
13963 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
13964 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
13965 predefined meaning.
13966
13967 @node C Constants
13968 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
13969
13970 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
13971
13972 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
13973 following ways:
13974
13975 @itemize @bullet
13976 @item
13977 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
13978 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
13979 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
13980 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
13981 @code{long} value.
13982
13983 @item
13984 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
13985 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
13986 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
13987 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
13988 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
13989 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
13990 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
13991 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
13992 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
13993 constant.
13994
13995 @item
13996 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
13997 integral equivalents.
13998
13999 @item
14000 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14001 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14002 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14003 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14004 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14005 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14006 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14007 @samp{\n} for newline.
14008
14009 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14010 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14011 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14012 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14013
14014 @item
14015 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14016 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14017 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14018 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14019 characters.
14020
14021 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14022 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14023 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14024
14025 @item
14026 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14027 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14028
14029 @item
14030 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14031 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14032 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14033 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14034 @end itemize
14035
14036 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14037 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14038
14039 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14040 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14041
14042 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14043 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14044 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14045 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14046 @quotation
14047 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14048 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14049 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14050 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14051 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14052 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14053 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14054 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14055 @end quotation
14056
14057 @enumerate
14058
14059 @cindex member functions
14060 @item
14061 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14062
14063 @smallexample
14064 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14065 @end smallexample
14066
14067 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14068 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14069 @item
14070 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14071 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14072 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14073 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14074 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14075
14076 @cindex call overloaded functions
14077 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14078 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14079 @item
14080 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14081 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14082 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14083 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14084 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14085 default arguments.
14086
14087 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14088 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14089 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14090 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14091 number of function arguments.
14092
14093 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14094 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14095 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14096
14097 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14098 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14099 @smallexample
14100 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14101 @end smallexample
14102
14103 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14104 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14105
14106 @cindex reference declarations
14107 @item
14108 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14109 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14110 dereferenced.
14111
14112 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14113 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14114 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14115 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14116 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14117
14118 @item
14119 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14120 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14121 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14122 necessary, for example in an expression like
14123 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14124 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14125 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14126
14127 @item
14128 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14129 specification.
14130 @end enumerate
14131
14132 @node C Defaults
14133 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14134
14135 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14136
14137 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14138 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14139 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14140 selects the working language.
14141
14142 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14143 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14144 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14145 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14146 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14147 for further details.
14148
14149 @node C Checks
14150 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14151
14152 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14153
14154 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14155 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14156 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14157 constants to pointers.
14158
14159 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14160 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14161 that is not itself an array.
14162
14163 @node Debugging C
14164 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14165
14166 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14167 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14168 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14169 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14170
14171 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14172 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14173 ,Expressions}.
14174
14175 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14176 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14177
14178 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14179
14180 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14181 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14182
14183 @table @code
14184 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14185 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14186 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14187 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14188 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14189 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14190
14191 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14192 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14193 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14194 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14195 classes.
14196 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14197
14198 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14199 @item catch throw
14200 @itemx catch rethrow
14201 @itemx catch catch
14202 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14203 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14204
14205 @cindex inheritance
14206 @item ptype @var{typename}
14207 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14208 @var{typename}.
14209 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14210
14211 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14212 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14213 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14214 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14215 multiple inheritance is in use.
14216
14217 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14218 @item set print demangle
14219 @itemx show print demangle
14220 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14221 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14222 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14223 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14224 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14225
14226 @item set print object
14227 @itemx show print object
14228 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14229 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14230
14231 @item set print vtbl
14232 @itemx show print vtbl
14233 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14234 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14235 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14236 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14237
14238 @kindex set overload-resolution
14239 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14240 @item set overload-resolution on
14241 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14242 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14243 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14244 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14245 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14246 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14247
14248 @item set overload-resolution off
14249 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14250 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14251 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14252 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14253 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14254 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14255 argument types.
14256
14257 @kindex show overload-resolution
14258 @item show overload-resolution
14259 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14260
14261 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14262 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14263 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14264 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14265 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14266 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14267 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14268 @end table
14269
14270 @node Decimal Floating Point
14271 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14272 @cindex decimal floating point format
14273
14274 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14275 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14276 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14277 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14278
14279 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14280 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14281 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14282 configured target.
14283
14284 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14285 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14286 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14287
14288 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14289 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14290 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14291
14292 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14293 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14294 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14295
14296 @node D
14297 @subsection D
14298
14299 @cindex D
14300 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14301 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14302 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14303
14304 @node Go
14305 @subsection Go
14306
14307 @cindex Go (programming language)
14308 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14309 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14310
14311 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14312
14313 @table @code
14314 @cindex current Go package
14315 @item The current Go package
14316 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14317 specifying global variables and functions.
14318
14319 For example, given the program:
14320
14321 @example
14322 package main
14323 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14324 func main () @{
14325 // ...
14326 @}
14327 @end example
14328
14329 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14330
14331 @example
14332 (gdb) p myglob
14333 (gdb) p main.myglob
14334 @end example
14335
14336 @cindex builtin Go types
14337 @item Builtin Go types
14338 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14339 as a string.
14340
14341 @cindex builtin Go functions
14342 @item Builtin Go functions
14343 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14344 function and handles it internally.
14345
14346 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14347 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14348 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14349 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14350 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14351 @end table
14352
14353 @node Objective-C
14354 @subsection Objective-C
14355
14356 @cindex Objective-C
14357 This section provides information about some commands and command
14358 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14359 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14360 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14361
14362 @menu
14363 * Method Names in Commands::
14364 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14365 @end menu
14366
14367 @node Method Names in Commands
14368 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14369
14370 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14371 names as line specifications:
14372
14373 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14374 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14375 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14376 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14377 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14378 @itemize
14379 @item @code{clear}
14380 @item @code{break}
14381 @item @code{info line}
14382 @item @code{jump}
14383 @item @code{list}
14384 @end itemize
14385
14386 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14387
14388 @smallexample
14389 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14390 @end smallexample
14391
14392 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14393 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14394 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14395 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14396 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14397 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14398 debugged, enter:
14399
14400 @smallexample
14401 break -[Fruit create]
14402 @end smallexample
14403
14404 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14405 enter:
14406
14407 @smallexample
14408 list +[NSText initialize]
14409 @end smallexample
14410
14411 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14412 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14413 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14414 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14415
14416 @smallexample
14417 break create
14418 @end smallexample
14419
14420 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14421 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14422 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14423 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14424 none apply.
14425
14426 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14427 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14428
14429 @smallexample
14430 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14431 @end smallexample
14432
14433 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14434 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14435 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14436 @kindex print-object
14437 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14438
14439 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14440
14441 @smallexample
14442 print -[@var{object} hash]
14443 @end smallexample
14444
14445 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14446 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14447 @noindent
14448 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14449 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14450 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14451 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14452 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14453 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14454
14455 @node OpenCL C
14456 @subsection OpenCL C
14457
14458 @cindex OpenCL C
14459 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14460
14461 @menu
14462 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14463 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14464 * OpenCL C Operators::
14465 @end menu
14466
14467 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14468 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14469
14470 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14471 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14472 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14473 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14474 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14475
14476 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14477 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14478
14479 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14480 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14481 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14482 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14483
14484 @node OpenCL C Operators
14485 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14486
14487 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14488 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14489 vector data types.
14490
14491 @node Fortran
14492 @subsection Fortran
14493 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14494
14495 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14496 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14497
14498 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14499 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14500 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14501 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14502 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14503 underscore.
14504
14505 @menu
14506 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14507 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14508 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14509 @end menu
14510
14511 @node Fortran Operators
14512 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14513
14514 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14515
14516 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14517 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14518 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14519
14520 @table @code
14521 @item **
14522 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14523 of the second one.
14524
14525 @item :
14526 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14527 represent a section of array.
14528
14529 @item %
14530 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14531 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14532 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14533 union type.
14534 @end table
14535
14536 @node Fortran Defaults
14537 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14538
14539 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14540
14541 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14542 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14543 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14544 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14545
14546 @node Special Fortran Commands
14547 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14548
14549 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14550
14551 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14552 such as displaying common blocks.
14553
14554 @table @code
14555 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14556 @kindex info common
14557 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14558 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14559 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14560 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14561 printed.
14562 @end table
14563
14564 @node Pascal
14565 @subsection Pascal
14566
14567 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14568 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14569 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14570 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14571 syntax.
14572
14573 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14574 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14575 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14576
14577 @node Modula-2
14578 @subsection Modula-2
14579
14580 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14581
14582 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14583 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14584 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14585 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14586 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14587 table.
14588
14589 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14590 @menu
14591 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14592 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14593 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14594 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14595 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14596 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14597 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14598 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14599 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14600 @end menu
14601
14602 @node M2 Operators
14603 @subsubsection Operators
14604 @cindex Modula-2 operators
14605
14606 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14607 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14608 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
14609 following definitions hold:
14610
14611 @itemize @bullet
14612
14613 @item
14614 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
14615 their subranges.
14616
14617 @item
14618 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
14619
14620 @item
14621 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
14622
14623 @item
14624 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
14625 @var{type}}.
14626
14627 @item
14628 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
14629
14630 @item
14631 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
14632
14633 @item
14634 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
14635 @end itemize
14636
14637 @noindent
14638 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
14639 increasing precedence:
14640
14641 @table @code
14642 @item ,
14643 Function argument or array index separator.
14644
14645 @item :=
14646 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
14647 @var{value}.
14648
14649 @item <@r{, }>
14650 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
14651 types.
14652
14653 @item <=@r{, }>=
14654 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
14655 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
14656 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
14657
14658 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
14659 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
14660 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
14661 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
14662 comment character.
14663
14664 @item IN
14665 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
14666 Same precedence as @code{<}.
14667
14668 @item OR
14669 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14670
14671 @item AND@r{, }&
14672 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14673
14674 @item @@
14675 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14676
14677 @item +@r{, }-
14678 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
14679 and difference on set types.
14680
14681 @item *
14682 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
14683 on set types.
14684
14685 @item /
14686 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
14687 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
14688
14689 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
14690 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
14691 precedence as @code{*}.
14692
14693 @item -
14694 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
14695
14696 @item ^
14697 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
14698
14699 @item NOT
14700 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
14701 @code{^}.
14702
14703 @item .
14704 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
14705 precedence as @code{^}.
14706
14707 @item []
14708 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
14709
14710 @item ()
14711 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
14712 as @code{^}.
14713
14714 @item ::@r{, }.
14715 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
14716 @end table
14717
14718 @quotation
14719 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
14720 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
14721 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
14722 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
14723 @end quotation
14724
14725
14726 @node Built-In Func/Proc
14727 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
14728 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
14729
14730 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
14731 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
14732
14733 @table @var
14734
14735 @item a
14736 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
14737
14738 @item c
14739 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
14740
14741 @item i
14742 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
14743
14744 @item m
14745 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
14746 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
14747 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
14748
14749 @item n
14750 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
14751
14752 @item r
14753 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
14754
14755 @item t
14756 represents a type.
14757
14758 @item v
14759 represents a variable.
14760
14761 @item x
14762 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
14763 explanation of the function for details.
14764 @end table
14765
14766 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
14767
14768 @table @code
14769 @item ABS(@var{n})
14770 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
14771
14772 @item CAP(@var{c})
14773 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
14774 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
14775
14776 @item CHR(@var{i})
14777 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14778
14779 @item DEC(@var{v})
14780 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14781
14782 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
14783 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14784 new value.
14785
14786 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14787 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
14788 set.
14789
14790 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
14791 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
14792
14793 @item HIGH(@var{a})
14794 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
14795
14796 @item INC(@var{v})
14797 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14798
14799 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
14800 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14801 new value.
14802
14803 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14804 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
14805 there. Returns the new set.
14806
14807 @item MAX(@var{t})
14808 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
14809
14810 @item MIN(@var{t})
14811 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
14812
14813 @item ODD(@var{i})
14814 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
14815
14816 @item ORD(@var{x})
14817 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
14818 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
14819 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
14820 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
14821
14822 @item SIZE(@var{x})
14823 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
14824 variable or a type.
14825
14826 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
14827 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
14828
14829 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
14830 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
14831 variable or a type.
14832
14833 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
14834 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14835 @end table
14836
14837 @quotation
14838 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
14839 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
14840 an error.
14841 @end quotation
14842
14843 @cindex Modula-2 constants
14844 @node M2 Constants
14845 @subsubsection Constants
14846
14847 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
14848 ways:
14849
14850 @itemize @bullet
14851
14852 @item
14853 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
14854 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
14855 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
14856 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
14857
14858 @item
14859 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
14860 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
14861 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
14862 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
14863 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
14864 digits.
14865
14866 @item
14867 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
14868 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
14869 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
14870 followed by a @samp{C}.
14871
14872 @item
14873 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
14874 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
14875 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
14876 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
14877 sequences.
14878
14879 @item
14880 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
14881
14882 @item
14883 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
14884 @code{FALSE}.
14885
14886 @item
14887 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
14888
14889 @item
14890 Set constants are not yet supported.
14891 @end itemize
14892
14893 @node M2 Types
14894 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
14895 @cindex Modula-2 types
14896
14897 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
14898 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
14899 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
14900 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
14901 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
14902 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
14903
14904 The first example contains the following section of code:
14905
14906 @smallexample
14907 VAR
14908 s: SET OF CHAR ;
14909 r: [20..40] ;
14910 @end smallexample
14911
14912 @noindent
14913 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
14914 @code{r} and @code{s}.
14915
14916 @smallexample
14917 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14918 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
14919 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14920 SET OF CHAR
14921 (@value{GDBP}) print r
14922 21
14923 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
14924 [20..40]
14925 @end smallexample
14926
14927 @noindent
14928 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
14929
14930 @smallexample
14931 VAR
14932 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
14933 @end smallexample
14934
14935 @noindent
14936 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
14937
14938 @smallexample
14939 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14940 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
14941 @end smallexample
14942
14943 @noindent
14944 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
14945 expressions using the debugger.
14946
14947 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
14948 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
14949
14950 @smallexample
14951 VAR
14952 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
14953 @end smallexample
14954
14955 @smallexample
14956 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
14957 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
14958 @end smallexample
14959
14960 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
14961 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
14962 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
14963 above.
14964
14965 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
14966
14967 @smallexample
14968 TYPE
14969 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
14970 t = [blue..yellow] ;
14971 VAR
14972 s: t ;
14973 BEGIN
14974 s := blue ;
14975 @end smallexample
14976
14977 @noindent
14978 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
14979 and value of a variable.
14980
14981 @smallexample
14982 (@value{GDBP}) print s
14983 $1 = blue
14984 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
14985 type = [blue..yellow]
14986 @end smallexample
14987
14988 @noindent
14989 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
14990 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
14991 their @code{C} counterparts.
14992
14993 @smallexample
14994 VAR
14995 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
14996 BEGIN
14997 s[1] := 1 ;
14998 @end smallexample
14999
15000 @smallexample
15001 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15002 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15003 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15004 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15005 @end smallexample
15006
15007 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15008 pointer types as shown in this example:
15009
15010 @smallexample
15011 VAR
15012 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15013 BEGIN
15014 NEW(s) ;
15015 s^[1] := 1 ;
15016 @end smallexample
15017
15018 @noindent
15019 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15020
15021 @smallexample
15022 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15023 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15024 @end smallexample
15025
15026 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15027 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15028 types:
15029
15030 @smallexample
15031 TYPE
15032 foo = RECORD
15033 f1: CARDINAL ;
15034 f2: CHAR ;
15035 f3: myarray ;
15036 END ;
15037
15038 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15039 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15040 VAR
15041 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15042 @end smallexample
15043
15044 @noindent
15045 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15046 below.
15047
15048 @smallexample
15049 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15050 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15051 f1 : CARDINAL;
15052 f2 : CHAR;
15053 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15054 END
15055 @end smallexample
15056
15057 @node M2 Defaults
15058 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15059 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15060
15061 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15062 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15063 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15064 selected the working language.
15065
15066 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15067 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15068 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15069 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15070
15071 @node Deviations
15072 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15073 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15074
15075 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15076 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15077
15078 @itemize @bullet
15079 @item
15080 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15081 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15082 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15083 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15084 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15085 returned a pointer.)
15086
15087 @item
15088 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15089 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15090 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15091 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15092
15093 @item
15094 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15095 argument.
15096
15097 @item
15098 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15099 @end itemize
15100
15101 @node M2 Checks
15102 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15103 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15104
15105 @quotation
15106 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15107 range checking.
15108 @end quotation
15109 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15110
15111 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15112
15113 @itemize @bullet
15114 @item
15115 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15116 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15117
15118 @item
15119 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15120 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15121 @end itemize
15122
15123 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15124 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15125
15126 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15127 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15128
15129 @node M2 Scope
15130 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15131 @cindex scope
15132 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15133 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15134 @ifinfo
15135 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15136 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15137 @end ifinfo
15138 @ifnotinfo
15139 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15140 @end ifnotinfo
15141
15142 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15143 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15144 similar syntax:
15145
15146 @smallexample
15147
15148 @var{module} . @var{id}
15149 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15150 @end smallexample
15151
15152 @noindent
15153 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15154 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15155 identifier within your program, except another module.
15156
15157 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15158 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15159 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15160 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15161
15162 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15163 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15164 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15165 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15166 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15167 @var{module}.
15168
15169 @node GDB/M2
15170 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15171
15172 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15173 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15174 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15175 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15176 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15177 analogue in Modula-2.
15178
15179 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15180 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15181 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15182 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15183 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15184 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15185
15186 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15187 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15188 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15189
15190 @node Ada
15191 @subsection Ada
15192 @cindex Ada
15193
15194 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15195 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15196 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15197 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15198 to be difficult.
15199
15200
15201 @cindex expressions in Ada
15202 @menu
15203 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15204 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15205 in @value{GDBN}.
15206 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15207 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15208 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15209 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15210 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15211 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15212 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15213 Profile
15214 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15215 @end menu
15216
15217 @node Ada Mode Intro
15218 @subsubsection Introduction
15219 @cindex Ada mode, general
15220
15221 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15222 syntax, with some extensions.
15223 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15224
15225 @itemize @bullet
15226 @item
15227 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15228 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15229 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15230 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15231
15232 @item
15233 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15234 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15235
15236 @item
15237 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15238 @end itemize
15239
15240 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15241 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15242 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15243 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15244 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15245
15246 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15247 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15248 was translated from an Ada source file.
15249
15250 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15251 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15252 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15253 middle (to allow based literals).
15254
15255 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
15256 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
15257 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
15258 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
15259 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
15260 functions to procedures elsewhere.
15261
15262 @node Omissions from Ada
15263 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15264 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15265
15266 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15267
15268 @itemize @bullet
15269 @item
15270 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15271
15272 @itemize @minus
15273 @item
15274 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15275 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15276
15277 @item
15278 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15279
15280 @item
15281 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15282
15283 @item
15284 @t{'Tag}.
15285
15286 @item
15287 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15288 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15289
15290 @item
15291 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15292 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15293
15294 @item
15295 @t{'Address}.
15296 @end itemize
15297
15298 @item
15299 The names in
15300 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15301 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15302 not currently available.
15303
15304 @item
15305 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15306 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15307 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15308 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15309 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15310 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15311 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15312 indeterminate values.
15313
15314 @item
15315 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15316 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15317 are not implemented.
15318
15319 @item
15320 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15321 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15322 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15323 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15324 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15325
15326 @smallexample
15327 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15328 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15329 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15330 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15331 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15332 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15333 @end smallexample
15334
15335 Changing a
15336 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15337 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15338 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15339 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15340 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15341 declared to have a type such as:
15342
15343 @smallexample
15344 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15345 Id : Integer;
15346 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15347 end record;
15348 @end smallexample
15349
15350 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15351 assignments:
15352
15353 @smallexample
15354 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15355 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15356 @end smallexample
15357
15358 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15359 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15360 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15361 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15362 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15363 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15364 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15365 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15366
15367 @item
15368 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15369
15370 @item
15371 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15372 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15373 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15374 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15375 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15376 the proper resolution.
15377
15378 @item
15379 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15380
15381 @item
15382 Entry calls are not implemented.
15383
15384 @item
15385 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15386 formats are not supported.
15387
15388 @item
15389 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15390
15391 @item
15392 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15393 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15394 context.
15395 Should your program
15396 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15397 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15398 @end itemize
15399
15400 @node Additions to Ada
15401 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15402 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15403
15404 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15405 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15406
15407 @itemize @bullet
15408 @item
15409 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15410 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15411 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15412 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15413 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15414 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15415 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15416 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15417
15418 @item
15419 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15420 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15421 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15422
15423 @item
15424 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15425 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15426
15427 @item
15428 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15429 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15430 @end itemize
15431
15432 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15433 additions specific to Ada:
15434
15435 @itemize @bullet
15436 @item
15437 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15438 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15439
15440 @smallexample
15441 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15442 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15443 @end smallexample
15444
15445 @item
15446 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15447 the value of its right-hand operand.
15448 This allows, for example,
15449 complex conditional breaks:
15450
15451 @smallexample
15452 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15453 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15454 @end smallexample
15455
15456 @item
15457 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15458 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15459 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15460 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15461 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15462 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15463 in strings. For example,
15464 @smallexample
15465 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15466 @end smallexample
15467 @noindent
15468 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15469 after each period.
15470
15471 @item
15472 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15473 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15474 to write
15475
15476 @smallexample
15477 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15478 @end smallexample
15479
15480 @item
15481 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15482 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15483 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15484 of 3 might print as
15485
15486 @smallexample
15487 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15488 @end smallexample
15489
15490 @noindent
15491 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15492 clause.
15493
15494 @item
15495 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15496 multi-character subsequence of
15497 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15498 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15499 in place of @t{a'length}.
15500
15501 @item
15502 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15503 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15504 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15505 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15506 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15507 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15508 For example,
15509 @smallexample
15510 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15511 @end smallexample
15512
15513 @item
15514 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15515 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15516 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15517 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15518 object.
15519
15520 @end itemize
15521
15522 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15523 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15524
15525 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15526 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15527 before reaching the main procedure.
15528 As defined in the Ada Reference
15529 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15530 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15531 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15532 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15533
15534 @node Ada Exceptions
15535 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
15536
15537 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
15538
15539 @table @code
15540 @kindex info exceptions
15541 @item info exceptions
15542 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
15543 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
15544 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
15545 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
15546 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
15547 @end table
15548
15549 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
15550 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
15551 argument.
15552
15553 @smallexample
15554 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
15555 All defined Ada exceptions:
15556 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15557 program_error: 0x613d20
15558 storage_error: 0x613ce0
15559 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
15560 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15561 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
15562 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
15563 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15564 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15565 @end smallexample
15566
15567 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
15568 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
15569
15570 @node Ada Tasks
15571 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15572 @cindex Ada, tasking
15573
15574 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15575 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15576
15577 @table @code
15578 @kindex info tasks
15579 @item info tasks
15580 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
15581
15582
15583 @smallexample
15584 @iftex
15585 @leftskip=0.5cm
15586 @end iftex
15587 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15588 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15589 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15590 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
15591 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
15592 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
15593
15594 @end smallexample
15595
15596 @noindent
15597 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
15598 task currently being inspected.
15599
15600 @table @asis
15601 @item ID
15602 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
15603
15604 @item TID
15605 The Ada task ID.
15606
15607 @item P-ID
15608 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
15609
15610 @item Pri
15611 The base priority of the task.
15612
15613 @item State
15614 Current state of the task.
15615
15616 @table @code
15617 @item Unactivated
15618 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
15619 executing.
15620
15621 @item Runnable
15622 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
15623 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
15624
15625 @item Terminated
15626 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
15627 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
15628 terminated themselves.
15629
15630 @item Child Activation Wait
15631 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
15632
15633 @item Accept Statement
15634 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
15635
15636 @item Waiting on entry call
15637 The task is waiting on an entry call.
15638
15639 @item Async Select Wait
15640 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
15641 select statement.
15642
15643 @item Delay Sleep
15644 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
15645 alternative open.
15646
15647 @item Child Termination Wait
15648 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
15649 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
15650 waiting on a terminate Phase.
15651
15652 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
15653 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
15654 finish terminating.
15655
15656 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
15657 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
15658 @end table
15659
15660 @item Name
15661 Name of the task in the program.
15662
15663 @end table
15664
15665 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
15666 @item info task @var{taskno}
15667 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
15668 the following example:
15669 @smallexample
15670 @iftex
15671 @leftskip=0.5cm
15672 @end iftex
15673 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15674 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15675 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15676 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
15677 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
15678 Ada Task: 0x807c468
15679 Name: task_1
15680 Thread: 0x807f378
15681 Parent: 1 (main_task)
15682 Base Priority: 15
15683 State: Runnable
15684 @end smallexample
15685
15686 @item task
15687 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
15688 @cindex current Ada task ID
15689 This command prints the ID of the current task.
15690
15691 @smallexample
15692 @iftex
15693 @leftskip=0.5cm
15694 @end iftex
15695 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15696 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15697 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15698 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15699 (@value{GDBP}) task
15700 [Current task is 2]
15701 @end smallexample
15702
15703 @item task @var{taskno}
15704 @cindex Ada task switching
15705 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
15706 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
15707 from the current task to the given task.
15708
15709 @smallexample
15710 @iftex
15711 @leftskip=0.5cm
15712 @end iftex
15713 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15714 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15715 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15716 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15717 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
15718 [Switching to task 1]
15719 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15720 (@value{GDBP}) bt
15721 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15722 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
15723 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
15724 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
15725 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
15726 @end smallexample
15727
15728 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
15729 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
15730 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
15731 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
15732 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
15733 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
15734 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
15735 @var{linespec} argument specifies source lines, as described
15736 in @ref{Specify Location}.
15737
15738 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
15739 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
15740 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
15741 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
15742 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
15743
15744 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
15745 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
15746 program.
15747
15748 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
15749 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
15750 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
15751
15752 For example,
15753
15754 @smallexample
15755 @iftex
15756 @leftskip=0.5cm
15757 @end iftex
15758 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15759 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15760 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15761 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
15762 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15763 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
15764 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
15765 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
15766 (@value{GDBP}) cont
15767 Continuing.
15768 task # 1 running
15769 task # 2 running
15770
15771 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
15772 15 flush;
15773 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15774 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15775 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15776 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
15777 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15778 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
15779 @end smallexample
15780 @end table
15781
15782 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
15783 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15784 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
15785
15786 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
15787 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
15788 the platform being used.
15789 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
15790 switching is not supported.
15791
15792 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
15793 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
15794 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
15795 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
15796 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
15797 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
15798
15799 @node Ravenscar Profile
15800 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
15801 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
15802
15803 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
15804 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
15805 requirements.
15806
15807 @table @code
15808 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
15809 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
15810 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
15811 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15812 Profile. This is the default.
15813
15814 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
15815 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
15816 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15817 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
15818 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
15819 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
15820 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
15821
15822 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
15823 @item show ravenscar task-switching
15824 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
15825 using the Ravenscar Profile.
15826
15827 @end table
15828
15829 @node Ada Glitches
15830 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
15831 @cindex Ada, problems
15832
15833 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
15834 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
15835 @value{GDBN},
15836 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
15837 and the GNU Ada compiler.
15838
15839 @itemize @bullet
15840 @item
15841 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
15842 storage are invisible to the debugger.
15843
15844 @item
15845 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
15846 argument lists are treated as positional).
15847
15848 @item
15849 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
15850
15851 @item
15852 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
15853 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
15854 the host machine.
15855
15856 @item
15857 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
15858 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
15859 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
15860 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
15861 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
15862 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
15863 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
15864 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
15865 you can usually resolve the confusion
15866 by qualifying the problematic names with package
15867 @code{Standard} explicitly.
15868 @end itemize
15869
15870 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
15871 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
15872 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
15873 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
15874 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
15875 enabled.
15876
15877 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15878 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
15879 @table @code
15880
15881 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
15882 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
15883 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
15884 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
15885 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
15886 This is the default.
15887
15888 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
15889 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
15890 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
15891 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
15892 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
15893 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
15894 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
15895
15896 @end table
15897
15898 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
15899 @cindex GNAT encoding
15900 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
15901 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
15902 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
15903 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
15904 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
15905 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
15906
15907 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
15908 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
15909 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
15910 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
15911 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
15912 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
15913 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
15914 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
15915
15916 @table @code
15917
15918 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
15919 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
15920 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
15921 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
15922
15923 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
15924 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
15925 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
15926
15927 @end table
15928
15929 @node Unsupported Languages
15930 @section Unsupported Languages
15931
15932 @cindex unsupported languages
15933 @cindex minimal language
15934 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
15935 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
15936 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
15937 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
15938 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
15939 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
15940
15941 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
15942 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
15943 language.
15944
15945 @node Symbols
15946 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
15947
15948 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
15949 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
15950 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
15951 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
15952 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
15953 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
15954 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
15955
15956 @cindex symbol names
15957 @cindex names of symbols
15958 @cindex quoting names
15959 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
15960 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
15961 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
15962 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
15963 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
15964 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
15965 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
15966 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
15967
15968 @smallexample
15969 p 'foo.c'::x
15970 @end smallexample
15971
15972 @noindent
15973 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
15974
15975 @table @code
15976 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
15977 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
15978 @kindex set case-sensitive
15979 @item set case-sensitive on
15980 @itemx set case-sensitive off
15981 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
15982 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
15983 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
15984 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
15985 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
15986 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
15987 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
15988 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
15989 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
15990 case-insensitive matches.
15991
15992 @kindex show case-sensitive
15993 @item show case-sensitive
15994 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
15995 lookups.
15996
15997 @kindex set print type methods
15998 @item set print type methods
15999 @itemx set print type methods on
16000 @itemx set print type methods off
16001 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16002 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16003 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16004 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16005 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16006 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16007
16008 @kindex show print type methods
16009 @item show print type methods
16010 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16011 classes.
16012
16013 @kindex set print type typedefs
16014 @item set print type typedefs
16015 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16016 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16017
16018 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16019 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16020 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16021 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16022 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16023 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16024 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16025 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16026 types.
16027
16028 @kindex show print type typedefs
16029 @item show print type typedefs
16030 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16031 printing classes.
16032
16033 @kindex info address
16034 @cindex address of a symbol
16035 @item info address @var{symbol}
16036 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16037 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16038 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16039 is always stored.
16040
16041 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16042 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16043 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16044
16045 @kindex info symbol
16046 @cindex symbol from address
16047 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16048 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16049 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16050 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16051 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16052
16053 @smallexample
16054 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16055 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16056 @end smallexample
16057
16058 @noindent
16059 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16060 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16061
16062 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16063 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16064
16065 @smallexample
16066 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16067 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16068 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16069 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16070 @end smallexample
16071
16072 @kindex whatis
16073 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16074 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16075 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16076 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16077
16078 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16079 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16080 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16081
16082 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16083 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16084 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16085 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16086 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16087 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16088 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16089 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16090 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16091
16092 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16093 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16094 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16095 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16096 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16097 unroll it.
16098
16099 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16100 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16101 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16102
16103 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16104 Available flags are:
16105
16106 @table @code
16107 @item r
16108 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16109 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16110 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16111
16112 @item m
16113 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16114
16115 @item M
16116 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16117 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16118
16119 @item t
16120 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16121 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16122 names are substituted when printing other types.
16123
16124 @item T
16125 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16126 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16127 @end table
16128
16129 @kindex ptype
16130 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16131 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16132 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16133 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16134
16135 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16136 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16137 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16138 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16139 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16140 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16141 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16142 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16143
16144 For example, for this variable declaration:
16145
16146 @smallexample
16147 typedef double real_t;
16148 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16149 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16150 complex_t var;
16151 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16152 @end smallexample
16153
16154 @noindent
16155 the two commands give this output:
16156
16157 @smallexample
16158 @group
16159 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16160 type = complex_t
16161 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16162 type = struct complex @{
16163 real_t real;
16164 double imag;
16165 @}
16166 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16167 type = struct complex
16168 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16169 type = struct complex
16170 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16171 type = struct complex @{
16172 real_t real;
16173 double imag;
16174 @}
16175 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16176 type = real_t *
16177 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16178 type = double *
16179 @end group
16180 @end smallexample
16181
16182 @noindent
16183 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16184 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16185
16186 @cindex incomplete type
16187 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16188 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16189 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16190 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16191 given these declarations:
16192
16193 @smallexample
16194 struct foo;
16195 struct foo *fooptr;
16196 @end smallexample
16197
16198 @noindent
16199 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16200
16201 @smallexample
16202 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16203 $1 = <incomplete type>
16204 @end smallexample
16205
16206 @noindent
16207 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16208 completely specified.
16209
16210 @kindex info types
16211 @item info types @var{regexp}
16212 @itemx info types
16213 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16214 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16215 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16216 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16217 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16218 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16219 name is @code{value}.
16220
16221 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16222 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16223 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16224
16225 @kindex info type-printers
16226 @item info type-printers
16227 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16228 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16229 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16230 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16231 type printers.
16232
16233 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16234
16235 @kindex enable type-printer
16236 @kindex disable type-printer
16237 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16238 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16239 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16240
16241 @kindex info scope
16242 @cindex local variables
16243 @item info scope @var{location}
16244 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16245 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16246 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16247 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16248 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16249
16250 @smallexample
16251 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16252 Scope for command_line_handler:
16253 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16254 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16255 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16256 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16257 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16258 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16259 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16260 @end smallexample
16261
16262 @noindent
16263 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16264 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16265 collect}.
16266
16267 @kindex info source
16268 @item info source
16269 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16270 the function containing the current point of execution:
16271 @itemize @bullet
16272 @item
16273 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16274 @item
16275 the directory it was compiled in,
16276 @item
16277 its length, in lines,
16278 @item
16279 which programming language it is written in,
16280 @item
16281 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16282 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16283 @item
16284 whether the debugging information includes information about
16285 preprocessor macros.
16286 @end itemize
16287
16288
16289 @kindex info sources
16290 @item info sources
16291 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16292 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16293 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16294
16295 @kindex info functions
16296 @item info functions
16297 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16298
16299 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16300 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16301 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16302 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16303 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16304 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16305 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16306 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16307
16308 @kindex info variables
16309 @item info variables
16310 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16311 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16312
16313 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16314 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16315 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16316 @var{regexp}.
16317
16318 @kindex info classes
16319 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16320 @item info classes
16321 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16322 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16323 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16324 expression.
16325
16326 @kindex info selectors
16327 @item info selectors
16328 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16329 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16330 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16331 expression.
16332
16333 @ignore
16334 This was never implemented.
16335 @kindex info methods
16336 @item info methods
16337 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16338 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16339 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16340 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16341 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16342 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16343 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16344 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16345 @end ignore
16346
16347 @cindex opaque data types
16348 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16349 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16350 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16351 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16352 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16353 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16354 another source file. The default is on.
16355
16356 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16357 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16358
16359 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16360 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16361 is printed as follows:
16362 @smallexample
16363 @{<no data fields>@}
16364 @end smallexample
16365
16366 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16367 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16368 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16369
16370 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16371 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16372 @item set print symbol-loading
16373 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16374 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16375 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16376 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16377 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
16378 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
16379 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
16380 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
16381 can be annoying.
16382 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
16383 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
16384 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
16385 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
16386
16387 @kindex show print symbol-loading
16388 @item show print symbol-loading
16389 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
16390 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
16391
16392 @kindex maint print symbols
16393 @cindex symbol dump
16394 @kindex maint print psymbols
16395 @cindex partial symbol dump
16396 @kindex maint print msymbols
16397 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16398 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16399 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16400 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16401 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16402 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16403 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16404 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16405 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16406 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16407 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16408 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16409 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16410 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16411 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16412 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16413 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16414 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16415
16416 @kindex maint info symtabs
16417 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16418 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16419 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16420 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16421 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16422 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16423 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16424
16425 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16426 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16427 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16428 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16429 structure in more detail. For example:
16430
16431 @smallexample
16432 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16433 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16434 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16435 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16436 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16437 readin no
16438 fullname (null)
16439 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16440 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16441 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16442 dependencies (none)
16443 @}
16444 @}
16445 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16446 (@value{GDBP})
16447 @end smallexample
16448 @noindent
16449 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16450 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16451 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16452 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16453 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16454
16455 @smallexample
16456 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16457 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16458 line 1574.
16459 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16460 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16461 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16462 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16463 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
16464 dirname (null)
16465 fullname (null)
16466 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
16467 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
16468 debugformat DWARF 2
16469 @}
16470 @}
16471 (@value{GDBP})
16472 @end smallexample
16473 @end table
16474
16475
16476 @node Altering
16477 @chapter Altering Execution
16478
16479 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
16480 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
16481 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
16482 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
16483 program.
16484
16485 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
16486 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
16487 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
16488
16489 @menu
16490 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
16491 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
16492 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
16493 * Returning:: Returning from a function
16494 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
16495 * Patching:: Patching your program
16496 @end menu
16497
16498 @node Assignment
16499 @section Assignment to Variables
16500
16501 @cindex assignment
16502 @cindex setting variables
16503 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
16504 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
16505
16506 @smallexample
16507 print x=4
16508 @end smallexample
16509
16510 @noindent
16511 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
16512 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
16513 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
16514 information on operators in supported languages.
16515
16516 @kindex set variable
16517 @cindex variables, setting
16518 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
16519 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
16520 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
16521 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
16522 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
16523
16524 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
16525 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
16526 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
16527 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
16528 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
16529 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
16530 command @code{set width}:
16531
16532 @smallexample
16533 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
16534 type = double
16535 (@value{GDBP}) p width
16536 $4 = 13
16537 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
16538 Invalid syntax in expression.
16539 @end smallexample
16540
16541 @noindent
16542 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
16543 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
16544
16545 @smallexample
16546 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
16547 @end smallexample
16548
16549 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
16550 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
16551 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
16552 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
16553 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
16554 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
16555
16556 @smallexample
16557 @group
16558 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
16559 type = double
16560 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16561 $1 = 1
16562 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
16563 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16564 $2 = 1
16565 (@value{GDBP}) r
16566 The program being debugged has been started already.
16567 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
16568 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
16569 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
16570 Invalid bfd target.
16571 (@value{GDBP}) show g
16572 The current BFD target is "=4".
16573 @end group
16574 @end smallexample
16575
16576 @noindent
16577 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
16578 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
16579 @code{g}, use
16580
16581 @smallexample
16582 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
16583 @end smallexample
16584
16585 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
16586 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
16587 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
16588 same length or shorter.
16589 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
16590 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
16591
16592 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
16593 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
16594 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
16595 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
16596 and representation in memory), and
16597
16598 @smallexample
16599 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
16600 @end smallexample
16601
16602 @noindent
16603 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
16604
16605 @node Jumping
16606 @section Continuing at a Different Address
16607
16608 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
16609 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
16610 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
16611
16612 @table @code
16613 @kindex jump
16614 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
16615 @item jump @var{linespec}
16616 @itemx j @var{linespec}
16617 @itemx jump @var{location}
16618 @itemx j @var{location}
16619 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
16620 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
16621 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
16622 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
16623 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
16624 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16625
16626 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
16627 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
16628 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
16629 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
16630 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
16631 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
16632 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
16633 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
16634 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
16635 @end table
16636
16637 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
16638 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
16639 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
16640 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
16641 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
16642 example,
16643
16644 @smallexample
16645 set $pc = 0x485
16646 @end smallexample
16647
16648 @noindent
16649 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
16650 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
16651 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
16652
16653 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
16654 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
16655 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
16656 detail.
16657
16658 @c @group
16659 @node Signaling
16660 @section Giving your Program a Signal
16661 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
16662
16663 @table @code
16664 @kindex signal
16665 @item signal @var{signal}
16666 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
16667 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
16668 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
16669 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16670
16671 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
16672 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
16673 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16674 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
16675 signal.
16676
16677 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
16678 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
16679 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
16680 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
16681 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
16682 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
16683 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
16684 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
16685
16686 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
16687 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
16688 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
16689 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
16690 passes the signal directly to your program.
16691
16692 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
16693 after executing the command.
16694
16695 @kindex queue-signal
16696 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
16697 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
16698 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
16699 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
16700 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16701 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
16702 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
16703 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
16704 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
16705
16706 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
16707 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
16708 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
16709 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16710 @code{continue} command.
16711
16712 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
16713 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
16714 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
16715 (@pxref{Signals}).
16716 @end table
16717 @c @end group
16718
16719 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
16720 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
16721
16722 @node Returning
16723 @section Returning from a Function
16724
16725 @table @code
16726 @cindex returning from a function
16727 @kindex return
16728 @item return
16729 @itemx return @var{expression}
16730 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
16731 command. If you give an
16732 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
16733 value.
16734 @end table
16735
16736 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
16737 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
16738 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
16739 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
16740
16741 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
16742 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
16743 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
16744 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
16745 of functions.
16746
16747 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
16748 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
16749 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
16750 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
16751 selected stack frame returns naturally.
16752
16753 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
16754 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
16755 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
16756 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
16757 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
16758 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
16759 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
16760 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
16761 assignment into the right register(s).
16762
16763 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
16764 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
16765 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
16766 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
16767 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
16768 into a @code{long long int}:
16769
16770 @smallexample
16771 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
16772 29 return 31;
16773 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16774 Make func return now? (y or n) y
16775 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
16776 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
16777 (@value{GDBP})
16778 @end smallexample
16779
16780 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
16781 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
16782 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
16783 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
16784 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
16785 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
16786 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
16787 an appropriate cast explicitly:
16788
16789 @smallexample
16790 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
16791 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
16792 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
16793 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
16794 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
16795 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
16796 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
16797 (@value{GDBP})
16798 @end smallexample
16799
16800 @node Calling
16801 @section Calling Program Functions
16802
16803 @table @code
16804 @cindex calling functions
16805 @cindex inferior functions, calling
16806 @item print @var{expr}
16807 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
16808 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
16809 debugged.
16810
16811 @kindex call
16812 @item call @var{expr}
16813 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
16814 returned values.
16815
16816 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
16817 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
16818 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
16819 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
16820 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
16821 value history.
16822 @end table
16823
16824 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
16825 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
16826 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
16827 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
16828
16829 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
16830 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
16831 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
16832 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
16833 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
16834 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
16835 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
16836 in that case is controlled by the
16837 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
16838
16839 @table @code
16840 @item set unwindonsignal
16841 @kindex set unwindonsignal
16842 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
16843 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
16844 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
16845 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
16846 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
16847 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
16848 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
16849 received.
16850
16851 @item show unwindonsignal
16852 @kindex show unwindonsignal
16853 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16854 @value{GDBN}.
16855
16856 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16857 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
16858 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
16859 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
16860 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
16861 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
16862 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
16863 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
16864 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
16865 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
16866
16867 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16868 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
16869 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
16870 @value{GDBN}.
16871
16872 @end table
16873
16874 @cindex weak alias functions
16875 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
16876 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
16877 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
16878 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
16879 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
16880 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
16881 function instead.
16882
16883 @node Patching
16884 @section Patching Programs
16885
16886 @cindex patching binaries
16887 @cindex writing into executables
16888 @cindex writing into corefiles
16889
16890 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
16891 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
16892 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
16893 patching your program's binary.
16894
16895 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
16896 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
16897 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
16898 repairs.
16899
16900 @table @code
16901 @kindex set write
16902 @item set write on
16903 @itemx set write off
16904 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
16905 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
16906 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
16907
16908 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
16909 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
16910 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
16911
16912 @item show write
16913 @kindex show write
16914 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
16915 as well as reading.
16916 @end table
16917
16918 @node GDB Files
16919 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
16920
16921 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
16922 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
16923 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
16924 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
16925
16926 @menu
16927 * Files:: Commands to specify files
16928 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
16929 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
16930 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
16931 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
16932 * Data Files:: GDB data files
16933 @end menu
16934
16935 @node Files
16936 @section Commands to Specify Files
16937
16938 @cindex symbol table
16939 @cindex core dump file
16940
16941 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
16942 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
16943 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
16944 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
16945
16946 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
16947 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
16948 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
16949 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
16950 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
16951 new files are useful.
16952
16953 @table @code
16954 @cindex executable file
16955 @kindex file
16956 @item file @var{filename}
16957 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
16958 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
16959 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
16960 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
16961 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
16962 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
16963 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
16964 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
16965
16966 @cindex unlinked object files
16967 @cindex patching object files
16968 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
16969 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
16970 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
16971 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
16972 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
16973 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
16974 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
16975 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
16976
16977 @item file
16978 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
16979 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
16980
16981 @kindex exec-file
16982 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16983 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
16984 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
16985 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
16986 discard information on the executable file.
16987
16988 @kindex symbol-file
16989 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
16990 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
16991 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
16992 table and program to run from the same file.
16993
16994 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
16995 program's symbol table.
16996
16997 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
16998 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
16999 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
17000 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
17001 @value{GDBN}.
17002
17003 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
17004 executing it once.
17005
17006 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
17007 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
17008 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
17009 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
17010 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
17011 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
17012 optimized code.
17013
17014 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
17015 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
17016 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
17017 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
17018 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
17019
17020 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
17021 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
17022 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
17023 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
17024 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
17025 Warnings and Messages}.)
17026
17027 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
17028 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
17029 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
17030 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
17031 in stabs format.
17032
17033 @kindex readnow
17034 @cindex reading symbols immediately
17035 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
17036 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17037 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17038 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
17039 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
17040 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
17041 entire symbol table available.
17042
17043 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
17044 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
17045 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
17046 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
17047 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
17048 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
17049 @c files.
17050
17051 @kindex core-file
17052 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17053 @itemx core
17054 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
17055 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
17056 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
17057 executable file itself for other parts.
17058
17059 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
17060 to be used.
17061
17062 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
17063 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
17064 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
17065 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
17066 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
17067
17068 @kindex add-symbol-file
17069 @cindex dynamic linking
17070 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
17071 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
17072 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
17073 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
17074 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
17075 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
17076 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
17077 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
17078 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
17079 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
17080 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
17081 @var{address} as an expression.
17082
17083 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
17084 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
17085 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
17086 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
17087
17088 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
17089
17090 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
17091 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
17092 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
17093 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
17094 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
17095 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
17096 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
17097 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
17098 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
17099
17100 @itemize @bullet
17101 @item
17102 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
17103 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
17104 @item
17105 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
17106 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
17107 @item
17108 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
17109 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
17110 @end itemize
17111
17112 @noindent
17113 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
17114 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
17115 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
17116 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
17117 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
17118 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
17119 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
17120 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
17121 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
17122 way.
17123
17124 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17125
17126 @kindex remove-symbol-file
17127 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
17128 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
17129 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
17130 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
17131 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
17132
17133 @smallexample
17134 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
17135 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
17136 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
17137 (y or n) y
17138 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
17139 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
17140 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
17141 (gdb)
17142 @end smallexample
17143
17144
17145 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17146
17147 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
17148 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
17149 @cindex load symbols from memory
17150 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
17151 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
17152 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
17153 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
17154 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
17155 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
17156 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
17157 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
17158 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
17159
17160 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
17161 @kindex assf
17162 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
17163 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
17164 This command is deprecated and will be removed in future versions
17165 of @value{GDBN}. Use the @code{sharedlibrary} command instead.
17166
17167 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
17168 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
17169 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
17170 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
17171 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
17172 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
17173 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
17174 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
17175
17176 @kindex section
17177 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
17178 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
17179 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
17180 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
17181 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
17182 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
17183 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
17184 their addresses.
17185
17186 @kindex info files
17187 @kindex info target
17188 @item info files
17189 @itemx info target
17190 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
17191 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
17192 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
17193 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
17194 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
17195 current ones.
17196
17197 @kindex maint info sections
17198 @item maint info sections
17199 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
17200 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
17201 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
17202 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
17203 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
17204 may be arbitrarily combined):
17205
17206 @table @code
17207 @item ALLOBJ
17208 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
17209 @item @var{sections}
17210 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
17211 @item @var{section-flags}
17212 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
17213 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
17214 @table @code
17215 @item ALLOC
17216 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
17217 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
17218 @item LOAD
17219 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
17220 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
17221 @item RELOC
17222 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
17223 @item READONLY
17224 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
17225 @item CODE
17226 Section contains executable code only.
17227 @item DATA
17228 Section contains data only (no executable code).
17229 @item ROM
17230 Section will reside in ROM.
17231 @item CONSTRUCTOR
17232 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
17233 @item HAS_CONTENTS
17234 Section is not empty.
17235 @item NEVER_LOAD
17236 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
17237 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
17238 A notification to the linker that the section contains
17239 COFF shared library information.
17240 @item IS_COMMON
17241 Section contains common symbols.
17242 @end table
17243 @end table
17244 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
17245 @cindex read-only sections
17246 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
17247 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
17248 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
17249 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
17250 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
17251 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
17252 enhancement to debugging performance.
17253
17254 The default is off.
17255
17256 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
17257 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
17258 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
17259 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
17260
17261 @item show trust-readonly-sections
17262 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
17263 @end table
17264
17265 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
17266 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
17267 name and remembers it that way.
17268
17269 @cindex shared libraries
17270 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
17271 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
17272 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
17273
17274 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
17275 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
17276
17277 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
17278 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
17279 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
17280 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
17281 debugging a core file).
17282
17283 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
17284 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
17285
17286 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
17287 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
17288 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
17289
17290 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
17291 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
17292 particularly large or there are many of them.
17293
17294 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
17295 commands:
17296
17297 @table @code
17298 @kindex set auto-solib-add
17299 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
17300 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
17301 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
17302 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
17303 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
17304 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
17305 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
17306
17307 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
17308 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
17309 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
17310 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
17311 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
17312 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
17313 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
17314 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
17315 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
17316
17317 @kindex show auto-solib-add
17318 @item show auto-solib-add
17319 Display the current autoloading mode.
17320 @end table
17321
17322 @cindex load shared library
17323 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
17324 command:
17325
17326 @table @code
17327 @kindex info sharedlibrary
17328 @kindex info share
17329 @item info share @var{regex}
17330 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17331 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
17332 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
17333 all shared libraries that are loaded.
17334
17335 @kindex sharedlibrary
17336 @kindex share
17337 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17338 @itemx share @var{regex}
17339 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
17340 Unix regular expression.
17341 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
17342 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
17343 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
17344 loaded.
17345
17346 @item nosharedlibrary
17347 @kindex nosharedlibrary
17348 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
17349 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
17350 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
17351 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
17352 discarded.
17353 @end table
17354
17355 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
17356 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
17357 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
17358 Catchpoints}).
17359
17360 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
17361 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
17362 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
17363 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
17364
17365 @table @code
17366 @item set stop-on-solib-events
17367 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
17368 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
17369 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
17370 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
17371 shared library.
17372
17373 @item show stop-on-solib-events
17374 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
17375 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
17376 library events happen.
17377 @end table
17378
17379 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
17380 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
17381 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
17382 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
17383 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
17384 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
17385 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
17386 not.
17387
17388 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
17389 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
17390 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
17391 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
17392 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
17393
17394 @table @code
17395 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
17396 @cindex system root, alternate
17397 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
17398 @kindex set sysroot
17399 @item set sysroot @var{path}
17400 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
17401 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
17402 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
17403 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
17404 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
17405 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
17406 under @var{path}.
17407
17408 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
17409 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
17410 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
17411 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
17412 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
17413 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
17414 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
17415 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
17416 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
17417
17418 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
17419 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
17420 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
17421 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
17422 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
17423
17424 @smallexample
17425 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
17426 @end smallexample
17427
17428 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
17429 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
17430 system:
17431
17432 @smallexample
17433 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
17434 @end smallexample
17435
17436 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
17437 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
17438 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
17439 colons:
17440
17441 @smallexample
17442 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
17443 @end smallexample
17444
17445 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
17446 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
17447 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
17448 @samp{z}):
17449
17450 @smallexample
17451 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
17452 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17453 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17454 @end smallexample
17455
17456 @noindent
17457 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
17458 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
17459 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
17460
17461 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
17462 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
17463
17464 @smallexample
17465 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
17466 @end smallexample
17467
17468 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
17469 if you don't want or need to.
17470
17471 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
17472 sysroot}.
17473
17474 @cindex default system root
17475 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
17476 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
17477 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
17478 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
17479 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
17480 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
17481 location.
17482
17483 @kindex show sysroot
17484 @item show sysroot
17485 Display the current shared library prefix.
17486
17487 @kindex set solib-search-path
17488 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
17489 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
17490 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
17491 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
17492 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
17493 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
17494 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17495 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
17496 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
17497 of shared library symbols.
17498
17499 @kindex show solib-search-path
17500 @item show solib-search-path
17501 Display the current shared library search path.
17502
17503 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
17504 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
17505 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
17506 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
17507 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
17508
17509 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
17510 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
17511 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
17512 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
17513 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
17514 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
17515 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
17516 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
17517 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
17518 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
17519 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
17520 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
17521 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
17522 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
17523 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
17524 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
17525 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
17526 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
17527 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
17528 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
17529 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
17530 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
17531
17532 @table @code
17533 @item unix
17534 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
17535 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
17536 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
17537 the forward slash.
17538
17539 @item dos-based
17540 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
17541 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
17542 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
17543 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
17544 considered directory separators.
17545
17546 @item auto
17547 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
17548 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
17549 This is the default.
17550 @end table
17551 @end table
17552
17553 @cindex file name canonicalization
17554 @cindex base name differences
17555 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
17556 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
17557 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
17558 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
17559 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
17560 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
17561 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
17562 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
17563 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
17564 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
17565 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
17566 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
17567 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
17568 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
17569 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
17570
17571 @table @code
17572 @item set basenames-may-differ
17573 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
17574 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17575
17576 @item show basenames-may-differ
17577 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
17578 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
17579 @end table
17580
17581 @node Separate Debug Files
17582 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
17583 @cindex separate debugging information files
17584 @cindex debugging information in separate files
17585 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
17586 @cindex debugging information directory, global
17587 @cindex global debugging information directories
17588 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
17589 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
17590
17591 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
17592 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
17593 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
17594 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
17595 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
17596 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
17597 install only when they need to debug a problem.
17598
17599 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
17600 file:
17601
17602 @itemize @bullet
17603 @item
17604 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
17605 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
17606 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
17607 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
17608 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
17609 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
17610 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
17611 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
17612
17613 @item
17614 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
17615 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
17616 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
17617 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
17618 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
17619 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
17620 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
17621 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
17622 below.
17623 @end itemize
17624
17625 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
17626 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
17627
17628 @itemize @bullet
17629 @item
17630 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
17631 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
17632 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
17633 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
17634 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
17635
17636 @item
17637 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
17638 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
17639 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
17640 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
17641 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
17642 hex characters, not 10.)
17643 @end itemize
17644
17645 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
17646 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
17647 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
17648 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
17649 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
17650 debug information files, in the indicated order:
17651
17652 @itemize @minus
17653 @item
17654 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
17655 @item
17656 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
17657 @item
17658 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
17659 @item
17660 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
17661 @end itemize
17662
17663 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
17664 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
17665 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
17666 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
17667 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
17668
17669 @table @code
17670
17671 @kindex set debug-file-directory
17672 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
17673 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17674 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
17675 concatenating them by a path separator.
17676
17677 @kindex show debug-file-directory
17678 @item show debug-file-directory
17679 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
17680 information files.
17681
17682 @end table
17683
17684 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
17685 @cindex debug link sections
17686 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
17687 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
17688
17689 @itemize
17690 @item
17691 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
17692 a zero byte,
17693 @item
17694 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
17695 boundary within the section, and
17696 @item
17697 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
17698 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
17699 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
17700 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
17701 @end itemize
17702
17703 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
17704 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
17705 described above.
17706
17707 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
17708 @cindex build ID sections
17709 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
17710 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
17711 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
17712 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
17713 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
17714 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
17715 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
17716 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
17717 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
17718
17719 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
17720 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
17721 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
17722 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
17723 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
17724 in an ordinary executable.
17725
17726 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
17727 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
17728 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
17729 following commands:
17730
17731 @smallexample
17732 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
17733 @kbd{strip -g foo}
17734 @end smallexample
17735
17736 @noindent
17737 These commands remove the debugging
17738 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
17739 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
17740 two files:
17741
17742 @itemize @bullet
17743 @item
17744 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
17745 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
17746
17747 @smallexample
17748 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
17749 @end smallexample
17750
17751 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
17752 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
17753 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
17754 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
17755
17756 @item
17757 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
17758 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
17759 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
17760 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
17761 @end itemize
17762
17763 @noindent
17764
17765 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
17766 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
17767 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
17768
17769 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
17770 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
17771 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
17772 @c different ways!
17773 @ifhtml
17774 @display
17775 @html
17776 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
17777 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
17778 @end html
17779 @end display
17780 @end ifhtml
17781 @ifnothtml
17782 @display
17783 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
17784 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
17785 @end display
17786 @end ifnothtml
17787
17788 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
17789 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
17790 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
17791 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
17792 CRC.
17793
17794 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
17795 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
17796 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
17797 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
17798 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
17799
17800 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
17801 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
17802 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
17803 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
17804 @code{0xffffffff}.
17805
17806 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
17807 @smallexample
17808 unsigned long
17809 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
17810 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
17811 @{
17812 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
17813 @{
17814 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
17815 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
17816 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
17817 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
17818 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
17819 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
17820 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
17821 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
17822 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
17823 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
17824 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
17825 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
17826 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
17827 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
17828 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
17829 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
17830 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
17831 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
17832 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
17833 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
17834 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
17835 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
17836 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
17837 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
17838 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
17839 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
17840 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
17841 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
17842 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
17843 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
17844 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
17845 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
17846 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
17847 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
17848 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
17849 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
17850 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
17851 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
17852 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
17853 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
17854 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
17855 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
17856 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
17857 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
17858 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
17859 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
17860 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
17861 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
17862 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
17863 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
17864 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
17865 0x2d02ef8d
17866 @};
17867 unsigned char *end;
17868
17869 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17870 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
17871 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
17872 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
17873 @}
17874 @end smallexample
17875
17876 @noindent
17877 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
17878
17879 @node MiniDebugInfo
17880 @section Debugging information in a special section
17881 @cindex separate debug sections
17882 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
17883
17884 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
17885 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
17886 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
17887 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
17888
17889 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
17890 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
17891 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
17892 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
17893 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
17894 debugging information might be included in the section.
17895
17896 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
17897 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
17898 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
17899
17900 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
17901 standard utilities:
17902
17903 @smallexample
17904 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
17905 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
17906 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17907 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
17908
17909 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
17910 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
17911 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
17912 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
17913 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
17914 | sort > funcsyms
17915
17916 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
17917 # table.
17918 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
17919
17920 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
17921 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
17922
17923 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
17924 # removing some unnecessary sections.
17925 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
17926 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
17927
17928 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
17929 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
17930
17931 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
17932 # original binary.
17933 xz mini_debuginfo
17934 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
17935 @end smallexample
17936
17937 @node Index Files
17938 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
17939 @cindex index files
17940 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
17941
17942 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
17943 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
17944 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
17945 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
17946 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
17947 startup.
17948
17949 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
17950 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
17951 using @command{objcopy}.
17952
17953 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
17954
17955 @table @code
17956 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
17957 @kindex save gdb-index
17958 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
17959 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
17960 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
17961 @var{directory}.
17962 @end table
17963
17964 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
17965 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
17966
17967 @smallexample
17968 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
17969 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
17970 @end smallexample
17971
17972 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
17973 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
17974 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
17975 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
17976 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
17977 The default is @code{off}.
17978 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
17979 @xref{Index Section Format}.
17980
17981 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
17982 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
17983
17984 @smallexample
17985 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17986 @end smallexample
17987
17988 Instead you must do, for example,
17989
17990 @smallexample
17991 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
17992 @end smallexample
17993
17994 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
17995 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
17996 currently work for programs using Ada.
17997
17998 @node Symbol Errors
17999 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
18000
18001 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
18002 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
18003 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
18004 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
18005 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
18006 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
18007 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
18008 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
18009 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
18010 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18011 Messages}).
18012
18013 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
18014
18015 @table @code
18016 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
18017
18018 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
18019 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
18020 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
18021 in its outer scope blocks.
18022
18023 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
18024 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
18025 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
18026 function.
18027
18028 @item block at @var{address} out of order
18029
18030 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
18031 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
18032 do so.
18033
18034 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
18035 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
18036 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
18037 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18038 Messages}.)
18039
18040 @item bad block start address patched
18041
18042 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
18043 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
18044 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
18045
18046 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
18047 starting on the previous source line.
18048
18049 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
18050
18051 @cindex foo
18052 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
18053 larger than the size of the string table.
18054
18055 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
18056 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
18057 with this name.
18058
18059 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
18060
18061 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
18062 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
18063 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
18064
18065 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
18066 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
18067 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
18068 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
18069 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
18070 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
18071
18072 @item stub type has NULL name
18073
18074 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
18075
18076 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
18077 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
18078 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
18079 it.
18080
18081 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
18082
18083 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
18084
18085 @end table
18086
18087 @node Data Files
18088 @section GDB Data Files
18089
18090 @cindex prefix for data files
18091 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
18092 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
18093
18094 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
18095 is currently using.
18096
18097 @table @code
18098 @kindex set data-directory
18099 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
18100 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
18101 to @var{directory}.
18102
18103 @kindex show data-directory
18104 @item show data-directory
18105 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
18106 @end table
18107
18108 @cindex default data directory
18109 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
18110 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
18111 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
18112 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18113 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
18114 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18115 location.
18116
18117 The data directory may also be specified with the
18118 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
18119 @xref{Mode Options}.
18120
18121 @node Targets
18122 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
18123
18124 @cindex debugging target
18125 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
18126
18127 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
18128 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
18129 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
18130 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
18131 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
18132 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
18133 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
18134 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
18135
18136 @cindex target architecture
18137 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
18138 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
18139 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
18140 command.
18141
18142 @table @code
18143 @kindex set architecture
18144 @kindex show architecture
18145 @item set architecture @var{arch}
18146 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
18147 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
18148 supported architectures.
18149
18150 @item show architecture
18151 Show the current target architecture.
18152
18153 @item set processor
18154 @itemx processor
18155 @kindex set processor
18156 @kindex show processor
18157 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
18158 and @code{show architecture}.
18159 @end table
18160
18161 @menu
18162 * Active Targets:: Active targets
18163 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
18164 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
18165 @end menu
18166
18167 @node Active Targets
18168 @section Active Targets
18169
18170 @cindex stacking targets
18171 @cindex active targets
18172 @cindex multiple targets
18173
18174 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
18175 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
18176 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
18177 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
18178 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
18179 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
18180 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
18181 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
18182 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
18183
18184 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
18185 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
18186 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
18187 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
18188
18189 @node Target Commands
18190 @section Commands for Managing Targets
18191
18192 @table @code
18193 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
18194 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
18195 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
18196 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
18197 protocol of the target machine.
18198
18199 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
18200 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
18201 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
18202
18203 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
18204 after executing the command.
18205
18206 @kindex help target
18207 @item help target
18208 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
18209 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
18210 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
18211
18212 @item help target @var{name}
18213 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
18214 select it.
18215
18216 @kindex set gnutarget
18217 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
18218 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
18219 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
18220 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
18221 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
18222 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
18223
18224 @quotation
18225 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
18226 you must know the actual BFD name.
18227 @end quotation
18228
18229 @noindent
18230 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
18231
18232 @kindex show gnutarget
18233 @item show gnutarget
18234 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
18235 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
18236 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
18237 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
18238 @end table
18239
18240 @cindex common targets
18241 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
18242 configuration):
18243
18244 @table @code
18245 @kindex target
18246 @item target exec @var{program}
18247 @cindex executable file target
18248 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
18249 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
18250
18251 @item target core @var{filename}
18252 @cindex core dump file target
18253 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
18254 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
18255
18256 @item target remote @var{medium}
18257 @cindex remote target
18258 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
18259 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
18260 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
18261
18262 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
18263 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
18264
18265 @smallexample
18266 target remote /dev/ttya
18267 @end smallexample
18268
18269 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
18270 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
18271 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
18272 clobbered by the download.
18273
18274 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18275 @cindex built-in simulator target
18276 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
18277 In general,
18278 @smallexample
18279 target sim
18280 load
18281 run
18282 @end smallexample
18283 @noindent
18284 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
18285 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
18286 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
18287 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
18288 Processors}.
18289
18290 @item target native
18291 @cindex native target
18292 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
18293 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
18294 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
18295 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
18296
18297 @end table
18298
18299 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
18300 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
18301
18302 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
18303 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
18304 various aspects of this process.
18305
18306 @table @code
18307
18308 @item set hash
18309 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18310 @cindex hash mark while downloading
18311 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
18312 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
18313 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
18314 monitor.
18315
18316 @item show hash
18317 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18318 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
18319
18320 @item set debug monitor
18321 @kindex set debug monitor
18322 @cindex display remote monitor communications
18323 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
18324 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18325
18326 @item show debug monitor
18327 @kindex show debug monitor
18328 Show the current status of displaying communications between
18329 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18330 @end table
18331
18332 @table @code
18333
18334 @kindex load @var{filename}
18335 @item load @var{filename}
18336 @anchor{load}
18337 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
18338 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
18339 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
18340 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
18341 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
18342 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18343
18344 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
18345 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
18346 target is @dots{}}''
18347
18348 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
18349 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
18350 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
18351 specifies a fixed address.
18352 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
18353
18354 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
18355 load programs into flash memory.
18356
18357 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
18358 @end table
18359
18360 @node Byte Order
18361 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
18362
18363 @cindex choosing target byte order
18364 @cindex target byte order
18365
18366 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
18367 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
18368 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
18369 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
18370 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
18371 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
18372
18373 @table @code
18374 @kindex set endian
18375 @item set endian big
18376 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
18377
18378 @item set endian little
18379 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
18380
18381 @item set endian auto
18382 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
18383 executable.
18384
18385 @item show endian
18386 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
18387
18388 @end table
18389
18390 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
18391 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
18392 target system.
18393
18394
18395 @node Remote Debugging
18396 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
18397 @cindex remote debugging
18398
18399 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
18400 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
18401 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
18402 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
18403 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
18404
18405 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
18406 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
18407 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
18408 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
18409 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
18410 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
18411
18412 Other remote targets may be available in your
18413 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
18414
18415 @menu
18416 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
18417 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
18418 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
18419 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
18420 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
18421 @end menu
18422
18423 @node Connecting
18424 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
18425
18426 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
18427 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
18428 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
18429 program as the first argument.
18430
18431 @cindex @code{target remote}
18432 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
18433 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
18434 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
18435 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
18436 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
18437 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
18438
18439 @table @code
18440
18441 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
18442 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
18443 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
18444 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
18445
18446 @smallexample
18447 target remote /dev/ttyb
18448 @end smallexample
18449
18450 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
18451 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
18452 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
18453 @code{target} command.
18454
18455 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
18456 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18457 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
18458 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
18459 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
18460 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
18461 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
18462 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
18463 target.
18464
18465 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
18466 @code{manyfarms}:
18467
18468 @smallexample
18469 target remote manyfarms:2828
18470 @end smallexample
18471
18472 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
18473 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
18474 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
18475 port 1234 on your local machine:
18476
18477 @smallexample
18478 target remote :1234
18479 @end smallexample
18480 @noindent
18481
18482 Note that the colon is still required here.
18483
18484 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18485 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
18486 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
18487 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
18488
18489 @smallexample
18490 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
18491 @end smallexample
18492
18493 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
18494 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
18495 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
18496 cause havoc with your debugging session.
18497
18498 @item target remote | @var{command}
18499 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
18500 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
18501 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
18502 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
18503 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
18504 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
18505 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
18506 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
18507
18508 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
18509 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
18510 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
18511
18512 @end table
18513
18514 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
18515 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
18516 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
18517 need to use @kbd{run}.
18518
18519 @cindex interrupting remote programs
18520 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
18521 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
18522 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
18523 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
18524 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
18525 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
18526
18527 @smallexample
18528 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
18529 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
18530 @end smallexample
18531
18532 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
18533 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
18534 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
18535 goes back to waiting.
18536
18537 @table @code
18538 @kindex detach (remote)
18539 @item detach
18540 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
18541 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
18542 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
18543 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
18544 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
18545
18546 @kindex disconnect
18547 @item disconnect
18548 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
18549 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
18550 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
18551 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
18552 another target.
18553
18554 @cindex send command to remote monitor
18555 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
18556 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
18557 @kindex monitor
18558 @item monitor @var{cmd}
18559 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
18560 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
18561 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
18562 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
18563 and implement.
18564 @end table
18565
18566 @node File Transfer
18567 @section Sending files to a remote system
18568 @cindex remote target, file transfer
18569 @cindex file transfer
18570 @cindex sending files to remote systems
18571
18572 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
18573 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
18574 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
18575 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
18576 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
18577 the only way to upload or download files.
18578
18579 Not all remote targets support these commands.
18580
18581 @table @code
18582 @kindex remote put
18583 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
18584 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
18585 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
18586
18587 @kindex remote get
18588 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
18589 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
18590 on the host system.
18591
18592 @kindex remote delete
18593 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
18594 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
18595
18596 @end table
18597
18598 @node Server
18599 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
18600
18601 @kindex gdbserver
18602 @cindex remote connection without stubs
18603 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
18604 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
18605 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
18606
18607 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
18608 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
18609 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
18610 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
18611 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
18612 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
18613 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
18614 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
18615 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
18616 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
18617 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
18618 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
18619 choice for debugging.
18620
18621 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
18622 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
18623 protocol.
18624
18625 @quotation
18626 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
18627 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
18628 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
18629 target system with the same privileges as the user running
18630 @code{gdbserver}.
18631 @end quotation
18632
18633 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
18634 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
18635 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
18636
18637 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
18638 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
18639 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
18640 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
18641 system does all the symbol handling.
18642
18643 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
18644 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
18645 syntax is:
18646
18647 @smallexample
18648 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
18649 @end smallexample
18650
18651 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
18652 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
18653 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
18654 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
18655 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
18656 @file{/dev/com1}:
18657
18658 @smallexample
18659 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
18660 @end smallexample
18661
18662 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
18663 with it.
18664
18665 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
18666
18667 @smallexample
18668 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
18669 @end smallexample
18670
18671 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
18672 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
18673 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
18674 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
18675 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
18676 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
18677 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
18678 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
18679 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
18680 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
18681 @code{target remote} command.
18682
18683 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
18684 with ssh:
18685
18686 @smallexample
18687 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
18688 @end smallexample
18689
18690 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
18691 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
18692 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
18693 You could elide it if you want to.
18694
18695 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
18696 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
18697 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
18698 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
18699
18700 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
18701 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
18702 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
18703
18704 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
18705 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
18706
18707 @smallexample
18708 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
18709 @end smallexample
18710
18711 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
18712 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
18713
18714 @pindex pidof
18715 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
18716 @code{pidof} utility:
18717
18718 @smallexample
18719 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
18720 @end smallexample
18721
18722 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
18723 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
18724 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
18725
18726 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
18727 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
18728 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
18729
18730 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
18731 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
18732 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
18733 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
18734
18735 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
18736 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
18737 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
18738 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
18739 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
18740 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
18741 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
18742 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
18743 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
18744
18745 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
18746 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
18747 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
18748 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
18749 the program you want to debug.
18750
18751 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
18752 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
18753 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
18754 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
18755 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
18756 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
18757
18758 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
18759
18760 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
18761
18762 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
18763 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
18764 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
18765 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
18766 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
18767 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
18768 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
18769 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
18770
18771 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
18772 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
18773 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
18774
18775 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
18776 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
18777 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
18778 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
18779 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
18780 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
18781 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
18782 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
18783 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
18784 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
18785 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
18786 instance closes its port after the first connection.
18787
18788 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
18789 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
18790
18791 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18792 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
18793 status information about the debugging process.
18794 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
18795 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
18796 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
18797 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
18798
18799 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
18800 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
18801 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
18802 Possible options are:
18803
18804 @table @code
18805 @item none
18806 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
18807 @item all
18808 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
18809 @item timestamps
18810 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
18811 @end table
18812
18813 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
18814 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
18815
18816 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
18817 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
18818 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
18819 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
18820 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
18821
18822 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
18823 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
18824 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
18825 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
18826
18827 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
18828 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
18829 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
18830 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
18831
18832 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
18833 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
18834 environment:
18835
18836 @smallexample
18837 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
18838 @end smallexample
18839
18840 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
18841
18842 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
18843
18844 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
18845 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
18846 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
18847 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
18848
18849 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
18850 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
18851 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
18852 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
18853 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
18854 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
18855 programs.
18856
18857 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
18858 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
18859 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
18860 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
18861 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
18862 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
18863 already on the target.
18864
18865 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
18866 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
18867 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
18868
18869 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
18870 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
18871 Here are the available commands.
18872
18873 @table @code
18874 @item monitor help
18875 List the available monitor commands.
18876
18877 @item monitor set debug 0
18878 @itemx monitor set debug 1
18879 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
18880
18881 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
18882 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
18883 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
18884 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
18885
18886 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
18887 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
18888 Possible options are:
18889
18890 @table @code
18891 @item none
18892 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
18893 @item all
18894 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
18895 @item timestamps
18896 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
18897 @end table
18898
18899 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
18900 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
18901
18902 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
18903 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
18904 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18905 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
18906 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
18907 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
18908
18909 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
18910 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
18911
18912 @item monitor exit
18913 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
18914 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
18915 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
18916 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
18917 of a multi-process mode debug session.
18918
18919 @end table
18920
18921 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18922 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
18923
18924 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
18925 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
18926
18927 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
18928 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
18929 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
18930 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
18931 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
18932 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
18933 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
18934 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
18935 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
18936 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
18937 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
18938 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
18939
18940 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
18941
18942 @table @code
18943 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
18944
18945 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
18946 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
18947 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
18948
18949 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
18950
18951 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
18952 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
18953 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
18954 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
18955 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
18956 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
18957
18958 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
18959
18960 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
18961 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
18962 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
18963 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
18964 command for that. For example:
18965
18966 @smallexample
18967 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
18968 @end smallexample
18969
18970 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
18971 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
18972 @end table
18973
18974 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
18975 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
18976 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
18977 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
18978 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
18979 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
18980 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
18981 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
18982 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
18983 @code{gdbserver} like so:
18984
18985 @smallexample
18986 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
18987 @end smallexample
18988
18989 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
18990
18991 @smallexample
18992 $ gdb myprogram
18993 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
18994 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
18995 (@value{GDBP}) b main
18996 (@value{GDBP}) continue
18997 @end smallexample
18998
18999 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
19000 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
19001 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
19002 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
19003 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
19004 tracing.
19005
19006 @node Remote Configuration
19007 @section Remote Configuration
19008
19009 @kindex set remote
19010 @kindex show remote
19011 This section documents the configuration options available when
19012 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
19013 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
19014 system-call-allowed}.
19015
19016 @table @code
19017 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
19018 @cindex address size for remote targets
19019 @cindex bits in remote address
19020 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
19021 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
19022 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
19023 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
19024
19025 @item show remoteaddresssize
19026 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
19027
19028 @item set serial baud @var{n}
19029 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
19030 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
19031 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
19032 remote targets.
19033
19034 @item show serial baud
19035 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
19036
19037 @item set remotebreak
19038 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19039 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
19040 @anchor{set remotebreak}
19041 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
19042 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
19043 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
19044 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
19045 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
19046
19047 @item show remotebreak
19048 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
19049 interrupt the remote program.
19050
19051 @item set remoteflow on
19052 @itemx set remoteflow off
19053 @kindex set remoteflow
19054 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
19055 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
19056
19057 @item show remoteflow
19058 @kindex show remoteflow
19059 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
19060
19061 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
19062 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
19063 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
19064 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
19065 @code{ascii}.
19066
19067 @item show remotelogbase
19068 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
19069 protocol.
19070
19071 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
19072 @cindex record serial communications on file
19073 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
19074 default is not to record at all.
19075
19076 @item show remotelogfile.
19077 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
19078 serial communications.
19079
19080 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
19081 @cindex timeout for serial communications
19082 @cindex remote timeout
19083 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
19084 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
19085
19086 @item show remotetimeout
19087 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
19088 responses.
19089
19090 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
19091 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
19092 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
19093 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
19094 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
19095 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
19096 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
19097 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
19098
19099 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
19100 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
19101 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
19102 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
19103 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
19104 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
19105 as unlimited.
19106
19107 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
19108 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
19109 a remote hardware watchpoint.
19110
19111 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
19112 @itemx show remote exec-file
19113 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
19114 @cindex executable file, for remote target
19115 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
19116 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
19117 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
19118 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
19119
19120 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
19121 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19122 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
19123 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
19124 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
19125 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
19126 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
19127 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
19128 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
19129 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
19130
19131 @item show interrupt-sequence
19132 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
19133 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
19134 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
19135 also known as Magic SysRq g.
19136
19137 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
19138 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
19139 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
19140 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
19141 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
19142 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
19143
19144 @item show interrupt-on-connect
19145 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
19146 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
19147
19148 @kindex set tcp
19149 @kindex show tcp
19150 @item set tcp auto-retry on
19151 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
19152 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
19153 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
19154 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
19155 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
19156 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
19157 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
19158 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
19159
19160 @item set tcp auto-retry off
19161 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
19162
19163 @item show tcp auto-retry
19164 Show the current auto-retry setting.
19165
19166 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
19167 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
19168 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
19169 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
19170 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
19171 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
19172 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
19173 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
19174 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
19175 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
19176 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
19177
19178 @item show tcp connect-timeout
19179 Show the current connection timeout setting.
19180 @end table
19181
19182 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
19183 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
19184 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
19185 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
19186 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
19187 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
19188 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
19189 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
19190 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
19191
19192 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
19193 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
19194 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
19195 @value{GDBN} developers.
19196
19197 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
19198 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
19199 are:
19200
19201 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
19202 @item Command Name
19203 @tab Remote Packet
19204 @tab Related Features
19205
19206 @item @code{fetch-register}
19207 @tab @code{p}
19208 @tab @code{info registers}
19209
19210 @item @code{set-register}
19211 @tab @code{P}
19212 @tab @code{set}
19213
19214 @item @code{binary-download}
19215 @tab @code{X}
19216 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
19217
19218 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
19219 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
19220 @tab @code{info auxv}
19221
19222 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
19223 @tab @code{qSymbol}
19224 @tab Detecting multiple threads
19225
19226 @item @code{attach}
19227 @tab @code{vAttach}
19228 @tab @code{attach}
19229
19230 @item @code{verbose-resume}
19231 @tab @code{vCont}
19232 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
19233
19234 @item @code{run}
19235 @tab @code{vRun}
19236 @tab @code{run}
19237
19238 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
19239 @tab @code{Z0}
19240 @tab @code{break}
19241
19242 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
19243 @tab @code{Z1}
19244 @tab @code{hbreak}
19245
19246 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
19247 @tab @code{Z2}
19248 @tab @code{watch}
19249
19250 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
19251 @tab @code{Z3}
19252 @tab @code{rwatch}
19253
19254 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
19255 @tab @code{Z4}
19256 @tab @code{awatch}
19257
19258 @item @code{target-features}
19259 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
19260 @tab @code{set architecture}
19261
19262 @item @code{library-info}
19263 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
19264 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
19265
19266 @item @code{memory-map}
19267 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
19268 @tab @code{info mem}
19269
19270 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
19271 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
19272 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
19273
19274 @item @code{read-spu-object}
19275 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
19276 @tab @code{info spu}
19277
19278 @item @code{write-spu-object}
19279 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
19280 @tab @code{info spu}
19281
19282 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
19283 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
19284 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
19285
19286 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
19287 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
19288 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
19289
19290 @item @code{threads}
19291 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
19292 @tab @code{info threads}
19293
19294 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
19295 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
19296 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
19297
19298 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
19299 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
19300 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
19301
19302 @item @code{search-memory}
19303 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
19304 @tab @code{find}
19305
19306 @item @code{supported-packets}
19307 @tab @code{qSupported}
19308 @tab Remote communications parameters
19309
19310 @item @code{pass-signals}
19311 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
19312 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19313
19314 @item @code{program-signals}
19315 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
19316 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19317
19318 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
19319 @tab @code{vFile:close}
19320 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19321
19322 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
19323 @tab @code{vFile:open}
19324 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19325
19326 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
19327 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
19328 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19329
19330 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
19331 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
19332 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19333
19334 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
19335 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
19336 @tab @code{remote delete}
19337
19338 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
19339 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
19340 @tab Host I/O
19341
19342 @item @code{noack-packet}
19343 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
19344 @tab Packet acknowledgment
19345
19346 @item @code{osdata}
19347 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
19348 @tab @code{info os}
19349
19350 @item @code{query-attached}
19351 @tab @code{qAttached}
19352 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
19353
19354 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
19355 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
19356 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
19357
19358 @item @code{trace-status}
19359 @tab @code{qTStatus}
19360 @tab @code{tstatus}
19361
19362 @item @code{traceframe-info}
19363 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
19364 @tab Traceframe info
19365
19366 @item @code{install-in-trace}
19367 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
19368 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
19369
19370 @item @code{disable-randomization}
19371 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
19372 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
19373
19374 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
19375 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
19376 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
19377 @end multitable
19378
19379 @node Remote Stub
19380 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
19381
19382 @cindex debugging stub, example
19383 @cindex remote stub, example
19384 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
19385 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
19386 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
19387 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
19388 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
19389 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
19390 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
19391 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
19392
19393 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
19394 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
19395 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
19396 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
19397 program, you need:
19398
19399 @enumerate
19400 @item
19401 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
19402 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
19403 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
19404
19405 @item
19406 A C subroutine library to support your program's
19407 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
19408
19409 @item
19410 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
19411 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
19412 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
19413 documentation.
19414 @end enumerate
19415
19416 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
19417 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
19418 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
19419
19420 @table @emph
19421 @item On the host,
19422 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
19423 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
19424 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
19425
19426 @item On the target,
19427 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
19428 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
19429 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
19430
19431 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
19432 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
19433 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
19434 @end table
19435
19436 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
19437 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
19438 @sc{sparc} boards.
19439
19440 @cindex remote serial stub list
19441 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
19442
19443 @table @code
19444
19445 @item i386-stub.c
19446 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
19447 @cindex Intel
19448 @cindex i386
19449 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
19450
19451 @item m68k-stub.c
19452 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
19453 @cindex Motorola 680x0
19454 @cindex m680x0
19455 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
19456
19457 @item sh-stub.c
19458 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
19459 @cindex Renesas
19460 @cindex SH
19461 For Renesas SH architectures.
19462
19463 @item sparc-stub.c
19464 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
19465 @cindex Sparc
19466 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
19467
19468 @item sparcl-stub.c
19469 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
19470 @cindex Fujitsu
19471 @cindex SparcLite
19472 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
19473
19474 @end table
19475
19476 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
19477 recently added stubs.
19478
19479 @menu
19480 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
19481 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
19482 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
19483 @end menu
19484
19485 @node Stub Contents
19486 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
19487
19488 @cindex remote serial stub
19489 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
19490 subroutines:
19491
19492 @table @code
19493 @item set_debug_traps
19494 @findex set_debug_traps
19495 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
19496 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
19497 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
19498 program's startup code.
19499
19500 @item handle_exception
19501 @findex handle_exception
19502 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
19503 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
19504 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
19505 run when a trap is triggered.
19506
19507 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
19508 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
19509 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
19510 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
19511 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
19512 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
19513 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
19514 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
19515 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
19516 machine.
19517
19518 @item breakpoint
19519 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
19520 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
19521 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
19522 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
19523 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
19524 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
19525 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
19526 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
19527 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
19528 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
19529 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
19530
19531 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
19532 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
19533 start of your debugging session.
19534 @end table
19535
19536 @node Bootstrapping
19537 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
19538
19539 @cindex remote stub, support routines
19540 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
19541 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
19542 debugging target machine.
19543
19544 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
19545 serial port.
19546
19547 @table @code
19548 @item int getDebugChar()
19549 @findex getDebugChar
19550 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
19551 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
19552 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19553
19554 @item void putDebugChar(int)
19555 @findex putDebugChar
19556 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
19557 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
19558 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
19559 @end table
19560
19561 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
19562 @cindex interrupting remote targets
19563 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
19564 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
19565 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
19566 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
19567 remote system to stop.
19568
19569 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
19570 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
19571 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
19572 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
19573
19574 Other routines you need to supply are:
19575
19576 @table @code
19577 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
19578 @findex exceptionHandler
19579 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
19580 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
19581 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
19582 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
19583 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
19584 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
19585 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
19586 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
19587 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
19588 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
19589 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
19590 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
19591 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
19592
19593 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
19594 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
19595 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
19596 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
19597 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
19598
19599 @item void flush_i_cache()
19600 @findex flush_i_cache
19601 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
19602 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
19603 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
19604
19605 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
19606 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
19607 @end table
19608
19609 @noindent
19610 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
19611
19612 @table @code
19613 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
19614 @findex memset
19615 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
19616 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
19617 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
19618 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
19619 @end table
19620
19621 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
19622 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
19623 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
19624 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
19625
19626
19627 @node Debug Session
19628 @subsection Putting it All Together
19629
19630 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
19631 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
19632 steps.
19633
19634 @enumerate
19635 @item
19636 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
19637 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
19638 @display
19639 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
19640 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
19641 @end display
19642
19643 @item
19644 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
19645 procedure is called:
19646
19647 @smallexample
19648 set_debug_traps();
19649 breakpoint();
19650 @end smallexample
19651
19652 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
19653 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
19654 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
19655 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
19656 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
19657 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
19658 progress.
19659
19660 @item
19661 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
19662 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
19663
19664 @smallexample
19665 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
19666 @end smallexample
19667
19668 @noindent
19669 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
19670 function in your program, that function is called when
19671 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
19672 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
19673 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
19674
19675 @item
19676 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
19677 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
19678
19679 @item
19680 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
19681 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
19682
19683 @item
19684 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
19685 @c document that. FIXME.
19686 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
19687 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
19688
19689 @item
19690 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
19691 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19692
19693 @end enumerate
19694
19695 @node Configurations
19696 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
19697
19698 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
19699 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
19700 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
19701
19702 There are three major categories of configurations: native
19703 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
19704 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
19705 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
19706 are quite different from each other.
19707
19708 @menu
19709 * Native::
19710 * Embedded OS::
19711 * Embedded Processors::
19712 * Architectures::
19713 @end menu
19714
19715 @node Native
19716 @section Native
19717
19718 This section describes details specific to particular native
19719 configurations.
19720
19721 @menu
19722 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
19723 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
19724 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
19725 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
19726 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
19727 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
19728 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
19729 @end menu
19730
19731 @node HP-UX
19732 @subsection HP-UX
19733
19734 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
19735 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
19736 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
19737
19738
19739 @node BSD libkvm Interface
19740 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
19741
19742 @cindex libkvm
19743 @cindex kernel memory image
19744 @cindex kernel crash dump
19745
19746 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
19747 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
19748 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
19749 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
19750 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
19751 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
19752 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
19753 @code{kvm} target:
19754
19755 @smallexample
19756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
19757 @end smallexample
19758
19759 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
19760 argument:
19761
19762 @smallexample
19763 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
19764 @end smallexample
19765
19766 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
19767 available:
19768
19769 @table @code
19770 @kindex kvm
19771 @item kvm pcb
19772 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
19773
19774 @item kvm proc
19775 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
19776 modern FreeBSD systems.
19777 @end table
19778
19779 @node SVR4 Process Information
19780 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
19781 @cindex /proc
19782 @cindex examine process image
19783 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
19784
19785 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
19786 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
19787 process using file-system subroutines.
19788
19789 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
19790 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
19791 information about the process running your program, or about any
19792 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
19793 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, but not HP-UX, for example.
19794
19795 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
19796 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
19797
19798 @table @code
19799 @kindex info proc
19800 @cindex process ID
19801 @item info proc
19802 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
19803 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
19804 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
19805 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
19806 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
19807 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
19808 executable file's absolute file name.
19809
19810 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
19811 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
19812 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
19813 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
19814 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
19815 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
19816
19817 @item info proc cmdline
19818 @cindex info proc cmdline
19819 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
19820 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19821
19822 @item info proc cwd
19823 @cindex info proc cwd
19824 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
19825 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19826
19827 @item info proc exe
19828 @cindex info proc exe
19829 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
19830 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
19831
19832 @item info proc mappings
19833 @cindex memory address space mappings
19834 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
19835 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
19836 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
19837 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
19838 memory access rights to that range.
19839
19840 @item info proc stat
19841 @itemx info proc status
19842 @cindex process detailed status information
19843 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
19844 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
19845 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
19846 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
19847 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
19848 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
19849 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
19850
19851 @item info proc all
19852 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
19853 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
19854
19855 @ignore
19856 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
19857 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
19858 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
19859 @kindex info proc times
19860 @item info proc times
19861 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
19862 its children.
19863
19864 @kindex info proc id
19865 @item info proc id
19866 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
19867 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
19868 @end ignore
19869
19870 @item set procfs-trace
19871 @kindex set procfs-trace
19872 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
19873 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
19874
19875 @item show procfs-trace
19876 @kindex show procfs-trace
19877 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
19878
19879 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
19880 @kindex set procfs-file
19881 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
19882 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
19883 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
19884 standard output.
19885
19886 @item show procfs-file
19887 @kindex show procfs-file
19888 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
19889
19890 @item proc-trace-entry
19891 @itemx proc-trace-exit
19892 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
19893 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
19894 @kindex proc-trace-entry
19895 @kindex proc-trace-exit
19896 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
19897 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
19898 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
19899 from the @code{syscall} interface.
19900
19901 @item info pidlist
19902 @kindex info pidlist
19903 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
19904 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
19905 processes and all the threads within each process.
19906
19907 @item info meminfo
19908 @kindex info meminfo
19909 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
19910 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
19911 @end table
19912
19913 @node DJGPP Native
19914 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
19915 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
19916 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
19917 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
19918
19919 @cindex DPMI
19920 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
19921 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
19922 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
19923 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
19924
19925 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
19926 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
19927 subsection describes those commands.
19928
19929 @table @code
19930 @kindex info dos
19931 @item info dos
19932 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
19933 information about the target system and important OS structures.
19934
19935 @kindex sysinfo
19936 @cindex MS-DOS system info
19937 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
19938 @item info dos sysinfo
19939 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
19940 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
19941 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
19942
19943 @cindex GDT
19944 @cindex LDT
19945 @cindex IDT
19946 @cindex segment descriptor tables
19947 @cindex descriptor tables display
19948 @item info dos gdt
19949 @itemx info dos ldt
19950 @itemx info dos idt
19951 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
19952 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
19953 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
19954 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
19955 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
19956 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
19957 rights.
19958
19959 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
19960 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
19961 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
19962 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
19963 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
19964
19965 @cindex garbled pointers
19966 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
19967 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
19968 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
19969 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
19970 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
19971 debugged program's data segment:
19972
19973 @smallexample
19974 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
19975 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
19976 @end smallexample
19977
19978 @noindent
19979 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
19980 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
19981
19982 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
19983 @item info dos pde
19984 @itemx info dos pte
19985 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
19986 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
19987 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
19988 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
19989 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
19990 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
19991 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
19992 that is currently in use.
19993
19994 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
19995 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
19996 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
19997 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
19998 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
19999 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
20000 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
20001
20002 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
20003 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
20004 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
20005 controller.
20006
20007 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
20008
20009 @cindex physical address from linear address
20010 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
20011 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
20012 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
20013 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
20014 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
20015 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
20016 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
20017
20018 @smallexample
20019 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
20020 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
20021 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
20022 @end smallexample
20023
20024 @noindent
20025 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
20026 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
20027 attributes of that page.
20028
20029 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
20030 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
20031 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
20032 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
20033 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
20034 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
20035
20036 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
20037 transfer buffer:
20038
20039 @smallexample
20040 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
20041 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
20042 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
20043 @end smallexample
20044
20045 @noindent
20046 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
20047 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
20048 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
20049 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
20050 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
20051
20052 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
20053 @end table
20054
20055 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
20056 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
20057 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
20058 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
20059
20060 @table @code
20061 @kindex set com1base
20062 @kindex set com1irq
20063 @kindex set com2base
20064 @kindex set com2irq
20065 @kindex set com3base
20066 @kindex set com3irq
20067 @kindex set com4base
20068 @kindex set com4irq
20069 @item set com1base @var{addr}
20070 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
20071 port.
20072
20073 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
20074 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
20075 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
20076
20077 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
20078 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
20079 other 3 COM ports.
20080
20081 @kindex show com1base
20082 @kindex show com1irq
20083 @kindex show com2base
20084 @kindex show com2irq
20085 @kindex show com3base
20086 @kindex show com3irq
20087 @kindex show com4base
20088 @kindex show com4irq
20089 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
20090 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
20091 lines used by the COM ports.
20092
20093 @item info serial
20094 @kindex info serial
20095 @cindex DOS serial port status
20096 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
20097 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
20098 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
20099 counts of various errors encountered so far.
20100 @end table
20101
20102
20103 @node Cygwin Native
20104 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
20105 @cindex MS Windows debugging
20106 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
20107 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
20108
20109 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
20110 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
20111
20112 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
20113 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
20114 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
20115 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
20116 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
20117 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
20118 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
20119 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
20120
20121 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
20122 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
20123 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
20124
20125 @table @code
20126 @kindex info w32
20127 @item info w32
20128 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
20129 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20130
20131 @item info w32 selector
20132 This command displays information returned by
20133 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
20134 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
20135 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
20136 Without argument, this command displays information
20137 about the six segment registers.
20138
20139 @item info w32 thread-information-block
20140 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
20141 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
20142 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
20143
20144 @kindex info dll
20145 @item info dll
20146 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
20147
20148 @kindex dll-symbols
20149 @item dll-symbols
20150 This command is deprecated and will be removed in future versions
20151 of @value{GDBN}. Use the @code{sharedlibrary} command instead.
20152
20153 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
20154 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
20155
20156 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
20157 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
20158 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
20159 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
20160 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
20161 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
20162 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
20163 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
20164 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
20165 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
20166 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
20167
20168 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
20169 @item show cygwin-exceptions
20170 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
20171 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
20172
20173 @kindex set new-console
20174 @item set new-console @var{mode}
20175 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
20176 be started in a new console on next start.
20177 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
20178 be started in the same console as the debugger.
20179
20180 @kindex show new-console
20181 @item show new-console
20182 Displays whether a new console is used
20183 when the debuggee is started.
20184
20185 @kindex set new-group
20186 @item set new-group @var{mode}
20187 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
20188 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
20189 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
20190 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
20191
20192 @kindex show new-group
20193 @item show new-group
20194 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
20195
20196 @kindex set debugevents
20197 @item set debugevents
20198 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
20199 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
20200 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
20201 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
20202 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
20203
20204 @kindex set debugexec
20205 @item set debugexec
20206 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
20207 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
20208
20209 @kindex set debugexceptions
20210 @item set debugexceptions
20211 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
20212 debuggee seen by the debugger.
20213
20214 @kindex set debugmemory
20215 @item set debugmemory
20216 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
20217 and writes by the debugger.
20218
20219 @kindex set shell
20220 @item set shell
20221 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
20222 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
20223
20224 @kindex show shell
20225 @item show shell
20226 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
20227
20228 @end table
20229
20230 @menu
20231 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
20232 @end menu
20233
20234 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
20235 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
20236 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
20237 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
20238
20239 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
20240 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
20241 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
20242 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
20243 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
20244 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
20245 ``minimal symbols''.
20246
20247 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
20248 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
20249 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
20250 program run once to completion.
20251
20252 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
20253
20254 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
20255 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
20256 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
20257 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
20258 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
20259 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
20260 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
20261 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
20262 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
20263
20264 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
20265 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
20266 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
20267 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
20268 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
20269 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
20270
20271 @smallexample
20272 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
20273 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
20274
20275 Non-debugging symbols:
20276 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
20277 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
20278 @end smallexample
20279
20280 @smallexample
20281 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
20282 All functions matching regular expression "!":
20283
20284 Non-debugging symbols:
20285 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
20286 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
20287 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
20288 [etc...]
20289 @end smallexample
20290
20291 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
20292
20293 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
20294 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
20295 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
20296 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
20297 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
20298 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
20299 a function within a DLL without a running program.
20300
20301 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
20302 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
20303 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
20304 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
20305 problem:
20306
20307 @smallexample
20308 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
20309 $1 = 268572168
20310 @end smallexample
20311
20312 @smallexample
20313 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
20314 0x10021610: "\230y\""
20315 @end smallexample
20316
20317 And two possible solutions:
20318
20319 @smallexample
20320 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
20321 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20322 @end smallexample
20323
20324 @smallexample
20325 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
20326 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
20327 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
20328 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
20329 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
20330 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20331 @end smallexample
20332
20333 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
20334 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
20335 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
20336 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
20337 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
20338
20339 @smallexample
20340 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
20341 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
20342 @end smallexample
20343
20344 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
20345 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
20346 safe.
20347
20348 @node Hurd Native
20349 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
20350 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
20351
20352 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
20353 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
20354
20355 @table @code
20356 @item set signals
20357 @itemx set sigs
20358 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
20359 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20360 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
20361 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
20362 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
20363 @code{signals}.
20364
20365 @item show signals
20366 @itemx show sigs
20367 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
20368 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20369 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
20370
20371 @item set signal-thread
20372 @itemx set sigthread
20373 @kindex set signal-thread
20374 @kindex set sigthread
20375 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
20376 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
20377 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
20378 signal-thread}.
20379
20380 @item show signal-thread
20381 @itemx show sigthread
20382 @kindex show signal-thread
20383 @kindex show sigthread
20384 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
20385 delivered a signal.
20386
20387 @item set stopped
20388 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20389 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
20390 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
20391 continued by delivering a signal to it.
20392
20393 @item show stopped
20394 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20395 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
20396 stopped.
20397
20398 @item set exceptions
20399 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20400 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
20401 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
20402 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
20403 trapping on.
20404
20405 @item show exceptions
20406 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20407 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
20408
20409 @item set task pause
20410 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
20411 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20412 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20413 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
20414 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
20415 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
20416 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
20417 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
20418 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
20419
20420 @item show task pause
20421 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
20422 Show the current state of task suspension.
20423
20424 @item set task detach-suspend-count
20425 @cindex task suspend count
20426 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20427 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
20428 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
20429
20430 @item show task detach-suspend-count
20431 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
20432
20433 @item set task exception-port
20434 @itemx set task excp
20435 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20436 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
20437 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
20438 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
20439
20440 @item set noninvasive
20441 @cindex noninvasive task options
20442 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
20443 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
20444 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
20445 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
20446
20447 @item info send-rights
20448 @itemx info receive-rights
20449 @itemx info port-rights
20450 @itemx info port-sets
20451 @itemx info dead-names
20452 @itemx info ports
20453 @itemx info psets
20454 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20455 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20456 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20457 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20458 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20459 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
20460 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
20461 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
20462 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
20463
20464 @item set thread pause
20465 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
20466 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20467 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20468 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
20469 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
20470 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
20471 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
20472 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
20473 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
20474 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
20475 only the current thread.
20476
20477 @item show thread pause
20478 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
20479 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
20480
20481 @item set thread run
20482 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20483
20484 @item show thread run
20485 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
20486
20487 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
20488 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20489 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20490 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
20491 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
20492 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
20493 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
20494
20495 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
20496 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
20497 detaching.
20498
20499 @item set thread exception-port
20500 @itemx set thread excp
20501 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
20502 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
20503 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
20504
20505 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
20506 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
20507 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
20508 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
20509
20510 @item set thread default
20511 @itemx show thread default
20512 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20513 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
20514 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
20515 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
20516 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
20517 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
20518 the non-default commands.
20519 @end table
20520
20521 @node Darwin
20522 @subsection Darwin
20523 @cindex Darwin
20524
20525 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
20526
20527 @table @code
20528 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
20529 @kindex set debug darwin
20530 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
20531 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
20532
20533 @item show debug darwin
20534 @kindex show debug darwin
20535 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
20536
20537 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
20538 @kindex set debug mach-o
20539 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
20540 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
20541 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
20542 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
20543 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
20544 usage.
20545
20546 @item show debug mach-o
20547 @kindex show debug mach-o
20548 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
20549
20550 @item set mach-exceptions on
20551 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
20552 @kindex set mach-exceptions
20553 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
20554 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
20555 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
20556 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
20557
20558 @item show mach-exceptions
20559 @kindex show mach-exceptions
20560 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
20561 @end table
20562
20563
20564 @node Embedded OS
20565 @section Embedded Operating Systems
20566
20567 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
20568 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
20569 architectures.
20570
20571 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
20572 various real-time operating systems.
20573
20574 @node Embedded Processors
20575 @section Embedded Processors
20576
20577 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
20578 configurations.
20579
20580 @cindex send command to simulator
20581 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
20582 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
20583
20584 @table @code
20585 @item sim @var{command}
20586 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
20587 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
20588 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
20589 acceptable commands.
20590 @end table
20591
20592
20593 @menu
20594 * ARM:: ARM RDI
20595 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
20596 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
20597 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
20598 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
20599 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
20600 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
20601 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
20602 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
20603 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
20604 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
20605 * CRIS:: CRIS
20606 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
20607 @end menu
20608
20609 @node ARM
20610 @subsection ARM
20611 @cindex ARM RDI
20612
20613 @table @code
20614 @kindex target rdi
20615 @item target rdi @var{dev}
20616 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
20617 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
20618 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
20619
20620 @kindex target rdp
20621 @item target rdp @var{dev}
20622 ARM Demon monitor.
20623
20624 @end table
20625
20626 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
20627
20628 @table @code
20629 @item set arm disassembler
20630 @kindex set arm
20631 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
20632 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
20633
20634 @item show arm disassembler
20635 @kindex show arm
20636 Show the current disassembly style.
20637
20638 @item set arm apcs32
20639 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
20640 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
20641
20642 @item show arm apcs32
20643 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
20644
20645 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
20646 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
20647 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
20648
20649 @table @code
20650 @item auto
20651 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
20652 @item softfpa
20653 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
20654 processors.
20655 @item fpa
20656 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
20657 @item softvfp
20658 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
20659 @item vfp
20660 VFP co-processor.
20661 @end table
20662
20663 @item show arm fpu
20664 Show the current type of the FPU.
20665
20666 @item set arm abi
20667 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
20668
20669 @item show arm abi
20670 Show the currently used ABI.
20671
20672 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20673 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
20674 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
20675 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
20676 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
20677 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
20678 register).
20679
20680 @item show arm fallback-mode
20681 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
20682
20683 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
20684 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
20685 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
20686 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
20687 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
20688
20689 @item show arm force-mode
20690 Show the current forced instruction mode.
20691
20692 @item set debug arm
20693 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
20694 target support subsystem.
20695
20696 @item show debug arm
20697 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
20698 @end table
20699
20700 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
20701 using the RDI interface:
20702
20703 @table @code
20704 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20705 @kindex rdilogfile
20706 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
20707 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
20708 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
20709 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
20710 @file{rdi.log}.
20711
20712 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
20713 @kindex rdilogenable
20714 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
20715 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
20716 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
20717 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
20718 are logged to a file.
20719
20720 @item set rdiromatzero
20721 @kindex set rdiromatzero
20722 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
20723 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
20724 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
20725 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
20726 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
20727
20728 @item show rdiromatzero
20729 @kindex show rdiromatzero
20730 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
20731
20732 @item set rdiheartbeat
20733 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
20734 @cindex RDI heartbeat
20735 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
20736 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
20737 well as the Angel monitor.
20738
20739 @item show rdiheartbeat
20740 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
20741 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
20742 @end table
20743
20744 @table @code
20745 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20746 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
20747
20748 @table @code
20749 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
20750 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
20751 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
20752 The default value is @code{all}.
20753
20754 @table @code
20755 @item none
20756 @item demon
20757 @item angel
20758 @item redboot
20759 @item all
20760 @end table
20761 @end table
20762 @end table
20763
20764 @node M32R/D
20765 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
20766
20767 @table @code
20768 @kindex target m32r
20769 @item target m32r @var{dev}
20770 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
20771
20772 @kindex target m32rsdi
20773 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
20774 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
20775 @end table
20776
20777 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
20778
20779 @table @code
20780 @item set download-path @var{path}
20781 @kindex set download-path
20782 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
20783 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20784
20785 @item show download-path
20786 @kindex show download-path
20787 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
20788
20789 @item set board-address @var{addr}
20790 @kindex set board-address
20791 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
20792 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
20793
20794 @item show board-address
20795 @kindex show board-address
20796 Show the current IP address of the target board.
20797
20798 @item set server-address @var{addr}
20799 @kindex set server-address
20800 @cindex download server address (M32R)
20801 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
20802 host machine.
20803
20804 @item show server-address
20805 @kindex show server-address
20806 Display the IP address of the download server.
20807
20808 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20809 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
20810 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
20811 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
20812 executable file is uploaded.
20813
20814 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
20815 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
20816 Test the @code{upload} command.
20817 @end table
20818
20819 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
20820
20821 @table @code
20822 @item sdireset
20823 @kindex sdireset
20824 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
20825 This command resets the SDI connection.
20826
20827 @item sdistatus
20828 @kindex sdistatus
20829 This command shows the SDI connection status.
20830
20831 @item debug_chaos
20832 @kindex debug_chaos
20833 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
20834 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
20835
20836 @item use_debug_dma
20837 @kindex use_debug_dma
20838 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
20839
20840 @item use_mon_code
20841 @kindex use_mon_code
20842 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
20843
20844 @item use_ib_break
20845 @kindex use_ib_break
20846 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
20847
20848 @item use_dbt_break
20849 @kindex use_dbt_break
20850 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
20851 @end table
20852
20853 @node M68K
20854 @subsection M68k
20855
20856 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
20857 target command for the following ROM monitor.
20858
20859 @table @code
20860
20861 @kindex target dbug
20862 @item target dbug @var{dev}
20863 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
20864
20865 @end table
20866
20867 @node MicroBlaze
20868 @subsection MicroBlaze
20869 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
20870 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
20871
20872 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
20873 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
20874 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
20875 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
20876 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
20877 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
20878 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
20879 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
20880 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
20881 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
20882 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
20883
20884 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
20885
20886 @table @code
20887 @item target remote :1234
20888 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
20889 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
20890
20891 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
20892 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
20893 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
20894
20895 @item load
20896 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
20897
20898 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
20899 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
20900
20901 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
20902 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
20903 @end table
20904
20905 @node MIPS Embedded
20906 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
20907
20908 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
20909 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
20910 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
20911 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
20912
20913 @need 1000
20914 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
20915
20916 @table @code
20917 @item target mips @var{port}
20918 @kindex target mips @var{port}
20919 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
20920 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
20921 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
20922 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
20923 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
20924 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
20925
20926 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
20927 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
20928 debugger:
20929
20930 @smallexample
20931 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
20932 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
20933 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
20934 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
20935 (@value{GDBP}) run
20936 @end smallexample
20937
20938 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
20939 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
20940 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
20941 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
20942 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
20943
20944 @item target pmon @var{port}
20945 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
20946 PMON ROM monitor.
20947
20948 @item target ddb @var{port}
20949 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
20950 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
20951
20952 @item target lsi @var{port}
20953 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
20954 LSI variant of PMON.
20955
20956 @kindex target r3900
20957 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
20958 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
20959
20960 @kindex target array
20961 @item target array @var{dev}
20962 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
20963
20964 @end table
20965
20966
20967 @noindent
20968 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
20969
20970 @table @code
20971 @item set mipsfpu double
20972 @itemx set mipsfpu single
20973 @itemx set mipsfpu none
20974 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
20975 @itemx show mipsfpu
20976 @kindex set mipsfpu
20977 @kindex show mipsfpu
20978 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
20979 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
20980 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
20981 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
20982 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
20983 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
20984 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
20985 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
20986 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
20987 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
20988 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
20989 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
20990 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
20991
20992 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
20993 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
20994 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
20995
20996 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
20997 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
20998
20999 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
21000 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
21001 @itemx show timeout
21002 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
21003 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21004 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21005 @kindex set timeout
21006 @kindex show timeout
21007 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
21008 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
21009 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
21010 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
21011 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
21012 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
21013 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
21014 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
21015 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
21016 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
21017
21018 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
21019 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
21020 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
21021 to run before stopping.
21022
21023 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
21024 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21025 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
21026 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
21027 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
21028 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
21029
21030 @item show syn-garbage-limit
21031 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21032 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
21033 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
21034
21035 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
21036 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21037 @cindex remote monitor prompt
21038 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
21039 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
21040 @table @asis
21041 @item pmon target
21042 @samp{PMON}
21043 @item ddb target
21044 @samp{NEC010}
21045 @item lsi target
21046 @samp{PMON>}
21047 @end table
21048
21049 @item show monitor-prompt
21050 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21051 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
21052 remote monitor.
21053
21054 @item set monitor-warnings
21055 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21056 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
21057 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
21058 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
21059 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
21060
21061 @item show monitor-warnings
21062 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21063 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
21064
21065 @item pmon @var{command}
21066 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21067 @cindex send PMON command
21068 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
21069 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
21070 @end table
21071
21072 @node PowerPC Embedded
21073 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
21074
21075 @cindex DVC register
21076 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
21077 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
21078
21079 @smallexample
21080 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
21081 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
21082 @end smallexample
21083
21084 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
21085 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
21086 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
21087 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
21088 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
21089 or newer.
21090
21091 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
21092 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
21093 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
21094 watching variables of scalar types.
21095
21096 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
21097 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
21098
21099 @smallexample
21100 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
21101 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
21102 @end smallexample
21103
21104 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
21105 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
21106
21107 @cindex ranged breakpoint
21108 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
21109 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
21110 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
21111 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
21112 use the @code{break-range} command.
21113
21114 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
21115
21116 @table @code
21117 @kindex break-range
21118 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
21119 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
21120 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
21121 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
21122 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
21123 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
21124 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
21125 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
21126 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
21127
21128 @kindex set powerpc
21129 @item set powerpc soft-float
21130 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
21131 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
21132 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
21133 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21134
21135 @item set powerpc vector-abi
21136 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
21137 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
21138 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
21139 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
21140 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
21141 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
21142 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21143
21144 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
21145 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
21146 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
21147 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
21148 address of its first byte.
21149
21150 @kindex target dink32
21151 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
21152 DINK32 ROM monitor.
21153
21154 @kindex target ppcbug
21155 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
21156 @kindex target ppcbug1
21157 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
21158 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
21159
21160 @kindex target sds
21161 @item target sds @var{dev}
21162 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
21163 @end table
21164
21165 @cindex SDS protocol
21166 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
21167 by @value{GDBN}:
21168
21169 @table @code
21170 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
21171 @kindex set sdstimeout
21172 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
21173 default is 2 seconds.
21174
21175 @item show sdstimeout
21176 @kindex show sdstimeout
21177 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
21178
21179 @item sds @var{command}
21180 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
21181 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
21182 @end table
21183
21184
21185 @node PA
21186 @subsection HP PA Embedded
21187
21188 @table @code
21189
21190 @kindex target op50n
21191 @item target op50n @var{dev}
21192 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
21193
21194 @kindex target w89k
21195 @item target w89k @var{dev}
21196 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
21197
21198 @end table
21199
21200 @node Sparclet
21201 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
21202
21203 @cindex Sparclet
21204
21205 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
21206 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
21207 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
21208 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
21209 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
21210
21211 @table @code
21212 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
21213 @kindex remotetimeout
21214 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
21215 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
21216 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
21217 @end table
21218
21219 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
21220 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
21221 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
21222 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
21223 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
21224
21225 @smallexample
21226 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
21227 @end smallexample
21228
21229 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
21230
21231 @smallexample
21232 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
21233 @end smallexample
21234
21235 @cindex running, on Sparclet
21236 Once you have set
21237 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
21238 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
21239 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
21240
21241 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
21242
21243 @smallexample
21244 (gdbslet)
21245 @end smallexample
21246
21247 @menu
21248 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
21249 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
21250 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
21251 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
21252 @end menu
21253
21254 @node Sparclet File
21255 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
21256
21257 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
21258
21259 @smallexample
21260 (gdbslet) file prog
21261 @end smallexample
21262
21263 @need 1000
21264 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
21265 @value{GDBN} locates
21266 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
21267 path.
21268 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
21269 files will be searched as well.
21270 @value{GDBN} locates
21271 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
21272 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
21273 If it fails
21274 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
21275
21276 @smallexample
21277 prog: No such file or directory.
21278 @end smallexample
21279
21280 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
21281 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
21282 @code{target} command again.
21283
21284 @node Sparclet Connection
21285 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
21286
21287 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
21288 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
21289
21290 @smallexample
21291 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
21292 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
21293 main () at ../prog.c:3
21294 @end smallexample
21295
21296 @need 750
21297 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
21298
21299 @smallexample
21300 Connected to ttya.
21301 @end smallexample
21302
21303 @node Sparclet Download
21304 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
21305
21306 @cindex download to Sparclet
21307 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
21308 you can use the @value{GDBN}
21309 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
21310 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
21311 command.
21312 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
21313 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
21314 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
21315 of each of the file's sections.
21316 For instance, if the program
21317 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
21318 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
21319
21320 @smallexample
21321 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
21322 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
21323 @end smallexample
21324
21325 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
21326 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
21327 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
21328
21329 @node Sparclet Execution
21330 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
21331
21332 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
21333 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
21334 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
21335 manual for the list of commands.
21336
21337 @smallexample
21338 (gdbslet) b main
21339 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
21340 (gdbslet) run
21341 Starting program: prog
21342 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
21343 3 char *symarg = 0;
21344 (gdbslet) step
21345 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
21346 (gdbslet)
21347 @end smallexample
21348
21349 @node Sparclite
21350 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
21351
21352 @table @code
21353
21354 @kindex target sparclite
21355 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
21356 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
21357 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
21358 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
21359 remote protocol.
21360
21361 @end table
21362
21363 @node Z8000
21364 @subsection Zilog Z8000
21365
21366 @cindex Z8000
21367 @cindex simulator, Z8000
21368 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
21369
21370 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
21371 a Z8000 simulator.
21372
21373 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
21374 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
21375 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
21376 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
21377
21378 @table @code
21379 @item target sim @var{args}
21380 @kindex sim
21381 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
21382 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
21383 options, specify them via @var{args}.
21384 @end table
21385
21386 @noindent
21387 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
21388 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
21389 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
21390 to run your program, and so on.
21391
21392 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
21393 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
21394 additional items of information as specially named registers:
21395
21396 @table @code
21397
21398 @item cycles
21399 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
21400
21401 @item insts
21402 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
21403
21404 @item time
21405 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
21406
21407 @end table
21408
21409 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
21410 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
21411 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
21412 simulated clock ticks.
21413
21414 @node AVR
21415 @subsection Atmel AVR
21416 @cindex AVR
21417
21418 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
21419 following AVR-specific commands:
21420
21421 @table @code
21422 @item info io_registers
21423 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
21424 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
21425 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
21426 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
21427 @end table
21428
21429 @node CRIS
21430 @subsection CRIS
21431 @cindex CRIS
21432
21433 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
21434 following CRIS-specific commands:
21435
21436 @table @code
21437 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
21438 @cindex CRIS version
21439 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
21440 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
21441 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
21442
21443 @item show cris-version
21444 Show the current CRIS version.
21445
21446 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
21447 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
21448 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
21449 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
21450 @code{R59}.
21451
21452 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
21453 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
21454
21455 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
21456 @cindex CRIS mode
21457 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
21458 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
21459 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
21460
21461 @item show cris-mode
21462 Show the current CRIS mode.
21463 @end table
21464
21465 @node Super-H
21466 @subsection Renesas Super-H
21467 @cindex Super-H
21468
21469 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
21470 commands:
21471
21472 @table @code
21473 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
21474 @kindex set sh calling-convention
21475 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
21476 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
21477 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
21478 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
21479 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
21480 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
21481 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
21482 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
21483 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
21484 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
21485
21486 @item show sh calling-convention
21487 @kindex show sh calling-convention
21488 Show the current calling convention setting.
21489
21490 @end table
21491
21492
21493 @node Architectures
21494 @section Architectures
21495
21496 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
21497 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
21498
21499 @menu
21500 * AArch64::
21501 * i386::
21502 * Alpha::
21503 * MIPS::
21504 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
21505 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21506 * PowerPC::
21507 * Nios II::
21508 @end menu
21509
21510 @node AArch64
21511 @subsection AArch64
21512 @cindex AArch64 support
21513
21514 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
21515 following special commands:
21516
21517 @table @code
21518 @item set debug aarch64
21519 @kindex set debug aarch64
21520 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
21521 messages are to be displayed.
21522
21523 @item show debug aarch64
21524 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
21525
21526 @end table
21527
21528 @node i386
21529 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
21530
21531 @table @code
21532 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
21533 @kindex set struct-convention
21534 @cindex struct return convention
21535 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
21536 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
21537 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
21538 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
21539 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
21540 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
21541 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
21542 be returned in a register.
21543
21544 @item show struct-convention
21545 @kindex show struct-convention
21546 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
21547 from functions.
21548 @end table
21549
21550 @subsubsection Intel(R) @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
21551 @cindex Intel(R) Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
21552
21553 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
21554 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
21555 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
21556 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
21557 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
21558 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
21559 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
21560
21561 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
21562 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
21563 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
21564 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
21565 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
21566 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
21567
21568 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
21569 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
21570 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
21571
21572 @smallexample
21573 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
21574 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
21575 @end smallexample
21576
21577 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
21578 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
21579 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
21580 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
21581 the pointer.
21582
21583 @node Alpha
21584 @subsection Alpha
21585
21586 See the following section.
21587
21588 @node MIPS
21589 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
21590
21591 @cindex stack on Alpha
21592 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
21593 @cindex Alpha stack
21594 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
21595 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
21596 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
21597 find the beginning of a function.
21598
21599 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
21600 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
21601 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
21602 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
21603 commands:
21604
21605 @table @code
21606 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
21607 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
21608 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
21609 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
21610 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
21611 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
21612 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
21613 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
21614
21615 @item show heuristic-fence-post
21616 Display the current limit.
21617 @end table
21618
21619 @noindent
21620 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
21621 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
21622
21623 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
21624 programs:
21625
21626 @table @code
21627 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
21628 @kindex set mips abi
21629 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
21630 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
21631 values of @var{arg} are:
21632
21633 @table @samp
21634 @item auto
21635 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
21636 default).
21637 @item o32
21638 @item o64
21639 @item n32
21640 @item n64
21641 @item eabi32
21642 @item eabi64
21643 @end table
21644
21645 @item show mips abi
21646 @kindex show mips abi
21647 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21648
21649 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
21650 @kindex set mips compression
21651 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
21652 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
21653 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
21654 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
21655 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
21656 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
21657 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
21658 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
21659 provided by the executable.
21660
21661 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
21662 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
21663 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
21664 identified as such.
21665
21666 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
21667 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
21668 implicitly from an executable.
21669
21670 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
21671 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
21672 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
21673 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
21674 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
21675
21676 @item show mips compression
21677 @kindex show mips compression
21678 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
21679 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
21680
21681 @item set mipsfpu
21682 @itemx show mipsfpu
21683 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
21684
21685 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
21686 @kindex set mips mask-address
21687 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
21688 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
21689 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
21690 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
21691 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
21692
21693 @item show mips mask-address
21694 @kindex show mips mask-address
21695 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
21696 not.
21697
21698 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21699 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21700 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
21701 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
21702 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
21703 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
21704
21705 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21706 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
21707 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
21708
21709 @item set debug mips
21710 @kindex set debug mips
21711 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
21712 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21713
21714 @item show debug mips
21715 @kindex show debug mips
21716 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
21717 @end table
21718
21719
21720 @node HPPA
21721 @subsection HPPA
21722 @cindex HPPA support
21723
21724 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
21725 following special commands:
21726
21727 @table @code
21728 @item set debug hppa
21729 @kindex set debug hppa
21730 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
21731 messages are to be displayed.
21732
21733 @item show debug hppa
21734 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
21735
21736 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
21737 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
21738 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
21739 given @var{address}.
21740
21741 @end table
21742
21743
21744 @node SPU
21745 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
21746 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
21747 @cindex SPU
21748
21749 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
21750 it provides the following special commands:
21751
21752 @table @code
21753 @item info spu event
21754 @kindex info spu
21755 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
21756 and pending event status.
21757
21758 @item info spu signal
21759 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
21760 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
21761 notification channels.
21762
21763 @item info spu mailbox
21764 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
21765 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
21766 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
21767
21768 @item info spu dma
21769 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21770 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21771 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21772
21773 @item info spu proxydma
21774 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
21775 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
21776 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
21777
21778 @end table
21779
21780 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
21781 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
21782 special commands:
21783
21784 @table @code
21785 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
21786 @kindex set spu
21787 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
21788 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
21789 function. The default is @code{off}.
21790
21791 @item show spu stop-on-load
21792 @kindex show spu
21793 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
21794
21795 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
21796 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
21797 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
21798 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
21799 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
21800 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
21801
21802 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
21803 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
21804
21805 @end table
21806
21807 @node PowerPC
21808 @subsection PowerPC
21809 @cindex PowerPC architecture
21810
21811 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
21812 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
21813 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
21814 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
21815 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
21816
21817 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
21818 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
21819 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
21820
21821 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
21822 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
21823
21824 @node Nios II
21825 @subsection Nios II
21826 @cindex Nios II architecture
21827
21828 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
21829 it provides the following special commands:
21830
21831 @table @code
21832
21833 @item set debug nios2
21834 @kindex set debug nios2
21835 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
21836 target code in @value{GDBN}.
21837
21838 @item show debug nios2
21839 @kindex show debug nios2
21840 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
21841 @end table
21842
21843 @node Controlling GDB
21844 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
21845
21846 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
21847 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
21848 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
21849 described here.
21850
21851 @menu
21852 * Prompt:: Prompt
21853 * Editing:: Command editing
21854 * Command History:: Command history
21855 * Screen Size:: Screen size
21856 * Numbers:: Numbers
21857 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
21858 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
21859 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
21860 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
21861 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
21862 @end menu
21863
21864 @node Prompt
21865 @section Prompt
21866
21867 @cindex prompt
21868
21869 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
21870 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
21871 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
21872 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
21873 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
21874 which one you are talking to.
21875
21876 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
21877 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
21878 or a prompt that does not.
21879
21880 @table @code
21881 @kindex set prompt
21882 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
21883 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
21884
21885 @kindex show prompt
21886 @item show prompt
21887 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
21888 @end table
21889
21890 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
21891 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
21892 are:
21893
21894 @table @code
21895 @kindex set extended-prompt
21896 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
21897 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
21898 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
21899 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
21900 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
21901 is displayed.
21902
21903 For example:
21904
21905 @smallexample
21906 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
21907 @end smallexample
21908
21909 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
21910 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
21911
21912 @kindex show extended-prompt
21913 @item show extended-prompt
21914 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
21915 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
21916 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
21917 @end table
21918
21919 @node Editing
21920 @section Command Editing
21921 @cindex readline
21922 @cindex command line editing
21923
21924 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
21925 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
21926 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
21927 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
21928 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
21929 debugging sessions.
21930
21931 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
21932 command @code{set}.
21933
21934 @table @code
21935 @kindex set editing
21936 @cindex editing
21937 @item set editing
21938 @itemx set editing on
21939 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
21940
21941 @item set editing off
21942 Disable command line editing.
21943
21944 @kindex show editing
21945 @item show editing
21946 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
21947 @end table
21948
21949 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21950 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
21951 @end ifset
21952 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21953 @xref{Command Line Editing},
21954 @end ifclear
21955 for more details about the Readline
21956 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
21957 encouraged to read that chapter.
21958
21959 @node Command History
21960 @section Command History
21961 @cindex command history
21962
21963 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
21964 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
21965 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
21966 history facility.
21967
21968 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
21969 package, to provide the history facility.
21970 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
21971 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
21972 @end ifset
21973 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
21974 @xref{Using History Interactively},
21975 @end ifclear
21976 for the detailed description of the History library.
21977
21978 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
21979 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
21980 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
21981 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
21982 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
21983 pressed on a line by itself.
21984
21985 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
21986 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
21987 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
21988 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
21989
21990 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
21991 history.
21992
21993 @table @code
21994 @cindex history substitution
21995 @cindex history file
21996 @kindex set history filename
21997 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
21998 @item set history filename @var{fname}
21999 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22000 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22001 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22002 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22003 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22004 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22005 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22006 is not set.
22007
22008 @cindex save command history
22009 @kindex set history save
22010 @item set history save
22011 @itemx set history save on
22012 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22013 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22014
22015 @item set history save off
22016 Stop recording command history in a file.
22017
22018 @cindex history size
22019 @kindex set history size
22020 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
22021 @item set history size @var{size}
22022 @itemx set history size unlimited
22023 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22024 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
22025 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set. If @var{size}
22026 is @code{unlimited}, the number of commands @value{GDBN} keeps in the
22027 history list is unlimited.
22028 @end table
22029
22030 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22031 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22032 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22033 @end ifset
22034 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22035 @xref{Event Designators},
22036 @end ifclear
22037 for more details.
22038
22039 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22040 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22041 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22042 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22043 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22044 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22045 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22046 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22047
22048 The commands to control history expansion are:
22049
22050 @table @code
22051 @item set history expansion on
22052 @itemx set history expansion
22053 @kindex set history expansion
22054 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22055
22056 @item set history expansion off
22057 Disable history expansion.
22058
22059 @c @group
22060 @kindex show history
22061 @item show history
22062 @itemx show history filename
22063 @itemx show history save
22064 @itemx show history size
22065 @itemx show history expansion
22066 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22067 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22068 @c @end group
22069 @end table
22070
22071 @table @code
22072 @kindex show commands
22073 @cindex show last commands
22074 @cindex display command history
22075 @item show commands
22076 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22077
22078 @item show commands @var{n}
22079 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22080
22081 @item show commands +
22082 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22083 @end table
22084
22085 @node Screen Size
22086 @section Screen Size
22087 @cindex size of screen
22088 @cindex screen size
22089 @cindex pagination
22090 @cindex page size
22091 @cindex pauses in output
22092
22093 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22094 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22095 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22096 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22097 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22098 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22099 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22100 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22101
22102 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22103 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22104 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22105 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22106 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22107 width} commands:
22108
22109 @table @code
22110 @kindex set height
22111 @kindex set width
22112 @kindex show width
22113 @kindex show height
22114 @item set height @var{lpp}
22115 @itemx set height unlimited
22116 @itemx show height
22117 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22118 @itemx set width unlimited
22119 @itemx show width
22120 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22121 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22122 commands display the current settings.
22123
22124 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22125 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22126 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22127 buffer.
22128
22129 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22130 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22131
22132 @item set pagination on
22133 @itemx set pagination off
22134 @kindex set pagination
22135 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22136 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22137 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22138 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22139
22140 @item show pagination
22141 @kindex show pagination
22142 Show the current pagination mode.
22143 @end table
22144
22145 @node Numbers
22146 @section Numbers
22147 @cindex number representation
22148 @cindex entering numbers
22149
22150 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22151 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22152 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22153 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22154 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22155 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22156 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22157 both input and output with the commands described below.
22158
22159 @table @code
22160 @kindex set input-radix
22161 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22162 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22163 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22164 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22165 example, any of
22166
22167 @smallexample
22168 set input-radix 012
22169 set input-radix 10.
22170 set input-radix 0xa
22171 @end smallexample
22172
22173 @noindent
22174 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22175 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22176 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22177 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22178 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22179 change the radix.
22180
22181 @kindex set output-radix
22182 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22183 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22184 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22185 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22186
22187 @kindex show input-radix
22188 @item show input-radix
22189 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22190
22191 @kindex show output-radix
22192 @item show output-radix
22193 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22194
22195 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22196 @itemx show radix
22197 @kindex set radix
22198 @kindex show radix
22199 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22200 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22201 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22202 default value of 10.
22203
22204 @end table
22205
22206 @node ABI
22207 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22208
22209 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22210 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22211 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22212 current ABI.
22213
22214 @cindex OS ABI
22215 @kindex set osabi
22216 @kindex show osabi
22217 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22218
22219 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22220 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22221 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22222 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22223 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22224 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22225 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22226 platform provides.
22227
22228 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22229 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22230 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22231 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22232
22233 @table @code
22234 @item show osabi
22235 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22236
22237 @item set osabi
22238 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22239
22240 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22241 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22242 @end table
22243
22244 @cindex float promotion
22245
22246 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22247 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22248 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22249 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22250 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22251 @code{double} and then passed.
22252
22253 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22254 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22255 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22256
22257 @table @code
22258 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
22259 @item set coerce-float-to-double
22260 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
22261 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
22262 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
22263
22264 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
22265 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
22266 functions.
22267
22268 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
22269 @item show coerce-float-to-double
22270 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
22271 @end table
22272
22273 @kindex set cp-abi
22274 @kindex show cp-abi
22275 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
22276 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
22277 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
22278 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
22279 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
22280 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
22281 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
22282 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
22283 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
22284 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
22285 ``auto''.
22286
22287 @table @code
22288 @item show cp-abi
22289 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
22290
22291 @item set cp-abi
22292 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
22293
22294 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
22295 @itemx set cp-abi auto
22296 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
22297 @end table
22298
22299 @node Auto-loading
22300 @section Automatically loading associated files
22301 @cindex auto-loading
22302
22303 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
22304 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
22305 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
22306 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
22307 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
22308 sources).
22309
22310 @menu
22311 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22312 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
22313
22314 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
22315 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
22316 @end menu
22317
22318 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
22319 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
22320 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
22321
22322 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
22323 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
22324 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22325
22326 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
22327 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
22328
22329 @table @code
22330 @anchor{set auto-load off}
22331 @kindex set auto-load off
22332 @item set auto-load off
22333 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
22334 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
22335 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
22336 @smallexample
22337 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
22338 @end smallexample
22339
22340 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
22341 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
22342 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
22343 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
22344 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
22345 @code{set auto-load no}.
22346
22347 @anchor{show auto-load}
22348 @kindex show auto-load
22349 @item show auto-load
22350 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
22351 or disabled.
22352
22353 @smallexample
22354 (gdb) show auto-load
22355 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
22356 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
22357 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
22358 is on.
22359 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
22360 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22361 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22362 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
22363 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22364 @end smallexample
22365
22366 @anchor{info auto-load}
22367 @kindex info auto-load
22368 @item info auto-load
22369 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
22370 not.
22371
22372 @smallexample
22373 (gdb) info auto-load
22374 gdb-scripts:
22375 Loaded Script
22376 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
22377 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
22378 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
22379 loaded.
22380 python-scripts:
22381 Loaded Script
22382 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
22383 @end smallexample
22384 @end table
22385
22386 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
22387
22388 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
22389 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
22390 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
22391 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
22392 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
22393 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
22394 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
22395 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22396 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22397 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22398 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22399 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22400 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22401 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
22402 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22403 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
22404 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22405 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
22406 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22407 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
22408 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22409 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
22410 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22411 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
22412 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22413 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22414 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22415 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
22416 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22417 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
22418 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
22419 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22420 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
22421 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22422 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
22423 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22424 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
22425 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
22426 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
22427 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
22428 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
22429 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
22430 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
22431 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
22432 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
22433 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
22434 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
22435 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
22436 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
22437 @end multitable
22438
22439 @node Init File in the Current Directory
22440 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
22441 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
22442
22443 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
22444 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
22445 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
22446
22447 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
22448 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22449
22450 @table @code
22451 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
22452 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
22453 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
22454 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
22455 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
22456
22457 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
22458 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
22459 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
22460 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22461 current directory is enabled or disabled.
22462
22463 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22464 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
22465 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
22466 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22467 current directory have been auto-loaded.
22468 @end table
22469
22470 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
22471 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
22472 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
22473
22474 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
22475
22476 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
22477 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
22478
22479 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
22480 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
22481 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
22482 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
22483 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
22484 library.
22485
22486 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
22487 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22488
22489 @table @code
22490 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
22491 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
22492 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
22493 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
22494
22495 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
22496 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
22497 @item show auto-load libthread-db
22498 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
22499 enabled or disabled.
22500
22501 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
22502 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
22503 @item info auto-load libthread-db
22504 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
22505 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
22506 @end table
22507
22508 @node Auto-loading safe path
22509 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
22510 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
22511
22512 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
22513 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
22514 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
22515 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
22516 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
22517
22518 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
22519 get loaded:
22520
22521 @smallexample
22522 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
22523 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
22524 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
22525 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22526 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22527 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
22528 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
22529 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
22530 @end smallexample
22531
22532 @noindent
22533 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
22534 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
22535
22536 @smallexample
22537 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
22538 @end smallexample
22539
22540 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
22541
22542 @table @code
22543 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
22544 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
22545 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
22546 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
22547 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
22548 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
22549 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
22550 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
22551 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
22552 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
22553
22554 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
22555 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
22556 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
22557
22558 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
22559 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
22560 @item show auto-load safe-path
22561 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
22562 scripts.
22563
22564 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
22565 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
22566 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
22567 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
22568 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
22569 by the host platform path separator in use.
22570 @end table
22571
22572 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
22573 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
22574 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22575 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
22576 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
22577
22578 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
22579 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
22580 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
22581 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
22582 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
22583 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
22584 init file in the current directory
22585 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
22586
22587 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
22588 example, you could use one of the following ways:
22589
22590 @table @asis
22591 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
22592 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
22593 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
22594 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
22595
22596 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
22597 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
22598 @value{GDBN} session.
22599
22600 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
22601 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22602 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
22603 from trusted sources.
22604
22605 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
22606 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
22607 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
22608 trusted sources.
22609 @end table
22610
22611 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
22612 also suppresses any such warning messages:
22613
22614 @table @asis
22615 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
22616 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
22617
22618 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
22619 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
22620 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
22621 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
22622 @end table
22623
22624 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
22625 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
22626 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
22627 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
22628 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
22629 recommended to be entered.
22630
22631 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
22632 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
22633 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
22634
22635 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
22636 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
22637 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
22638 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
22639 be printed.
22640
22641 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22642 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
22643 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
22644
22645 @smallexample
22646 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
22647 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
22648 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
22649 for objfile "/tmp/true".
22650 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
22651 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
22652 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
22653 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
22654 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
22655 @end smallexample
22656
22657 @table @code
22658 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
22659 @kindex set debug auto-load
22660 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
22661 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
22662
22663 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
22664 @kindex show debug auto-load
22665 @item show debug auto-load
22666 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
22667 on or off.
22668 @end table
22669
22670 @node Messages/Warnings
22671 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
22672
22673 @cindex verbose operation
22674 @cindex optional warnings
22675 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
22676 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
22677 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
22678 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
22679
22680 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
22681 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
22682 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
22683
22684 @table @code
22685 @kindex set verbose
22686 @item set verbose on
22687 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22688
22689 @item set verbose off
22690 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
22691
22692 @kindex show verbose
22693 @item show verbose
22694 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
22695 @end table
22696
22697 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
22698 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
22699 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
22700 Symbol Files}).
22701
22702 @table @code
22703
22704 @kindex set complaints
22705 @item set complaints @var{limit}
22706 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
22707 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
22708 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
22709 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
22710
22711 @kindex show complaints
22712 @item show complaints
22713 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
22714
22715 @end table
22716
22717 @anchor{confirmation requests}
22718 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
22719 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
22720 you try to run a program which is already running:
22721
22722 @smallexample
22723 (@value{GDBP}) run
22724 The program being debugged has been started already.
22725 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
22726 @end smallexample
22727
22728 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
22729 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
22730
22731 @table @code
22732
22733 @kindex set confirm
22734 @cindex flinching
22735 @cindex confirmation
22736 @cindex stupid questions
22737 @item set confirm off
22738 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
22739 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
22740 automatically disables confirmation requests.
22741
22742 @item set confirm on
22743 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
22744
22745 @kindex show confirm
22746 @item show confirm
22747 Displays state of confirmation requests.
22748
22749 @end table
22750
22751 @cindex command tracing
22752 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
22753 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
22754 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
22755 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
22756
22757 @table @code
22758 @kindex set trace-commands
22759 @cindex command scripts, debugging
22760 @item set trace-commands on
22761 Enable command tracing.
22762 @item set trace-commands off
22763 Disable command tracing.
22764 @item show trace-commands
22765 Display the current state of command tracing.
22766 @end table
22767
22768 @node Debugging Output
22769 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
22770 @cindex optional debugging messages
22771
22772 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
22773 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
22774 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
22775 section documents those commands.
22776
22777 @table @code
22778 @kindex set exec-done-display
22779 @item set exec-done-display
22780 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
22781 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
22782 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
22783 @kindex show exec-done-display
22784 @item show exec-done-display
22785 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
22786 notification.
22787 @kindex set debug
22788 @cindex ARM AArch64
22789 @item set debug aarch64
22790 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
22791 The default is off.
22792 @kindex show debug
22793 @item show debug aarch64
22794 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22795 ARM AArch64.
22796 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
22797 @cindex architecture debugging info
22798 @item set debug arch
22799 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
22800 @item show debug arch
22801 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
22802 @item set debug aix-solib
22803 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
22804 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
22805 support module. The default is off.
22806 @item show debug aix-thread
22807 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
22808 @item set debug aix-thread
22809 @cindex AIX threads
22810 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
22811 module.
22812 @item show debug aix-thread
22813 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
22814 @item set debug check-physname
22815 @cindex physname
22816 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
22817 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
22818 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
22819 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
22820 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
22821 both ways and display any discrepancies.
22822 @item show debug check-physname
22823 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
22824 @item set debug coff-pe-read
22825 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
22826 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
22827 exported symbols. The default is off.
22828 @item show debug coff-pe-read
22829 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22830 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22831 @item set debug dwarf2-die
22832 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
22833 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
22834 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
22835 A value of zero turns off the display.
22836 @item show debug dwarf2-die
22837 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
22838 @item set debug dwarf2-read
22839 @cindex DWARF2 Reading
22840 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
22841 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
22842 A value of 1 provides basic information.
22843 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
22844 @item show debug dwarf2-read
22845 Show the current state of DWARF2 reader debugging.
22846 @item set debug displaced
22847 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
22848 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
22849 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
22850 @item show debug displaced
22851 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
22852 related to displaced stepping.
22853 @item set debug event
22854 @cindex event debugging info
22855 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
22856 default is off.
22857 @item show debug event
22858 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
22859 info.
22860 @item set debug expression
22861 @cindex expression debugging info
22862 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
22863 expression parsing. The default is off.
22864 @item show debug expression
22865 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
22866 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
22867 @item set debug frame
22868 @cindex frame debugging info
22869 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
22870 default is off.
22871 @item show debug frame
22872 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
22873 info.
22874 @item set debug gnu-nat
22875 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
22876 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
22877 @item show debug gnu-nat
22878 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
22879 @item set debug infrun
22880 @cindex inferior debugging info
22881 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
22882 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
22883 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
22884 @item show debug infrun
22885 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
22886 @item set debug jit
22887 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
22888 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
22889 @item show debug jit
22890 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
22891 @item set debug lin-lwp
22892 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
22893 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
22894 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
22895 @item show debug lin-lwp
22896 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
22897 @item set debug mach-o
22898 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
22899 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
22900 processing. The default is off.
22901 @item show debug mach-o
22902 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
22903 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
22904 @item set debug notification
22905 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
22906 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
22907 The default is off.
22908 @item show debug notification
22909 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
22910 @item set debug observer
22911 @cindex observer debugging info
22912 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
22913 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
22914 @item show debug observer
22915 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
22916 @item set debug overload
22917 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
22918 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
22919 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
22920 is off.
22921 @item show debug overload
22922 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
22923 debugging info.
22924 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
22925 @cindex debug expression parser
22926 @item set debug parser
22927 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
22928 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
22929 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
22930 details. The default is off.
22931 @item show debug parser
22932 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
22933 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
22934 @cindex serial connections, debugging
22935 @cindex debug remote protocol
22936 @cindex remote protocol debugging
22937 @cindex display remote packets
22938 @item set debug remote
22939 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
22940 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
22941 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
22942 @item show debug remote
22943 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
22944 @item set debug serial
22945 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
22946 default is off.
22947 @item show debug serial
22948 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
22949 info.
22950 @item set debug solib-frv
22951 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
22952 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
22953 @item show debug solib-frv
22954 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
22955 messages.
22956 @item set debug symfile
22957 @cindex symbol file functions
22958 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
22959 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
22960 @item show debug symfile
22961 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
22962 @item set debug symtab-create
22963 @cindex symbol table creation
22964 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
22965 The default is 0 (off).
22966 A value of 1 provides basic information.
22967 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
22968 @item show debug symtab-create
22969 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
22970 @item set debug target
22971 @cindex target debugging info
22972 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
22973 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
22974 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
22975 value of large memory transfers.
22976 @item show debug target
22977 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
22978 info.
22979 @item set debug timestamp
22980 @cindex timestampping debugging info
22981 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
22982 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
22983 message.
22984 @item show debug timestamp
22985 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
22986 debugging info.
22987 @item set debug varobj
22988 @cindex variable object debugging info
22989 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
22990 info. The default is off.
22991 @item show debug varobj
22992 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
22993 debugging info.
22994 @item set debug xml
22995 @cindex XML parser debugging
22996 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
22997 @item show debug xml
22998 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
22999 @end table
23000
23001 @node Other Misc Settings
23002 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23003 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23004
23005 @table @code
23006 @kindex set interactive-mode
23007 @item set interactive-mode
23008 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23009 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23010 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23011 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23012 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23013 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23014 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23015 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23016
23017 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23018 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23019 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23020 inside a cygwin window.
23021
23022 @kindex show interactive-mode
23023 @item show interactive-mode
23024 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23025 @end table
23026
23027 @node Extending GDB
23028 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23029 @cindex extending GDB
23030
23031 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23032 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23033 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23034 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23035 being debugged.
23036
23037 @menu
23038 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23039 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23040 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23041 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
23042 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23043 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
23044 @end menu
23045
23046 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23047 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23048 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23049 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23050 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23051 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23052
23053 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23054 setting:
23055
23056 @table @code
23057 @kindex set script-extension
23058 @kindex show script-extension
23059 @item set script-extension off
23060 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23061
23062 @item set script-extension soft
23063 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23064 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23065 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23066 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23067
23068 @item set script-extension strict
23069 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23070 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23071 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23072
23073 @item show script-extension
23074 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23075
23076 @end table
23077
23078 @node Sequences
23079 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23080
23081 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23082 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23083 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23084 files.
23085
23086 @menu
23087 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23088 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23089 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23090 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23091 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23092 @end menu
23093
23094 @node Define
23095 @subsection User-defined Commands
23096
23097 @cindex user-defined command
23098 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23099 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23100 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23101 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23102 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23103 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23104
23105 @smallexample
23106 define adder
23107 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23108 end
23109 @end smallexample
23110
23111 @noindent
23112 To execute the command use:
23113
23114 @smallexample
23115 adder 1 2 3
23116 @end smallexample
23117
23118 @noindent
23119 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23120 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23121 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23122 functions calls.
23123
23124 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23125 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23126 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23127 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23128
23129 @smallexample
23130 define adder
23131 if $argc == 2
23132 print $arg0 + $arg1
23133 end
23134 if $argc == 3
23135 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23136 end
23137 end
23138 @end smallexample
23139
23140 @table @code
23141
23142 @kindex define
23143 @item define @var{commandname}
23144 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23145 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23146 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23147 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23148 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23149 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23150
23151 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23152 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23153 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23154
23155 @kindex document
23156 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23157 @item document @var{commandname}
23158 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23159 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23160 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23161 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23162 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23163 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23164
23165 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23166 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23167 does not change the documentation.
23168
23169 @kindex dont-repeat
23170 @cindex don't repeat command
23171 @item dont-repeat
23172 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23173 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23174 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23175
23176 @kindex help user-defined
23177 @item help user-defined
23178 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23179 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23180 included (if any).
23181
23182 @kindex show user
23183 @item show user
23184 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23185 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23186 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23187 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23188 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23189
23190 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23191 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23192 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23193 @item show max-user-call-depth
23194 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23195 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23196 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23197 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23198 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23199 @end table
23200
23201 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23202 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23203
23204 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23205 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23206 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23207
23208 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23209 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23210 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23211 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23212
23213 @node Hooks
23214 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23215 @cindex command hooks
23216 @cindex hooks, for commands
23217 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23218
23219 @kindex hook
23220 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23221 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23222 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23223 before that command.
23224
23225 @cindex hooks, post-command
23226 @kindex hookpost
23227 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23228 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23229 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23230 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
23231 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
23232
23233 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
23234 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
23235
23236 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
23237 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
23238
23239 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
23240 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
23241 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
23242 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
23243 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
23244
23245 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
23246 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
23247 you could define:
23248
23249 @smallexample
23250 define hook-stop
23251 handle SIGALRM nopass
23252 end
23253
23254 define hook-run
23255 handle SIGALRM pass
23256 end
23257
23258 define hook-continue
23259 handle SIGALRM pass
23260 end
23261 @end smallexample
23262
23263 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
23264 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
23265 you could define:
23266
23267 @smallexample
23268 define hook-echo
23269 echo <<<---
23270 end
23271
23272 define hookpost-echo
23273 echo --->>>\n
23274 end
23275
23276 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
23277 <<<---Hello World--->>>
23278 (@value{GDBP})
23279
23280 @end smallexample
23281
23282 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
23283 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
23284 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
23285 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
23286 @c or not?
23287 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
23288 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
23289 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
23290
23291 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
23292 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
23293 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
23294
23295 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
23296 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
23297
23298 @node Command Files
23299 @subsection Command Files
23300
23301 @cindex command files
23302 @cindex scripting commands
23303 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
23304 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
23305 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
23306 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
23307 terminal.
23308
23309 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
23310 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
23311 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
23312 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
23313 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
23314
23315 @table @code
23316 @kindex source
23317 @cindex execute commands from a file
23318 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
23319 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
23320 @end table
23321
23322 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
23323 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
23324 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
23325 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
23326 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
23327
23328 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
23329 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
23330 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
23331 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
23332 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
23333 is not relevant to scripts.
23334
23335 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
23336 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
23337 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
23338 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
23339 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23340 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
23341 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
23342 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
23343 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23344 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
23345 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
23346 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
23347 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
23348 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
23349
23350 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
23351 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
23352 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
23353
23354 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
23355 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
23356 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
23357 when called from command files.
23358
23359 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
23360 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
23361 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
23362 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
23363 the next command.
23364
23365 @smallexample
23366 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
23367 @end smallexample
23368
23369 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
23370 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
23371 would be directed to @file{log}.
23372
23373 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
23374 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
23375 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
23376 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
23377 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
23378 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
23379 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
23380 conditionally, etc.
23381
23382 @table @code
23383 @kindex if
23384 @kindex else
23385 @item if
23386 @itemx else
23387 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
23388 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
23389 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
23390 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
23391 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
23392 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
23393 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23394
23395 @kindex while
23396 @item while
23397 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
23398 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
23399 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
23400 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
23401 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
23402 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
23403
23404 @kindex loop_break
23405 @item loop_break
23406 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
23407 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
23408 line.
23409
23410 @kindex loop_continue
23411 @item loop_continue
23412 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
23413 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
23414 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
23415 the controlling expression.
23416
23417 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
23418 @item end
23419 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
23420 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
23421 @end table
23422
23423
23424 @node Output
23425 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
23426
23427 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
23428 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
23429 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
23430 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
23431 want.
23432
23433 @table @code
23434 @kindex echo
23435 @item echo @var{text}
23436 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
23437 @c because it is not in ANSI.
23438 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
23439 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
23440 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
23441 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
23442 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
23443 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
23444 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
23445 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
23446 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
23447
23448 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
23449 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
23450
23451 @smallexample
23452 echo This is some text\n\
23453 which is continued\n\
23454 onto several lines.\n
23455 @end smallexample
23456
23457 produces the same output as
23458
23459 @smallexample
23460 echo This is some text\n
23461 echo which is continued\n
23462 echo onto several lines.\n
23463 @end smallexample
23464
23465 @kindex output
23466 @item output @var{expression}
23467 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
23468 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
23469 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
23470 on expressions.
23471
23472 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
23473 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
23474 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
23475 Formats}, for more information.
23476
23477 @kindex printf
23478 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23479 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23480 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
23481 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
23482 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
23483 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
23484 executing the code below:
23485
23486 @smallexample
23487 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
23488 @end smallexample
23489
23490 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
23491 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
23492 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
23493 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
23494 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
23495 printed.
23496
23497 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
23498
23499 @smallexample
23500 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
23501 @end smallexample
23502
23503 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
23504 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
23505 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
23506
23507 @itemize @bullet
23508 @item
23509 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
23510
23511 @item
23512 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
23513 width.
23514
23515 @item
23516 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
23517 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
23518
23519 @item
23520 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
23521 supported.
23522
23523 @item
23524 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
23525
23526 @item
23527 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
23528 @end itemize
23529
23530 @noindent
23531 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
23532 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
23533 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
23534 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
23535
23536 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
23537 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
23538 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
23539 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
23540 supported.
23541
23542 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
23543 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
23544 together with a floating point specifier.
23545 letters:
23546
23547 @itemize @bullet
23548 @item
23549 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
23550
23551 @item
23552 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
23553
23554 @item
23555 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
23556 @end itemize
23557
23558 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
23559 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
23560 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
23561
23562 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
23563 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
23564
23565 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
23566 @smallexample
23567 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
23568 @end smallexample
23569
23570 @kindex eval
23571 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
23572 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
23573 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
23574
23575 @end table
23576
23577 @node Auto-loading sequences
23578 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
23579 @cindex native script auto-loading
23580
23581 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23582 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
23583 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
23584 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23585
23586 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23587 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23588
23589 @table @code
23590 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
23591 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
23592 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
23593 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
23594
23595 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
23596 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
23597 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
23598 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
23599 disabled.
23600
23601 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
23602 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
23603 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
23604 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
23605 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
23606 auto-loaded.
23607 @end table
23608
23609 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
23610 matching names are printed.
23611
23612 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
23613 @include python.texi
23614
23615 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
23616 @include guile.texi
23617
23618 @node Auto-loading extensions
23619 @section Auto-loading extensions
23620 @cindex auto-loading extensions
23621
23622 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
23623 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
23624 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
23625 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
23626 section of modern file formats like ELF.
23627
23628 @menu
23629 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
23630 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23631 * Which flavor to choose?::
23632 @end menu
23633
23634 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
23635 debugging commands and features.
23636
23637 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
23638 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
23639 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
23640 for more information.
23641 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
23642 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
23643
23644 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
23645 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23646
23647 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
23648 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
23649 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
23650 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23651 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
23652
23653 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
23654 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
23655 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
23656 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
23657
23658 @table @code
23659 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
23660 GDB's own command language
23661 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
23662 Python
23663 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
23664 Guile
23665 @end table
23666
23667 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
23668 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
23669 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
23670 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
23671 script in the specified extension language.
23672
23673 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
23674 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
23675
23676 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
23677 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23678
23679 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
23680 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
23681 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
23682 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
23683 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
23684 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
23685
23686 @table @code
23687 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
23688 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
23689 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23690 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
23691 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
23692 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
23693
23694 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
23695 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
23696
23697 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
23698 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
23699 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
23700 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
23701
23702 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
23703 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
23704 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
23705 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
23706 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
23707 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
23708 platform.
23709
23710 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23711 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23712 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23713
23714 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
23715 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
23716 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
23717 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23718
23719 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
23720 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
23721 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
23722 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
23723 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
23724 @end table
23725
23726 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
23727 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
23728 @var{objfile} is opened.
23729 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
23730 is evaluated more than once.
23731
23732 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
23733 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23734 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
23735
23736 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
23737 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
23738 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
23739 If this section exists, its contents is a list of NUL-terminated names
23740 of scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-NULL prefix byte that
23741 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language.
23742
23743 @value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
23744 current directory and then along the source search path
23745 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
23746 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
23747 directory is not relevant to scripts.
23748
23749 Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
23750 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
23751
23752 @example
23753 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
23754 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
23755 asm("\
23756 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
23757 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
23758 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
23759 .popsection \n\
23760 ");
23761 @end example
23762
23763 @noindent
23764 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
23765 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
23766
23767 @example
23768 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
23769 @end example
23770
23771 The script name may include directories if desired.
23772
23773 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
23774 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23775
23776 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
23777 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
23778 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
23779 will remove duplicates.
23780
23781 @node Which flavor to choose?
23782 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
23783
23784 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
23785 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
23786
23787 @noindent
23788 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
23789
23790 @itemize @bullet
23791 @item
23792 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
23793
23794 @item
23795 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
23796
23797 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
23798 in the source search path.
23799 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
23800 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
23801
23802 @item
23803 Doesn't require source code additions.
23804 @end itemize
23805
23806 @noindent
23807 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
23808
23809 @itemize @bullet
23810 @item
23811 Works with static linking.
23812
23813 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
23814 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
23815 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
23816 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
23817 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
23818
23819 @item
23820 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
23821
23822 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
23823 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
23824
23825 @item
23826 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
23827
23828 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
23829 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
23830 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
23831 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
23832 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
23833 top of the source tree to the source search path.
23834 @end itemize
23835
23836 @node Multiple Extension Languages
23837 @section Multiple Extension Languages
23838
23839 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
23840 and generally do not interfere with each other.
23841 There are some things to be aware of, however.
23842
23843 @subsection Python comes first
23844
23845 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
23846 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
23847 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
23848 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
23849 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
23850 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
23851 pretty-printed form of a value).
23852 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
23853 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
23854 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
23855
23856 @node Aliases
23857 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
23858 @cindex aliases for commands
23859
23860 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
23861 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
23862 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
23863 that involves less typing.
23864
23865 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
23866 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
23867 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
23868
23869 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
23870 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
23871 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
23872
23873 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
23874
23875 @table @code
23876
23877 @kindex alias
23878 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
23879
23880 @end table
23881
23882 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
23883 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
23884 underscores.
23885
23886 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
23887 that is being aliased.
23888
23889 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
23890 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
23891 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
23892
23893 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
23894 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
23895
23896 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
23897 of a command so that there is less to type.
23898 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
23899 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
23900 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
23901 The following will accomplish this.
23902
23903 @smallexample
23904 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
23905 @end smallexample
23906
23907 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
23908 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
23909 for it with the @samp{document} command.
23910 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
23911
23912 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
23913 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
23914 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
23915 of a command.
23916
23917 @smallexample
23918 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
23919 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
23920 (gdb) set p elms 20
23921 (gdb) show p elms
23922 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
23923 @end smallexample
23924
23925 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
23926 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
23927 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
23928
23929 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
23930 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
23931
23932 @smallexample
23933 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
23934 @end smallexample
23935
23936 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
23937 alias for a more complex command.
23938 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
23939
23940 @smallexample
23941 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
23942 (gdb) spe 20
23943 @end smallexample
23944
23945 @node Interpreters
23946 @chapter Command Interpreters
23947 @cindex command interpreters
23948
23949 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
23950 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
23951 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
23952
23953 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
23954 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
23955 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
23956 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
23957
23958 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
23959 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
23960 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
23961 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
23962
23963 @table @code
23964 @item console
23965 @cindex console interpreter
23966 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
23967 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
23968 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
23969
23970 @item mi
23971 @cindex mi interpreter
23972 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
23973 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
23974 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
23975 Interface}.
23976
23977 @item mi2
23978 @cindex mi2 interpreter
23979 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
23980
23981 @item mi1
23982 @cindex mi1 interpreter
23983 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
23984
23985 @end table
23986
23987 @cindex invoke another interpreter
23988 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
23989 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
23990 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
23991 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
23992 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
23993 the IDE inoperable!
23994
23995 @kindex interpreter-exec
23996 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
23997 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
23998 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
23999 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24000
24001 @smallexample
24002 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24003 @end smallexample
24004
24005 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24006 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24007
24008 @node TUI
24009 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24010 @cindex TUI
24011 @cindex Text User Interface
24012
24013 @menu
24014 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24015 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24016 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24017 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24018 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24019 @end menu
24020
24021 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24022 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24023 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24024 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24025 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24026 is available.
24027
24028 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
24029 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
24030 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
24031 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
24032 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
24033
24034 @node TUI Overview
24035 @section TUI Overview
24036
24037 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
24038
24039 @table @emph
24040 @item command
24041 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
24042 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
24043 managed using readline.
24044
24045 @item source
24046 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
24047 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
24048
24049 @item assembly
24050 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
24051
24052 @item register
24053 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
24054 when their values change.
24055 @end table
24056
24057 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
24058 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
24059 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
24060 indicates the breakpoint type:
24061
24062 @table @code
24063 @item B
24064 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24065
24066 @item b
24067 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24068
24069 @item H
24070 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24071
24072 @item h
24073 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24074 @end table
24075
24076 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24077
24078 @table @code
24079 @item +
24080 Breakpoint is enabled.
24081
24082 @item -
24083 Breakpoint is disabled.
24084 @end table
24085
24086 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24087 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24088 changes.
24089
24090 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24091 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24092 layouts:
24093
24094 @itemize @bullet
24095 @item
24096 source only,
24097
24098 @item
24099 assembly only,
24100
24101 @item
24102 source and assembly,
24103
24104 @item
24105 source and registers, or
24106
24107 @item
24108 assembly and registers.
24109 @end itemize
24110
24111 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24112
24113 @table @emph
24114 @item target
24115 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24116 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24117
24118 @item process
24119 Gives the current process or thread number.
24120 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24121
24122 @item function
24123 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24124 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24125 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24126 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24127
24128 @item line
24129 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24130 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24131
24132 @item pc
24133 Indicates the current program counter address.
24134 @end table
24135
24136 @node TUI Keys
24137 @section TUI Key Bindings
24138 @cindex TUI key bindings
24139
24140 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24141 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24142 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24143 @end ifset
24144 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24145 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24146 @end ifclear
24147 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24148 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24149
24150 @table @kbd
24151 @kindex C-x C-a
24152 @item C-x C-a
24153 @kindex C-x a
24154 @itemx C-x a
24155 @kindex C-x A
24156 @itemx C-x A
24157 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24158 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24159 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24160 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24161 The screen is then refreshed.
24162
24163 @kindex C-x 1
24164 @item C-x 1
24165 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24166 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24167 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24168
24169 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24170
24171 @kindex C-x 2
24172 @item C-x 2
24173 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24174 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24175 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24176 previous layout and the new one.
24177
24178 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24179
24180 @kindex C-x o
24181 @item C-x o
24182 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24183 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24184 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24185
24186 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24187
24188 @kindex C-x s
24189 @item C-x s
24190 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24191 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24192 @end table
24193
24194 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24195
24196 @table @asis
24197 @kindex PgUp
24198 @item @key{PgUp}
24199 Scroll the active window one page up.
24200
24201 @kindex PgDn
24202 @item @key{PgDn}
24203 Scroll the active window one page down.
24204
24205 @kindex Up
24206 @item @key{Up}
24207 Scroll the active window one line up.
24208
24209 @kindex Down
24210 @item @key{Down}
24211 Scroll the active window one line down.
24212
24213 @kindex Left
24214 @item @key{Left}
24215 Scroll the active window one column left.
24216
24217 @kindex Right
24218 @item @key{Right}
24219 Scroll the active window one column right.
24220
24221 @kindex C-L
24222 @item @kbd{C-L}
24223 Refresh the screen.
24224 @end table
24225
24226 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
24227 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
24228 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
24229 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
24230 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
24231
24232 @node TUI Single Key Mode
24233 @section TUI Single Key Mode
24234 @cindex TUI single key mode
24235
24236 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
24237 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
24238 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
24239
24240 @table @kbd
24241 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24242 @item c
24243 continue
24244
24245 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24246 @item d
24247 down
24248
24249 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24250 @item f
24251 finish
24252
24253 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24254 @item n
24255 next
24256
24257 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24258 @item q
24259 exit the SingleKey mode.
24260
24261 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24262 @item r
24263 run
24264
24265 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24266 @item s
24267 step
24268
24269 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24270 @item u
24271 up
24272
24273 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24274 @item v
24275 info locals
24276
24277 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24278 @item w
24279 where
24280 @end table
24281
24282 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
24283 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
24284 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
24285 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
24286 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
24287 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
24288
24289
24290 @node TUI Commands
24291 @section TUI-specific Commands
24292 @cindex TUI commands
24293
24294 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
24295 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
24296 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
24297 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
24298
24299 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
24300 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
24301 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
24302 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
24303 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
24304
24305 @table @code
24306 @item info win
24307 @kindex info win
24308 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
24309
24310 @item layout next
24311 @kindex layout
24312 Display the next layout.
24313
24314 @item layout prev
24315 Display the previous layout.
24316
24317 @item layout src
24318 Display the source window only.
24319
24320 @item layout asm
24321 Display the assembly window only.
24322
24323 @item layout split
24324 Display the source and assembly window.
24325
24326 @item layout regs
24327 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
24328
24329 @item focus next
24330 @kindex focus
24331 Make the next window active for scrolling.
24332
24333 @item focus prev
24334 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
24335
24336 @item focus src
24337 Make the source window active for scrolling.
24338
24339 @item focus asm
24340 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
24341
24342 @item focus regs
24343 Make the register window active for scrolling.
24344
24345 @item focus cmd
24346 Make the command window active for scrolling.
24347
24348 @item refresh
24349 @kindex refresh
24350 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
24351
24352 @item tui reg float
24353 @kindex tui reg
24354 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
24355
24356 @item tui reg general
24357 Show the general registers in the register window.
24358
24359 @item tui reg next
24360 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
24361 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
24362 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
24363 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
24364
24365 @item tui reg system
24366 Show the system registers in the register window.
24367
24368 @item update
24369 @kindex update
24370 Update the source window and the current execution point.
24371
24372 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
24373 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
24374 @kindex winheight
24375 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
24376 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
24377 decrease it.
24378
24379 @item tabset @var{nchars}
24380 @kindex tabset
24381 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
24382 @end table
24383
24384 @node TUI Configuration
24385 @section TUI Configuration Variables
24386 @cindex TUI configuration variables
24387
24388 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
24389
24390 @table @code
24391 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
24392 @kindex set tui border-kind
24393 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
24394 The possible values are the following:
24395 @table @code
24396 @item space
24397 Use a space character to draw the border.
24398
24399 @item ascii
24400 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
24401
24402 @item acs
24403 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
24404 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
24405 @end table
24406
24407 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
24408 @kindex set tui border-mode
24409 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
24410 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
24411 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
24412 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
24413 @table @code
24414 @item normal
24415 Use normal attributes to display the border.
24416
24417 @item standout
24418 Use standout mode.
24419
24420 @item reverse
24421 Use reverse video mode.
24422
24423 @item half
24424 Use half bright mode.
24425
24426 @item half-standout
24427 Use half bright and standout mode.
24428
24429 @item bold
24430 Use extra bright or bold mode.
24431
24432 @item bold-standout
24433 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
24434 @end table
24435 @end table
24436
24437 @node Emacs
24438 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
24439
24440 @cindex Emacs
24441 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
24442 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
24443 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
24444 @value{GDBN}.
24445
24446 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
24447 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
24448 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
24449 created Emacs buffer.
24450 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
24451
24452 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
24453 things:
24454
24455 @itemize @bullet
24456 @item
24457 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
24458 the GUD buffer.
24459
24460 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
24461 and output done by the program you are debugging.
24462
24463 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
24464 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
24465 in this way.
24466
24467 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
24468 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
24469 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
24470 stop.
24471
24472 @item
24473 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
24474
24475 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
24476 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
24477 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
24478 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
24479 and the source.
24480
24481 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
24482 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
24483 @end itemize
24484
24485 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
24486 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
24487 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
24488 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
24489
24490 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
24491 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
24492 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
24493 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
24494 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
24495 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
24496 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
24497 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
24498 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
24499
24500 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
24501 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
24502 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
24503 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24504
24505 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
24506 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
24507 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
24508 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
24509 one you want.
24510
24511 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
24512 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
24513
24514 @table @kbd
24515 @item C-h m
24516 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
24517
24518 @item C-c C-s
24519 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
24520 update the display window to show the current file and location.
24521
24522 @item C-c C-n
24523 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
24524 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
24525 to show the current file and location.
24526
24527 @item C-c C-i
24528 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
24529 display window accordingly.
24530
24531 @item C-c C-f
24532 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
24533 @code{finish} command.
24534
24535 @item C-c C-r
24536 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
24537 command.
24538
24539 @item C-c <
24540 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
24541 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
24542 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
24543
24544 @item C-c >
24545 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
24546 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
24547 @end table
24548
24549 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
24550 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
24551
24552 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
24553 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
24554 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
24555 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
24556 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
24557 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
24558 speedbar displays watch expressions.
24559
24560 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
24561 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
24562 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
24563 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
24564 frame.
24565
24566 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
24567 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
24568 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
24569 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
24570 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
24571 to correspond properly with the code.
24572
24573 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
24574 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
24575 Emacs Manual}).
24576
24577 @node GDB/MI
24578 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
24579
24580 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
24581
24582 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
24583 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
24584 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
24585 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
24586 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
24587 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
24588
24589 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
24590 in the form of a reference manual.
24591
24592 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
24593 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
24594 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
24595
24596 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
24597
24598 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
24599 This chapter uses the following notation:
24600
24601 @itemize @bullet
24602 @item
24603 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
24604
24605 @item
24606 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
24607 it may or may not be given.
24608
24609 @item
24610 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24611 may repeat zero or more times.
24612
24613 @item
24614 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
24615 may repeat one or more times.
24616
24617 @item
24618 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
24619 @end itemize
24620
24621 @ignore
24622 @heading Dependencies
24623 @end ignore
24624
24625 @menu
24626 * GDB/MI General Design::
24627 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
24628 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
24629 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
24630 * GDB/MI Output Records::
24631 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
24632 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
24633 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
24634 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
24635 * GDB/MI Program Context::
24636 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
24637 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
24638 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
24639 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
24640 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
24641 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
24642 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
24643 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
24644 * GDB/MI File Commands::
24645 @ignore
24646 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
24647 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
24648 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
24649 @end ignore
24650 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
24651 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
24652 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
24653 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
24654 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
24655 @end menu
24656
24657 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24658 @node GDB/MI General Design
24659 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
24660 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
24661
24662 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
24663 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
24664 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
24665 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
24666 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
24667 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
24668 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
24669 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
24670 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
24671 a command and reported as part of that command response.
24672
24673 The important examples of notifications are:
24674 @itemize @bullet
24675
24676 @item
24677 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
24678 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
24679 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
24680 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
24681 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
24682 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
24683 command itself was successfully executed.
24684
24685 @item
24686 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
24687 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
24688 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
24689 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
24690 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
24691 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
24692
24693 @item
24694 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
24695 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
24696 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
24697 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
24698 orthogonal frontend design.
24699
24700 @end itemize
24701
24702 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
24703 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
24704 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
24705 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
24706 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
24707 the user interface.
24708
24709
24710 @menu
24711 * Context management::
24712 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
24713 * Thread groups::
24714 @end menu
24715
24716 @node Context management
24717 @subsection Context management
24718
24719 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
24720
24721 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
24722 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
24723 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
24724 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
24725 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
24726 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
24727 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
24728 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
24729 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
24730
24731 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
24732 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
24733 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
24734 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
24735 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
24736 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
24737 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
24738 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
24739 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
24740 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
24741 for thread and frame to operate on.
24742
24743 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
24744 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
24745 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
24746 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
24747 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
24748 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
24749 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
24750 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
24751 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
24752 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
24753
24754 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
24755 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
24756 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
24757 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
24758 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
24759 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
24760 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
24761 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
24762 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
24763 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
24764 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
24765 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
24766 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
24767 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
24768 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
24769 @samp{--frame} options.
24770
24771 @subsubsection Language
24772
24773 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
24774 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
24775 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
24776 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
24777 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
24778 For instance:
24779
24780 @smallexample
24781 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
24782 ^done,value="4"
24783 (gdb)
24784 @end smallexample
24785
24786 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
24787 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
24788 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
24789
24790 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
24791 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
24792
24793 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
24794 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
24795 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
24796 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
24797 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
24798 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
24799 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
24800 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
24801 @code{-list-target-features} command.
24802
24803 @table @code
24804 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
24805 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
24806 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
24807
24808 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
24809 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
24810 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
24811
24812 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
24813 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
24814 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
24815 MI commands even while the target is running.
24816
24817 @item -gdb-show mi-async
24818 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
24819 @end table
24820
24821 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
24822 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
24823 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
24824 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
24825 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
24826 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
24827
24828 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
24829 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
24830 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
24831 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
24832 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
24833 are running.
24834
24835 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
24836 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
24837 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
24838 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
24839 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
24840 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
24841 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
24842 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
24843 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
24844 @samp{--thread} option).
24845
24846 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
24847 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
24848 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
24849 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
24850
24851 @node Thread groups
24852 @subsection Thread groups
24853 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
24854 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
24855 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
24856 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
24857 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
24858
24859 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
24860 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
24861 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
24862 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
24863 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
24864 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
24865 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
24866 into processes.
24867
24868 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
24869 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
24870 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
24871 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
24872 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
24873 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
24874 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
24875 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
24876 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
24877 the members of specific thread group.
24878
24879 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
24880 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
24881 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
24882 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
24883 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
24884 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
24885 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
24886 after attaching to that thread group.
24887
24888 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
24889 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
24890 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
24891 such thread groups.
24892
24893 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
24894 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
24895 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
24896
24897 @menu
24898 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
24899 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
24900 @end menu
24901
24902 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
24903 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
24904
24905 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
24906 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
24907 @table @code
24908 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
24909 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
24910
24911 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
24912 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
24913 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
24914
24915 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
24916 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
24917 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
24918
24919 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
24920 "any sequence of digits"
24921
24922 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
24923 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
24924
24925 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
24926 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
24927
24928 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
24929 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
24930
24931 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
24932 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
24933 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
24934
24935 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
24936 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
24937
24938 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
24939 @code{CR | CR-LF}
24940 @end table
24941
24942 @noindent
24943 Notes:
24944
24945 @itemize @bullet
24946 @item
24947 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
24948 output is described below.
24949
24950 @item
24951 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
24952 finishes.
24953
24954 @item
24955 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
24956 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
24957 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
24958 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
24959 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
24960 @end itemize
24961
24962 Pragmatics:
24963
24964 @itemize @bullet
24965 @item
24966 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
24967
24968 @item
24969 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
24970 @end itemize
24971
24972 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
24973 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
24974
24975 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
24976 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
24977 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
24978 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
24979 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
24980 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
24981
24982 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
24983 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
24984 @var{token}.
24985
24986 @table @code
24987 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
24988 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
24989
24990 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
24991 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
24992
24993 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
24994 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
24995
24996 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
24997 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
24998
24999 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
25000 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
25001
25002 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
25003 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
25004
25005 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
25006 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
25007
25008 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
25009 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
25010
25011 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
25012 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
25013
25014 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
25015 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
25016 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
25017
25018 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
25019 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
25020
25021 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
25022 @code{ @var{string} }
25023
25024 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
25025 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
25026
25027 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
25028 @code{@var{c-string}}
25029
25030 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
25031 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
25032
25033 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
25034 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
25035 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
25036
25037 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
25038 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
25039
25040 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
25041 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
25042
25043 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
25044 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
25045
25046 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
25047 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
25048
25049 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25050 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25051
25052 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25053 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
25054 @end table
25055
25056 @noindent
25057 Notes:
25058
25059 @itemize @bullet
25060 @item
25061 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
25062
25063 @item
25064 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
25065 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
25066 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
25067 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
25068 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
25069 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
25070 prior command.
25071
25072 @item
25073 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25074 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
25075 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
25076 prefixed by @samp{+}.
25077
25078 @item
25079 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25080 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
25081 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
25082 @samp{*}.
25083
25084 @item
25085 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25086 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
25087 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
25088 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25089
25090 @item
25091 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25092 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25093 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25094 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25095
25096 @item
25097 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25098 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25099 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25100
25101 @item
25102 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25103 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25104 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25105 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25106
25107 @item
25108 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25109 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25110 @var{values}.
25111
25112
25113 @end itemize
25114
25115 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25116 details about the various output records.
25117
25118 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25119 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25120 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25121
25122 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25123 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25124
25125 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25126 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25127 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25128 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25129 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25130 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25131
25132 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25133 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25134 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25135
25136 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25137 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25138 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25139 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25140
25141 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25142 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25143
25144 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
25145 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
25146 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
25147 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
25148 might change.
25149
25150 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
25151 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
25152 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
25153 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
25154
25155 @itemize @bullet
25156 @item
25157 New MI commands may be added.
25158
25159 @item
25160 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
25161
25162 @item
25163 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
25164 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
25165
25166 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
25167 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
25168
25169 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
25170 @c resolve inconsistencies.
25171 @end itemize
25172
25173 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
25174 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
25175 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
25176 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
25177 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
25178
25179 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
25180 @c version?
25181
25182 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
25183 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
25184 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
25185 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
25186 @cindex mailing lists
25187
25188 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25189 @node GDB/MI Output Records
25190 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
25191
25192 @menu
25193 * GDB/MI Result Records::
25194 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
25195 * GDB/MI Async Records::
25196 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
25197 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
25198 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
25199 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
25200 @end menu
25201
25202 @node GDB/MI Result Records
25203 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
25204
25205 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25206 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
25207 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
25208 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
25209
25210 @table @code
25211 @findex ^done
25212 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
25213 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
25214 values.
25215
25216 @item "^running"
25217 @findex ^running
25218 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
25219 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
25220 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
25221 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
25222 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
25223 which threads are resumed.
25224
25225 @item "^connected"
25226 @findex ^connected
25227 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
25228
25229 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
25230 @findex ^error
25231 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
25232 the corresponding error message.
25233
25234 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
25235 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
25236 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
25237
25238 @table @samp
25239 @item "undefined-command"
25240 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
25241 @end table
25242
25243 @item "^exit"
25244 @findex ^exit
25245 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
25246
25247 @end table
25248
25249 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
25250 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
25251
25252 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
25253 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25254 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
25255 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
25256 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
25257
25258 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
25259 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
25260 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
25261 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
25262 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
25263
25264 @table @code
25265 @item "~" @var{string-output}
25266 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
25267 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
25268
25269 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
25270 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
25271 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
25272 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
25273
25274 @item "&" @var{string-output}
25275 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
25276 internals.
25277 @end table
25278
25279 @node GDB/MI Async Records
25280 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
25281
25282 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25283 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
25284 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
25285 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
25286 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
25287 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
25288
25289 The following is the list of possible async records:
25290
25291 @table @code
25292
25293 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
25294 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
25295 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
25296 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
25297 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
25298 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
25299 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
25300 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
25301 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
25302 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
25303
25304 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
25305 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
25306 following values:
25307
25308 @table @code
25309 @item breakpoint-hit
25310 A breakpoint was reached.
25311 @item watchpoint-trigger
25312 A watchpoint was triggered.
25313 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
25314 A read watchpoint was triggered.
25315 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
25316 An access watchpoint was triggered.
25317 @item function-finished
25318 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25319 @item location-reached
25320 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25321 @item watchpoint-scope
25322 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
25323 @item end-stepping-range
25324 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
25325 similar CLI command was accomplished.
25326 @item exited-signalled
25327 The inferior exited because of a signal.
25328 @item exited
25329 The inferior exited.
25330 @item exited-normally
25331 The inferior exited normally.
25332 @item signal-received
25333 A signal was received by the inferior.
25334 @item solib-event
25335 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
25336 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
25337 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
25338 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
25339 @item fork
25340 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
25341 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25342 @item vfork
25343 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
25344 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25345 @item syscall-entry
25346 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
25347 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25348 @item syscall-entry
25349 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
25350 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25351 @item exec
25352 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
25353 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25354 @end table
25355
25356 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
25357 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
25358 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
25359 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
25360 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
25361 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
25362 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
25363 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
25364 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
25365 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
25366 if such information is not available.
25367
25368 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
25369 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
25370 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
25371 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
25372 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
25373 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
25374 cannot be used in any way.
25375
25376 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
25377 A thread group became associated with a running program,
25378 either because the program was just started or the thread group
25379 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
25380 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
25381 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
25382
25383 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
25384 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
25385 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
25386 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
25387 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
25388 only when the inferior exited with some code.
25389
25390 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25391 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25392 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
25393 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
25394 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
25395
25396 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
25397 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
25398 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
25399 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
25400 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
25401 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
25402 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
25403
25404 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
25405 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
25406 that thread.
25407
25408 @item =library-loaded,...
25409 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
25410 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
25411 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
25412 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
25413 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
25414 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
25415 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
25416 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
25417 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
25418 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
25419 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
25420 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
25421 thread groups.
25422
25423 @item =library-unloaded,...
25424 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
25425 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
25426 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
25427 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
25428 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
25429 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
25430 thread groups.
25431
25432 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
25433 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
25434 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
25435 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
25436 frame is @var{tpnum}.
25437
25438 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
25439 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
25440 initial value @var{initial}.
25441
25442 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
25443 @itemx =tsv-deleted
25444 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
25445 trace state variables are deleted.
25446
25447 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
25448 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
25449 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
25450 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
25451 value of trace state variable is known.
25452
25453 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
25454 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
25455 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
25456 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
25457 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
25458 user.
25459
25460 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
25461 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
25462 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
25463
25464 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
25465 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
25466
25467 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
25468 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
25469 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
25470 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
25471 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
25472
25473 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
25474 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
25475 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
25476 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
25477 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
25478 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
25479
25480 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
25481 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
25482 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
25483 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
25484 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
25485 executable code.
25486 @end table
25487
25488 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
25489 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
25490
25491 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
25492 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
25493 following fields:
25494
25495 @table @code
25496 @item number
25497 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
25498 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
25499 @samp{1.2}.
25500
25501 @item type
25502 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
25503 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
25504
25505 @item catch-type
25506 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
25507 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
25508
25509 @item disp
25510 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
25511 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
25512 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
25513
25514 @item enabled
25515 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
25516 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
25517 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
25518
25519 @item addr
25520 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
25521 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
25522 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
25523 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
25524 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
25525
25526 @item func
25527 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
25528 If not known, this field is not present.
25529
25530 @item filename
25531 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
25532 If not known, this field is not present.
25533
25534 @item fullname
25535 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
25536 known. If not known, this field is not present.
25537
25538 @item line
25539 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
25540 If not known, this field is not present.
25541
25542 @item at
25543 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
25544 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
25545 by a symbol name.
25546
25547 @item pending
25548 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
25549 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
25550
25551 @item evaluated-by
25552 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
25553 @samp{target}.
25554
25555 @item thread
25556 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
25557 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
25558
25559 @item task
25560 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
25561 field will hold the task identifier.
25562
25563 @item cond
25564 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
25565
25566 @item ignore
25567 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
25568
25569 @item enable
25570 The enable count of the breakpoint.
25571
25572 @item traceframe-usage
25573 FIXME.
25574
25575 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
25576 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
25577
25578 @item mask
25579 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
25580
25581 @item pass
25582 A tracepoint's pass count.
25583
25584 @item original-location
25585 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
25586 This field is optional.
25587
25588 @item times
25589 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
25590
25591 @item installed
25592 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
25593 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
25594 is not.
25595
25596 @item what
25597 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
25598
25599 @end table
25600
25601 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
25602 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
25603
25604 @smallexample
25605 -> -break-insert main
25606 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25607 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
25608 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
25609 times="0"@}
25610 <- (gdb)
25611 @end smallexample
25612
25613 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
25614 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
25615
25616 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
25617 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
25618 fields:
25619
25620 @table @code
25621 @item level
25622 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
25623 zero. This field is always present.
25624
25625 @item func
25626 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
25627 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
25628
25629 @item addr
25630 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
25631
25632 @item file
25633 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
25634 address. This field may be absent.
25635
25636 @item line
25637 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
25638 may be absent.
25639
25640 @item from
25641 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
25642 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
25643
25644 @end table
25645
25646 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
25647 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
25648
25649 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
25650 uses a tuple with the following fields:
25651
25652 @table @code
25653 @item id
25654 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
25655 always present.
25656
25657 @item target-id
25658 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
25659
25660 @item details
25661 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
25662 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
25663 frontend. This field is optional.
25664
25665 @item state
25666 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
25667 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
25668
25669 @item core
25670 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
25671 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
25672 @end table
25673
25674 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
25675 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
25676
25677 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
25678 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
25679 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
25680 the @code{exception-name} field.
25681
25682 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25683 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
25684 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
25685 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
25686
25687 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
25688 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
25689 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
25690 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
25691
25692 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
25693 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
25694
25695 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
25696
25697 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
25698 information of the breakpoint.
25699
25700 @smallexample
25701 -> -break-insert main
25702 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25703 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
25704 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
25705 times="0"@}
25706 <- (gdb)
25707 @end smallexample
25708
25709 @subheading Program Execution
25710
25711 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
25712 reason that execution stopped.
25713
25714 @smallexample
25715 -> -exec-run
25716 <- ^running
25717 <- (gdb)
25718 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
25719 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
25720 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
25721 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
25722 <- (gdb)
25723 -> -exec-continue
25724 <- ^running
25725 <- (gdb)
25726 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
25727 <- (gdb)
25728 @end smallexample
25729
25730 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
25731
25732 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
25733
25734 @smallexample
25735 -> (gdb)
25736 <- -gdb-exit
25737 <- ^exit
25738 @end smallexample
25739
25740 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
25741 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
25742 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
25743 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
25744 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
25745 fails to exit in reasonable time.
25746
25747 @subheading A Bad Command
25748
25749 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
25750
25751 @smallexample
25752 -> -rubbish
25753 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
25754 <- (gdb)
25755 @end smallexample
25756
25757
25758 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25759 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
25760 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
25761
25762 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
25763 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
25764
25765 @subheading Motivation
25766
25767 The motivation for this collection of commands.
25768
25769 @subheading Introduction
25770
25771 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
25772
25773 @subheading Commands
25774
25775 For each command in the block, the following is described:
25776
25777 @subsubheading Synopsis
25778
25779 @smallexample
25780 -command @var{args}@dots{}
25781 @end smallexample
25782
25783 @subsubheading Result
25784
25785 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25786
25787 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
25788
25789 @subsubheading Example
25790
25791 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
25792 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
25793
25794
25795 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25796 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
25797 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
25798
25799 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
25800 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
25801 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
25802 breakpoints.
25803
25804 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
25805 @findex -break-after
25806
25807 @subsubheading Synopsis
25808
25809 @smallexample
25810 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
25811 @end smallexample
25812
25813 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
25814 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
25815 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
25816 @samp{-break-list} command below.
25817
25818 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25819
25820 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
25821
25822 @subsubheading Example
25823
25824 @smallexample
25825 (gdb)
25826 -break-insert main
25827 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25828 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25829 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
25830 times="0"@}
25831 (gdb)
25832 -break-after 1 3
25833 ~
25834 ^done
25835 (gdb)
25836 -break-list
25837 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25838 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25839 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25840 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25841 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25842 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25843 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25844 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25845 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25846 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25847 (gdb)
25848 @end smallexample
25849
25850 @ignore
25851 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
25852 @findex -break-catch
25853 @end ignore
25854
25855 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
25856 @findex -break-commands
25857
25858 @subsubheading Synopsis
25859
25860 @smallexample
25861 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
25862 @end smallexample
25863
25864 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
25865 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
25866 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
25867 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
25868 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
25869 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
25870
25871 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25872
25873 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
25874
25875 @subsubheading Example
25876
25877 @smallexample
25878 (gdb)
25879 -break-insert main
25880 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
25881 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
25882 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
25883 times="0"@}
25884 (gdb)
25885 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
25886 ^done
25887 (gdb)
25888 @end smallexample
25889
25890 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
25891 @findex -break-condition
25892
25893 @subsubheading Synopsis
25894
25895 @smallexample
25896 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
25897 @end smallexample
25898
25899 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
25900 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
25901 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
25902 command below).
25903
25904 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25905
25906 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
25907
25908 @subsubheading Example
25909
25910 @smallexample
25911 (gdb)
25912 -break-condition 1 1
25913 ^done
25914 (gdb)
25915 -break-list
25916 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25917 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25918 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25919 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25920 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25921 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25922 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25923 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
25924 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25925 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
25926 (gdb)
25927 @end smallexample
25928
25929 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
25930 @findex -break-delete
25931
25932 @subsubheading Synopsis
25933
25934 @smallexample
25935 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25936 @end smallexample
25937
25938 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
25939 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
25940
25941 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25942
25943 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
25944
25945 @subsubheading Example
25946
25947 @smallexample
25948 (gdb)
25949 -break-delete 1
25950 ^done
25951 (gdb)
25952 -break-list
25953 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
25954 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25955 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25956 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25957 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25958 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25959 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25960 body=[]@}
25961 (gdb)
25962 @end smallexample
25963
25964 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
25965 @findex -break-disable
25966
25967 @subsubheading Synopsis
25968
25969 @smallexample
25970 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
25971 @end smallexample
25972
25973 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
25974 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
25975
25976 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
25977
25978 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
25979
25980 @subsubheading Example
25981
25982 @smallexample
25983 (gdb)
25984 -break-disable 2
25985 ^done
25986 (gdb)
25987 -break-list
25988 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
25989 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
25990 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
25991 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
25992 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
25993 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
25994 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
25995 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
25996 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
25997 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
25998 (gdb)
25999 @end smallexample
26000
26001 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
26002 @findex -break-enable
26003
26004 @subsubheading Synopsis
26005
26006 @smallexample
26007 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26008 @end smallexample
26009
26010 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
26011
26012 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26013
26014 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
26015
26016 @subsubheading Example
26017
26018 @smallexample
26019 (gdb)
26020 -break-enable 2
26021 ^done
26022 (gdb)
26023 -break-list
26024 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26025 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26026 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26027 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26028 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26029 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26030 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26031 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26032 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26033 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26034 (gdb)
26035 @end smallexample
26036
26037 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
26038 @findex -break-info
26039
26040 @subsubheading Synopsis
26041
26042 @smallexample
26043 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
26044 @end smallexample
26045
26046 @c REDUNDANT???
26047 Get information about a single breakpoint.
26048
26049 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
26050 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
26051 table.
26052
26053 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26054
26055 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
26056
26057 @subsubheading Example
26058 N.A.
26059
26060 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
26061 @findex -break-insert
26062
26063 @subsubheading Synopsis
26064
26065 @smallexample
26066 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
26067 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26068 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
26069 @end smallexample
26070
26071 @noindent
26072 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26073
26074 @itemize @bullet
26075 @item function
26076 @c @item +offset
26077 @c @item -offset
26078 @c @item linenum
26079 @item filename:linenum
26080 @item filename:function
26081 @item *address
26082 @end itemize
26083
26084 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26085
26086 @table @samp
26087 @item -t
26088 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26089 @item -h
26090 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26091 @item -f
26092 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26093 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26094 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26095 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26096 cannot be parsed.
26097 @item -d
26098 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26099 @item -a
26100 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26101 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26102 @item -c @var{condition}
26103 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26104 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26105 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26106 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26107 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26108 @end table
26109
26110 @subsubheading Result
26111
26112 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26113 resulting breakpoint.
26114
26115 Note: this format is open to change.
26116 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26117
26118 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26119
26120 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26121 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
26122
26123 @subsubheading Example
26124
26125 @smallexample
26126 (gdb)
26127 -break-insert main
26128 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26129 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26130 times="0"@}
26131 (gdb)
26132 -break-insert -t foo
26133 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26134 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26135 times="0"@}
26136 (gdb)
26137 -break-list
26138 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26139 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26140 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26141 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26142 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26143 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26144 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26145 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26146 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
26147 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26148 times="0"@},
26149 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26150 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
26151 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26152 times="0"@}]@}
26153 (gdb)
26154 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
26155 @c ~int foo(int, int);
26156 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
26157 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26158 @c times="0"@}
26159 @c (gdb)
26160 @end smallexample
26161
26162 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
26163 @findex -dprintf-insert
26164
26165 @subsubheading Synopsis
26166
26167 @smallexample
26168 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
26169 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26170 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
26171 [ @var{argument} ]
26172 @end smallexample
26173
26174 @noindent
26175 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26176
26177 @itemize @bullet
26178 @item @var{function}
26179 @c @item +offset
26180 @c @item -offset
26181 @c @item @var{linenum}
26182 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
26183 @item @var{filename}:function
26184 @item *@var{address}
26185 @end itemize
26186
26187 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26188
26189 @table @samp
26190 @item -t
26191 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26192 @item -f
26193 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
26194 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26195 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26196 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26197 cannot be parsed.
26198 @item -d
26199 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26200 @item -c @var{condition}
26201 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26202 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26203 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
26204 to @var{ignore-count}.
26205 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26206 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26207 @end table
26208
26209 @subsubheading Result
26210
26211 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26212 resulting breakpoint.
26213
26214 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26215
26216 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26217
26218 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
26219
26220 @subsubheading Example
26221
26222 @smallexample
26223 (gdb)
26224 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
26225 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26226 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26227 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
26228 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
26229 original-location="foo"@}
26230 (gdb)
26231 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
26232 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26233 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26234 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
26235 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
26236 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
26237 (gdb)
26238 @end smallexample
26239
26240 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
26241 @findex -break-list
26242
26243 @subsubheading Synopsis
26244
26245 @smallexample
26246 -break-list
26247 @end smallexample
26248
26249 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
26250
26251 @table @samp
26252 @item Number
26253 number of the breakpoint
26254 @item Type
26255 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
26256 @item Disposition
26257 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
26258 or @samp{nokeep}
26259 @item Enabled
26260 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
26261 @item Address
26262 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
26263 @item What
26264 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
26265 name, line number
26266 @item Thread-groups
26267 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
26268 @item Times
26269 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
26270 @end table
26271
26272 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
26273 @code{body} field is an empty list.
26274
26275 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26276
26277 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
26278
26279 @subsubheading Example
26280
26281 @smallexample
26282 (gdb)
26283 -break-list
26284 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26285 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26286 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26287 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26288 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26289 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26290 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26291 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26292 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26293 times="0"@},
26294 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26295 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26296 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26297 (gdb)
26298 @end smallexample
26299
26300 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
26301
26302 @smallexample
26303 (gdb)
26304 -break-list
26305 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26306 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26307 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26308 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26309 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26310 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26311 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26312 body=[]@}
26313 (gdb)
26314 @end smallexample
26315
26316 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
26317 @findex -break-passcount
26318
26319 @subsubheading Synopsis
26320
26321 @smallexample
26322 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
26323 @end smallexample
26324
26325 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
26326 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
26327 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
26328 command @samp{passcount}.
26329
26330 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
26331 @findex -break-watch
26332
26333 @subsubheading Synopsis
26334
26335 @smallexample
26336 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
26337 @end smallexample
26338
26339 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
26340 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
26341 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
26342 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
26343 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
26344 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
26345 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
26346 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
26347
26348 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
26349 breakpoints inserted.
26350
26351 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26352
26353 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
26354 @samp{rwatch}.
26355
26356 @subsubheading Example
26357
26358 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
26359
26360 @smallexample
26361 (gdb)
26362 -break-watch x
26363 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
26364 (gdb)
26365 -exec-continue
26366 ^running
26367 (gdb)
26368 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
26369 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
26370 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26371 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
26372 (gdb)
26373 @end smallexample
26374
26375 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
26376 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
26377 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
26378
26379 @smallexample
26380 (gdb)
26381 -break-watch C
26382 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
26383 (gdb)
26384 -exec-continue
26385 ^running
26386 (gdb)
26387 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
26388 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26389 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26390 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26391 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26392 (gdb)
26393 -exec-continue
26394 ^running
26395 (gdb)
26396 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
26397 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26398 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26399 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26400 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26401 (gdb)
26402 @end smallexample
26403
26404 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
26405 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
26406 deleted.
26407
26408 @smallexample
26409 (gdb)
26410 -break-watch C
26411 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
26412 (gdb)
26413 -break-list
26414 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26415 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26416 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26417 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26418 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26419 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26420 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26421 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26422 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26423 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26424 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26425 times="1"@},
26426 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26427 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26428 (gdb)
26429 -exec-continue
26430 ^running
26431 (gdb)
26432 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
26433 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26434 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26435 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26436 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26437 (gdb)
26438 -break-list
26439 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26440 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26441 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26442 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26443 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26444 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26445 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26446 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26447 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26448 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26449 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
26450 times="1"@},
26451 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26452 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
26453 (gdb)
26454 -exec-continue
26455 ^running
26456 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
26457 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26458 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26459 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26460 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26461 (gdb)
26462 -break-list
26463 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26464 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26465 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26466 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26467 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26468 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26469 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26470 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26471 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26472 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26473 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
26474 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
26475 (gdb)
26476 @end smallexample
26477
26478
26479 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26480 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26481 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
26482
26483 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26484 catchpoints.
26485
26486 @menu
26487 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26488 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26489 @end menu
26490
26491 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26492 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26493
26494 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
26495 @findex -catch-load
26496
26497 @subsubheading Synopsis
26498
26499 @smallexample
26500 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26501 @end smallexample
26502
26503 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
26504 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26505 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
26506 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26507 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
26508
26509
26510 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26511
26512 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
26513
26514 @subsubheading Example
26515
26516 @smallexample
26517 -catch-load -t foo.so
26518 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26519 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
26520 (gdb)
26521 @end smallexample
26522
26523
26524 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
26525 @findex -catch-unload
26526
26527 @subsubheading Synopsis
26528
26529 @smallexample
26530 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
26531 @end smallexample
26532
26533 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
26534 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
26535 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
26536 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
26537 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
26538
26539 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26540
26541 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
26542
26543 @subsubheading Example
26544
26545 @smallexample
26546 -catch-unload -d bar.so
26547 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26548 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
26549 (gdb)
26550 @end smallexample
26551
26552 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
26553 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
26554
26555 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
26556 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
26557
26558 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
26559 @findex -catch-assert
26560
26561 @subsubheading Synopsis
26562
26563 @smallexample
26564 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
26565 @end smallexample
26566
26567 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
26568
26569 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
26570
26571 @table @samp
26572 @item -c @var{condition}
26573 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26574 @item -d
26575 Create a disabled catchpoint.
26576 @item -t
26577 Create a temporary catchpoint.
26578 @end table
26579
26580 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26581
26582 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
26583
26584 @subsubheading Example
26585
26586 @smallexample
26587 -catch-assert
26588 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26589 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
26590 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
26591 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
26592 (gdb)
26593 @end smallexample
26594
26595 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
26596 @findex -catch-exception
26597
26598 @subsubheading Synopsis
26599
26600 @smallexample
26601 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
26602 [ -t ] [ -u ]
26603 @end smallexample
26604
26605 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
26606 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
26607 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
26608 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
26609 catchpoints.
26610
26611 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
26612
26613 @table @samp
26614 @item -c @var{condition}
26615 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26616 @item -d
26617 Create a disabled catchpoint.
26618 @item -e @var{exception-name}
26619 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
26620 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
26621 @item -t
26622 Create a temporary catchpoint.
26623 @item -u
26624 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
26625 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
26626 @end table
26627
26628 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26629
26630 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
26631 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
26632
26633 @subsubheading Example
26634
26635 @smallexample
26636 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
26637 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26638 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
26639 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
26640 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
26641 (gdb)
26642 @end smallexample
26643
26644 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26645 @node GDB/MI Program Context
26646 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
26647
26648 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
26649 @findex -exec-arguments
26650
26651
26652 @subsubheading Synopsis
26653
26654 @smallexample
26655 -exec-arguments @var{args}
26656 @end smallexample
26657
26658 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
26659 @samp{-exec-run}.
26660
26661 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26662
26663 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
26664
26665 @subsubheading Example
26666
26667 @smallexample
26668 (gdb)
26669 -exec-arguments -v word
26670 ^done
26671 (gdb)
26672 @end smallexample
26673
26674
26675 @ignore
26676 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
26677 @findex -exec-show-arguments
26678
26679 @subsubheading Synopsis
26680
26681 @smallexample
26682 -exec-show-arguments
26683 @end smallexample
26684
26685 Print the arguments of the program.
26686
26687 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26688
26689 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
26690
26691 @subsubheading Example
26692 N.A.
26693 @end ignore
26694
26695
26696 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
26697 @findex -environment-cd
26698
26699 @subsubheading Synopsis
26700
26701 @smallexample
26702 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
26703 @end smallexample
26704
26705 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
26706
26707 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26708
26709 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
26710
26711 @subsubheading Example
26712
26713 @smallexample
26714 (gdb)
26715 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
26716 ^done
26717 (gdb)
26718 @end smallexample
26719
26720
26721 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
26722 @findex -environment-directory
26723
26724 @subsubheading Synopsis
26725
26726 @smallexample
26727 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
26728 @end smallexample
26729
26730 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
26731 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
26732 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
26733 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
26734 occurs as normal.
26735 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
26736 multiple directories in a single command
26737 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
26738 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
26739 If blanks are needed as
26740 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
26741 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
26742 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
26743 character must not be used
26744 in any directory name.
26745 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
26746
26747 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26748
26749 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
26750
26751 @subsubheading Example
26752
26753 @smallexample
26754 (gdb)
26755 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
26756 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
26757 (gdb)
26758 -environment-directory ""
26759 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
26760 (gdb)
26761 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
26762 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
26763 (gdb)
26764 -environment-directory -r
26765 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
26766 (gdb)
26767 @end smallexample
26768
26769
26770 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
26771 @findex -environment-path
26772
26773 @subsubheading Synopsis
26774
26775 @smallexample
26776 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
26777 @end smallexample
26778
26779 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
26780 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
26781 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
26782 supplied in addition to the
26783 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
26784 occurs as normal.
26785 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
26786 multiple directories in a single command
26787 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
26788 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
26789 If blanks are needed as
26790 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
26791 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
26792 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
26793 character must not be used
26794 in any directory name.
26795 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
26796
26797
26798 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26799
26800 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
26801
26802 @subsubheading Example
26803
26804 @smallexample
26805 (gdb)
26806 -environment-path
26807 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
26808 (gdb)
26809 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
26810 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
26811 (gdb)
26812 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
26813 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
26814 (gdb)
26815 @end smallexample
26816
26817
26818 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
26819 @findex -environment-pwd
26820
26821 @subsubheading Synopsis
26822
26823 @smallexample
26824 -environment-pwd
26825 @end smallexample
26826
26827 Show the current working directory.
26828
26829 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26830
26831 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
26832
26833 @subsubheading Example
26834
26835 @smallexample
26836 (gdb)
26837 -environment-pwd
26838 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
26839 (gdb)
26840 @end smallexample
26841
26842 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26843 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
26844 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
26845
26846
26847 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
26848 @findex -thread-info
26849
26850 @subsubheading Synopsis
26851
26852 @smallexample
26853 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
26854 @end smallexample
26855
26856 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
26857 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
26858 threads. When printing information about all threads,
26859 also reports the current thread.
26860
26861 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26862
26863 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
26864 about all threads.
26865
26866 @subsubheading Result
26867
26868 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
26869 defined for a given thread:
26870
26871 @table @samp
26872 @item current
26873 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
26874
26875 @item id
26876 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
26877
26878 @item target-id
26879 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
26880
26881 @item details
26882 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
26883 field is optional.
26884
26885 @item name
26886 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
26887 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
26888 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
26889 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
26890 field is omitted.
26891
26892 @item frame
26893 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
26894
26895 @item state
26896 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
26897 values:
26898
26899 @table @code
26900 @item stopped
26901 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
26902 threads.
26903
26904 @item running
26905 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
26906 threads.
26907
26908 @end table
26909
26910 @item core
26911 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
26912 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
26913
26914 @end table
26915
26916 @subsubheading Example
26917
26918 @smallexample
26919 -thread-info
26920 ^done,threads=[
26921 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
26922 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
26923 args=[]@},state="running"@},
26924 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
26925 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
26926 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
26927 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
26928 state="running"@}],
26929 current-thread-id="1"
26930 (gdb)
26931 @end smallexample
26932
26933 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
26934 @findex -thread-list-ids
26935
26936 @subsubheading Synopsis
26937
26938 @smallexample
26939 -thread-list-ids
26940 @end smallexample
26941
26942 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
26943 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
26944
26945 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
26946 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
26947
26948 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26949
26950 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
26951
26952 @subsubheading Example
26953
26954 @smallexample
26955 (gdb)
26956 -thread-list-ids
26957 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
26958 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
26959 (gdb)
26960 @end smallexample
26961
26962
26963 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
26964 @findex -thread-select
26965
26966 @subsubheading Synopsis
26967
26968 @smallexample
26969 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
26970 @end smallexample
26971
26972 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
26973 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
26974
26975 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
26976 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
26977
26978 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26979
26980 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
26981
26982 @subsubheading Example
26983
26984 @smallexample
26985 (gdb)
26986 -exec-next
26987 ^running
26988 (gdb)
26989 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
26990 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
26991 (gdb)
26992 -thread-list-ids
26993 ^done,
26994 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
26995 number-of-threads="3"
26996 (gdb)
26997 -thread-select 3
26998 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
26999 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
27000 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
27001 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
27002 (gdb)
27003 @end smallexample
27004
27005 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27006 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
27007 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
27008
27009 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
27010 @findex -ada-task-info
27011
27012 @subsubheading Synopsis
27013
27014 @smallexample
27015 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
27016 @end smallexample
27017
27018 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
27019 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
27020
27021 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27022
27023 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
27024 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
27025
27026 @subsubheading Result
27027
27028 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
27029 defined for each Ada task:
27030
27031 @table @samp
27032 @item current
27033 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27034
27035 @item id
27036 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
27037
27038 @item task-id
27039 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
27040
27041 @item thread-id
27042 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
27043
27044 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
27045 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
27046 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
27047
27048 @item parent-id
27049 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
27050 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
27051
27052 @item priority
27053 The base priority of the task.
27054
27055 @item state
27056 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
27057 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
27058
27059 @item name
27060 The name of the task.
27061
27062 @end table
27063
27064 @subsubheading Example
27065
27066 @smallexample
27067 -ada-task-info
27068 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
27069 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
27070 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
27071 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
27072 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
27073 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
27074 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
27075 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
27076 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
27077 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
27078 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
27079 (gdb)
27080 @end smallexample
27081
27082 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27083 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
27084 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
27085
27086 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
27087 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
27088 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27089 other cases.
27090
27091 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27092 @findex -exec-continue
27093
27094 @subsubheading Synopsis
27095
27096 @smallexample
27097 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27098 @end smallexample
27099
27100 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27101 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27102 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27103 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27104 @itemize @bullet
27105 @item
27106 breakpoints or watchpoints
27107 @item
27108 signals or exceptions
27109 @item
27110 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27111 @item
27112 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27113 @end itemize
27114 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27115 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27116 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27117 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27118 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27119 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27120
27121 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27122
27123 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27124
27125 @subsubheading Example
27126
27127 @smallexample
27128 -exec-continue
27129 ^running
27130 (gdb)
27131 @@Hello world
27132 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27133 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27134 line="13"@}
27135 (gdb)
27136 @end smallexample
27137
27138
27139 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27140 @findex -exec-finish
27141
27142 @subsubheading Synopsis
27143
27144 @smallexample
27145 -exec-finish [--reverse]
27146 @end smallexample
27147
27148 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
27149 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
27150 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
27151 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
27152 function was called.
27153
27154 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27155
27156 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
27157
27158 @subsubheading Example
27159
27160 Function returning @code{void}.
27161
27162 @smallexample
27163 -exec-finish
27164 ^running
27165 (gdb)
27166 @@hello from foo
27167 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27168 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
27169 (gdb)
27170 @end smallexample
27171
27172 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
27173 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
27174 value itself.
27175
27176 @smallexample
27177 -exec-finish
27178 ^running
27179 (gdb)
27180 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
27181 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
27182 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27183 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
27184 (gdb)
27185 @end smallexample
27186
27187
27188 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
27189 @findex -exec-interrupt
27190
27191 @subsubheading Synopsis
27192
27193 @smallexample
27194 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
27195 @end smallexample
27196
27197 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
27198 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
27199 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
27200 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
27201 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
27202
27203 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
27204 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
27205 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
27206 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
27207
27208 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
27209 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
27210 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
27211 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
27212
27213 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27214
27215 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
27216
27217 @subsubheading Example
27218
27219 @smallexample
27220 (gdb)
27221 111-exec-continue
27222 111^running
27223
27224 (gdb)
27225 222-exec-interrupt
27226 222^done
27227 (gdb)
27228 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
27229 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27230 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
27231 (gdb)
27232
27233 (gdb)
27234 -exec-interrupt
27235 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
27236 (gdb)
27237 @end smallexample
27238
27239 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
27240 @findex -exec-jump
27241
27242 @subsubheading Synopsis
27243
27244 @smallexample
27245 -exec-jump @var{location}
27246 @end smallexample
27247
27248 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
27249 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
27250 different forms of @var{location}.
27251
27252 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27253
27254 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
27255
27256 @subsubheading Example
27257
27258 @smallexample
27259 -exec-jump foo.c:10
27260 *running,thread-id="all"
27261 ^running
27262 @end smallexample
27263
27264
27265 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
27266 @findex -exec-next
27267
27268 @subsubheading Synopsis
27269
27270 @smallexample
27271 -exec-next [--reverse]
27272 @end smallexample
27273
27274 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27275 of the next source line is reached.
27276
27277 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27278 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
27279 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
27280 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
27281 source line where the function was called.
27282
27283
27284 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27285
27286 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
27287
27288 @subsubheading Example
27289
27290 @smallexample
27291 -exec-next
27292 ^running
27293 (gdb)
27294 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
27295 (gdb)
27296 @end smallexample
27297
27298
27299 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
27300 @findex -exec-next-instruction
27301
27302 @subsubheading Synopsis
27303
27304 @smallexample
27305 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
27306 @end smallexample
27307
27308 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
27309 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
27310 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
27311 printed as well.
27312
27313 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27314 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
27315 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
27316 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
27317 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
27318
27319 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27320
27321 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
27322
27323 @subsubheading Example
27324
27325 @smallexample
27326 (gdb)
27327 -exec-next-instruction
27328 ^running
27329
27330 (gdb)
27331 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27332 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
27333 (gdb)
27334 @end smallexample
27335
27336
27337 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
27338 @findex -exec-return
27339
27340 @subsubheading Synopsis
27341
27342 @smallexample
27343 -exec-return
27344 @end smallexample
27345
27346 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
27347 Displays the new current frame.
27348
27349 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27350
27351 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
27352
27353 @subsubheading Example
27354
27355 @smallexample
27356 (gdb)
27357 200-break-insert callee4
27358 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
27359 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27360 (gdb)
27361 000-exec-run
27362 000^running
27363 (gdb)
27364 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27365 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27366 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27367 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27368 (gdb)
27369 205-break-delete
27370 205^done
27371 (gdb)
27372 111-exec-return
27373 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
27374 args=[@{name="strarg",
27375 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27376 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27377 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27378 (gdb)
27379 @end smallexample
27380
27381
27382 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
27383 @findex -exec-run
27384
27385 @subsubheading Synopsis
27386
27387 @smallexample
27388 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
27389 @end smallexample
27390
27391 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
27392 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
27393 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
27394 the program has exited exceptionally.
27395
27396 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
27397 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
27398 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
27399 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
27400 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
27401
27402 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
27403 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
27404 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
27405 (@pxref{Starting}).
27406
27407 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27408
27409 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
27410
27411 @subsubheading Examples
27412
27413 @smallexample
27414 (gdb)
27415 -break-insert main
27416 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27417 (gdb)
27418 -exec-run
27419 ^running
27420 (gdb)
27421 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27422 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27423 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27424 (gdb)
27425 @end smallexample
27426
27427 @noindent
27428 Program exited normally:
27429
27430 @smallexample
27431 (gdb)
27432 -exec-run
27433 ^running
27434 (gdb)
27435 x = 55
27436 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27437 (gdb)
27438 @end smallexample
27439
27440 @noindent
27441 Program exited exceptionally:
27442
27443 @smallexample
27444 (gdb)
27445 -exec-run
27446 ^running
27447 (gdb)
27448 x = 55
27449 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
27450 (gdb)
27451 @end smallexample
27452
27453 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
27454 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
27455
27456 @smallexample
27457 (gdb)
27458 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
27459 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
27460 @end smallexample
27461
27462
27463 @c @subheading -exec-signal
27464
27465
27466 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
27467 @findex -exec-step
27468
27469 @subsubheading Synopsis
27470
27471 @smallexample
27472 -exec-step [--reverse]
27473 @end smallexample
27474
27475 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27476 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
27477 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
27478 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
27479 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
27480 previously executed source line.
27481
27482 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27483
27484 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
27485
27486 @subsubheading Example
27487
27488 Stepping into a function:
27489
27490 @smallexample
27491 -exec-step
27492 ^running
27493 (gdb)
27494 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27495 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
27496 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
27497 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
27498 (gdb)
27499 @end smallexample
27500
27501 Regular stepping:
27502
27503 @smallexample
27504 -exec-step
27505 ^running
27506 (gdb)
27507 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
27508 (gdb)
27509 @end smallexample
27510
27511
27512 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
27513 @findex -exec-step-instruction
27514
27515 @subsubheading Synopsis
27516
27517 @smallexample
27518 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
27519 @end smallexample
27520
27521 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
27522 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
27523 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
27524 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
27525 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
27526 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
27527 as well.
27528
27529 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27530
27531 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
27532
27533 @subsubheading Example
27534
27535 @smallexample
27536 (gdb)
27537 -exec-step-instruction
27538 ^running
27539
27540 (gdb)
27541 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27542 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27543 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27544 (gdb)
27545 -exec-step-instruction
27546 ^running
27547
27548 (gdb)
27549 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27550 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27551 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27552 (gdb)
27553 @end smallexample
27554
27555
27556 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
27557 @findex -exec-until
27558
27559 @subsubheading Synopsis
27560
27561 @smallexample
27562 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
27563 @end smallexample
27564
27565 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
27566 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
27567 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
27568 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
27569
27570 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27571
27572 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
27573
27574 @subsubheading Example
27575
27576 @smallexample
27577 (gdb)
27578 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
27579 ^running
27580 (gdb)
27581 x = 55
27582 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27583 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
27584 (gdb)
27585 @end smallexample
27586
27587 @ignore
27588 @subheading -file-clear
27589 Is this going away????
27590 @end ignore
27591
27592 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27593 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
27594 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
27595
27596 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
27597 @findex -enable-frame-filters
27598
27599 @smallexample
27600 -enable-frame-filters
27601 @end smallexample
27602
27603 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
27604 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
27605 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
27606 request that this functionality be enabled.
27607
27608 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
27609
27610 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
27611 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
27612
27613 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
27614 @findex -stack-info-frame
27615
27616 @subsubheading Synopsis
27617
27618 @smallexample
27619 -stack-info-frame
27620 @end smallexample
27621
27622 Get info on the selected frame.
27623
27624 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27625
27626 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
27627 (without arguments).
27628
27629 @subsubheading Example
27630
27631 @smallexample
27632 (gdb)
27633 -stack-info-frame
27634 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
27635 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27636 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
27637 (gdb)
27638 @end smallexample
27639
27640 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
27641 @findex -stack-info-depth
27642
27643 @subsubheading Synopsis
27644
27645 @smallexample
27646 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
27647 @end smallexample
27648
27649 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
27650 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
27651
27652 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27653
27654 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
27655
27656 @subsubheading Example
27657
27658 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
27659
27660 @smallexample
27661 (gdb)
27662 -stack-info-depth
27663 ^done,depth="12"
27664 (gdb)
27665 -stack-info-depth 4
27666 ^done,depth="4"
27667 (gdb)
27668 -stack-info-depth 12
27669 ^done,depth="12"
27670 (gdb)
27671 -stack-info-depth 11
27672 ^done,depth="11"
27673 (gdb)
27674 -stack-info-depth 13
27675 ^done,depth="12"
27676 (gdb)
27677 @end smallexample
27678
27679 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
27680 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
27681 @findex -stack-list-arguments
27682
27683 @subsubheading Synopsis
27684
27685 @smallexample
27686 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27687 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
27688 @end smallexample
27689
27690 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
27691 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
27692 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
27693 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
27694 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
27695 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
27696 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
27697 which case only existing frames will be returned.
27698
27699 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27700 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27701 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27702 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27703 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
27704 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
27705
27706 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
27707 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
27708 are still displayed, however.
27709
27710 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
27711 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
27712
27713 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27714
27715 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
27716 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
27717 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
27718
27719 @subsubheading Example
27720
27721 @smallexample
27722 (gdb)
27723 -stack-list-frames
27724 ^done,
27725 stack=[
27726 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27727 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27728 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
27729 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
27730 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27731 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
27732 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
27733 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27734 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
27735 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
27736 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27737 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
27738 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
27739 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27740 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
27741 (gdb)
27742 -stack-list-arguments 0
27743 ^done,
27744 stack-args=[
27745 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
27746 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
27747 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
27748 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
27749 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
27750 (gdb)
27751 -stack-list-arguments 1
27752 ^done,
27753 stack-args=[
27754 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
27755 frame=@{level="1",
27756 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
27757 frame=@{level="2",args=[
27758 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27759 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
27760 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
27761 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27762 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
27763 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
27764 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
27765 (gdb)
27766 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
27767 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
27768 (gdb)
27769 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
27770 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
27771 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
27772 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
27773 (gdb)
27774 @end smallexample
27775
27776 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
27777
27778
27779 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
27780 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
27781 @findex -stack-list-frames
27782
27783 @subsubheading Synopsis
27784
27785 @smallexample
27786 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
27787 @end smallexample
27788
27789 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
27790 following info:
27791
27792 @table @samp
27793 @item @var{level}
27794 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
27795 @item @var{addr}
27796 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
27797 @item @var{func}
27798 Function name.
27799 @item @var{file}
27800 File name of the source file where the function lives.
27801 @item @var{fullname}
27802 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
27803 @item @var{line}
27804 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
27805 @item @var{from}
27806 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
27807 if the frame's function is not known.
27808 @end table
27809
27810 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
27811 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
27812 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
27813 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
27814 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
27815 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
27816 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
27817 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
27818 Python frame filters will not be executed.
27819
27820 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27821
27822 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
27823
27824 @subsubheading Example
27825
27826 Full stack backtrace:
27827
27828 @smallexample
27829 (gdb)
27830 -stack-list-frames
27831 ^done,stack=
27832 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
27833 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
27834 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27835 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27836 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27837 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27838 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27839 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27840 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27841 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27842 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27843 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27844 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27845 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27846 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27847 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27848 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27849 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27850 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27851 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27852 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27853 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27854 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
27855 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
27856 (gdb)
27857 @end smallexample
27858
27859 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
27860
27861 @smallexample
27862 (gdb)
27863 -stack-list-frames 3 5
27864 ^done,stack=
27865 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27866 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27867 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27868 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27869 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27870 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
27871 (gdb)
27872 @end smallexample
27873
27874 Show a single frame:
27875
27876 @smallexample
27877 (gdb)
27878 -stack-list-frames 3 3
27879 ^done,stack=
27880 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
27881 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
27882 (gdb)
27883 @end smallexample
27884
27885
27886 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
27887 @findex -stack-list-locals
27888 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
27889
27890 @subsubheading Synopsis
27891
27892 @smallexample
27893 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27894 @end smallexample
27895
27896 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
27897 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27898 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27899 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27900 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27901 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
27902 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
27903 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
27904 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
27905 Python frame filters will not be executed.
27906
27907 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
27908 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
27909 variables are still displayed, however.
27910
27911 This command is deprecated in favor of the
27912 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
27913
27914 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27915
27916 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
27917
27918 @subsubheading Example
27919
27920 @smallexample
27921 (gdb)
27922 -stack-list-locals 0
27923 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
27924 (gdb)
27925 -stack-list-locals --all-values
27926 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
27927 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
27928 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
27929 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
27930 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
27931 (gdb)
27932 @end smallexample
27933
27934 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
27935 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
27936 @findex -stack-list-variables
27937
27938 @subsubheading Synopsis
27939
27940 @smallexample
27941 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
27942 @end smallexample
27943
27944 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
27945 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27946 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27947 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27948 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27949 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
27950 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
27951
27952 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
27953 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
27954 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
27955
27956 @subsubheading Example
27957
27958 @smallexample
27959 (gdb)
27960 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
27961 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
27962 (gdb)
27963 @end smallexample
27964
27965
27966 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
27967 @findex -stack-select-frame
27968
27969 @subsubheading Synopsis
27970
27971 @smallexample
27972 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
27973 @end smallexample
27974
27975 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
27976 the stack.
27977
27978 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
27979 option to every command.
27980
27981 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27982
27983 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
27984 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
27985
27986 @subsubheading Example
27987
27988 @smallexample
27989 (gdb)
27990 -stack-select-frame 2
27991 ^done
27992 (gdb)
27993 @end smallexample
27994
27995 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27996 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
27997 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
27998
27999 @ignore
28000
28001 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28002
28003 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
28004 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
28005 used by @code{Insight}.
28006
28007 The two main reasons for that are:
28008
28009 @enumerate 1
28010 @item
28011 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
28012
28013 @item
28014 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
28015 now).
28016 @end enumerate
28017
28018 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
28019 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
28020 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
28021 hints about their use.
28022
28023 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
28024 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
28025 least, the following operations:
28026
28027 @itemize @bullet
28028 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
28029 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
28030 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
28031 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
28032 @end itemize
28033
28034 @end ignore
28035
28036 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
28037
28038 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28039
28040 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
28041 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
28042 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
28043 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
28044 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
28045 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
28046 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
28047 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
28048 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
28049 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
28050 object, or to change display format.
28051
28052 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
28053 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
28054 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
28055 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
28056 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
28057 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
28058 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
28059 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
28060 child will be created.
28061
28062 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
28063 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
28064 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
28065 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
28066 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
28067
28068 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
28069 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
28070 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
28071 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
28072 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
28073 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
28074 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
28075 variables that frontend has created.
28076
28077 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
28078 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
28079 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
28080 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
28081 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
28082 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
28083 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
28084 implicitly updated.
28085
28086 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
28087 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
28088 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28089 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28090 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28091 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28092 frame. Consider this example:
28093
28094 @smallexample
28095 void do_work(...)
28096 @{
28097 struct work_state state;
28098
28099 if (...)
28100 do_work(...);
28101 @}
28102 @end smallexample
28103
28104 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28105 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28106 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28107 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28108 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28109
28110 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28111 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28112 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28113 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28114 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28115 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28116
28117 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28118 access this functionality:
28119
28120 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28121 @item @strong{Operation}
28122 @tab @strong{Description}
28123
28124 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28125 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28126 @item @code{-var-create}
28127 @tab create a variable object
28128 @item @code{-var-delete}
28129 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28130 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28131 @tab set the display format of this variable
28132 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28133 @tab show the display format of this variable
28134 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28135 @tab tells how many children this object has
28136 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28137 @tab return a list of the object's children
28138 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28139 @tab show the type of this variable object
28140 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28141 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28142 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28143 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
28144 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
28145 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
28146 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
28147 @tab get the value of this variable
28148 @item @code{-var-assign}
28149 @tab set the value of this variable
28150 @item @code{-var-update}
28151 @tab update the variable and its children
28152 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
28153 @tab set frozeness attribute
28154 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
28155 @tab set range of children to display on update
28156 @end multitable
28157
28158 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
28159 how it can be used.
28160
28161 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
28162
28163 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
28164 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
28165
28166 @smallexample
28167 -enable-pretty-printing
28168 @end smallexample
28169
28170 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
28171 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
28172 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28173 request that this functionality be enabled.
28174
28175 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28176
28177 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28178 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28179
28180 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
28181 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
28182
28183 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
28184 @findex -var-create
28185
28186 @subsubheading Synopsis
28187
28188 @smallexample
28189 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
28190 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
28191 @end smallexample
28192
28193 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
28194 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
28195 register.
28196
28197 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
28198 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
28199 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
28200 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
28201 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
28202
28203 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
28204 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
28205 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
28206 object must be created.
28207
28208 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
28209 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
28210
28211 @itemize @bullet
28212 @item
28213 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
28214
28215 @item
28216 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
28217
28218 @item
28219 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
28220 @end itemize
28221
28222 @cindex dynamic varobj
28223 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
28224 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
28225 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
28226 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
28227 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
28228 compatibility for existing clients.
28229
28230 @subsubheading Result
28231
28232 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
28233 are:
28234
28235 @table @samp
28236 @item name
28237 The name of the varobj.
28238
28239 @item numchild
28240 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
28241 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
28242 @samp{has_more} attribute.
28243
28244 @item value
28245 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
28246 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
28247 will not be interesting.
28248
28249 @item type
28250 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
28251 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
28252 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28253 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28254 @emph{declared} one.
28255
28256 @item thread-id
28257 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
28258 thread's identifier.
28259
28260 @item has_more
28261 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
28262 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
28263
28264 @item dynamic
28265 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28266 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28267 then this attribute will not be present.
28268
28269 @item displayhint
28270 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28271 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28272 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28273 @end table
28274
28275 Typical output will look like this:
28276
28277 @smallexample
28278 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
28279 has_more="@var{has_more}"
28280 @end smallexample
28281
28282
28283 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
28284 @findex -var-delete
28285
28286 @subsubheading Synopsis
28287
28288 @smallexample
28289 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
28290 @end smallexample
28291
28292 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
28293 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
28294
28295 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
28296
28297
28298 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
28299 @findex -var-set-format
28300
28301 @subsubheading Synopsis
28302
28303 @smallexample
28304 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
28305 @end smallexample
28306
28307 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
28308 @var{format-spec}.
28309
28310 @anchor{-var-set-format}
28311 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
28312
28313 @smallexample
28314 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
28315 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
28316 @end smallexample
28317
28318 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
28319 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
28320 for pointers, etc.).
28321
28322 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
28323 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
28324
28325 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
28326 @findex -var-show-format
28327
28328 @subsubheading Synopsis
28329
28330 @smallexample
28331 -var-show-format @var{name}
28332 @end smallexample
28333
28334 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
28335
28336 @smallexample
28337 @var{format} @expansion{}
28338 @var{format-spec}
28339 @end smallexample
28340
28341
28342 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
28343 @findex -var-info-num-children
28344
28345 @subsubheading Synopsis
28346
28347 @smallexample
28348 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
28349 @end smallexample
28350
28351 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
28352
28353 @smallexample
28354 numchild=@var{n}
28355 @end smallexample
28356
28357 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
28358 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
28359 be available.
28360
28361
28362 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
28363 @findex -var-list-children
28364
28365 @subsubheading Synopsis
28366
28367 @smallexample
28368 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
28369 @end smallexample
28370 @anchor{-var-list-children}
28371
28372 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
28373 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
28374 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
28375 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
28376 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
28377 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
28378 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
28379 and unions.
28380
28381 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
28382 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
28383 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
28384 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
28385 reported.
28386
28387 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
28388 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
28389 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
28390 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
28391 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
28392 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
28393 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
28394 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
28395 the visible items.
28396
28397 For each child the following results are returned:
28398
28399 @table @var
28400
28401 @item name
28402 Name of the variable object created for this child.
28403
28404 @item exp
28405 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
28406 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
28407
28408 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
28409 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
28410
28411 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
28412 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
28413 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
28414 type and value are not present.
28415
28416 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
28417 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
28418 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
28419
28420 @item numchild
28421 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
28422 0.
28423
28424 @item type
28425 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
28426 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28427 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28428 @emph{declared} one.
28429
28430 @item value
28431 If values were requested, this is the value.
28432
28433 @item thread-id
28434 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
28435 Otherwise this result is not present.
28436
28437 @item frozen
28438 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
28439
28440 @item displayhint
28441 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28442 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28443 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28444
28445 @item dynamic
28446 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28447 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28448 then this attribute will not be present.
28449
28450 @end table
28451
28452 The result may have its own attributes:
28453
28454 @table @samp
28455 @item displayhint
28456 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28457 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28458 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28459
28460 @item has_more
28461 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
28462 remaining after the end of the selected range.
28463 @end table
28464
28465 @subsubheading Example
28466
28467 @smallexample
28468 (gdb)
28469 -var-list-children n
28470 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28471 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28472 (gdb)
28473 -var-list-children --all-values n
28474 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28475 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28476 @end smallexample
28477
28478
28479 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
28480 @findex -var-info-type
28481
28482 @subsubheading Synopsis
28483
28484 @smallexample
28485 -var-info-type @var{name}
28486 @end smallexample
28487
28488 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
28489 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
28490 @value{GDBN} CLI:
28491
28492 @smallexample
28493 type=@var{typename}
28494 @end smallexample
28495
28496
28497 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
28498 @findex -var-info-expression
28499
28500 @subsubheading Synopsis
28501
28502 @smallexample
28503 -var-info-expression @var{name}
28504 @end smallexample
28505
28506 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
28507 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
28508 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
28509
28510 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
28511 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
28512
28513 @smallexample
28514 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
28515 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
28516 @end smallexample
28517
28518 @noindent
28519 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
28520 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
28521
28522 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
28523 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
28524 is of limited use.
28525
28526 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
28527 @findex -var-info-path-expression
28528
28529 @subsubheading Synopsis
28530
28531 @smallexample
28532 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
28533 @end smallexample
28534
28535 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
28536 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
28537 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
28538 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
28539 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
28540 watchpoint from a variable object.
28541
28542 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
28543 and will give an error when invoked on one.
28544
28545 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
28546 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
28547 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
28548 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
28549 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
28550 @smallexample
28551 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
28552 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
28553 @end smallexample
28554
28555 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
28556 @findex -var-show-attributes
28557
28558 @subsubheading Synopsis
28559
28560 @smallexample
28561 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
28562 @end smallexample
28563
28564 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
28565
28566 @smallexample
28567 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
28568 @end smallexample
28569
28570 @noindent
28571 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
28572
28573 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
28574 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
28575
28576 @subsubheading Synopsis
28577
28578 @smallexample
28579 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
28580 @end smallexample
28581
28582 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
28583 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
28584 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
28585 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
28586 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
28587 the current display format will be used. The current display format
28588 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
28589
28590 @smallexample
28591 value=@var{value}
28592 @end smallexample
28593
28594 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
28595 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
28596
28597 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
28598 @findex -var-assign
28599
28600 @subsubheading Synopsis
28601
28602 @smallexample
28603 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
28604 @end smallexample
28605
28606 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
28607 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
28608 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
28609 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
28610
28611 @subsubheading Example
28612
28613 @smallexample
28614 (gdb)
28615 -var-assign var1 3
28616 ^done,value="3"
28617 (gdb)
28618 -var-update *
28619 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
28620 (gdb)
28621 @end smallexample
28622
28623 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
28624 @findex -var-update
28625
28626 @subsubheading Synopsis
28627
28628 @smallexample
28629 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
28630 @end smallexample
28631
28632 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
28633 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
28634 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
28635 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
28636 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
28637 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
28638 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
28639 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
28640 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
28641 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
28642 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
28643 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
28644 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
28645
28646 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
28647 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
28648 diagnostic.
28649
28650 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
28651 only the selected range of children will be reported.
28652
28653 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
28654 @samp{changelist}.
28655
28656 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
28657
28658 @table @samp
28659 @item name
28660 The name of the varobj.
28661
28662 @item value
28663 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
28664 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
28665
28666 @item in_scope
28667 @anchor{-var-update}
28668 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
28669
28670 @table @code
28671 @item "true"
28672 The variable object's current value is valid.
28673
28674 @item "false"
28675 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
28676 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
28677 scope.
28678
28679 @item "invalid"
28680 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
28681 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
28682 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
28683 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
28684 objects.
28685 @end table
28686
28687 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
28688 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
28689
28690 @item type_changed
28691 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
28692 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
28693 be @samp{false}.
28694
28695 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
28696 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
28697 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
28698 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
28699 unset.
28700
28701 @item new_type
28702 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
28703 hold the new type.
28704
28705 @item new_num_children
28706 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
28707 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
28708
28709 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
28710 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
28711 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
28712 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
28713 children which may be available.
28714
28715 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
28716 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
28717 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
28718 only happen at the end of the update range).
28719
28720 @item displayhint
28721 The display hint, if any.
28722
28723 @item has_more
28724 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
28725 available outside the varobj's update range.
28726
28727 @item dynamic
28728 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28729 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28730 then this attribute will not be present.
28731
28732 @item new_children
28733 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
28734 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
28735 be listed in this attribute.
28736 @end table
28737
28738 @subsubheading Example
28739
28740 @smallexample
28741 (gdb)
28742 -var-assign var1 3
28743 ^done,value="3"
28744 (gdb)
28745 -var-update --all-values var1
28746 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
28747 type_changed="false"@}]
28748 (gdb)
28749 @end smallexample
28750
28751 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
28752 @findex -var-set-frozen
28753 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
28754
28755 @subsubheading Synopsis
28756
28757 @smallexample
28758 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
28759 @end smallexample
28760
28761 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
28762 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
28763 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
28764 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
28765 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
28766 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
28767 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
28768 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
28769 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
28770 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
28771 @code{-var-update} does.
28772
28773 @subsubheading Example
28774
28775 @smallexample
28776 (gdb)
28777 -var-set-frozen V 1
28778 ^done
28779 (gdb)
28780 @end smallexample
28781
28782 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
28783 @findex -var-set-update-range
28784 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
28785
28786 @subsubheading Synopsis
28787
28788 @smallexample
28789 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
28790 @end smallexample
28791
28792 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
28793 @code{-var-update}.
28794
28795 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
28796 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
28797 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
28798 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
28799
28800 @subsubheading Example
28801
28802 @smallexample
28803 (gdb)
28804 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
28805 ^done
28806 @end smallexample
28807
28808 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
28809 @findex -var-set-visualizer
28810 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
28811
28812 @subsubheading Synopsis
28813
28814 @smallexample
28815 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
28816 @end smallexample
28817
28818 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
28819
28820 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
28821 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
28822
28823 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
28824 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
28825 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
28826 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
28827 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
28828 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
28829 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
28830
28831 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
28832 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
28833 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
28834 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
28835
28836 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
28837 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
28838 can be used to check this.
28839
28840 @subsubheading Example
28841
28842 Resetting the visualizer:
28843
28844 @smallexample
28845 (gdb)
28846 -var-set-visualizer V None
28847 ^done
28848 @end smallexample
28849
28850 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
28851
28852 @smallexample
28853 (gdb)
28854 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
28855 ^done
28856 @end smallexample
28857
28858 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
28859 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
28860
28861 @smallexample
28862 (gdb)
28863 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
28864 ^done
28865 @end smallexample
28866
28867 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28868 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
28869 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
28870
28871 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
28872 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
28873 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
28874 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
28875
28876 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
28877 @c @subheading -data-assign
28878 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
28879 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
28880 @c set variable
28881 @c @subsubheading Example
28882 @c N.A.
28883
28884 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
28885 @findex -data-disassemble
28886
28887 @subsubheading Synopsis
28888
28889 @smallexample
28890 -data-disassemble
28891 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
28892 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
28893 -- @var{mode}
28894 @end smallexample
28895
28896 @noindent
28897 Where:
28898
28899 @table @samp
28900 @item @var{start-addr}
28901 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
28902 @item @var{end-addr}
28903 is the end address
28904 @item @var{filename}
28905 is the name of the file to disassemble
28906 @item @var{linenum}
28907 is the line number to disassemble around
28908 @item @var{lines}
28909 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
28910 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
28911 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
28912 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
28913 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
28914 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
28915 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
28916 are displayed.
28917 @item @var{mode}
28918 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
28919 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
28920 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
28921 @end table
28922
28923 @subsubheading Result
28924
28925 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
28926 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
28927 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
28928
28929 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
28930 following fields:
28931
28932 @table @code
28933 @item address
28934 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
28935
28936 @item func-name
28937 The name of the function this instruction is within.
28938
28939 @item offset
28940 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
28941
28942 @item inst
28943 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
28944
28945 @item opcodes
28946 This field is only present for mode 2. This contains the raw opcode
28947 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
28948
28949 @end table
28950
28951 For modes 1 and 3 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
28952 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
28953
28954 @table @code
28955 @item line
28956 The line number within @samp{file}.
28957
28958 @item file
28959 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
28960 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
28961 used.
28962
28963 @item fullname
28964 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
28965 using the source file search path
28966 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
28967 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
28968
28969 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
28970 present in the debug information.
28971
28972 @item line_asm_insn
28973 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
28974 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
28975 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
28976 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
28977 @samp{opcodes}.
28978
28979 @end table
28980
28981 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
28982 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
28983 adjust its format.
28984
28985 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28986
28987 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
28988
28989 @subsubheading Example
28990
28991 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
28992
28993 @smallexample
28994 (gdb)
28995 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
28996 ^done,
28997 asm_insns=[
28998 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
28999 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29000 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29001 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29002 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
29003 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
29004 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
29005 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29006 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
29007 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
29008 (gdb)
29009 @end smallexample
29010
29011 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
29012 @code{main}.
29013
29014 @smallexample
29015 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
29016 ^done,asm_insns=[
29017 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29018 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29019 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29020 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29021 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29022 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29023 [@dots{}]
29024 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
29025 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
29026 (gdb)
29027 @end smallexample
29028
29029 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
29030
29031 @smallexample
29032 (gdb)
29033 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
29034 ^done,asm_insns=[
29035 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29036 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29037 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29038 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29039 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29040 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
29041 (gdb)
29042 @end smallexample
29043
29044 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
29045
29046 @smallexample
29047 (gdb)
29048 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
29049 ^done,asm_insns=[
29050 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
29051 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29052 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29053 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
29054 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
29055 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
29056 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29057 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29058 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
29059 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29060 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29061 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
29062 (gdb)
29063 @end smallexample
29064
29065
29066 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
29067 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
29068
29069 @subsubheading Synopsis
29070
29071 @smallexample
29072 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
29073 @end smallexample
29074
29075 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
29076 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
29077 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
29078
29079 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29080
29081 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
29082 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
29083 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
29084
29085 @subsubheading Example
29086
29087 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
29088 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29089 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29090 output.
29091
29092 @smallexample
29093 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29094 211^done,value="1"
29095 (gdb)
29096 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29097 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29098 (gdb)
29099 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29100 411^done,value="4"
29101 (gdb)
29102 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29103 511^done,value="4"
29104 (gdb)
29105 @end smallexample
29106
29107
29108 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29109 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29110
29111 @subsubheading Synopsis
29112
29113 @smallexample
29114 -data-list-changed-registers
29115 @end smallexample
29116
29117 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29118
29119 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29120
29121 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29122 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29123
29124 @subsubheading Example
29125
29126 On a PPC MBX board:
29127
29128 @smallexample
29129 (gdb)
29130 -exec-continue
29131 ^running
29132
29133 (gdb)
29134 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
29135 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
29136 line="5"@}
29137 (gdb)
29138 -data-list-changed-registers
29139 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
29140 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
29141 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
29142 (gdb)
29143 @end smallexample
29144
29145
29146 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
29147 @findex -data-list-register-names
29148
29149 @subsubheading Synopsis
29150
29151 @smallexample
29152 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
29153 @end smallexample
29154
29155 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
29156 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
29157 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
29158 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
29159 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
29160 include empty register names.
29161
29162 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29163
29164 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
29165 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
29166 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
29167
29168 @subsubheading Example
29169
29170 For the PPC MBX board:
29171 @smallexample
29172 (gdb)
29173 -data-list-register-names
29174 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
29175 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
29176 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
29177 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
29178 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
29179 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
29180 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
29181 (gdb)
29182 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
29183 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
29184 (gdb)
29185 @end smallexample
29186
29187 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
29188 @findex -data-list-register-values
29189
29190 @subsubheading Synopsis
29191
29192 @smallexample
29193 -data-list-register-values
29194 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
29195 @end smallexample
29196
29197 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
29198 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
29199 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
29200 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
29201 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
29202 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
29203
29204 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
29205
29206 @table @code
29207 @item x
29208 Hexadecimal
29209 @item o
29210 Octal
29211 @item t
29212 Binary
29213 @item d
29214 Decimal
29215 @item r
29216 Raw
29217 @item N
29218 Natural
29219 @end table
29220
29221 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29222
29223 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
29224 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
29225
29226 @subsubheading Example
29227
29228 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
29229 don't appear in the actual output):
29230
29231 @smallexample
29232 (gdb)
29233 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
29234 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29235 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
29236 (gdb)
29237 -data-list-register-values x
29238 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
29239 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29240 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
29241 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
29242 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
29243 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
29244 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
29245 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
29246 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
29247 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29248 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
29249 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
29250 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
29251 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
29252 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
29253 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
29254 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
29255 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
29256 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
29257 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
29258 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
29259 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
29260 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
29261 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
29262 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
29263 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
29264 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
29265 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
29266 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
29267 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
29268 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
29269 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
29270 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29271 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
29272 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
29273 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
29274 (gdb)
29275 @end smallexample
29276
29277
29278 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
29279 @findex -data-read-memory
29280
29281 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
29282
29283 @subsubheading Synopsis
29284
29285 @smallexample
29286 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29287 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
29288 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
29289 @end smallexample
29290
29291 @noindent
29292 where:
29293
29294 @table @samp
29295 @item @var{address}
29296 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29297 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29298 quoted using the C convention.
29299
29300 @item @var{word-format}
29301 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
29302 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
29303 ,Output Formats}).
29304
29305 @item @var{word-size}
29306 The size of each memory word in bytes.
29307
29308 @item @var{nr-rows}
29309 The number of rows in the output table.
29310
29311 @item @var{nr-cols}
29312 The number of columns in the output table.
29313
29314 @item @var{aschar}
29315 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
29316 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
29317 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
29318 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
29319
29320 @item @var{byte-offset}
29321 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
29322 @end table
29323
29324 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
29325 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
29326 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
29327 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
29328 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
29329 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
29330 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
29331 @samp{addr}.
29332
29333 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
29334 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
29335 @samp{prev-page}.
29336
29337 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29338
29339 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
29340 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
29341
29342 @subsubheading Example
29343
29344 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
29345 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
29346 word. Display each word in hex.
29347
29348 @smallexample
29349 (gdb)
29350 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
29351 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
29352 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
29353 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
29354 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
29355 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
29356 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
29357 (gdb)
29358 @end smallexample
29359
29360 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
29361 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
29362
29363 @smallexample
29364 (gdb)
29365 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
29366 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
29367 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
29368 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
29369 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
29370 (gdb)
29371 @end smallexample
29372
29373 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
29374 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
29375 used as the non-printable character.
29376
29377 @smallexample
29378 (gdb)
29379 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
29380 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
29381 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
29382 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
29383 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29384 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29385 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29386 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29387 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
29388 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
29389 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
29390 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
29391 (gdb)
29392 @end smallexample
29393
29394 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
29395 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
29396
29397 @subsubheading Synopsis
29398
29399 @smallexample
29400 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29401 @var{address} @var{count}
29402 @end smallexample
29403
29404 @noindent
29405 where:
29406
29407 @table @samp
29408 @item @var{address}
29409 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29410 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29411 quoted using the C convention.
29412
29413 @item @var{count}
29414 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
29415
29416 @item @var{byte-offset}
29417 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
29418 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
29419 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
29420 perform address arithmetics itself.
29421
29422 @end table
29423
29424 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
29425 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
29426 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
29427 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
29428 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
29429 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
29430
29431 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
29432 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
29433 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
29434 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
29435 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
29436 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
29437 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
29438 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
29439
29440 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
29441 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
29442 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
29443 and has the following fields:
29444
29445 @table @code
29446 @item begin
29447 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29448
29449 @item end
29450 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29451
29452 @item offset
29453 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
29454 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
29455
29456 @item contents
29457 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
29458
29459 @end table
29460
29461
29462
29463 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29464
29465 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
29466
29467 @subsubheading Example
29468
29469 @smallexample
29470 (gdb)
29471 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
29472 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
29473 end="0xbffff15e",
29474 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
29475 (gdb)
29476 @end smallexample
29477
29478
29479 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
29480 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
29481
29482 @subsubheading Synopsis
29483
29484 @smallexample
29485 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
29486 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
29487 @end smallexample
29488
29489 @noindent
29490 where:
29491
29492 @table @samp
29493 @item @var{address}
29494 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29495 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29496 quoted using the C convention.
29497
29498 @item @var{contents}
29499 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
29500
29501 @item @var{count}
29502 Optional argument indicating the number of bytes to be written. If @var{count}
29503 is greater than @var{contents}' length, @value{GDBN} will repeatedly
29504 write @var{contents} until it fills @var{count} bytes.
29505
29506 @end table
29507
29508 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29509
29510 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29511
29512 @subsubheading Example
29513
29514 @smallexample
29515 (gdb)
29516 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
29517 ^done
29518 (gdb)
29519 @end smallexample
29520
29521 @smallexample
29522 (gdb)
29523 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
29524 ^done
29525 (gdb)
29526 @end smallexample
29527
29528 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29529 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
29530 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
29531
29532 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
29533 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
29534
29535 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
29536 @findex -trace-find
29537
29538 @subsubheading Synopsis
29539
29540 @smallexample
29541 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
29542 @end smallexample
29543
29544 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
29545 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
29546 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
29547
29548 @table @samp
29549
29550 @item none
29551 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
29552
29553 @item frame-number
29554 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
29555 that index.
29556
29557 @item tracepoint-number
29558 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
29559 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
29560
29561 @item pc
29562 An address is required as parameter. Finds
29563 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
29564 address.
29565
29566 @item pc-inside-range
29567 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
29568 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
29569 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29570
29571 @item pc-outside-range
29572 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
29573 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
29574 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29575
29576 @item line
29577 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
29578 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
29579 the specified location.
29580
29581 @end table
29582
29583 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
29584 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
29585
29586 @table @samp
29587 @item found
29588 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
29589 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
29590
29591 @item traceframe
29592 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
29593 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29594
29595 @item tracepoint
29596 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
29597 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29598
29599 @item frame
29600 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
29601 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
29602 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
29603
29604 @end table
29605
29606 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29607
29608 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
29609
29610 @subheading -trace-define-variable
29611 @findex -trace-define-variable
29612
29613 @subsubheading Synopsis
29614
29615 @smallexample
29616 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
29617 @end smallexample
29618
29619 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
29620 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
29621 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
29622 with the @samp{$} character.
29623
29624 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29625
29626 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
29627
29628 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
29629 @findex -trace-frame-collected
29630
29631 @subsubheading Synopsis
29632
29633 @smallexample
29634 -trace-frame-collected
29635 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
29636 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
29637 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
29638 [--memory-contents]
29639 @end smallexample
29640
29641 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
29642 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
29643 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
29644 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
29645 See the output description table below for more details.
29646
29647 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
29648 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
29649 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
29650 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
29651 memory range and which is a computed expression.
29652
29653 For instance, if the actions were
29654 @smallexample
29655 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
29656 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
29657 @end smallexample
29658
29659 @noindent
29660 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
29661 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
29662 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
29663 objects would be computed expressions.
29664
29665 An example output would be:
29666
29667 @smallexample
29668 (gdb)
29669 -trace-frame-collected
29670 ^done,
29671 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
29672 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
29673 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
29674 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
29675 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
29676 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
29677 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
29678 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
29679 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
29680 ...
29681 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
29682 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
29683 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
29684 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
29685 (gdb)
29686 @end smallexample
29687
29688 Where:
29689
29690 @table @code
29691 @item explicit-variables
29692 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
29693 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
29694 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
29695 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
29696 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
29697 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
29698 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
29699 arrays, structures and unions.
29700
29701 @item computed-expressions
29702 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
29703 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
29704 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
29705 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
29706
29707 @item registers
29708 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
29709 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
29710 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
29711 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
29712 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
29713
29714 @item tvars
29715 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
29716 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
29717 current value are returned.
29718
29719 @item memory
29720 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
29721 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
29722 collected memory range and has the following fields:
29723
29724 @table @code
29725 @item address
29726 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
29727
29728 @item length
29729 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
29730
29731 @item contents
29732 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
29733 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
29734
29735 @end table
29736
29737 @end table
29738
29739 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29740
29741 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29742
29743 @subsubheading Example
29744
29745 @subheading -trace-list-variables
29746 @findex -trace-list-variables
29747
29748 @subsubheading Synopsis
29749
29750 @smallexample
29751 -trace-list-variables
29752 @end smallexample
29753
29754 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
29755 table has the following fields:
29756
29757 @table @samp
29758 @item name
29759 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
29760
29761 @item initial
29762 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
29763 field is always present.
29764
29765 @item current
29766 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
29767 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
29768 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
29769 presently running.
29770
29771 @end table
29772
29773 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29774
29775 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
29776
29777 @subsubheading Example
29778
29779 @smallexample
29780 (gdb)
29781 -trace-list-variables
29782 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
29783 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
29784 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
29785 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
29786 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
29787 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
29788 (gdb)
29789 @end smallexample
29790
29791 @subheading -trace-save
29792 @findex -trace-save
29793
29794 @subsubheading Synopsis
29795
29796 @smallexample
29797 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
29798 @end smallexample
29799
29800 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
29801 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
29802 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
29803 to perform the save.
29804
29805 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29806
29807 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
29808
29809
29810 @subheading -trace-start
29811 @findex -trace-start
29812
29813 @subsubheading Synopsis
29814
29815 @smallexample
29816 -trace-start
29817 @end smallexample
29818
29819 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
29820 have any fields.
29821
29822 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29823
29824 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
29825
29826 @subheading -trace-status
29827 @findex -trace-status
29828
29829 @subsubheading Synopsis
29830
29831 @smallexample
29832 -trace-status
29833 @end smallexample
29834
29835 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
29836 the following fields:
29837
29838 @table @samp
29839
29840 @item supported
29841 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
29842 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
29843 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
29844 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
29845 started. This field is always present.
29846
29847 @item running
29848 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
29849 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
29850 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
29851
29852 @item stop-reason
29853 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
29854 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
29855 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
29856 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
29857 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
29858 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
29859 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
29860 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
29861 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
29862
29863 @item stopping-tracepoint
29864 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
29865 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
29866 @samp{passcount}.
29867
29868 @item frames
29869 @itemx frames-created
29870 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
29871 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
29872 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
29873 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
29874
29875 @item buffer-size
29876 @itemx buffer-free
29877 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
29878 remaining space. These fields are optional.
29879
29880 @item circular
29881 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
29882 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
29883 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
29884 and may fill up.
29885
29886 @item disconnected
29887 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
29888 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
29889 that the trace run will stop.
29890
29891 @item trace-file
29892 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
29893 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
29894
29895 @end table
29896
29897 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29898
29899 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
29900
29901 @subheading -trace-stop
29902 @findex -trace-stop
29903
29904 @subsubheading Synopsis
29905
29906 @smallexample
29907 -trace-stop
29908 @end smallexample
29909
29910 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
29911 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
29912 @samp{running} fields are not output.
29913
29914 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29915
29916 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
29917
29918
29919 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29920 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
29921 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
29922
29923
29924 @ignore
29925 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
29926 @findex -symbol-info-address
29927
29928 @subsubheading Synopsis
29929
29930 @smallexample
29931 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
29932 @end smallexample
29933
29934 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
29935
29936 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29937
29938 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
29939
29940 @subsubheading Example
29941 N.A.
29942
29943
29944 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
29945 @findex -symbol-info-file
29946
29947 @subsubheading Synopsis
29948
29949 @smallexample
29950 -symbol-info-file
29951 @end smallexample
29952
29953 Show the file for the symbol.
29954
29955 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29956
29957 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
29958 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
29959
29960 @subsubheading Example
29961 N.A.
29962
29963
29964 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
29965 @findex -symbol-info-function
29966
29967 @subsubheading Synopsis
29968
29969 @smallexample
29970 -symbol-info-function
29971 @end smallexample
29972
29973 Show which function the symbol lives in.
29974
29975 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29976
29977 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
29978
29979 @subsubheading Example
29980 N.A.
29981
29982
29983 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
29984 @findex -symbol-info-line
29985
29986 @subsubheading Synopsis
29987
29988 @smallexample
29989 -symbol-info-line
29990 @end smallexample
29991
29992 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
29993
29994 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29995
29996 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
29997 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
29998
29999 @subsubheading Example
30000 N.A.
30001
30002
30003 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
30004 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
30005
30006 @subsubheading Synopsis
30007
30008 @smallexample
30009 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
30010 @end smallexample
30011
30012 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
30013
30014 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30015
30016 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
30017
30018 @subsubheading Example
30019 N.A.
30020
30021
30022 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
30023 @findex -symbol-list-functions
30024
30025 @subsubheading Synopsis
30026
30027 @smallexample
30028 -symbol-list-functions
30029 @end smallexample
30030
30031 List the functions in the executable.
30032
30033 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30034
30035 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
30036 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30037
30038 @subsubheading Example
30039 N.A.
30040 @end ignore
30041
30042
30043 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
30044 @findex -symbol-list-lines
30045
30046 @subsubheading Synopsis
30047
30048 @smallexample
30049 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
30050 @end smallexample
30051
30052 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
30053 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
30054 ascending PC order.
30055
30056 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30057
30058 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30059
30060 @subsubheading Example
30061 @smallexample
30062 (gdb)
30063 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
30064 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
30065 (gdb)
30066 @end smallexample
30067
30068
30069 @ignore
30070 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
30071 @findex -symbol-list-types
30072
30073 @subsubheading Synopsis
30074
30075 @smallexample
30076 -symbol-list-types
30077 @end smallexample
30078
30079 List all the type names.
30080
30081 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30082
30083 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
30084 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30085
30086 @subsubheading Example
30087 N.A.
30088
30089
30090 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30091 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30092
30093 @subsubheading Synopsis
30094
30095 @smallexample
30096 -symbol-list-variables
30097 @end smallexample
30098
30099 List all the global and static variable names.
30100
30101 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30102
30103 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30104
30105 @subsubheading Example
30106 N.A.
30107
30108
30109 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30110 @findex -symbol-locate
30111
30112 @subsubheading Synopsis
30113
30114 @smallexample
30115 -symbol-locate
30116 @end smallexample
30117
30118 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30119
30120 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30121
30122 @subsubheading Example
30123 N.A.
30124
30125
30126 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
30127 @findex -symbol-type
30128
30129 @subsubheading Synopsis
30130
30131 @smallexample
30132 -symbol-type @var{variable}
30133 @end smallexample
30134
30135 Show type of @var{variable}.
30136
30137 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30138
30139 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
30140 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
30141
30142 @subsubheading Example
30143 N.A.
30144 @end ignore
30145
30146
30147 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30148 @node GDB/MI File Commands
30149 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
30150
30151 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
30152 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
30153
30154 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
30155 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
30156
30157 @subsubheading Synopsis
30158
30159 @smallexample
30160 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
30161 @end smallexample
30162
30163 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
30164 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
30165 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
30166 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
30167 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
30168 notification.
30169
30170 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30171
30172 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
30173
30174 @subsubheading Example
30175
30176 @smallexample
30177 (gdb)
30178 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30179 ^done
30180 (gdb)
30181 @end smallexample
30182
30183
30184 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
30185 @findex -file-exec-file
30186
30187 @subsubheading Synopsis
30188
30189 @smallexample
30190 -file-exec-file @var{file}
30191 @end smallexample
30192
30193 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
30194 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
30195 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
30196 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
30197 notification.
30198
30199 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30200
30201 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
30202
30203 @subsubheading Example
30204
30205 @smallexample
30206 (gdb)
30207 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30208 ^done
30209 (gdb)
30210 @end smallexample
30211
30212
30213 @ignore
30214 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
30215 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
30216
30217 @subsubheading Synopsis
30218
30219 @smallexample
30220 -file-list-exec-sections
30221 @end smallexample
30222
30223 List the sections of the current executable file.
30224
30225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30226
30227 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
30228 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
30229 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
30230
30231 @subsubheading Example
30232 N.A.
30233 @end ignore
30234
30235
30236 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
30237 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
30238
30239 @subsubheading Synopsis
30240
30241 @smallexample
30242 -file-list-exec-source-file
30243 @end smallexample
30244
30245 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
30246 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
30247 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
30248 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
30249
30250 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30251
30252 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
30253
30254 @subsubheading Example
30255
30256 @smallexample
30257 (gdb)
30258 123-file-list-exec-source-file
30259 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
30260 (gdb)
30261 @end smallexample
30262
30263
30264 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
30265 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
30266
30267 @subsubheading Synopsis
30268
30269 @smallexample
30270 -file-list-exec-source-files
30271 @end smallexample
30272
30273 List the source files for the current executable.
30274
30275 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
30276 name) of a source file.
30277
30278 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30279
30280 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
30281 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
30282
30283 @subsubheading Example
30284 @smallexample
30285 (gdb)
30286 -file-list-exec-source-files
30287 ^done,files=[
30288 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
30289 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
30290 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
30291 (gdb)
30292 @end smallexample
30293
30294 @ignore
30295 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
30296 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
30297
30298 @subsubheading Synopsis
30299
30300 @smallexample
30301 -file-list-shared-libraries
30302 @end smallexample
30303
30304 List the shared libraries in the program.
30305
30306 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30307
30308 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
30309
30310 @subsubheading Example
30311 N.A.
30312
30313
30314 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
30315 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
30316
30317 @subsubheading Synopsis
30318
30319 @smallexample
30320 -file-list-symbol-files
30321 @end smallexample
30322
30323 List symbol files.
30324
30325 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30326
30327 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
30328
30329 @subsubheading Example
30330 N.A.
30331 @end ignore
30332
30333
30334 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
30335 @findex -file-symbol-file
30336
30337 @subsubheading Synopsis
30338
30339 @smallexample
30340 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
30341 @end smallexample
30342
30343 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
30344 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
30345 produced, except for a completion notification.
30346
30347 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30348
30349 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
30350
30351 @subsubheading Example
30352
30353 @smallexample
30354 (gdb)
30355 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30356 ^done
30357 (gdb)
30358 @end smallexample
30359
30360 @ignore
30361 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30362 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
30363 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
30364
30365 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
30366
30367 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
30368
30369 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
30370
30371 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
30372
30373 @c @subheading -overlay-map
30374
30375 @c @subheading -overlay-off
30376
30377 @c @subheading -overlay-on
30378
30379 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
30380
30381 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30382 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
30383 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
30384
30385 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
30386
30387 @c @subheading -signal-handle
30388
30389 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
30390
30391 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
30392 @end ignore
30393
30394
30395 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30396 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
30397 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
30398
30399
30400 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
30401 @findex -target-attach
30402
30403 @subsubheading Synopsis
30404
30405 @smallexample
30406 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
30407 @end smallexample
30408
30409 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
30410 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
30411 group, the id previously returned by
30412 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
30413
30414 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30415
30416 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
30417
30418 @subsubheading Example
30419 @smallexample
30420 (gdb)
30421 -target-attach 34
30422 =thread-created,id="1"
30423 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
30424 ^done
30425 (gdb)
30426 @end smallexample
30427
30428 @ignore
30429 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
30430 @findex -target-compare-sections
30431
30432 @subsubheading Synopsis
30433
30434 @smallexample
30435 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
30436 @end smallexample
30437
30438 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
30439 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
30440
30441 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30442
30443 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
30444
30445 @subsubheading Example
30446 N.A.
30447 @end ignore
30448
30449
30450 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
30451 @findex -target-detach
30452
30453 @subsubheading Synopsis
30454
30455 @smallexample
30456 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
30457 @end smallexample
30458
30459 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
30460 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
30461 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
30462
30463 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30464
30465 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
30466
30467 @subsubheading Example
30468
30469 @smallexample
30470 (gdb)
30471 -target-detach
30472 ^done
30473 (gdb)
30474 @end smallexample
30475
30476
30477 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
30478 @findex -target-disconnect
30479
30480 @subsubheading Synopsis
30481
30482 @smallexample
30483 -target-disconnect
30484 @end smallexample
30485
30486 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
30487 generally not resumed.
30488
30489 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30490
30491 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
30492
30493 @subsubheading Example
30494
30495 @smallexample
30496 (gdb)
30497 -target-disconnect
30498 ^done
30499 (gdb)
30500 @end smallexample
30501
30502
30503 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
30504 @findex -target-download
30505
30506 @subsubheading Synopsis
30507
30508 @smallexample
30509 -target-download
30510 @end smallexample
30511
30512 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
30513 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
30514
30515 @table @samp
30516 @item section
30517 The name of the section.
30518 @item section-sent
30519 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
30520 @item section-size
30521 The size of the section.
30522 @item total-sent
30523 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
30524 @item total-size
30525 The size of the overall executable to download.
30526 @end table
30527
30528 @noindent
30529 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
30530 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
30531
30532 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
30533 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
30534
30535 @table @samp
30536 @item section
30537 The name of the section.
30538 @item section-size
30539 The size of the section.
30540 @item total-size
30541 The size of the overall executable to download.
30542 @end table
30543
30544 @noindent
30545 At the end, a summary is printed.
30546
30547 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30548
30549 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
30550
30551 @subsubheading Example
30552
30553 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
30554 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
30555
30556 @smallexample
30557 (gdb)
30558 -target-download
30559 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
30560 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
30561 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
30562 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
30563 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
30564 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
30565 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
30566 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
30567 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
30568 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
30569 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
30570 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
30571 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
30572 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
30573 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
30574 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
30575 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
30576 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
30577 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
30578 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
30579 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
30580 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
30581 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
30582 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
30583 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
30584 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
30585 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
30586 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30587 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30588 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
30589 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
30590 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
30591 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
30592 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
30593 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
30594 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
30595 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
30596 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
30597 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
30598 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
30599 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
30600 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
30601 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
30602 write-rate="429"
30603 (gdb)
30604 @end smallexample
30605
30606
30607 @ignore
30608 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
30609 @findex -target-exec-status
30610
30611 @subsubheading Synopsis
30612
30613 @smallexample
30614 -target-exec-status
30615 @end smallexample
30616
30617 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
30618 not, for instance).
30619
30620 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30621
30622 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30623
30624 @subsubheading Example
30625 N.A.
30626
30627
30628 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
30629 @findex -target-list-available-targets
30630
30631 @subsubheading Synopsis
30632
30633 @smallexample
30634 -target-list-available-targets
30635 @end smallexample
30636
30637 List the possible targets to connect to.
30638
30639 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30640
30641 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
30642
30643 @subsubheading Example
30644 N.A.
30645
30646
30647 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
30648 @findex -target-list-current-targets
30649
30650 @subsubheading Synopsis
30651
30652 @smallexample
30653 -target-list-current-targets
30654 @end smallexample
30655
30656 Describe the current target.
30657
30658 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30659
30660 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
30661 other things).
30662
30663 @subsubheading Example
30664 N.A.
30665
30666
30667 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
30668 @findex -target-list-parameters
30669
30670 @subsubheading Synopsis
30671
30672 @smallexample
30673 -target-list-parameters
30674 @end smallexample
30675
30676 @c ????
30677 @end ignore
30678
30679 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30680
30681 No equivalent.
30682
30683 @subsubheading Example
30684 N.A.
30685
30686
30687 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
30688 @findex -target-select
30689
30690 @subsubheading Synopsis
30691
30692 @smallexample
30693 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
30694 @end smallexample
30695
30696 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
30697
30698 @table @samp
30699 @item @var{type}
30700 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
30701 @item @var{parameters}
30702 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
30703 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
30704 @end table
30705
30706 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
30707 which the target program is, in the following form:
30708
30709 @smallexample
30710 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
30711 args=[@var{arg list}]
30712 @end smallexample
30713
30714 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30715
30716 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
30717
30718 @subsubheading Example
30719
30720 @smallexample
30721 (gdb)
30722 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
30723 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
30724 (gdb)
30725 @end smallexample
30726
30727 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30728 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
30729 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
30730
30731
30732 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
30733 @findex -target-file-put
30734
30735 @subsubheading Synopsis
30736
30737 @smallexample
30738 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
30739 @end smallexample
30740
30741 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
30742 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
30743
30744 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30745
30746 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
30747
30748 @subsubheading Example
30749
30750 @smallexample
30751 (gdb)
30752 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
30753 ^done
30754 (gdb)
30755 @end smallexample
30756
30757
30758 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
30759 @findex -target-file-get
30760
30761 @subsubheading Synopsis
30762
30763 @smallexample
30764 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
30765 @end smallexample
30766
30767 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
30768 on the host system.
30769
30770 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30771
30772 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
30773
30774 @subsubheading Example
30775
30776 @smallexample
30777 (gdb)
30778 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
30779 ^done
30780 (gdb)
30781 @end smallexample
30782
30783
30784 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
30785 @findex -target-file-delete
30786
30787 @subsubheading Synopsis
30788
30789 @smallexample
30790 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
30791 @end smallexample
30792
30793 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
30794
30795 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30796
30797 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
30798
30799 @subsubheading Example
30800
30801 @smallexample
30802 (gdb)
30803 -target-file-delete remotefile
30804 ^done
30805 (gdb)
30806 @end smallexample
30807
30808
30809 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30810 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
30811 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
30812
30813 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
30814 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
30815
30816 @subsubheading Synopsis
30817
30818 @smallexample
30819 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
30820 @end smallexample
30821
30822 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
30823 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
30824 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
30825
30826 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30827
30828 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
30829
30830 @subsubheading Result
30831
30832 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
30833 defined for each exception:
30834
30835 @table @samp
30836 @item name
30837 The name of the exception.
30838
30839 @item address
30840 The address of the exception.
30841
30842 @end table
30843
30844 @subsubheading Example
30845
30846 @smallexample
30847 -info-ada-exceptions aint
30848 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
30849 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30850 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
30851 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
30852 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
30853 @end smallexample
30854
30855 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
30856
30857 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
30858 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
30859 Catchpoint Commands}.
30860
30861
30862 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30863 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
30864 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
30865
30866 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
30867 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
30868 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
30869 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
30870
30871 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
30872 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
30873 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
30874
30875 @subsubheading Synopsis
30876
30877 @smallexample
30878 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
30879 @end smallexample
30880
30881 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
30882
30883 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
30884 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
30885 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
30886 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
30887 dash.
30888
30889 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30890
30891 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30892
30893 @subsubheading Result
30894
30895 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
30896
30897 @table @samp
30898 @item exists
30899 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
30900 @code{"false"} otherwise.
30901
30902 @end table
30903
30904 @subsubheading Example
30905
30906 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
30907
30908 @smallexample
30909 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
30910 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
30911 @end smallexample
30912
30913 @noindent
30914 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
30915 to the debugger:
30916
30917 @smallexample
30918 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
30919 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
30920 @end smallexample
30921
30922 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
30923 @findex -list-features
30924 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
30925
30926 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
30927 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
30928 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
30929 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
30930 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
30931 startup.
30932
30933 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
30934 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
30935 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
30936 is given below.
30937
30938 Example output:
30939
30940 @smallexample
30941 (gdb) -list-features
30942 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
30943 @end smallexample
30944
30945 The current list of features is:
30946
30947 @ftable @samp
30948 @item frozen-varobjs
30949 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
30950 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
30951 of @code{-varobj-create}.
30952 @item pending-breakpoints
30953 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
30954 command.
30955 @item python
30956 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
30957 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
30958 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
30959 @item thread-info
30960 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
30961 @item data-read-memory-bytes
30962 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
30963 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
30964 @item breakpoint-notifications
30965 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
30966 CLI will be announced via async records.
30967 @item ada-task-info
30968 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
30969 @item language-option
30970 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
30971 option (@pxref{Context management}).
30972 @item info-gdb-mi-command
30973 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
30974 @item undefined-command-error-code
30975 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
30976 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
30977 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
30978 @item exec-run-start-option
30979 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
30980 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
30981 @end ftable
30982
30983 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
30984 @findex -list-target-features
30985
30986 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
30987 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
30988 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
30989 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
30990 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
30991 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
30992 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
30993 Example output:
30994
30995 @smallexample
30996 (gdb) -list-target-features
30997 ^done,result=["async"]
30998 @end smallexample
30999
31000 The current list of features is:
31001
31002 @table @samp
31003 @item async
31004 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
31005 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
31006 while the target is running.
31007
31008 @item reverse
31009 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
31010 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31011
31012 @end table
31013
31014 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31015 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
31016 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31017
31018 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
31019
31020 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
31021 @findex -gdb-exit
31022
31023 @subsubheading Synopsis
31024
31025 @smallexample
31026 -gdb-exit
31027 @end smallexample
31028
31029 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
31030
31031 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31032
31033 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
31034
31035 @subsubheading Example
31036
31037 @smallexample
31038 (gdb)
31039 -gdb-exit
31040 ^exit
31041 @end smallexample
31042
31043
31044 @ignore
31045 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
31046 @findex -exec-abort
31047
31048 @subsubheading Synopsis
31049
31050 @smallexample
31051 -exec-abort
31052 @end smallexample
31053
31054 Kill the inferior running program.
31055
31056 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31057
31058 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
31059
31060 @subsubheading Example
31061 N.A.
31062 @end ignore
31063
31064
31065 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
31066 @findex -gdb-set
31067
31068 @subsubheading Synopsis
31069
31070 @smallexample
31071 -gdb-set
31072 @end smallexample
31073
31074 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
31075 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
31076
31077 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31078
31079 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
31080
31081 @subsubheading Example
31082
31083 @smallexample
31084 (gdb)
31085 -gdb-set $foo=3
31086 ^done
31087 (gdb)
31088 @end smallexample
31089
31090
31091 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31092 @findex -gdb-show
31093
31094 @subsubheading Synopsis
31095
31096 @smallexample
31097 -gdb-show
31098 @end smallexample
31099
31100 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
31101
31102 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31103
31104 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
31105
31106 @subsubheading Example
31107
31108 @smallexample
31109 (gdb)
31110 -gdb-show annotate
31111 ^done,value="0"
31112 (gdb)
31113 @end smallexample
31114
31115 @c @subheading -gdb-source
31116
31117
31118 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
31119 @findex -gdb-version
31120
31121 @subsubheading Synopsis
31122
31123 @smallexample
31124 -gdb-version
31125 @end smallexample
31126
31127 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
31128
31129 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31130
31131 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
31132 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
31133
31134 @subsubheading Example
31135
31136 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
31137 @c box in TeX.
31138 @smallexample
31139 (gdb)
31140 -gdb-version
31141 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
31142 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31143 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
31144 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
31145 ~ certain conditions.
31146 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31147 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
31148 ~ details.
31149 ~This GDB was configured as
31150 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
31151 ^done
31152 (gdb)
31153 @end smallexample
31154
31155 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
31156 @findex -list-thread-groups
31157
31158 @subheading Synopsis
31159
31160 @smallexample
31161 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
31162 @end smallexample
31163
31164 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
31165 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
31166 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
31167 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
31168 top-level thread groups.
31169
31170 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
31171 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
31172 available on the target.
31173
31174 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
31175 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
31176 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
31177 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
31178 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
31179 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
31180 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
31181 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
31182
31183 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
31184 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
31185 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
31186 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
31187 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
31188 @samp{threads} field.
31189
31190 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
31191 the following caveats:
31192
31193 @itemize @bullet
31194 @item
31195 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
31196 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
31197 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
31198
31199 @item
31200 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
31201 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
31202 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
31203 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
31204 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
31205 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
31206
31207 @end itemize
31208
31209 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
31210 have the following fields:
31211
31212 @table @code
31213 @item id
31214 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
31215 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
31216 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
31217
31218 @item type
31219 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
31220 valid type.
31221
31222 @item pid
31223 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
31224 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
31225
31226 @item exit-code
31227 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
31228 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
31229 only if the process is not running.
31230
31231 @item num_children
31232 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
31233 absent for an available thread group.
31234
31235 @item threads
31236 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
31237 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
31238 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
31239
31240 @item cores
31241 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
31242 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
31243 such information is not available.
31244
31245 @item executable
31246 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
31247 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
31248 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
31249
31250 @end table
31251
31252 @subheading Example
31253
31254 @smallexample
31255 @value{GDBP}
31256 -list-thread-groups
31257 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
31258 -list-thread-groups 17
31259 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
31260 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
31261 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
31262 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
31263 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
31264 -list-thread-groups --available
31265 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
31266 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
31267 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31268 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31269 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
31270 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
31271 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31272 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31273 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
31274 @end smallexample
31275
31276 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
31277 @findex -info-os
31278
31279 @subsubheading Synopsis
31280
31281 @smallexample
31282 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
31283 @end smallexample
31284
31285 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
31286 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
31287 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
31288 of data of that type.
31289
31290 The types of information available depend on the target operating
31291 system.
31292
31293 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31294
31295 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
31296
31297 @subsubheading Example
31298
31299 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
31300 like this:
31301
31302 @smallexample
31303 @value{GDBP}
31304 -info-os
31305 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="9",nr_cols="3",
31306 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
31307 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
31308 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
31309 body=[item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
31310 col2="Processes"@},
31311 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
31312 col2="Process groups"@},
31313 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
31314 col2="Threads"@},
31315 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
31316 col2="File descriptors"@},
31317 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
31318 col2="Sockets"@},
31319 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
31320 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
31321 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
31322 col2="Semaphores"@},
31323 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
31324 col2="Message queues"@},
31325 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
31326 col2="Kernel modules"@}]@}
31327 @value{GDBP}
31328 -info-os processes
31329 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
31330 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
31331 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
31332 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
31333 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
31334 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
31335 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
31336 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
31337 ...
31338 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
31339 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
31340 (gdb)
31341 @end smallexample
31342
31343 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
31344 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
31345 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
31346 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
31347 @code{info os} omits it.)
31348
31349 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
31350 @findex -add-inferior
31351
31352 @subheading Synopsis
31353
31354 @smallexample
31355 -add-inferior
31356 @end smallexample
31357
31358 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
31359 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
31360 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
31361 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
31362 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
31363 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
31364
31365 @subheading Example
31366
31367 @smallexample
31368 @value{GDBP}
31369 -add-inferior
31370 ^done,inferior="i3"
31371 @end smallexample
31372
31373 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
31374 @findex -interpreter-exec
31375
31376 @subheading Synopsis
31377
31378 @smallexample
31379 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
31380 @end smallexample
31381 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
31382
31383 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
31384
31385 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31386
31387 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
31388
31389 @subheading Example
31390
31391 @smallexample
31392 (gdb)
31393 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
31394 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
31395 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
31396 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
31397 ^done
31398 (gdb)
31399 @end smallexample
31400
31401 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
31402 @findex -inferior-tty-set
31403
31404 @subheading Synopsis
31405
31406 @smallexample
31407 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31408 @end smallexample
31409
31410 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
31411
31412 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31413
31414 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
31415
31416 @subheading Example
31417
31418 @smallexample
31419 (gdb)
31420 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31421 ^done
31422 (gdb)
31423 @end smallexample
31424
31425 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
31426 @findex -inferior-tty-show
31427
31428 @subheading Synopsis
31429
31430 @smallexample
31431 -inferior-tty-show
31432 @end smallexample
31433
31434 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
31435
31436 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31437
31438 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
31439
31440 @subheading Example
31441
31442 @smallexample
31443 (gdb)
31444 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31445 ^done
31446 (gdb)
31447 -inferior-tty-show
31448 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
31449 (gdb)
31450 @end smallexample
31451
31452 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
31453 @findex -enable-timings
31454
31455 @subheading Synopsis
31456
31457 @smallexample
31458 -enable-timings [yes | no]
31459 @end smallexample
31460
31461 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
31462 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
31463 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
31464 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
31465
31466 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31467
31468 No equivalent.
31469
31470 @subheading Example
31471
31472 @smallexample
31473 (gdb)
31474 -enable-timings
31475 ^done
31476 (gdb)
31477 -break-insert main
31478 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
31479 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
31480 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
31481 times="0"@},
31482 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
31483 (gdb)
31484 -enable-timings no
31485 ^done
31486 (gdb)
31487 -exec-run
31488 ^running
31489 (gdb)
31490 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
31491 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
31492 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
31493 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
31494 (gdb)
31495 @end smallexample
31496
31497 @node Annotations
31498 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
31499
31500 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
31501 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
31502 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
31503 relatively high level.
31504
31505 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
31506 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
31507
31508 @ignore
31509 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
31510 @end ignore
31511
31512 @menu
31513 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
31514 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
31515 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
31516 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
31517 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
31518 * Annotations for Running::
31519 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
31520 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
31521 @end menu
31522
31523 @node Annotations Overview
31524 @section What is an Annotation?
31525 @cindex annotations
31526
31527 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
31528 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
31529 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
31530 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
31531 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
31532 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
31533 cannot contain newline characters.
31534
31535 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
31536 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
31537 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
31538 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
31539 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
31540 means those three characters as output.
31541
31542 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
31543 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
31544 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
31545 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
31546 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
31547 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
31548 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
31549 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
31550 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
31551
31552 @table @code
31553 @kindex set annotate
31554 @item set annotate @var{level}
31555 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
31556 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
31557
31558 @item show annotate
31559 @kindex show annotate
31560 Show the current annotation level.
31561 @end table
31562
31563 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
31564
31565 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
31566
31567 @smallexample
31568 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
31569 GNU gdb 6.0
31570 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31571 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
31572 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
31573 under certain conditions.
31574 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31575 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
31576 for details.
31577 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
31578
31579 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31580 (@value{GDBP})
31581 ^Z^Zprompt
31582 @kbd{quit}
31583
31584 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31585 $
31586 @end smallexample
31587
31588 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
31589 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
31590 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
31591 output from @value{GDBN}.
31592
31593 @node Server Prefix
31594 @section The Server Prefix
31595 @cindex server prefix
31596
31597 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
31598 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
31599 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
31600 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
31601 a transparent manner.
31602
31603 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
31604 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
31605 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
31606 @code{print} command.
31607
31608 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
31609 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
31610
31611 @node Prompting
31612 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
31613
31614 @cindex annotations for prompts
31615 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
31616 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
31617 over, etc.
31618
31619 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
31620 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
31621 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
31622 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
31623 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
31624 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
31625 features the following annotations:
31626
31627 @smallexample
31628 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31629 ^Z^Zprompt
31630 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31631 @end smallexample
31632
31633 The input types are
31634
31635 @table @code
31636 @findex pre-prompt annotation
31637 @findex prompt annotation
31638 @findex post-prompt annotation
31639 @item prompt
31640 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
31641
31642 @findex pre-commands annotation
31643 @findex commands annotation
31644 @findex post-commands annotation
31645 @item commands
31646 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
31647 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
31648
31649 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
31650 @findex overload-choice annotation
31651 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
31652 @item overload-choice
31653 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
31654
31655 @findex pre-query annotation
31656 @findex query annotation
31657 @findex post-query annotation
31658 @item query
31659 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
31660
31661 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
31662 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
31663 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
31664 @item prompt-for-continue
31665 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
31666 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
31667 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
31668 presence of annotations.
31669 @end table
31670
31671 @node Errors
31672 @section Errors
31673 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
31674
31675 @findex quit annotation
31676 @smallexample
31677 ^Z^Zquit
31678 @end smallexample
31679
31680 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
31681
31682 @findex error annotation
31683 @smallexample
31684 ^Z^Zerror
31685 @end smallexample
31686
31687 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
31688
31689 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
31690 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
31691 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
31692 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
31693 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
31694 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
31695 to the top level.
31696
31697 @findex error-begin annotation
31698 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
31699
31700 @smallexample
31701 ^Z^Zerror-begin
31702 @end smallexample
31703
31704 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
31705 message.
31706
31707 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
31708 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
31709 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
31710
31711 @node Invalidation
31712 @section Invalidation Notices
31713
31714 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
31715 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
31716 changed.
31717
31718 @table @code
31719 @findex frames-invalid annotation
31720 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
31721
31722 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
31723 have changed.
31724
31725 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
31726 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
31727
31728 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
31729 deleted a breakpoint.
31730 @end table
31731
31732 @node Annotations for Running
31733 @section Running the Program
31734 @cindex annotations for running programs
31735
31736 @findex starting annotation
31737 @findex stopping annotation
31738 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
31739 @code{step} or @code{continue},
31740
31741 @smallexample
31742 ^Z^Zstarting
31743 @end smallexample
31744
31745 is output. When the program stops,
31746
31747 @smallexample
31748 ^Z^Zstopped
31749 @end smallexample
31750
31751 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
31752 annotations describe how the program stopped.
31753
31754 @table @code
31755 @findex exited annotation
31756 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
31757 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
31758 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
31759
31760 @findex signalled annotation
31761 @findex signal-name annotation
31762 @findex signal-name-end annotation
31763 @findex signal-string annotation
31764 @findex signal-string-end annotation
31765 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
31766 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
31767 annotation continues:
31768
31769 @smallexample
31770 @var{intro-text}
31771 ^Z^Zsignal-name
31772 @var{name}
31773 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
31774 @var{middle-text}
31775 ^Z^Zsignal-string
31776 @var{string}
31777 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
31778 @var{end-text}
31779 @end smallexample
31780
31781 @noindent
31782 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
31783 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
31784 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
31785 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
31786 user's benefit and have no particular format.
31787
31788 @findex signal annotation
31789 @item ^Z^Zsignal
31790 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
31791 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
31792 terminated with it.
31793
31794 @findex breakpoint annotation
31795 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
31796 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
31797
31798 @findex watchpoint annotation
31799 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
31800 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
31801 @end table
31802
31803 @node Source Annotations
31804 @section Displaying Source
31805 @cindex annotations for source display
31806
31807 @findex source annotation
31808 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
31809
31810 @smallexample
31811 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
31812 @end smallexample
31813
31814 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
31815 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
31816 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
31817 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
31818 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
31819 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
31820 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
31821 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
31822 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
31823 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
31824 depend on the language).
31825
31826 @node JIT Interface
31827 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
31828 @cindex just-in-time compilation
31829 @cindex JIT compilation interface
31830
31831 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
31832 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
31833 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
31834 performance while maintaining platform independence.
31835
31836 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
31837 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
31838 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
31839 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
31840 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
31841 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
31842
31843 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
31844 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
31845 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
31846 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
31847 LLVM JIT.
31848
31849 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
31850 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
31851 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
31852 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
31853 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
31854 out about additional code.
31855
31856 @menu
31857 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
31858 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
31859 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
31860 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
31861 @end menu
31862
31863 @node Declarations
31864 @section JIT Declarations
31865
31866 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
31867 implement the interface:
31868
31869 @smallexample
31870 typedef enum
31871 @{
31872 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
31873 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
31874 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
31875 @} jit_actions_t;
31876
31877 struct jit_code_entry
31878 @{
31879 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
31880 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
31881 const char *symfile_addr;
31882 uint64_t symfile_size;
31883 @};
31884
31885 struct jit_descriptor
31886 @{
31887 uint32_t version;
31888 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
31889 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
31890 uint32_t action_flag;
31891 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
31892 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
31893 @};
31894
31895 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
31896 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
31897
31898 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
31899 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
31900 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
31901 @end smallexample
31902
31903 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
31904 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
31905 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
31906
31907 @node Registering Code
31908 @section Registering Code
31909
31910 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
31911
31912 @itemize @bullet
31913 @item
31914 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
31915 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
31916
31917 @item
31918 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
31919 file.
31920
31921 @item
31922 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
31923
31924 @item
31925 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
31926
31927 @item
31928 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
31929 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
31930 @end itemize
31931
31932 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
31933 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
31934 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
31935 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
31936
31937 @node Unregistering Code
31938 @section Unregistering Code
31939
31940 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
31941
31942 @itemize @bullet
31943 @item
31944 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
31945
31946 @item
31947 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
31948
31949 @item
31950 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
31951 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
31952 @end itemize
31953
31954 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
31955 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
31956
31957 @node Custom Debug Info
31958 @section Custom Debug Info
31959 @cindex custom JIT debug info
31960 @cindex JIT debug info reader
31961
31962 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
31963 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
31964 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
31965 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
31966 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
31967 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
31968 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
31969 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
31970 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
31971
31972 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
31973 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
31974 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
31975 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
31976 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
31977 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
31978 compiler.
31979
31980 @menu
31981 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
31982 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
31983 @end menu
31984
31985 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
31986 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
31987 @kindex jit-reader-load
31988 @kindex jit-reader-unload
31989
31990 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
31991 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
31992
31993 @table @code
31994 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
31995 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
31996 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
31997 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
31998 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
31999 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
32000 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
32001
32002 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
32003 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
32004 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
32005 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
32006 @code{jit-reader-load}.
32007
32008 @item jit-reader-unload
32009 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
32010
32011 @end table
32012
32013 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32014 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32015 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
32016
32017 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
32018 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
32019
32020 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
32021 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
32022 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
32023 the system include directory.
32024
32025 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
32026 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
32027 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
32028
32029 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
32030 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
32031
32032 @findex gdb_init_reader
32033 @smallexample
32034 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
32035 @end smallexample
32036
32037 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
32038
32039 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
32040 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
32041 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
32042 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
32043 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
32044 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
32045
32046 @smallexample
32047 struct gdb_reader_funcs
32048 @{
32049 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
32050 int reader_version;
32051
32052 /* For use by the reader. */
32053 void *priv_data;
32054
32055 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
32056 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
32057 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
32058 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
32059 @};
32060 @end smallexample
32061
32062 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
32063 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
32064
32065 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
32066 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
32067 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
32068 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
32069 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
32070 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
32071 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
32072 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
32073 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
32074 target's address space.
32075
32076 @node In-Process Agent
32077 @chapter In-Process Agent
32078 @cindex debugging agent
32079 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
32080 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
32081 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
32082 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
32083 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
32084 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
32085 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
32086 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
32087 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
32088 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
32089 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
32090 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
32091 behavior without interrupting it.
32092
32093 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
32094 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
32095 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
32096 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
32097 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
32098 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
32099 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
32100 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
32101 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
32102
32103 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
32104 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
32105 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
32106 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
32107
32108 @anchor{Control Agent}
32109 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
32110 debugging with the following commands:
32111
32112 @table @code
32113 @kindex set agent on
32114 @item set agent on
32115 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
32116 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
32117 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
32118 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
32119 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
32120 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
32121
32122 @kindex set agent off
32123 @item set agent off
32124 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
32125 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
32126
32127 @kindex show agent
32128 @item show agent
32129 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
32130 the in-process agent.
32131 @end table
32132
32133 @menu
32134 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
32135 @end menu
32136
32137 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
32138 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
32139 @cindex in-process agent protocol
32140
32141 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
32142 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
32143 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
32144 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
32145 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
32146 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
32147 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
32148 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
32149 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
32150
32151 @menu
32152 * IPA Protocol Objects::
32153 * IPA Protocol Commands::
32154 @end menu
32155
32156 @node IPA Protocol Objects
32157 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
32158 @cindex ipa protocol objects
32159
32160 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
32161 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
32162
32163 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
32164 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
32165 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
32166 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
32167
32168 @enumerate
32169 @item
32170 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
32171 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
32172 @item
32173 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
32174 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
32175 the other one.
32176 @end enumerate
32177
32178 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
32179
32180 @enumerate
32181 @item
32182 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
32183 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
32184 @anchor{agent expression object}
32185 @item
32186 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
32187 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
32188 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
32189 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
32190 @item
32191 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
32192 @anchor{tracepoint object}
32193
32194 @end enumerate
32195
32196 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
32197 object:
32198
32199 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
32200 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
32201 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
32202 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
32203 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
32204 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
32205 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32206 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
32207 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
32208 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
32209 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
32210 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
32211 memory address for collecting.
32212 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
32213 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32214 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
32215 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32216 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
32217 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32218 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
32219 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
32220 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
32221 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
32222 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
32223 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
32224 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
32225 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
32226 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
32227 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
32228 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
32229 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
32230 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
32231 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
32232 @ref{agent expression object}
32233 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
32234 @ref{agent expression object}
32235 @item actions @tab variable
32236 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
32237 @end multitable
32238
32239 @node IPA Protocol Commands
32240 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
32241 @cindex ipa protocol commands
32242
32243 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
32244 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
32245
32246 @table @samp
32247
32248 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
32249 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
32250 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
32251 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
32252 in IPA finally.
32253
32254 Replies:
32255 @table @samp
32256 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
32257 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
32258 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
32259 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
32260 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
32261 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
32262 @item E @var{NN}
32263 for an error
32264
32265 @end table
32266
32267 @item close
32268 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
32269 is about to kill inferiors.
32270
32271 @item qTfSTM
32272 @xref{qTfSTM}.
32273 @item qTsSTM
32274 @xref{qTsSTM}.
32275 @item qTSTMat
32276 @xref{qTSTMat}.
32277 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
32278 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
32279
32280 Replies:
32281 @table @samp
32282 @item E @var{NN}
32283 for an error
32284 @end table
32285 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
32286 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
32287 @end table
32288
32289 @node GDB Bugs
32290 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
32291 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
32292 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
32293
32294 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
32295
32296 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
32297 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
32298 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
32299 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
32300
32301 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
32302 information that enables us to fix the bug.
32303
32304 @menu
32305 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
32306 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
32307 @end menu
32308
32309 @node Bug Criteria
32310 @section Have You Found a Bug?
32311 @cindex bug criteria
32312
32313 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
32314
32315 @itemize @bullet
32316 @cindex fatal signal
32317 @cindex debugger crash
32318 @cindex crash of debugger
32319 @item
32320 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
32321 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
32322
32323 @cindex error on valid input
32324 @item
32325 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
32326 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
32327 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
32328
32329 @cindex invalid input
32330 @item
32331 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
32332 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
32333 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
32334 for traditional practice''.
32335
32336 @item
32337 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
32338 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
32339 @end itemize
32340
32341 @node Bug Reporting
32342 @section How to Report Bugs
32343 @cindex bug reports
32344 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
32345
32346 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
32347 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
32348 contact that organization first.
32349
32350 You can find contact information for many support companies and
32351 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
32352 distribution.
32353 @c should add a web page ref...
32354
32355 @ifset BUGURL
32356 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
32357 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32358 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
32359 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
32360 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
32361 be used.
32362
32363 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
32364 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
32365 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
32366 @samp{bug-gdb}.
32367
32368 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
32369 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
32370 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
32371 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
32372 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
32373 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
32374 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
32375 bug reports to the mailing list.
32376 @end ifset
32377 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
32378 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32379 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
32380 @end ifclear
32381 @end ifset
32382
32383 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
32384 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
32385 fact or leave it out, state it!
32386
32387 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
32388 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
32389 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
32390 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
32391 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
32392 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
32393 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
32394 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
32395 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
32396
32397 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
32398 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
32399 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
32400 self-contained.
32401
32402 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
32403 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
32404 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
32405 bugs properly.
32406
32407 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
32408
32409 @itemize @bullet
32410 @item
32411 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
32412 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
32413 version}.
32414
32415 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
32416 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
32417
32418 @item
32419 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
32420 version number.
32421
32422 @item
32423 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
32424 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
32425 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
32426 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
32427
32428 @item
32429 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
32430 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
32431
32432 @item
32433 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
32434 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
32435 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
32436 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
32437 those compilers.
32438
32439 @item
32440 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
32441 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
32442 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
32443 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
32444
32445 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
32446 and then we might not encounter the bug.
32447
32448 @item
32449 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
32450 reproduce the bug.
32451
32452 @item
32453 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
32454 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
32455
32456 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
32457 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
32458 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
32459 a chance to make a mistake.
32460
32461 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
32462 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
32463 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
32464 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
32465 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
32466 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
32467 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
32468 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
32469
32470 @pindex script
32471 @cindex recording a session script
32472 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
32473 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
32474 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
32475 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
32476
32477 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
32478 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
32479
32480 @item
32481 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
32482 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
32483 it by context, not by line number.
32484
32485 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
32486 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
32487
32488 @end itemize
32489
32490 Here are some things that are not necessary:
32491
32492 @itemize @bullet
32493 @item
32494 A description of the envelope of the bug.
32495
32496 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
32497 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
32498 changes will not affect it.
32499
32500 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
32501 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
32502 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
32503 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
32504
32505 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
32506 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
32507 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
32508 less time, and so on.
32509
32510 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
32511 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
32512
32513 @item
32514 A patch for the bug.
32515
32516 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
32517 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
32518 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
32519 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
32520
32521 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
32522 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
32523 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
32524 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
32525
32526 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
32527 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
32528 help us to understand.
32529
32530 @item
32531 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
32532
32533 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
32534 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
32535 @end itemize
32536
32537 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
32538 @c and consists of the two following files:
32539 @c rluser.texi
32540 @c hsuser.texi
32541 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
32542 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
32543 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
32544 @include rluser.texi
32545 @include hsuser.texi
32546 @end ifclear
32547
32548 @node In Memoriam
32549 @appendix In Memoriam
32550
32551 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
32552 contributors:
32553
32554 @table @code
32555 @item Fred Fish
32556 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
32557 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
32558 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
32559
32560 @item Michael Snyder
32561 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
32562 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
32563 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
32564 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
32565 @end table
32566
32567 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
32568 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
32569
32570 @node Formatting Documentation
32571 @appendix Formatting Documentation
32572
32573 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
32574 @cindex reference card
32575 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
32576 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
32577 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
32578 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
32579 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
32580 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
32581
32582 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
32583 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
32584
32585 @smallexample
32586 make refcard.dvi
32587 @end smallexample
32588
32589 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
32590 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
32591 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
32592 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
32593 your @sc{dvi} output program.
32594
32595 @cindex documentation
32596
32597 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
32598 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
32599 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
32600 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
32601 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
32602 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
32603
32604 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
32605 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
32606 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
32607 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
32608 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
32609 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
32610 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
32611 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
32612
32613 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
32614 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
32615 @code{makeinfo}.
32616
32617 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
32618 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
32619 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
32620
32621 @smallexample
32622 cd gdb
32623 make gdb.info
32624 @end smallexample
32625
32626 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
32627 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
32628 Texinfo definitions file.
32629
32630 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
32631 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
32632 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
32633 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
32634 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
32635 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
32636 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
32637
32638 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
32639 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
32640 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
32641 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
32642 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
32643 directory.
32644
32645 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
32646 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
32647 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
32648 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
32649
32650 @smallexample
32651 make gdb.dvi
32652 @end smallexample
32653
32654 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
32655
32656 @node Installing GDB
32657 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
32658 @cindex installation
32659
32660 @menu
32661 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
32662 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
32663 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
32664 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
32665 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
32666 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
32667 @end menu
32668
32669 @node Requirements
32670 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
32671 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
32672
32673 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
32674 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
32675
32676 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
32677 @table @asis
32678 @item ISO C90 compiler
32679 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
32680 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
32681
32682 @end table
32683
32684 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
32685 @table @asis
32686 @item Expat
32687 @anchor{Expat}
32688 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
32689 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
32690 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
32691 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
32692 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
32693 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
32694
32695 Expat is used for:
32696
32697 @itemize @bullet
32698 @item
32699 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
32700 @item
32701 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
32702 @item
32703 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
32704 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
32705 @item
32706 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
32707 @item
32708 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
32709 @item
32710 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format})
32711 @end itemize
32712
32713 @item zlib
32714 @cindex compressed debug sections
32715 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
32716 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
32717 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
32718 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
32719 information in such binaries.
32720
32721 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
32722 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
32723 @url{http://zlib.net}.
32724
32725 @item iconv
32726 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
32727 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
32728 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
32729 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
32730
32731 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
32732 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
32733 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
32734 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
32735
32736 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
32737 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
32738 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
32739
32740 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
32741 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
32742 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
32743 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
32744 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
32745 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
32746 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
32747 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
32748 @end table
32749
32750 @node Running Configure
32751 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
32752 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
32753 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
32754 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
32755 build the @code{gdb} program.
32756 @iftex
32757 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
32758 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
32759 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
32760 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
32761 @end iftex
32762
32763 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
32764 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
32765 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
32766
32767 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
32768 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
32769
32770 @table @code
32771 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
32772 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
32773
32774 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
32775 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
32776
32777 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
32778 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
32779
32780 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
32781 @sc{gnu} include files
32782
32783 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
32784 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
32785
32786 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
32787 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
32788
32789 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
32790 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
32791
32792 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
32793 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
32794
32795 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
32796 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
32797 @end table
32798
32799 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
32800 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
32801 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
32802
32803 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
32804 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
32805 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
32806 argument.
32807
32808 For example:
32809
32810 @smallexample
32811 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32812 ./configure @var{host}
32813 make
32814 @end smallexample
32815
32816 @noindent
32817 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
32818 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
32819 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
32820 correct value by examining your system.)
32821
32822 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
32823 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
32824 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
32825 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
32826
32827 @need 750
32828 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
32829 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
32830 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
32831
32832 @smallexample
32833 sh configure @var{host}
32834 @end smallexample
32835
32836 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
32837 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
32838 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
32839 @file{configure}
32840 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
32841 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
32842
32843 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
32844 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
32845 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
32846 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
32847 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
32848 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
32849 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
32850 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
32851 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32852
32853 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
32854 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
32855 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
32856 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
32857 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
32858
32859 @node Separate Objdir
32860 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
32861
32862 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
32863 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
32864 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
32865 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
32866 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
32867 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
32868 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
32869 program specified there.
32870
32871 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
32872 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
32873 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
32874 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
32875 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
32876 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
32877
32878 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
32879 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
32880
32881 @smallexample
32882 @group
32883 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32884 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
32885 cd ../gdb-sun4
32886 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
32887 make
32888 @end group
32889 @end smallexample
32890
32891 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
32892 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
32893 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
32894 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
32895 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
32896 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
32897
32898 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
32899 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
32900 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
32901 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
32902 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32903
32904 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
32905 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
32906 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
32907 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
32908 You specify a cross-debugging target by
32909 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
32910
32911 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
32912 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
32913 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
32914
32915 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
32916 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
32917 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
32918 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
32919 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
32920
32921 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
32922 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
32923 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
32924 with each other.
32925
32926 @node Config Names
32927 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
32928
32929 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
32930 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
32931 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
32932 of information in the following pattern:
32933
32934 @smallexample
32935 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
32936 @end smallexample
32937
32938 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
32939 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
32940 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
32941
32942 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
32943 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
32944 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
32945 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
32946 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
32947 abbreviations---for example:
32948
32949 @smallexample
32950 % sh config.sub i386-linux
32951 i386-pc-linux-gnu
32952 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
32953 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
32954 % sh config.sub hp9k700
32955 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
32956 % sh config.sub sun4
32957 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
32958 % sh config.sub sun3
32959 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
32960 % sh config.sub i986v
32961 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
32962 @end smallexample
32963
32964 @noindent
32965 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
32966 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
32967
32968 @node Configure Options
32969 @section @file{configure} Options
32970
32971 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
32972 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
32973 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
32974 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
32975
32976 @smallexample
32977 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
32978 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
32979 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
32980 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
32981 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
32982 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
32983 @var{host}
32984 @end smallexample
32985
32986 @noindent
32987 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
32988 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
32989 @samp{--}.
32990
32991 @table @code
32992 @item --help
32993 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
32994
32995 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
32996 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
32997 @file{@var{dir}}.
32998
32999 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
33000 Configure the source to install programs under directory
33001 @file{@var{dir}}.
33002
33003 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
33004 @need 2000
33005 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
33006 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
33007 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
33008 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
33009 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
33010 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
33011 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
33012 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
33013 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
33014 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
33015 @var{dirname}.
33016
33017 @item --norecursion
33018 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
33019 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
33020
33021 @item --target=@var{target}
33022 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
33023 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
33024 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
33025
33026 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
33027
33028 @item @var{host} @dots{}
33029 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
33030
33031 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
33032 @end table
33033
33034 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
33035 needed for special purposes only.
33036
33037 @node System-wide configuration
33038 @section System-wide configuration and settings
33039 @cindex system-wide init file
33040
33041 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
33042 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
33043 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
33044
33045 Here is the corresponding configure option:
33046
33047 @table @code
33048 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
33049 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
33050 @var{file}.
33051 @end table
33052
33053 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
33054 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
33055
33056 @itemize @bullet
33057 @item
33058 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
33059 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
33060 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
33061 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
33062 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
33063 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
33064
33065 @item
33066 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
33067 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
33068 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33069 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33070 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
33071 @end itemize
33072
33073 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
33074 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
33075 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
33076 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
33077 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
33078 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
33079 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
33080 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
33081 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
33082 reread.
33083
33084 @menu
33085 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33086 @end menu
33087
33088 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
33089 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33090 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
33091
33092 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
33093 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
33094 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
33095 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
33096 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
33097 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
33098
33099 The following scripts are currently available:
33100 @itemize @bullet
33101
33102 @item @file{elinos.py}
33103 @pindex elinos.py
33104 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
33105 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
33106 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
33107 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
33108 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
33109 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
33110
33111 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
33112 @pindex wrs-linux.py
33113 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
33114 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
33115 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
33116 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
33117
33118 @end itemize
33119
33120 @node Maintenance Commands
33121 @appendix Maintenance Commands
33122 @cindex maintenance commands
33123 @cindex internal commands
33124
33125 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
33126 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
33127 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
33128 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
33129 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
33130
33131 @table @code
33132 @kindex maint agent
33133 @kindex maint agent-eval
33134 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33135 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33136 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
33137 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
33138 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
33139 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
33140 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
33141 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
33142 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
33143 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
33144 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
33145 addition and return the sum.
33146 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
33147 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
33148
33149 @kindex maint agent-printf
33150 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
33151 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
33152 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
33153 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
33154 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
33155
33156 @kindex maint info breakpoints
33157 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
33158 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
33159 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
33160 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
33161 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
33162 is shown:
33163
33164 @table @code
33165 @item breakpoint
33166 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
33167
33168 @item watchpoint
33169 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
33170
33171 @item longjmp
33172 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
33173 @code{longjmp} calls.
33174
33175 @item longjmp resume
33176 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
33177
33178 @item until
33179 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
33180
33181 @item finish
33182 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
33183
33184 @item shlib events
33185 Shared library events.
33186
33187 @end table
33188
33189 @kindex maint info bfds
33190 @item maint info bfds
33191 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
33192 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Top, , BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.
33193
33194 @kindex set displaced-stepping
33195 @kindex show displaced-stepping
33196 @cindex displaced stepping support
33197 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
33198 @item set displaced-stepping
33199 @itemx show displaced-stepping
33200 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
33201 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
33202 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
33203 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
33204 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
33205
33206 @table @code
33207 @item set displaced-stepping on
33208 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
33209 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
33210
33211 @item set displaced-stepping off
33212 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
33213 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
33214
33215 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
33216 @item set displaced-stepping auto
33217 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
33218 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
33219 architecture supports displaced stepping.
33220 @end table
33221
33222 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
33223 @item maint check-psymtabs
33224 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
33225 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
33226
33227 @kindex maint check-symtabs
33228 @item maint check-symtabs
33229 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
33230
33231 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
33232 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
33233 Expand symbol tables.
33234 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
33235 names matching @var{regexp}.
33236
33237 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
33238 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33239 @cindex demangler crashes
33240 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
33241 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33242 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
33243 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
33244 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
33245 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
33246 option to terminate the current session.
33247
33248 @kindex maint cplus first_component
33249 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
33250 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
33251
33252 @kindex maint cplus namespace
33253 @item maint cplus namespace
33254 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
33255
33256 @kindex maint demangle
33257 @item maint demangle @var{name}
33258 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
33259
33260 @kindex maint deprecate
33261 @kindex maint undeprecate
33262 @cindex deprecated commands
33263 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
33264 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
33265 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
33266 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
33267 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
33268 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
33269 the replacement as part of the warning.
33270
33271 @kindex maint dump-me
33272 @item maint dump-me
33273 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
33274 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
33275 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
33276 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
33277
33278 @kindex maint internal-error
33279 @kindex maint internal-warning
33280 @kindex maint demangler-warning
33281 @cindex demangler crashes
33282 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33283 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33284 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33285
33286 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
33287 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
33288 as though an internal problam has been detected. In addition to
33289 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
33290 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
33291 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
33292 @value{GDBN} session.
33293
33294 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
33295 used as the text of the error or warning message.
33296
33297 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
33298
33299 @smallexample
33300 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
33301 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
33302 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
33303 debugging may prove unreliable.
33304 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33305 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33306 (@value{GDBP})
33307 @end smallexample
33308
33309 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
33310 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
33311 @cindex demangler crashes
33312
33313 @kindex maint set internal-error
33314 @kindex maint show internal-error
33315 @kindex maint set internal-warning
33316 @kindex maint show internal-warning
33317 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
33318 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
33319 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33320 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
33321 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33322 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
33323 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33324 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
33325 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
33326 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
33327 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
33328 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
33329 described in the table below.
33330
33331 @table @samp
33332 @item quit
33333 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33334 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
33335
33336 @item corefile
33337 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33338 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
33339 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
33340 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
33341 disabled.
33342 @end table
33343
33344 @kindex maint packet
33345 @item maint packet @var{text}
33346 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
33347 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
33348 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
33349 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
33350 checksum.
33351
33352 @kindex maint print architecture
33353 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33354 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
33355 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
33356
33357 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
33358 @item maint print c-tdesc
33359 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
33360 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
33361 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
33362
33363 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
33364 @item maint print dummy-frames
33365 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
33366
33367 @smallexample
33368 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
33369 @dots{}
33370 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
33371 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
33372 58 return (a + b);
33373 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
33374 @dots{}
33375 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
33376 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
33377 (@value{GDBP})
33378 @end smallexample
33379
33380 Takes an optional file parameter.
33381
33382 @kindex maint print registers
33383 @kindex maint print raw-registers
33384 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
33385 @kindex maint print register-groups
33386 @kindex maint print remote-registers
33387 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33388 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33389 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33390 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33391 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33392 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
33393
33394 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
33395 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
33396 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
33397 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
33398 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
33399 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
33400 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
33401 and offsets in the `G' packets.
33402
33403 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
33404 write the information.
33405
33406 @kindex maint print reggroups
33407 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33408 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
33409 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
33410 information.
33411
33412 The register groups info looks like this:
33413
33414 @smallexample
33415 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
33416 Group Type
33417 general user
33418 float user
33419 all user
33420 vector user
33421 system user
33422 save internal
33423 restore internal
33424 @end smallexample
33425
33426 @kindex flushregs
33427 @item flushregs
33428 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
33429
33430 @kindex maint print objfiles
33431 @cindex info for known object files
33432 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
33433 Print a dump of all known object files.
33434 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
33435 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
33436 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
33437
33438 @kindex maint print section-scripts
33439 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
33440 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
33441 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
33442 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
33443 matching @var{regexp}.
33444 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
33445 and the full path if known.
33446 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
33447
33448 @kindex maint print statistics
33449 @cindex bcache statistics
33450 @item maint print statistics
33451 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
33452 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
33453 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
33454 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
33455 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
33456 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
33457 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
33458 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
33459 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
33460 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
33461 lengths.
33462
33463 @kindex maint print target-stack
33464 @cindex target stack description
33465 @item maint print target-stack
33466 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
33467 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
33468 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
33469 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
33470 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
33471 address.
33472
33473 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
33474 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
33475
33476 @kindex maint print type
33477 @cindex type chain of a data type
33478 @item maint print type @var{expr}
33479 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
33480 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
33481 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
33482 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
33483 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
33484
33485 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33486 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33487 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
33488 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
33489 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
33490 information.
33491
33492 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
33493 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
33494 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
33495 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
33496 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
33497 always see the disassembly form.
33498
33499 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
33500
33501 @smallexample
33502 (gdb) info addr argc
33503 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
33504 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
33505 @end smallexample
33506
33507 For more information on these expressions, see
33508 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
33509
33510 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33511 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33512 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
33513 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
33514 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
33515
33516 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
33517 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
33518 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
33519 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
33520 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
33521 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
33522 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
33523 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
33524 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
33525
33526 @kindex maint set profile
33527 @kindex maint show profile
33528 @cindex profiling GDB
33529 @item maint set profile
33530 @itemx maint show profile
33531 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
33532
33533 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
33534 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
33535 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
33536 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
33537 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
33538 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
33539 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
33540
33541 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
33542 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
33543
33544 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
33545 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
33546 @cindex hardware debug registers
33547 @item maint set show-debug-regs
33548 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
33549 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
33550 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
33551 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
33552 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
33553 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
33554
33555 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
33556 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
33557 @item maint set show-all-tib
33558 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
33559 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
33560 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
33561 command.
33562
33563 @kindex maint set target-async
33564 @kindex maint show target-async
33565 @item maint set target-async
33566 @itemx maint show target-async
33567 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
33568 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
33569 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
33570 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
33571
33572 @kindex maint set per-command
33573 @kindex maint show per-command
33574 @item maint set per-command
33575 @itemx maint show per-command
33576 @cindex resources used by commands
33577
33578 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
33579 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
33580
33581 @table @code
33582 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
33583 @itemx maint show per-command space
33584 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
33585 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
33586 took, following the command's own output.
33587 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
33588 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
33589
33590 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
33591 @itemx maint show per-command time
33592 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
33593 for each command.
33594 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
33595 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
33596 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
33597 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
33598 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
33599 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
33600 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
33601 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
33602 spent by the program been debugged.
33603 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
33604 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
33605
33606 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
33607 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
33608 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
33609 for each command.
33610 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
33611
33612 @enumerate a
33613 @item
33614 number of symbol tables
33615 @item
33616 number of primary symbol tables
33617 @item
33618 number of blocks in the blockvector
33619 @end enumerate
33620 @end table
33621
33622 @kindex maint space
33623 @cindex memory used by commands
33624 @item maint space @var{value}
33625 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
33626 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
33627
33628 @kindex maint time
33629 @cindex time of command execution
33630 @item maint time @var{value}
33631 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
33632 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
33633
33634 @kindex maint translate-address
33635 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
33636 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
33637 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
33638 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
33639 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
33640 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
33641 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
33642
33643 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
33644 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
33645 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
33646
33647 @end table
33648
33649 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
33650 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
33651
33652 @table @code
33653 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
33654 @kindex set watchdog
33655 @cindex watchdog timer
33656 @cindex timeout for commands
33657 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
33658 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
33659 reports and error and the command is aborted.
33660
33661 @item show watchdog
33662 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
33663 @end table
33664
33665 @node Remote Protocol
33666 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
33667
33668 @menu
33669 * Overview::
33670 * Packets::
33671 * Stop Reply Packets::
33672 * General Query Packets::
33673 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
33674 * Tracepoint Packets::
33675 * Host I/O Packets::
33676 * Interrupts::
33677 * Notification Packets::
33678 * Remote Non-Stop::
33679 * Packet Acknowledgment::
33680 * Examples::
33681 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
33682 * Library List Format::
33683 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
33684 * Memory Map Format::
33685 * Thread List Format::
33686 * Traceframe Info Format::
33687 * Branch Trace Format::
33688 @end menu
33689
33690 @node Overview
33691 @section Overview
33692
33693 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
33694 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
33695 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
33696 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
33697
33698 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
33699 transmitted and received data, respectively.
33700
33701 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
33702 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
33703 @cindex remote serial protocol
33704 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
33705 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
33706 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
33707 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
33708 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
33709
33710 @smallexample
33711 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33712 @end smallexample
33713 @noindent
33714
33715 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
33716 @noindent
33717 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
33718 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
33719 eight bit unsigned checksum).
33720
33721 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
33722 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
33723
33724 @smallexample
33725 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33726 @end smallexample
33727
33728 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
33729 @noindent
33730 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
33731 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
33732 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
33733
33734 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
33735 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
33736 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
33737 retransmission):
33738
33739 @smallexample
33740 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33741 <- @code{+}
33742 @end smallexample
33743 @noindent
33744
33745 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
33746 once a connection is established.
33747 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
33748
33749 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
33750 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
33751 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
33752 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
33753 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
33754 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
33755 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
33756
33757 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
33758 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
33759 exceptions).
33760
33761 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
33762 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
33763 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
33764 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
33765
33766 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
33767 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
33768 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
33769
33770 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
33771 @anchor{Binary Data}
33772 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
33773 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
33774 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
33775 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
33776 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
33777 binary data.
33778
33779 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
33780 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
33781 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
33782 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
33783 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
33784 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
33785 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
33786 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
33787 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
33788 (described next).
33789
33790 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
33791 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
33792 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
33793 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
33794 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
33795 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
33796 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
33797 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
33798 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
33799 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
33800 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
33801 3}} more times.
33802
33803 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
33804 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
33805 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
33806 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
33807 @samp{0*"00}.
33808
33809 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
33810 error number. That number is not well defined.
33811
33812 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
33813 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
33814 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
33815 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
33816 on that response.
33817
33818 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
33819 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
33820 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
33821 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
33822 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
33823 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
33824
33825 @node Packets
33826 @section Packets
33827
33828 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
33829 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
33830 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
33831 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
33832
33833 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
33834 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
33835 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
33836 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
33837 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
33838 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
33839 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
33840 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
33841 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
33842 @var{baz}.
33843
33844 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
33845 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
33846 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
33847 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
33848 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
33849 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
33850 pick any thread.
33851
33852 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
33853 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
33854 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
33855 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
33856 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
33857 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
33858 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
33859 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
33860 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
33861 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
33862 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
33863 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
33864 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
33865
33866 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
33867 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
33868 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
33869 more information.
33870
33871 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
33872 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
33873
33874 Here are the packet descriptions.
33875
33876 @table @samp
33877
33878 @item !
33879 @cindex @samp{!} packet
33880 @anchor{extended mode}
33881 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
33882 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
33883 debugged.
33884
33885 Reply:
33886 @table @samp
33887 @item OK
33888 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
33889 @end table
33890
33891 @item ?
33892 @cindex @samp{?} packet
33893 @anchor{? packet}
33894 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
33895 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
33896 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
33897
33898 Reply:
33899 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33900
33901 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
33902 @cindex @samp{A} packet
33903 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
33904 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
33905 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
33906
33907 Reply:
33908 @table @samp
33909 @item OK
33910 The arguments were set.
33911 @item E @var{NN}
33912 An error occurred.
33913 @end table
33914
33915 @item b @var{baud}
33916 @cindex @samp{b} packet
33917 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
33918 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
33919
33920 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
33921 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
33922 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
33923
33924 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
33925 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
33926 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
33927 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
33928 of view, nothing actually happened.}
33929
33930 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
33931 @cindex @samp{B} packet
33932 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
33933 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
33934
33935 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
33936 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
33937
33938 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
33939 @anchor{bc}
33940 @item bc
33941 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
33942 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33943
33944 Reply:
33945 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33946
33947 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
33948 @anchor{bs}
33949 @item bs
33950 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
33951 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33952
33953 Reply:
33954 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33955
33956 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
33957 @cindex @samp{c} packet
33958 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
33959 is omitted, resume at current address.
33960
33961 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33962 packet}.
33963
33964 Reply:
33965 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33966
33967 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
33968 @cindex @samp{C} packet
33969 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
33970 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
33971
33972 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33973 packet}.
33974
33975 Reply:
33976 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33977
33978 @item d
33979 @cindex @samp{d} packet
33980 Toggle debug flag.
33981
33982 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
33983 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
33984
33985 @item D
33986 @itemx D;@var{pid}
33987 @cindex @samp{D} packet
33988 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
33989 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
33990 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
33991
33992 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
33993 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
33994 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
33995 big-endian hex string.
33996
33997 Reply:
33998 @table @samp
33999 @item OK
34000 for success
34001 @item E @var{NN}
34002 for an error
34003 @end table
34004
34005 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
34006 @cindex @samp{F} packet
34007 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
34008 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
34009 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
34010
34011 @item g
34012 @anchor{read registers packet}
34013 @cindex @samp{g} packet
34014 Read general registers.
34015
34016 Reply:
34017 @table @samp
34018 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34019 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
34020 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
34021 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
34022 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
34023 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
34024 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
34025
34026 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
34027 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
34028 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
34029 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
34030 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
34031 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
34032 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
34033 have been collected, and both have zero value:
34034
34035 @smallexample
34036 -> @code{g}
34037 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
34038 @end smallexample
34039
34040 @item E @var{NN}
34041 for an error.
34042 @end table
34043
34044 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
34045 @cindex @samp{G} packet
34046 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
34047 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
34048
34049 Reply:
34050 @table @samp
34051 @item OK
34052 for success
34053 @item E @var{NN}
34054 for an error
34055 @end table
34056
34057 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
34058 @cindex @samp{H} packet
34059 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
34060 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
34061 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
34062 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
34063 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
34064 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
34065 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34066
34067 Reply:
34068 @table @samp
34069 @item OK
34070 for success
34071 @item E @var{NN}
34072 for an error
34073 @end table
34074
34075 @c FIXME: JTC:
34076 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
34077 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
34078 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
34079 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
34080 @c described. For example:
34081 @c
34082 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34083 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
34084 @c otherwise returns current registers.
34085 @c
34086 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34087 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
34088 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
34089
34090 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
34091 @anchor{cycle step packet}
34092 @cindex @samp{i} packet
34093 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
34094 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
34095 step starting at that address.
34096
34097 @item I
34098 @cindex @samp{I} packet
34099 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
34100 step packet}.
34101
34102 @item k
34103 @cindex @samp{k} packet
34104 Kill request.
34105
34106 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
34107
34108 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
34109 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
34110
34111 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
34112
34113 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
34114 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
34115 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
34116
34117 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
34118 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
34119 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
34120
34121 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
34122 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
34123 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
34124 (@pxref{? packet}).
34125
34126 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
34127 @cindex @samp{m} packet
34128 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34129 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
34130
34131 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
34132 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
34133 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
34134 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
34135 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
34136 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
34137 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
34138 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
34139
34140 Reply:
34141 @table @samp
34142 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34143 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
34144 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
34145 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
34146 @item E @var{NN}
34147 @var{NN} is errno
34148 @end table
34149
34150 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34151 @cindex @samp{M} packet
34152 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34153 The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
34154 hexadecimal number.
34155
34156 Reply:
34157 @table @samp
34158 @item OK
34159 for success
34160 @item E @var{NN}
34161 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
34162 written).
34163 @end table
34164
34165 @item p @var{n}
34166 @cindex @samp{p} packet
34167 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
34168 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
34169 register value is encoded.
34170
34171 Reply:
34172 @table @samp
34173 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34174 the register's value
34175 @item E @var{NN}
34176 for an error
34177 @item @w{}
34178 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
34179 @end table
34180
34181 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
34182 @anchor{write register packet}
34183 @cindex @samp{P} packet
34184 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
34185 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
34186 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
34187
34188 Reply:
34189 @table @samp
34190 @item OK
34191 for success
34192 @item E @var{NN}
34193 for an error
34194 @end table
34195
34196 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34197 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34198 @cindex @samp{q} packet
34199 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
34200 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
34201 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
34202
34203 @item r
34204 @cindex @samp{r} packet
34205 Reset the entire system.
34206
34207 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
34208
34209 @item R @var{XX}
34210 @cindex @samp{R} packet
34211 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
34212 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34213
34214 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
34215
34216 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34217 @cindex @samp{s} packet
34218 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
34219 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
34220
34221 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34222 packet}.
34223
34224 Reply:
34225 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34226
34227 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34228 @anchor{step with signal packet}
34229 @cindex @samp{S} packet
34230 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
34231 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
34232
34233 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34234 packet}.
34235
34236 Reply:
34237 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34238
34239 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
34240 @cindex @samp{t} packet
34241 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
34242 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
34243 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
34244
34245 @item T @var{thread-id}
34246 @cindex @samp{T} packet
34247 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34248
34249 Reply:
34250 @table @samp
34251 @item OK
34252 thread is still alive
34253 @item E @var{NN}
34254 thread is dead
34255 @end table
34256
34257 @item v
34258 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
34259 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
34260
34261 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
34262 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
34263 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
34264 The process ID is a
34265 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
34266 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
34267 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
34268
34269 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
34270 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
34271 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
34272 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
34273 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
34274 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
34275 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
34276 @c stopping or restarting threads.
34277
34278 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34279
34280 Reply:
34281 @table @samp
34282 @item E @var{nn}
34283 for an error
34284 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34285 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34286 @item OK
34287 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
34288 @end table
34289
34290 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
34291 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
34292 @anchor{vCont packet}
34293 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
34294 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
34295 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
34296 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
34297 in their current state in non-stop mode.
34298 Specifying multiple
34299 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
34300 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34301
34302 Currently supported actions are:
34303
34304 @table @samp
34305 @item c
34306 Continue.
34307 @item C @var{sig}
34308 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34309 @item s
34310 Step.
34311 @item S @var{sig}
34312 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34313 @item t
34314 Stop.
34315 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
34316 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
34317 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
34318 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
34319 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
34320 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
34321
34322 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
34323 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
34324 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
34325 jumps to @var{start}).
34326
34327 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
34328 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
34329 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
34330
34331 @end table
34332
34333 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
34334 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
34335 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
34336
34337 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
34338 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
34339 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
34340 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
34341 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
34342 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
34343 as an implementation detail.
34344
34345 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
34346 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
34347 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
34348 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
34349 @var{thread-id}.
34350
34351 Reply:
34352 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34353
34354 @item vCont?
34355 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
34356 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
34357
34358 Reply:
34359 @table @samp
34360 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
34361 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
34362 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
34363 @item @w{}
34364 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
34365 @end table
34366
34367 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
34368 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
34369 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
34370 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
34371
34372 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
34373 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
34374 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
34375 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
34376 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
34377 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
34378 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
34379 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
34380 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34381 packet is received.
34382
34383 Reply:
34384 @table @samp
34385 @item OK
34386 for success
34387 @item E @var{NN}
34388 for an error
34389 @end table
34390
34391 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34392 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
34393 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
34394 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
34395 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
34396 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
34397 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
34398 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
34399 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
34400 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
34401 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
34402 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
34403
34404
34405 Reply:
34406 @table @samp
34407 @item OK
34408 for success
34409 @item E.memtype
34410 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
34411 @item E @var{NN}
34412 for an error
34413 @end table
34414
34415 @item vFlashDone
34416 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
34417 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
34418 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
34419 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
34420 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
34421 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34422 request is completed.
34423
34424 @item vKill;@var{pid}
34425 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
34426 @anchor{vKill packet}
34427 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
34428 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
34429 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
34430 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34431
34432 Reply:
34433 @table @samp
34434 @item E @var{nn}
34435 for an error
34436 @item OK
34437 for success
34438 @end table
34439
34440 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
34441 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
34442 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
34443 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
34444 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
34445 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
34446 state.
34447
34448 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
34449
34450 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34451
34452 Reply:
34453 @table @samp
34454 @item E @var{nn}
34455 for an error
34456 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34457 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34458 @end table
34459
34460 @item vStopped
34461 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
34462 @xref{Notification Packets}.
34463
34464 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34465 @anchor{X packet}
34466 @cindex @samp{X} packet
34467 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
34468 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of bytes @var{length};
34469 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
34470
34471 Reply:
34472 @table @samp
34473 @item OK
34474 for success
34475 @item E @var{NN}
34476 for an error
34477 @end table
34478
34479 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34480 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
34481 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
34482 @cindex @samp{z} packet
34483 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
34484 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
34485 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
34486
34487 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
34488 separately.
34489
34490 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
34491 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
34492 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
34493 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
34494 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
34495 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
34496
34497 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34498 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
34499 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
34500 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
34501 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
34502 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
34503
34504 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
34505 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
34506 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
34507 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
34508 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
34509 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
34510 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
34511 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
34512 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
34513 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
34514
34515 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
34516 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
34517
34518 @table @samp
34519
34520 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34521 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34522 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34523
34524 @end table
34525
34526 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
34527 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
34528 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
34529 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
34530 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
34531 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
34532 separators. Each expression has the following form:
34533
34534 @table @samp
34535
34536 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
34537 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
34538 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
34539
34540 @end table
34541
34542 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
34543
34544 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
34545 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
34546 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
34547 target, is not defined.}
34548
34549 Reply:
34550 @table @samp
34551 @item OK
34552 success
34553 @item @w{}
34554 not supported
34555 @item E @var{NN}
34556 for an error
34557 @end table
34558
34559 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34560 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
34561 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
34562 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
34563 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
34564 address @var{addr}.
34565
34566 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
34567 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
34568 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
34569
34570 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
34571 movement.}
34572
34573 Reply:
34574 @table @samp
34575 @item OK
34576 success
34577 @item @w{}
34578 not supported
34579 @item E @var{NN}
34580 for an error
34581 @end table
34582
34583 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34584 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34585 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
34586 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
34587 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34588 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
34589
34590 Reply:
34591 @table @samp
34592 @item OK
34593 success
34594 @item @w{}
34595 not supported
34596 @item E @var{NN}
34597 for an error
34598 @end table
34599
34600 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34601 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34602 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
34603 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
34604 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34605 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
34606
34607 Reply:
34608 @table @samp
34609 @item OK
34610 success
34611 @item @w{}
34612 not supported
34613 @item E @var{NN}
34614 for an error
34615 @end table
34616
34617 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34618 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
34619 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
34620 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
34621 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
34622 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
34623
34624 Reply:
34625 @table @samp
34626 @item OK
34627 success
34628 @item @w{}
34629 not supported
34630 @item E @var{NN}
34631 for an error
34632 @end table
34633
34634 @end table
34635
34636 @node Stop Reply Packets
34637 @section Stop Reply Packets
34638 @cindex stop reply packets
34639
34640 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
34641 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
34642 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
34643 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
34644 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
34645 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
34646 @value{GDBN} source code.
34647
34648 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
34649 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
34650 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
34651 components.
34652
34653 @table @samp
34654
34655 @item S @var{AA}
34656 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
34657 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
34658 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
34659
34660 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
34661 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
34662 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
34663 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
34664 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
34665 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
34666 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
34667 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
34668
34669 @itemize @bullet
34670 @item
34671 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
34672 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
34673 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
34674 two-digit hex number.
34675
34676 @item
34677 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
34678 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34679
34680 @item
34681 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
34682 the core on which the stop event was detected.
34683
34684 @item
34685 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
34686 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
34687 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
34688 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
34689
34690 @item
34691 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
34692 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
34693 future.
34694 @end itemize
34695
34696 The currently defined stop reasons are:
34697
34698 @table @samp
34699 @item watch
34700 @itemx rwatch
34701 @itemx awatch
34702 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
34703 hex.
34704
34705 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
34706 @item library
34707 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
34708 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
34709 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
34710
34711 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
34712 @item replaylog
34713 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
34714 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
34715 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
34716 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
34717 for more information.
34718 @end table
34719
34720 @item W @var{AA}
34721 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34722 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
34723 applicable to certain targets.
34724
34725 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
34726 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
34727 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34728 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34729
34730 @item X @var{AA}
34731 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34732 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
34733
34734 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
34735 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
34736 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
34737 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34738
34739 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
34740 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
34741 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
34742 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
34743 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
34744
34745 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
34746 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
34747 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
34748 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
34749 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
34750 system calls.
34751
34752 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
34753 this very system call.
34754
34755 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
34756 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
34757 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
34758 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
34759 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
34760 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
34761
34762 @end table
34763
34764 @node General Query Packets
34765 @section General Query Packets
34766 @cindex remote query requests
34767
34768 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
34769 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
34770 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
34771 sending information to and from the stub.
34772
34773 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
34774 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
34775 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
34776 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
34777 conventions:
34778
34779 @itemize @bullet
34780 @item
34781 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
34782 @item
34783 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
34784 letter.
34785 @item
34786 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
34787 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
34788 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
34789 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
34790 @end itemize
34791
34792 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
34793 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
34794 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
34795 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
34796 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
34797 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
34798 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
34799 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
34800 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
34801 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
34802 packet.}.
34803
34804 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
34805 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
34806 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
34807 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
34808 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
34809
34810 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
34811
34812 @table @samp
34813
34814 @item QAgent:1
34815 @itemx QAgent:0
34816 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
34817 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
34818
34819 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
34820 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
34821 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
34822 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
34823 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
34824 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
34825 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
34826 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
34827 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
34828 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
34829 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
34830
34831 @item qC
34832 @cindex current thread, remote request
34833 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
34834 Return the current thread ID.
34835
34836 Reply:
34837 @table @samp
34838 @item QC @var{thread-id}
34839 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
34840 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34841 @item @r{(anything else)}
34842 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
34843 @end table
34844
34845 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
34846 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
34847 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
34848 @anchor{qCRC packet}
34849 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
34850 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
34851 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
34852 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
34853
34854 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
34855 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
34856 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
34857 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
34858 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
34859 detect trailing zeros.
34860
34861 Reply:
34862 @table @samp
34863 @item E @var{NN}
34864 An error (such as memory fault)
34865 @item C @var{crc32}
34866 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
34867 @end table
34868
34869 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
34870 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
34871 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
34872 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
34873 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
34874 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
34875 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
34876 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
34877 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
34878 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
34879 randomization.
34880
34881 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34882
34883 Reply:
34884 @table @samp
34885 @item OK
34886 The request succeeded.
34887
34888 @item E @var{nn}
34889 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
34890
34891 @item @w{}
34892 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
34893 by the stub.
34894 @end table
34895
34896 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34897 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34898 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
34899 address space randomization.
34900
34901 @item qfThreadInfo
34902 @itemx qsThreadInfo
34903 @cindex list active threads, remote request
34904 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
34905 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
34906 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
34907 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
34908 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
34909 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
34910 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
34911 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
34912
34913 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
34914
34915 Reply:
34916 @table @samp
34917 @item m @var{thread-id}
34918 A single thread ID
34919 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
34920 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
34921 @item l
34922 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
34923 @end table
34924
34925 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
34926 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
34927 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
34928 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
34929 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
34930 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
34931 fields.
34932
34933 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
34934 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
34935 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
34936 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
34937 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
34938
34939 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
34940 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
34941 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
34942 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
34943 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
34944
34945 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
34946 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34947
34948 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
34949 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
34950 information associated with the variable.)
34951
34952 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
34953 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
34954 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
34955 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
34956 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
34957 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
34958
34959 Reply:
34960 @table @samp
34961 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
34962 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
34963 local storage requested.
34964
34965 @item E @var{nn}
34966 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
34967
34968 @item @w{}
34969 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
34970 @end table
34971
34972 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
34973 @cindex get thread information block address
34974 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
34975 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
34976
34977 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
34978
34979 Reply:
34980 @table @samp
34981 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
34982 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
34983 thread information block.
34984
34985 @item E @var{nn}
34986 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
34987 address could not be retrieved.
34988
34989 @item @w{}
34990 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
34991 @end table
34992
34993 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
34994 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
34995 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
34996 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
34997 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
34998 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
34999 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
35000
35001 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
35002
35003 Reply:
35004 @table @samp
35005 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
35006 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
35007 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
35008 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
35009 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
35010 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
35011 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
35012 @end table
35013
35014 @item qOffsets
35015 @cindex section offsets, remote request
35016 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
35017 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
35018 image.
35019
35020 Reply:
35021 @table @samp
35022 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
35023 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
35024 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
35025 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
35026 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
35027 segments by the supplied offsets.
35028
35029 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
35030 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
35031 to the @code{Bss} section.}
35032
35033 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
35034 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
35035 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
35036 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
35037 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
35038 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
35039 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
35040 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
35041 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
35042 @end table
35043
35044 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
35045 @cindex thread information, remote request
35046 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
35047 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
35048 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
35049 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
35050
35051 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
35052 (see below).
35053
35054 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
35055
35056 @item QNonStop:1
35057 @itemx QNonStop:0
35058 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
35059 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
35060 @anchor{QNonStop}
35061 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
35062 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
35063
35064 Reply:
35065 @table @samp
35066 @item OK
35067 The request succeeded.
35068
35069 @item E @var{nn}
35070 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35071
35072 @item @w{}
35073 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
35074 the stub.
35075 @end table
35076
35077 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35078 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35079 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
35080 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
35081
35082 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35083 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
35084 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35085 @anchor{QPassSignals}
35086 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
35087 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35088 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35089 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
35090 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
35091 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
35092 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
35093 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
35094 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
35095
35096 Reply:
35097 @table @samp
35098 @item OK
35099 The request succeeded.
35100
35101 @item E @var{nn}
35102 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35103
35104 @item @w{}
35105 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
35106 the stub.
35107 @end table
35108
35109 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
35110 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
35111 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35112 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35113
35114 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35115 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
35116 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
35117 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
35118 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
35119 Others should be silently discarded.
35120
35121 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
35122 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
35123 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
35124 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
35125 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
35126 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
35127 signals.
35128
35129 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
35130 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
35131
35132 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35133 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35134 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
35135 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
35136 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
35137
35138 Reply:
35139 @table @samp
35140 @item OK
35141 The request succeeded.
35142
35143 @item E @var{nn}
35144 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35145
35146 @item @w{}
35147 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
35148 by the stub.
35149 @end table
35150
35151 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
35152 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
35153 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35154 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35155
35156 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
35157 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
35158 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
35159 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
35160 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
35161 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
35162 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
35163 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
35164 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
35165
35166 Reply:
35167 @table @samp
35168 @item OK
35169 A command response with no output.
35170 @item @var{OUTPUT}
35171 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
35172 @item E @var{NN}
35173 Indicate a badly formed request.
35174 @item @w{}
35175 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
35176 @end table
35177
35178 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
35179 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35180 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35181 packets.)
35182
35183 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
35184 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
35185 @ifnotinfo
35186 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
35187 @end ifnotinfo
35188 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
35189 @anchor{qSearch memory}
35190 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
35191 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
35192 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
35193
35194 Reply:
35195 @table @samp
35196 @item 0
35197 The pattern was not found.
35198 @item 1,address
35199 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
35200 @item E @var{NN}
35201 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
35202 @item @w{}
35203 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
35204 @end table
35205
35206 @item QStartNoAckMode
35207 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
35208 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
35209 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
35210 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
35211
35212 Reply:
35213 @table @samp
35214 @item OK
35215 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
35216 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
35217 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
35218 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
35219 @item @w{}
35220 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
35221 @end table
35222
35223 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
35224 @cindex supported packets, remote query
35225 @cindex features of the remote protocol
35226 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
35227 @anchor{qSupported}
35228 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
35229 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
35230 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
35231 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
35232 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
35233 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
35234 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
35235 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
35236 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
35237 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
35238 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
35239 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
35240 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
35241 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
35242
35243 Reply:
35244 @table @samp
35245 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
35246 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
35247 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
35248 possible forms).
35249 @item @w{}
35250 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
35251 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
35252 @end table
35253
35254 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
35255 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
35256 are:
35257
35258 @table @samp
35259 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
35260 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
35261 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
35262 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
35263 @item @var{name}+
35264 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
35265 need an associated value.
35266 @item @var{name}-
35267 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
35268 @item @var{name}?
35269 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
35270 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
35271 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
35272 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
35273 @end table
35274
35275 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
35276 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
35277 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
35278 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
35279 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
35280
35281 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
35282 are defined:
35283
35284 @table @samp
35285 @item multiprocess
35286 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
35287 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
35288 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
35289 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
35290 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
35291
35292 @item xmlRegisters
35293 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
35294 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
35295 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
35296 description.
35297
35298 @item qRelocInsn
35299 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
35300 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
35301 instruction reply packet}).
35302 @end table
35303
35304 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
35305 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
35306 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
35307 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
35308 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
35309 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
35310 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
35311 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
35312 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
35313 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
35314 all the features it supports.
35315
35316 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
35317 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
35318
35319 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
35320 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
35321 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
35322 form response.
35323
35324 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
35325 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
35326 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
35327 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
35328
35329 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
35330 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
35331 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
35332 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
35333 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
35334
35335 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
35336
35337 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
35338 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
35339 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
35340 @item Feature Name
35341 @tab Value Required
35342 @tab Default
35343 @tab Probe Allowed
35344
35345 @item @samp{PacketSize}
35346 @tab Yes
35347 @tab @samp{-}
35348 @tab No
35349
35350 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
35351 @tab No
35352 @tab @samp{-}
35353 @tab Yes
35354
35355 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
35356 @tab No
35357 @tab @samp{-}
35358 @tab Yes
35359
35360 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
35361 @tab No
35362 @tab @samp{-}
35363 @tab Yes
35364
35365 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
35366 @tab No
35367 @tab @samp{-}
35368 @tab Yes
35369
35370 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
35371 @tab No
35372 @tab @samp{-}
35373 @tab Yes
35374
35375 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
35376 @tab No
35377 @tab @samp{-}
35378 @tab No
35379
35380 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
35381 @tab No
35382 @tab @samp{-}
35383 @tab Yes
35384
35385 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
35386 @tab No
35387 @tab @samp{-}
35388 @tab Yes
35389
35390 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
35391 @tab No
35392 @tab @samp{-}
35393 @tab Yes
35394
35395 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
35396 @tab No
35397 @tab @samp{-}
35398 @tab Yes
35399
35400 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
35401 @tab No
35402 @tab @samp{-}
35403 @tab Yes
35404
35405 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
35406 @tab No
35407 @tab @samp{-}
35408 @tab Yes
35409
35410 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
35411 @tab No
35412 @tab @samp{-}
35413 @tab Yes
35414
35415 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
35416 @tab No
35417 @tab @samp{-}
35418 @tab Yes
35419
35420 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
35421 @tab No
35422 @tab @samp{-}
35423 @tab Yes
35424
35425 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
35426 @tab No
35427 @tab @samp{-}
35428 @tab Yes
35429
35430 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
35431 @tab Yes
35432 @tab @samp{-}
35433 @tab Yes
35434
35435 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
35436 @tab Yes
35437 @tab @samp{-}
35438 @tab Yes
35439
35440 @item @samp{QNonStop}
35441 @tab No
35442 @tab @samp{-}
35443 @tab Yes
35444
35445 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
35446 @tab No
35447 @tab @samp{-}
35448 @tab Yes
35449
35450 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
35451 @tab No
35452 @tab @samp{-}
35453 @tab Yes
35454
35455 @item @samp{multiprocess}
35456 @tab No
35457 @tab @samp{-}
35458 @tab No
35459
35460 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
35461 @tab No
35462 @tab @samp{-}
35463 @tab No
35464
35465 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
35466 @tab No
35467 @tab @samp{-}
35468 @tab No
35469
35470 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
35471 @tab No
35472 @tab @samp{-}
35473 @tab No
35474
35475 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
35476 @tab No
35477 @tab @samp{-}
35478 @tab No
35479
35480 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
35481 @tab No
35482 @tab @samp{-}
35483 @tab No
35484
35485 @item @samp{QAgent}
35486 @tab No
35487 @tab @samp{-}
35488 @tab No
35489
35490 @item @samp{QAllow}
35491 @tab No
35492 @tab @samp{-}
35493 @tab No
35494
35495 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
35496 @tab No
35497 @tab @samp{-}
35498 @tab No
35499
35500 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
35501 @tab No
35502 @tab @samp{-}
35503 @tab No
35504
35505 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
35506 @tab No
35507 @tab @samp{-}
35508 @tab No
35509
35510 @item @samp{tracenz}
35511 @tab No
35512 @tab @samp{-}
35513 @tab No
35514
35515 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
35516 @tab No
35517 @tab @samp{-}
35518 @tab No
35519
35520 @end multitable
35521
35522 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
35523
35524 @table @samp
35525 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
35526 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
35527 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
35528 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
35529 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
35530 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
35531 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
35532 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
35533 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
35534 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
35535
35536 @item qXfer:auxv:read
35537 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
35538 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
35539
35540 @item qXfer:btrace:read
35541 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
35542 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
35543
35544 @item qXfer:features:read
35545 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
35546 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
35547
35548 @item qXfer:libraries:read
35549 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
35550 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
35551
35552 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
35553 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
35554 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
35555
35556 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
35557 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
35558 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
35559 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
35560
35561 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
35562 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
35563 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
35564
35565 @item qXfer:sdata:read
35566 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
35567 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
35568
35569 @item qXfer:spu:read
35570 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
35571 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
35572
35573 @item qXfer:spu:write
35574 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
35575 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
35576
35577 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
35578 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
35579 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
35580
35581 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
35582 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
35583 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
35584
35585 @item qXfer:threads:read
35586 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
35587 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
35588
35589 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
35590 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
35591 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
35592
35593 @item qXfer:uib:read
35594 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
35595 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
35596
35597 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
35598 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
35599 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
35600
35601 @item QNonStop
35602 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
35603 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
35604
35605 @item QPassSignals
35606 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35607 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
35608
35609 @item QStartNoAckMode
35610 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
35611 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
35612
35613 @item multiprocess
35614 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
35615 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
35616 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
35617 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
35618 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
35619 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
35620 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
35621 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
35622 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
35623 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
35624 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
35625
35626 @item qXfer:osdata:read
35627 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
35628 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
35629
35630 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
35631 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
35632 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
35633 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
35634
35635 @item ConditionalTracepoints
35636 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
35637 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
35638
35639 @item ReverseContinue
35640 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
35641 (@pxref{bc}).
35642
35643 @item ReverseStep
35644 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
35645 (@pxref{bs}).
35646
35647 @item TracepointSource
35648 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
35649 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
35650
35651 @item QAgent
35652 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
35653
35654 @item QAllow
35655 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
35656
35657 @item QDisableRandomization
35658 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
35659
35660 @item StaticTracepoint
35661 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
35662 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
35663
35664 @item InstallInTrace
35665 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
35666 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
35667
35668 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
35669 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
35670 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
35671 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
35672
35673 @item QTBuffer:size
35674 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
35675 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
35676
35677 @item tracenz
35678 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
35679 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
35680 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
35681
35682 @item BreakpointCommands
35683 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
35684 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
35685 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
35686
35687 @item Qbtrace:off
35688 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
35689
35690 @item Qbtrace:bts
35691 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
35692
35693 @end table
35694
35695 @item qSymbol::
35696 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
35697 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
35698 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
35699 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
35700
35701 Reply:
35702 @table @samp
35703 @item OK
35704 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
35705 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
35706 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
35707 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
35708 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
35709 below.
35710 @end table
35711
35712 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
35713 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
35714
35715 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
35716 target has previously requested.
35717
35718 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
35719 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
35720 will be empty.
35721
35722 Reply:
35723 @table @samp
35724 @item OK
35725 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
35726 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
35727 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
35728 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
35729 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
35730 @end table
35731
35732 @item qTBuffer
35733 @itemx QTBuffer
35734 @itemx QTDisconnected
35735 @itemx QTDP
35736 @itemx QTDPsrc
35737 @itemx QTDV
35738 @itemx qTfP
35739 @itemx qTfV
35740 @itemx QTFrame
35741 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
35742
35743 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
35744
35745 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
35746 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
35747 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
35748 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
35749 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
35750 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
35751 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
35752 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
35753 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
35754 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
35755 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
35756
35757 Reply:
35758 @table @samp
35759 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35760 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
35761 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
35762 the thread's attributes.
35763 @end table
35764
35765 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
35766 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35767 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35768 packets.)
35769
35770 @item QTNotes
35771 @itemx qTP
35772 @itemx QTSave
35773 @itemx qTsP
35774 @itemx qTsV
35775 @itemx QTStart
35776 @itemx QTStop
35777 @itemx QTEnable
35778 @itemx QTDisable
35779 @itemx QTinit
35780 @itemx QTro
35781 @itemx qTStatus
35782 @itemx qTV
35783 @itemx qTfSTM
35784 @itemx qTsSTM
35785 @itemx qTSTMat
35786 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
35787
35788 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35789 @cindex read special object, remote request
35790 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
35791 @anchor{qXfer read}
35792 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
35793 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
35794 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
35795 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
35796 additional details about what data to access.
35797
35798 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
35799 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
35800 formats, listed below.
35801
35802 @table @samp
35803 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35804 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
35805 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
35806 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
35807
35808 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35809 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35810
35811 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35812 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
35813
35814 Return a description of the current branch trace.
35815 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
35816 packet may have one of the following values:
35817
35818 @table @code
35819 @item all
35820 Returns all available branch trace.
35821
35822 @item new
35823 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
35824 the last read request.
35825
35826 @item delta
35827 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
35828 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
35829 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
35830 used to stitch traces together.
35831
35832 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
35833 @end table
35834
35835 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
35836 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35837
35838 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35839 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
35840 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
35841 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
35842 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
35843
35844 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35845 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35846
35847 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35848 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
35849 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
35850 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35851 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35852
35853 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
35854 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
35855 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
35856
35857 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35858 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35859
35860 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35861 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
35862 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
35863 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
35864 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
35865 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
35866 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35867 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
35868
35869 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
35870 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
35871
35872 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35873 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35874
35875 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
35876 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
35877 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
35878 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
35879
35880 @table @code
35881 @item start=@var{address}
35882 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
35883 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
35884 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
35885 chosen as the starting point.
35886
35887 @item prev=@var{address}
35888 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
35889 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
35890 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
35891 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
35892 exists prior to the starting point.
35893
35894 @end table
35895
35896 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
35897 ignored.
35898
35899 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35900 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
35901 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
35902 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35903 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35904
35905 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35906 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35907
35908 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35909 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
35910
35911 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
35912 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
35913 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
35914 Action Lists}.
35915
35916 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35917 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35918 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35919
35920 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35921 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
35922 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
35923 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
35924 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35925
35926 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35927 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35928 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35929
35930 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35931 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
35932 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
35933 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
35934 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
35935 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
35936 in that context to be accessed.
35937
35938 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35939 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35940 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35941
35942 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35943 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
35944 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
35945 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35946 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35947
35948 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35949 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35950
35951 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35952 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
35953
35954 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
35955 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
35956 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35957
35958 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35959 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35960
35961 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35962 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
35963
35964 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
35965 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
35966
35967 This packet is not probed by default.
35968
35969 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35970 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
35971 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
35972 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
35973 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
35974
35975 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35976 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35977
35978 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35979 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
35980 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
35981 @xref{Operating System Information}.
35982
35983 @end table
35984
35985 Reply:
35986 @table @samp
35987 @item m @var{data}
35988 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
35989 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
35990 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
35991 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
35992 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
35993 request.
35994
35995 @item l @var{data}
35996 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
35997 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
35998 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
35999
36000 @item l
36001 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
36002 There is no more data to be read.
36003
36004 @item E00
36005 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
36006
36007 @item E @var{nn}
36008 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
36009 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
36010
36011 @item @w{}
36012 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
36013 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
36014 @end table
36015
36016 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36017 @cindex write data into object, remote request
36018 @anchor{qXfer write}
36019 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
36020 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
36021 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
36022 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
36023 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
36024 to access.
36025
36026 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
36027 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
36028 formats, listed below.
36029
36030 @table @samp
36031 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36032 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
36033 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
36034 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
36035 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
36036
36037 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36038 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36039 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36040
36041 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36042 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
36043 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
36044 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
36045 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
36046 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
36047 in that context to be accessed.
36048
36049 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36050 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36051 @end table
36052
36053 Reply:
36054 @table @samp
36055 @item @var{nn}
36056 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
36057 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
36058
36059 @item E00
36060 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
36061
36062 @item E @var{nn}
36063 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
36064 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
36065
36066 @item @w{}
36067 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
36068 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
36069 @end table
36070
36071 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
36072 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
36073 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
36074 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
36075 must respond with an empty packet.
36076
36077 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
36078 @cindex query attached, remote request
36079 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
36080 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
36081 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
36082 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
36083 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
36084 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
36085 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
36086
36087 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
36088 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
36089 the @code{quit} command.
36090
36091 Reply:
36092 @table @samp
36093 @item 1
36094 The remote server attached to an existing process.
36095 @item 0
36096 The remote server created a new process.
36097 @item E @var{NN}
36098 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36099 @end table
36100
36101 @item Qbtrace:bts
36102 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using bts tracing.
36103
36104 Reply:
36105 @table @samp
36106 @item OK
36107 Branch tracing has been enabled.
36108 @item E.errtext
36109 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36110 @end table
36111
36112 @item Qbtrace:off
36113 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
36114
36115 Reply:
36116 @table @samp
36117 @item OK
36118 Branch tracing has been disabled.
36119 @item E.errtext
36120 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36121 @end table
36122
36123 @end table
36124
36125 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36126 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36127
36128 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
36129 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
36130 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
36131
36132 @menu
36133 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
36134 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
36135 @end menu
36136
36137 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
36138 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
36139
36140 @menu
36141 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
36142 @end menu
36143
36144 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
36145 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
36146 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
36147
36148 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36149
36150 @table @r
36151
36152 @item 2
36153 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
36154
36155 @item 3
36156 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
36157
36158 @item 4
36159 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
36160
36161 @end table
36162
36163 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
36164 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
36165
36166 @menu
36167 * MIPS Register packet Format::
36168 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
36169 @end menu
36170
36171 @node MIPS Register packet Format
36172 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
36173 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
36174
36175 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
36176 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
36177 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
36178 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
36179 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
36180 most-significant -- least-significant.
36181
36182 @table @r
36183
36184 @item MIPS32
36185 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
36186 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
36187 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
36188
36189 @item MIPS64
36190 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
36191 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
36192 as @code{MIPS32}.
36193
36194 @end table
36195
36196 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
36197 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
36198 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
36199
36200 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36201
36202 @table @r
36203
36204 @item 2
36205 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
36206
36207 @item 3
36208 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36209
36210 @item 4
36211 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
36212
36213 @item 5
36214 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36215
36216 @end table
36217
36218 @node Tracepoint Packets
36219 @section Tracepoint Packets
36220 @cindex tracepoint packets
36221 @cindex packets, tracepoint
36222
36223 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
36224 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
36225
36226 @table @samp
36227
36228 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
36229 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
36230 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
36231 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
36232 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
36233 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
36234 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
36235 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
36236 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
36237 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
36238 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
36239 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
36240 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
36241 actions.
36242
36243 Replies:
36244 @table @samp
36245 @item OK
36246 The packet was understood and carried out.
36247 @item qRelocInsn
36248 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36249 @item @w{}
36250 The packet was not recognized.
36251 @end table
36252
36253 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
36254 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
36255 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
36256 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
36257 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
36258 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
36259 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
36260
36261 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
36262 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
36263 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
36264 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
36265 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
36266 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
36267 tracepoint actions.
36268
36269 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
36270 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
36271 following forms:
36272
36273 @table @samp
36274
36275 @item R @var{mask}
36276 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
36277 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
36278 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
36279 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
36280 not fit in a 32-bit word.
36281
36282 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
36283 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
36284 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
36285 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
36286 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
36287 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
36288 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
36289
36290 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36291 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
36292 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
36293 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
36294 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
36295 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
36296 packet).
36297
36298 @end table
36299
36300 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
36301 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
36302 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
36303 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
36304 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
36305 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
36306 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
36307 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
36308
36309 Replies:
36310 @table @samp
36311 @item OK
36312 The packet was understood and carried out.
36313 @item qRelocInsn
36314 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36315 @item @w{}
36316 The packet was not recognized.
36317 @end table
36318
36319 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
36320 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
36321 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
36322 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
36323 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
36324 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
36325 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
36326 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
36327
36328 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
36329 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
36330 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
36331 fit in a single packet.
36332 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
36333 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
36334
36335 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
36336 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
36337 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
36338 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
36339
36340 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
36341 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
36342 query packets.
36343
36344 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
36345 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
36346 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
36347 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
36348 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
36349 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
36350 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
36351 be found.
36352
36353 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
36354 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
36355 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
36356 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
36357 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
36358 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
36359 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
36360 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
36361 mentioned in expressions.
36362
36363 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
36364 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
36365 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
36366 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
36367 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
36368
36369 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
36370 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
36371 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
36372 one of the following forms:
36373
36374 @table @samp
36375 @item F @var{f}
36376 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
36377 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
36378 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
36379
36380 @item T @var{t}
36381 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
36382 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
36383
36384 @end table
36385
36386 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
36387 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36388 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
36389 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
36390
36391 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
36392 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36393 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
36394 is a hexadecimal number.
36395
36396 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
36397 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
36398 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
36399 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
36400 numbers.
36401
36402 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
36403 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
36404 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
36405
36406 @item qTMinFTPILen
36407 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
36408 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
36409 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
36410 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
36411 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
36412 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
36413 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
36414 arrange for that.
36415
36416 Replies:
36417
36418 @table @samp
36419 @item 0
36420 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
36421 @item @var{length}
36422 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
36423 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
36424 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
36425 regardless of size.
36426 @item E
36427 An error has occurred.
36428 @item @w{}
36429 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
36430 @end table
36431
36432 @item QTStart
36433 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
36434 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
36435 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
36436 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36437 instruction reply packet}).
36438
36439 @item QTStop
36440 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
36441 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
36442
36443 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36444 @anchor{QTEnable}
36445 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
36446 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36447 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
36448 of data from it will resume.
36449
36450 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
36451 @anchor{QTDisable}
36452 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
36453 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
36454 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
36455 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
36456
36457 @item QTinit
36458 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
36459 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
36460
36461 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
36462 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
36463 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
36464 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
36465 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
36466
36467 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
36468 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
36469 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
36470 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
36471
36472 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
36473 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
36474 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
36475 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
36476 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
36477 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
36478
36479 @item qTStatus
36480 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
36481 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
36482
36483 The reply has the form:
36484
36485 @table @samp
36486
36487 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
36488 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
36489 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
36490 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
36491
36492 @end table
36493
36494 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
36495 explanations as one of the optional fields:
36496
36497 @table @samp
36498
36499 @item tnotrun:0
36500 No trace has been run yet.
36501
36502 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
36503 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
36504 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
36505 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
36506 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
36507
36508 @item tfull:0
36509 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
36510
36511 @item tdisconnected:0
36512 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
36513
36514 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
36515 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
36516
36517 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
36518 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
36519 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
36520 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
36521 is hex encoded.
36522
36523 @item tunknown:0
36524 The trace stopped for some other reason.
36525
36526 @end table
36527
36528 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
36529 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
36530 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
36531 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
36532 trace.
36533
36534 @table @samp
36535
36536 @item tframes:@var{n}
36537 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
36538
36539 @item tcreated:@var{n}
36540 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
36541 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
36542
36543 @item tsize:@var{n}
36544 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
36545
36546 @item tfree:@var{n}
36547 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
36548
36549 @item circular:@var{n}
36550 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
36551 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
36552 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
36553 and may fill up.
36554
36555 @item disconn:@var{n}
36556 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
36557 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
36558 that the trace run will stop.
36559
36560 @end table
36561
36562 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
36563 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
36564 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
36565 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
36566 address @var{addr}.
36567
36568 Replies:
36569 @table @samp
36570 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
36571 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
36572 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
36573 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
36574 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
36575
36576 @end table
36577
36578 @item qTV:@var{var}
36579 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
36580 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
36581 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
36582
36583 Replies:
36584 @table @samp
36585 @item V@var{value}
36586 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
36587 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
36588 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
36589 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
36590 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
36591 program is running.
36592
36593 @item U
36594 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
36595 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
36596 was not collected.
36597 @end table
36598
36599 @item qTfP
36600 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
36601 @itemx qTsP
36602 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
36603 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
36604 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
36605 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
36606 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
36607 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
36608
36609 @item qTfV
36610 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
36611 @itemx qTsV
36612 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
36613 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
36614 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
36615 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
36616 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
36617 trace state variables.
36618
36619 @item qTfSTM
36620 @itemx qTsSTM
36621 @anchor{qTfSTM}
36622 @anchor{qTsSTM}
36623 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
36624 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
36625 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
36626 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
36627 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
36628 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
36629
36630 Reply:
36631 @table @samp
36632 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
36633 A single marker
36634 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
36635 a comma-separated list of markers
36636 @item l
36637 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
36638 @item E @var{nn}
36639 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36640 @item @w{}
36641 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
36642 stub.
36643 @end table
36644
36645 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
36646 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
36647
36648 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
36649 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
36650 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
36651 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
36652 @dfn{last}).
36653
36654 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
36655 @anchor{qTSTMat}
36656 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
36657 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
36658 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
36659 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
36660 tracepoint markers.
36661
36662 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
36663 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
36664 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
36665 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
36666 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
36667 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
36668
36669 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
36670 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
36671 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
36672 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
36673 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
36674 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
36675 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
36676 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
36677 available.
36678
36679 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
36680 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
36681 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
36682
36683 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
36684 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
36685 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
36686 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
36687 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
36688 use whatever size it prefers.
36689
36690 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
36691 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
36692 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
36693 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
36694 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
36695
36696 @end table
36697
36698 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
36699 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
36700 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
36701 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
36702 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
36703 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
36704 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
36705 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
36706 it had executed in the original location.
36707
36708 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
36709 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
36710 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
36711 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
36712 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
36713 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
36714 format of the request is:
36715
36716 @table @samp
36717 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
36718
36719 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
36720 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
36721 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
36722 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
36723 memory starting at @var{to}.
36724 @end table
36725
36726 Replies:
36727 @table @samp
36728 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
36729 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
36730 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
36731 @item E @var{NN}
36732 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
36733 relocating the instruction.
36734 @end table
36735
36736 @node Host I/O Packets
36737 @section Host I/O Packets
36738 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
36739 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
36740
36741 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
36742 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
36743 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
36744 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
36745 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
36746 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
36747 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
36748 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
36749 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
36750 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
36751
36752 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
36753 its arguments. They have this format:
36754
36755 @table @samp
36756
36757 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
36758 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
36759 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
36760 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
36761 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
36762 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
36763 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
36764 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
36765 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
36766
36767 @end table
36768
36769 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
36770
36771 @table @samp
36772
36773 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
36774 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
36775 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
36776 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
36777 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
36778 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
36779 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
36780 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
36781 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
36782 @var{attachment}.
36783
36784 @item @w{}
36785 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
36786
36787 @end table
36788
36789 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
36790
36791 @table @samp
36792 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
36793 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
36794 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
36795 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
36796 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
36797 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
36798 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
36799
36800 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
36801 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
36802 -1 if an error occurs.
36803
36804 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
36805 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
36806 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
36807 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
36808 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
36809 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
36810 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
36811 @var{count} was zero.
36812
36813 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
36814 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
36815 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
36816 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
36817 some characters were escaped.
36818
36819 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
36820 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
36821 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
36822 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
36823 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
36824 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
36825 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
36826 error occurred.
36827
36828 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
36829 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
36830 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
36831
36832 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
36833 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
36834 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
36835
36836 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
36837 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
36838 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
36839 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
36840 some characters were escaped.
36841
36842 @end table
36843
36844 @node Interrupts
36845 @section Interrupts
36846 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
36847
36848 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
36849 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
36850 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
36851 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
36852
36853 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
36854 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
36855 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
36856 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
36857 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
36858
36859 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
36860 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
36861 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
36862 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
36863 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
36864 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
36865 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
36866 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
36867
36868 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
36869 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
36870 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
36871
36872 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
36873 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
36874 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
36875 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
36876 currently-executing threads and processes.
36877 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
36878 running program, it should send one of the stop
36879 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
36880 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
36881 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
36882 Interrupts received while the
36883 program is stopped are discarded.
36884
36885 @node Notification Packets
36886 @section Notification Packets
36887 @cindex notification packets
36888 @cindex packets, notification
36889
36890 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
36891 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
36892 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
36893 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
36894 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
36895 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
36896 is not a problem.
36897
36898 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
36899 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
36900 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
36901 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
36902 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
36903 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
36904 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
36905
36906 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
36907 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
36908
36909 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
36910 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
36911 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
36912 not they understand it.
36913
36914 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
36915 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
36916 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
36917 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
36918 recipients.
36919
36920 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
36921 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
36922 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
36923 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
36924 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
36925
36926 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
36927 @table @samp
36928 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
36929 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
36930 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
36931 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
36932 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
36933 @item @var{ack}
36934 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
36935 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
36936 @end table
36937
36938 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
36939 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
36940
36941 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
36942 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
36943 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
36944 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
36945 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
36946 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
36947 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
36948 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
36949 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
36950 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
36951
36952 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
36953 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
36954 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
36955 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
36956 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
36957 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
36958
36959 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
36960 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
36961 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
36962 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
36963 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
36964
36965 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
36966 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
36967 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
36968 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
36969 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
36970 normally.
36971
36972 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
36973 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
36974 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
36975 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
36976 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
36977 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
36978 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
36979 the process shall be repeated.
36980
36981 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
36982 following example:
36983 @smallexample
36984 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
36985 @code{...}
36986 -> @code{vStopped}
36987 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
36988 -> @code{vStopped}
36989 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
36990 -> @code{vStopped}
36991 <- @code{OK}
36992 @end smallexample
36993
36994 The following notifications are defined:
36995 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
36996
36997 @item Notification
36998 @tab Ack
36999 @tab Event
37000 @tab Description
37001
37002 @item Stop
37003 @tab vStopped
37004 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
37005 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
37006 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
37007 @value{GDBN}.
37008 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
37009
37010 @end multitable
37011
37012 @node Remote Non-Stop
37013 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
37014
37015 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
37016 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
37017 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
37018 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37019
37020 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
37021 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
37022 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
37023 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
37024 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
37025 probe the target state after a mode change.
37026
37027 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
37028 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
37029 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
37030 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
37031 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
37032 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
37033 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
37034 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
37035 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
37036 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
37037 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
37038
37039 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
37040 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
37041 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
37042 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
37043 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
37044 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
37045 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
37046 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
37047 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
37048 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
37049 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
37050 @samp{OK}.
37051
37052 @node Packet Acknowledgment
37053 @section Packet Acknowledgment
37054
37055 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
37056 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
37057 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
37058 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
37059 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
37060 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
37061 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
37062
37063 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
37064 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
37065 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
37066 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
37067 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
37068
37069 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
37070 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
37071 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
37072 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
37073
37074 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
37075 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
37076 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
37077 @pxref{qSupported}.
37078 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
37079 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
37080 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
37081 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
37082 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
37083 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
37084 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
37085
37086 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
37087 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
37088 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
37089 connection.
37090 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
37091 new connection is established,
37092 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
37093 for the current connection, once disabled.
37094
37095 @node Examples
37096 @section Examples
37097
37098 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
37099 does not get any direct output:
37100
37101 @smallexample
37102 -> @code{R00}
37103 <- @code{+}
37104 @emph{target restarts}
37105 -> @code{?}
37106 <- @code{+}
37107 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37108 -> @code{+}
37109 @end smallexample
37110
37111 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
37112
37113 @smallexample
37114 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
37115 <- @code{+}
37116 -> @code{s}
37117 <- @code{+}
37118 @emph{time passes}
37119 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37120 -> @code{+}
37121 -> @code{g}
37122 <- @code{+}
37123 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
37124 -> @code{+}
37125 @end smallexample
37126
37127 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37128 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37129 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
37130
37131 @menu
37132 * File-I/O Overview::
37133 * Protocol Basics::
37134 * The F Request Packet::
37135 * The F Reply Packet::
37136 * The Ctrl-C Message::
37137 * Console I/O::
37138 * List of Supported Calls::
37139 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
37140 * Constants::
37141 * File-I/O Examples::
37142 @end menu
37143
37144 @node File-I/O Overview
37145 @subsection File-I/O Overview
37146 @cindex file-i/o overview
37147
37148 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
37149 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
37150 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
37151 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
37152 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
37153 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
37154
37155 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
37156 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
37157 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
37158 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
37159 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
37160
37161 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
37162 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37163 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
37164 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
37165 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
37166 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
37167 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
37168
37169 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
37170 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
37171 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
37172 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
37173 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
37174
37175 @smallexample
37176 (@value{GDBP}) continue
37177 <- target requests 'system call X'
37178 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
37179 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
37180 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
37181 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
37182 @end smallexample
37183
37184 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
37185 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
37186 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
37187 system are not supported by this protocol.
37188
37189 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
37190
37191 @node Protocol Basics
37192 @subsection Protocol Basics
37193 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
37194
37195 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
37196 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
37197 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
37198 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
37199 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
37200 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
37201 to call the appropriate host system call:
37202
37203 @itemize @bullet
37204 @item
37205 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
37206
37207 @item
37208 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
37209 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
37210 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
37211 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
37212
37213 @end itemize
37214
37215 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
37216
37217 @itemize @bullet
37218 @item
37219 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
37220 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
37221 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
37222 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
37223 packet.
37224
37225 @item
37226 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
37227 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
37228
37229 @item
37230 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
37231
37232 @item
37233 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
37234
37235 @item
37236 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
37237 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
37238 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
37239 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
37240 packet.
37241
37242 @end itemize
37243
37244 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
37245 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
37246
37247 @itemize @bullet
37248 @item
37249 Return value.
37250
37251 @item
37252 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
37253
37254 @item
37255 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
37256
37257 @end itemize
37258
37259 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
37260 the latest continue or step action.
37261
37262 @node The F Request Packet
37263 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
37264 @cindex file-i/o request packet
37265 @cindex @code{F} request packet
37266
37267 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
37268
37269 @table @samp
37270 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
37271
37272 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
37273 This is just the name of the function.
37274
37275 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
37276 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
37277 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
37278 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
37279 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
37280 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
37281 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
37282
37283 @end table
37284
37285
37286
37287 @node The F Reply Packet
37288 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
37289 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
37290 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
37291
37292 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
37293
37294 @table @samp
37295
37296 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
37297
37298 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
37299
37300 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
37301 representation.
37302 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
37303
37304 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
37305 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
37306 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
37307
37308 @smallexample
37309 F0,0,C
37310 @end smallexample
37311
37312 @noindent
37313 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
37314
37315 @smallexample
37316 F-1,4,C
37317 @end smallexample
37318
37319 @noindent
37320 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
37321
37322 @end table
37323
37324
37325 @node The Ctrl-C Message
37326 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
37327 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
37328
37329 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
37330 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
37331 the target should behave as if it had
37332 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
37333 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
37334 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
37335 packet.
37336
37337 It's important for the target to know in which
37338 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
37339
37340 @itemize @bullet
37341 @item
37342 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
37343
37344 @item
37345 The system call on the host has been finished.
37346
37347 @end itemize
37348
37349 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
37350 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
37351 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
37352 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
37353 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
37354 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
37355
37356 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
37357 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
37358 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
37359 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
37360 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
37361 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
37362 or the full action has been completed.
37363
37364 @node Console I/O
37365 @subsection Console I/O
37366 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
37367
37368 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
37369 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
37370 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
37371 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
37372 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
37373 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
37374 conditions is met:
37375
37376 @itemize @bullet
37377 @item
37378 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
37379 @code{read}
37380 system call is treated as finished.
37381
37382 @item
37383 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
37384 newline.
37385
37386 @item
37387 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
37388 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
37389
37390 @end itemize
37391
37392 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
37393 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
37394 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
37395 is stopped at the user's request.
37396
37397
37398 @node List of Supported Calls
37399 @subsection List of Supported Calls
37400 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
37401
37402 @menu
37403 * open::
37404 * close::
37405 * read::
37406 * write::
37407 * lseek::
37408 * rename::
37409 * unlink::
37410 * stat/fstat::
37411 * gettimeofday::
37412 * isatty::
37413 * system::
37414 @end menu
37415
37416 @node open
37417 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
37418 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
37419
37420 @table @asis
37421 @item Synopsis:
37422 @smallexample
37423 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
37424 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
37425 @end smallexample
37426
37427 @item Request:
37428 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
37429
37430 @noindent
37431 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37432
37433 @table @code
37434 @item O_CREAT
37435 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
37436 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
37437 are concerned.
37438
37439 @item O_EXCL
37440 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
37441 an error and open() fails.
37442
37443 @item O_TRUNC
37444 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
37445 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
37446 truncated to zero length.
37447
37448 @item O_APPEND
37449 The file is opened in append mode.
37450
37451 @item O_RDONLY
37452 The file is opened for reading only.
37453
37454 @item O_WRONLY
37455 The file is opened for writing only.
37456
37457 @item O_RDWR
37458 The file is opened for reading and writing.
37459 @end table
37460
37461 @noindent
37462 Other bits are silently ignored.
37463
37464
37465 @noindent
37466 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
37467
37468 @table @code
37469 @item S_IRUSR
37470 User has read permission.
37471
37472 @item S_IWUSR
37473 User has write permission.
37474
37475 @item S_IRGRP
37476 Group has read permission.
37477
37478 @item S_IWGRP
37479 Group has write permission.
37480
37481 @item S_IROTH
37482 Others have read permission.
37483
37484 @item S_IWOTH
37485 Others have write permission.
37486 @end table
37487
37488 @noindent
37489 Other bits are silently ignored.
37490
37491
37492 @item Return value:
37493 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
37494 occurred.
37495
37496 @item Errors:
37497
37498 @table @code
37499 @item EEXIST
37500 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
37501
37502 @item EISDIR
37503 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
37504
37505 @item EACCES
37506 The requested access is not allowed.
37507
37508 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37509 @var{pathname} was too long.
37510
37511 @item ENOENT
37512 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
37513
37514 @item ENODEV
37515 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
37516
37517 @item EROFS
37518 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
37519 write access was requested.
37520
37521 @item EFAULT
37522 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
37523
37524 @item ENOSPC
37525 No space on device to create the file.
37526
37527 @item EMFILE
37528 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
37529
37530 @item ENFILE
37531 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
37532 has been reached.
37533
37534 @item EINTR
37535 The call was interrupted by the user.
37536 @end table
37537
37538 @end table
37539
37540 @node close
37541 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
37542 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
37543
37544 @table @asis
37545 @item Synopsis:
37546 @smallexample
37547 int close(int fd);
37548 @end smallexample
37549
37550 @item Request:
37551 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
37552
37553 @item Return value:
37554 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
37555
37556 @item Errors:
37557
37558 @table @code
37559 @item EBADF
37560 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
37561
37562 @item EINTR
37563 The call was interrupted by the user.
37564 @end table
37565
37566 @end table
37567
37568 @node read
37569 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
37570 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
37571
37572 @table @asis
37573 @item Synopsis:
37574 @smallexample
37575 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
37576 @end smallexample
37577
37578 @item Request:
37579 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
37580
37581 @item Return value:
37582 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
37583 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
37584 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
37585
37586 @item Errors:
37587
37588 @table @code
37589 @item EBADF
37590 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
37591 reading.
37592
37593 @item EFAULT
37594 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37595
37596 @item EINTR
37597 The call was interrupted by the user.
37598 @end table
37599
37600 @end table
37601
37602 @node write
37603 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
37604 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
37605
37606 @table @asis
37607 @item Synopsis:
37608 @smallexample
37609 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
37610 @end smallexample
37611
37612 @item Request:
37613 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
37614
37615 @item Return value:
37616 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
37617 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
37618 is returned.
37619
37620 @item Errors:
37621
37622 @table @code
37623 @item EBADF
37624 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
37625 writing.
37626
37627 @item EFAULT
37628 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37629
37630 @item EFBIG
37631 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
37632 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
37633
37634 @item ENOSPC
37635 No space on device to write the data.
37636
37637 @item EINTR
37638 The call was interrupted by the user.
37639 @end table
37640
37641 @end table
37642
37643 @node lseek
37644 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
37645 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
37646
37647 @table @asis
37648 @item Synopsis:
37649 @smallexample
37650 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
37651 @end smallexample
37652
37653 @item Request:
37654 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
37655
37656 @var{flag} is one of:
37657
37658 @table @code
37659 @item SEEK_SET
37660 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
37661
37662 @item SEEK_CUR
37663 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
37664 bytes.
37665
37666 @item SEEK_END
37667 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
37668 bytes.
37669 @end table
37670
37671 @item Return value:
37672 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
37673 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
37674 value of -1 is returned.
37675
37676 @item Errors:
37677
37678 @table @code
37679 @item EBADF
37680 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
37681
37682 @item ESPIPE
37683 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
37684
37685 @item EINVAL
37686 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
37687
37688 @item EINTR
37689 The call was interrupted by the user.
37690 @end table
37691
37692 @end table
37693
37694 @node rename
37695 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
37696 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
37697
37698 @table @asis
37699 @item Synopsis:
37700 @smallexample
37701 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
37702 @end smallexample
37703
37704 @item Request:
37705 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
37706
37707 @item Return value:
37708 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37709
37710 @item Errors:
37711
37712 @table @code
37713 @item EISDIR
37714 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
37715 directory.
37716
37717 @item EEXIST
37718 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
37719
37720 @item EBUSY
37721 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
37722 process.
37723
37724 @item EINVAL
37725 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
37726 of itself.
37727
37728 @item ENOTDIR
37729 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
37730 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
37731 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
37732
37733 @item EFAULT
37734 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
37735
37736 @item EACCES
37737 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37738
37739 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37740
37741 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
37742
37743 @item ENOENT
37744 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
37745
37746 @item EROFS
37747 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
37748
37749 @item ENOSPC
37750 The device containing the file has no room for the new
37751 directory entry.
37752
37753 @item EINTR
37754 The call was interrupted by the user.
37755 @end table
37756
37757 @end table
37758
37759 @node unlink
37760 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
37761 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
37762
37763 @table @asis
37764 @item Synopsis:
37765 @smallexample
37766 int unlink(const char *pathname);
37767 @end smallexample
37768
37769 @item Request:
37770 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
37771
37772 @item Return value:
37773 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37774
37775 @item Errors:
37776
37777 @table @code
37778 @item EACCES
37779 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37780
37781 @item EPERM
37782 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
37783
37784 @item EBUSY
37785 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
37786 being used by another process.
37787
37788 @item EFAULT
37789 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37790
37791 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37792 @var{pathname} was too long.
37793
37794 @item ENOENT
37795 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
37796
37797 @item ENOTDIR
37798 A component of the path is not a directory.
37799
37800 @item EROFS
37801 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
37802
37803 @item EINTR
37804 The call was interrupted by the user.
37805 @end table
37806
37807 @end table
37808
37809 @node stat/fstat
37810 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
37811 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
37812 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
37813
37814 @table @asis
37815 @item Synopsis:
37816 @smallexample
37817 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
37818 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
37819 @end smallexample
37820
37821 @item Request:
37822 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
37823 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
37824
37825 @item Return value:
37826 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
37827
37828 @item Errors:
37829
37830 @table @code
37831 @item EBADF
37832 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
37833
37834 @item ENOENT
37835 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
37836 path is an empty string.
37837
37838 @item ENOTDIR
37839 A component of the path is not a directory.
37840
37841 @item EFAULT
37842 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37843
37844 @item EACCES
37845 No access to the file or the path of the file.
37846
37847 @item ENAMETOOLONG
37848 @var{pathname} was too long.
37849
37850 @item EINTR
37851 The call was interrupted by the user.
37852 @end table
37853
37854 @end table
37855
37856 @node gettimeofday
37857 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
37858 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
37859
37860 @table @asis
37861 @item Synopsis:
37862 @smallexample
37863 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
37864 @end smallexample
37865
37866 @item Request:
37867 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
37868
37869 @item Return value:
37870 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
37871
37872 @item Errors:
37873
37874 @table @code
37875 @item EINVAL
37876 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
37877
37878 @item EFAULT
37879 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
37880 @end table
37881
37882 @end table
37883
37884 @node isatty
37885 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
37886 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
37887
37888 @table @asis
37889 @item Synopsis:
37890 @smallexample
37891 int isatty(int fd);
37892 @end smallexample
37893
37894 @item Request:
37895 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
37896
37897 @item Return value:
37898 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
37899
37900 @item Errors:
37901
37902 @table @code
37903 @item EINTR
37904 The call was interrupted by the user.
37905 @end table
37906
37907 @end table
37908
37909 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
37910 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
37911 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
37912 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
37913 needed.
37914
37915
37916 @node system
37917 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
37918 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
37919
37920 @table @asis
37921 @item Synopsis:
37922 @smallexample
37923 int system(const char *command);
37924 @end smallexample
37925
37926 @item Request:
37927 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
37928
37929 @item Return value:
37930 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
37931 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
37932 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
37933 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
37934 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
37935 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
37936 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
37937
37938 @item Errors:
37939
37940 @table @code
37941 @item EINTR
37942 The call was interrupted by the user.
37943 @end table
37944
37945 @end table
37946
37947 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
37948 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
37949 the host is simplified before it's returned
37950 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
37951 is discarded, and the return value consists
37952 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
37953
37954 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
37955 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
37956 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
37957
37958 @table @code
37959 @item set remote system-call-allowed
37960 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
37961 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
37962 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
37963
37964 @item show remote system-call-allowed
37965 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
37966 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
37967 protocol.
37968 @end table
37969
37970 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
37971 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
37972 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
37973
37974 @menu
37975 * Integral Datatypes::
37976 * Pointer Values::
37977 * Memory Transfer::
37978 * struct stat::
37979 * struct timeval::
37980 @end menu
37981
37982 @node Integral Datatypes
37983 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
37984 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
37985
37986 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
37987 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
37988 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
37989
37990 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
37991 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
37992
37993 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
37994
37995 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
37996 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
37997
37998 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
37999
38000 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
38001 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
38002 byte order.
38003
38004 @node Pointer Values
38005 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
38006 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
38007
38008 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
38009 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
38010 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
38011 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
38012
38013 @smallexample
38014 @code{1aaf/12}
38015 @end smallexample
38016
38017 @noindent
38018 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
38019 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
38020 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
38021 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
38022
38023 @smallexample
38024 @code{123456/d}
38025 @end smallexample
38026
38027 @node Memory Transfer
38028 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
38029 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
38030
38031 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
38032 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
38033 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
38034 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
38035 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
38036 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
38037 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
38038
38039
38040 @node struct stat
38041 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
38042 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
38043
38044 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
38045 is defined as follows:
38046
38047 @smallexample
38048 struct stat @{
38049 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
38050 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
38051 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
38052 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
38053 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
38054 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
38055 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
38056 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
38057 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
38058 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
38059 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
38060 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
38061 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
38062 @};
38063 @end smallexample
38064
38065 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
38066 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
38067 structure is of size 64 bytes.
38068
38069 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
38070 range of values.
38071
38072 @table @code
38073
38074 @item st_dev
38075 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
38076
38077 @item st_ino
38078 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38079
38080 @item st_mode
38081 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
38082 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
38083
38084 @item st_uid
38085 @itemx st_gid
38086 @itemx st_rdev
38087 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38088
38089 @item st_atime
38090 @itemx st_mtime
38091 @itemx st_ctime
38092 These values have a host and file system dependent
38093 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
38094 support exact timing values.
38095 @end table
38096
38097 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
38098 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
38099 continuing.
38100
38101 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
38102 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
38103 get truncated on the target.
38104
38105 @node struct timeval
38106 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
38107 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
38108
38109 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
38110 is defined as follows:
38111
38112 @smallexample
38113 struct timeval @{
38114 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
38115 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
38116 @};
38117 @end smallexample
38118
38119 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
38120 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
38121 structure is of size 8 bytes.
38122
38123 @node Constants
38124 @subsection Constants
38125 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
38126
38127 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
38128 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
38129 values before and after the call as needed.
38130
38131 @menu
38132 * Open Flags::
38133 * mode_t Values::
38134 * Errno Values::
38135 * Lseek Flags::
38136 * Limits::
38137 @end menu
38138
38139 @node Open Flags
38140 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
38141 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
38142
38143 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
38144
38145 @smallexample
38146 O_RDONLY 0x0
38147 O_WRONLY 0x1
38148 O_RDWR 0x2
38149 O_APPEND 0x8
38150 O_CREAT 0x200
38151 O_TRUNC 0x400
38152 O_EXCL 0x800
38153 @end smallexample
38154
38155 @node mode_t Values
38156 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
38157 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
38158
38159 All values are given in octal representation.
38160
38161 @smallexample
38162 S_IFREG 0100000
38163 S_IFDIR 040000
38164 S_IRUSR 0400
38165 S_IWUSR 0200
38166 S_IXUSR 0100
38167 S_IRGRP 040
38168 S_IWGRP 020
38169 S_IXGRP 010
38170 S_IROTH 04
38171 S_IWOTH 02
38172 S_IXOTH 01
38173 @end smallexample
38174
38175 @node Errno Values
38176 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
38177 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
38178
38179 All values are given in decimal representation.
38180
38181 @smallexample
38182 EPERM 1
38183 ENOENT 2
38184 EINTR 4
38185 EBADF 9
38186 EACCES 13
38187 EFAULT 14
38188 EBUSY 16
38189 EEXIST 17
38190 ENODEV 19
38191 ENOTDIR 20
38192 EISDIR 21
38193 EINVAL 22
38194 ENFILE 23
38195 EMFILE 24
38196 EFBIG 27
38197 ENOSPC 28
38198 ESPIPE 29
38199 EROFS 30
38200 ENAMETOOLONG 91
38201 EUNKNOWN 9999
38202 @end smallexample
38203
38204 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
38205 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
38206
38207 @node Lseek Flags
38208 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
38209 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
38210
38211 @smallexample
38212 SEEK_SET 0
38213 SEEK_CUR 1
38214 SEEK_END 2
38215 @end smallexample
38216
38217 @node Limits
38218 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
38219 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
38220
38221 All values are given in decimal representation.
38222
38223 @smallexample
38224 INT_MIN -2147483648
38225 INT_MAX 2147483647
38226 UINT_MAX 4294967295
38227 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
38228 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
38229 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
38230 @end smallexample
38231
38232 @node File-I/O Examples
38233 @subsection File-I/O Examples
38234 @cindex file-i/o examples
38235
38236 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38237 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
38238
38239 @smallexample
38240 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
38241 @emph{request memory read from target}
38242 -> @code{m1234,6}
38243 <- XXXXXX
38244 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
38245 -> @code{F6}
38246 @end smallexample
38247
38248 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38249 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
38250
38251 @smallexample
38252 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38253 @emph{request memory write to target}
38254 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38255 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
38256 -> @code{F6}
38257 @end smallexample
38258
38259 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
38260 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
38261
38262 @smallexample
38263 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38264 -> @code{F-1,9}
38265 @end smallexample
38266
38267 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
38268 host is called:
38269
38270 @smallexample
38271 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38272 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
38273 <- @code{T02}
38274 @end smallexample
38275
38276 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
38277 host is called:
38278
38279 @smallexample
38280 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38281 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38282 <- @code{T02}
38283 @end smallexample
38284
38285 @node Library List Format
38286 @section Library List Format
38287 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38288
38289 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
38290 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
38291 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
38292 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
38293 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
38294 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
38295 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38296 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
38297 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
38298 are loaded.
38299
38300 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
38301 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
38302 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
38303 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
38304
38305 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
38306 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
38307 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
38308 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
38309 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
38310 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
38311
38312 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38313 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38314
38315 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
38316 offset, looks like this:
38317
38318 @smallexample
38319 <library-list>
38320 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
38321 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
38322 </library>
38323 </library-list>
38324 @end smallexample
38325
38326 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
38327 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
38328
38329 @smallexample
38330 <library-list>
38331 <library name="sharedlib.o">
38332 <section address="0x10000000"/>
38333 <section address="0x20000000"/>
38334 <section address="0x30000000"/>
38335 </library>
38336 </library-list>
38337 @end smallexample
38338
38339 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
38340
38341 @smallexample
38342 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
38343 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
38344 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38345 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
38346 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38347 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
38348 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38349 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
38350 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
38351 @end smallexample
38352
38353 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
38354 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
38355 section for each library.
38356
38357 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38358 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
38359 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
38360
38361 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
38362 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
38363 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
38364 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
38365
38366 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
38367 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
38368 target, the following parameters are reported:
38369
38370 @itemize @minus
38371 @item
38372 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
38373 @code{struct link_map}.
38374 @item
38375 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
38376 (Thread Local Storage) access.
38377 @item
38378 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
38379 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
38380 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
38381 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
38382 @item
38383 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
38384 @end itemize
38385
38386 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
38387 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
38388 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
38389
38390 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38391 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
38392
38393 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
38394 looks like this:
38395
38396 @smallexample
38397 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
38398 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
38399 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
38400 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
38401 l_ld="0x152350"/>
38402 </library-list-svr>
38403 @end smallexample
38404
38405 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
38406
38407 @smallexample
38408 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
38409 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
38410 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38411 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
38412 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
38413 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38414 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
38415 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
38416 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
38417 @end smallexample
38418
38419 @node Memory Map Format
38420 @section Memory Map Format
38421 @cindex memory map format
38422
38423 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
38424 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
38425 memory map.
38426
38427 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38428 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
38429 lists memory regions.
38430
38431 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38432 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
38433
38434 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38435
38436 @smallexample
38437 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38438 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
38439 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
38440 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
38441 <memory-map>
38442 region...
38443 </memory-map>
38444 @end smallexample
38445
38446 Each region can be either:
38447
38448 @itemize
38449
38450 @item
38451 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
38452 bytes from there:
38453
38454 @smallexample
38455 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38456 @end smallexample
38457
38458
38459 @item
38460 A region of read-only memory:
38461
38462 @smallexample
38463 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38464 @end smallexample
38465
38466
38467 @item
38468 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
38469 bytes in length:
38470
38471 @smallexample
38472 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
38473 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
38474 </memory>
38475 @end smallexample
38476
38477 @end itemize
38478
38479 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
38480 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
38481 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
38482
38483 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
38484
38485 @smallexample
38486 <!-- ................................................... -->
38487 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
38488 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
38489 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
38490 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
38491 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
38492 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
38493 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
38494 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
38495 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
38496 and its type, or device. -->
38497 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
38498 start CDATA #REQUIRED
38499 length CDATA #REQUIRED
38500 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
38501 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
38502 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
38503 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
38504 @end smallexample
38505
38506 @node Thread List Format
38507 @section Thread List Format
38508 @cindex thread list format
38509
38510 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
38511 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
38512 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
38513 the following structure:
38514
38515 @smallexample
38516 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38517 <threads>
38518 <thread id="id" core="0">
38519 ... description ...
38520 </thread>
38521 </threads>
38522 @end smallexample
38523
38524 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
38525 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
38526 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
38527 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
38528 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
38529
38530 @node Traceframe Info Format
38531 @section Traceframe Info Format
38532 @cindex traceframe info format
38533
38534 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
38535 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
38536 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
38537 collected in a traceframe.
38538
38539 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38540 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
38541
38542 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38543 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
38544
38545 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38546
38547 @smallexample
38548 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38549 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
38550 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
38551 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
38552 <traceframe-info>
38553 block...
38554 </traceframe-info>
38555 @end smallexample
38556
38557 Each traceframe block can be either:
38558
38559 @itemize
38560
38561 @item
38562 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
38563 @var{length} bytes from there:
38564
38565 @smallexample
38566 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
38567 @end smallexample
38568
38569 @item
38570 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
38571 collected:
38572
38573 @smallexample
38574 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
38575 @end smallexample
38576
38577 @end itemize
38578
38579 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
38580
38581 @smallexample
38582 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
38583 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38584
38585 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
38586 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
38587 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
38588 <!ELEMENT tvar>
38589 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
38590 @end smallexample
38591
38592 @node Branch Trace Format
38593 @section Branch Trace Format
38594 @cindex branch trace format
38595
38596 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
38597 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
38598 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
38599 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
38600
38601 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38602 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
38603
38604 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38605 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
38606
38607 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
38608
38609 @smallexample
38610 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38611 <!DOCTYPE btrace
38612 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
38613 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
38614 <btrace>
38615 block...
38616 </btrace>
38617 @end smallexample
38618
38619 @itemize
38620
38621 @item
38622 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
38623 and ending at @var{end}:
38624
38625 @smallexample
38626 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
38627 @end smallexample
38628
38629 @end itemize
38630
38631 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
38632
38633 @smallexample
38634 <!ELEMENT btrace (block)* >
38635 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
38636
38637 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
38638 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
38639 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
38640 @end smallexample
38641
38642 @include agentexpr.texi
38643
38644 @node Target Descriptions
38645 @appendix Target Descriptions
38646 @cindex target descriptions
38647
38648 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
38649 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
38650 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
38651 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
38652 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
38653 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
38654 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
38655
38656 @itemize @bullet
38657 @item
38658 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
38659 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
38660 @item
38661 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
38662 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
38663 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
38664 @item
38665 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
38666 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
38667 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
38668 @end itemize
38669
38670 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
38671 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
38672 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
38673 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
38674 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
38675
38676 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
38677 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
38678
38679 @menu
38680 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
38681 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
38682 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
38683 descriptions.
38684 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
38685 @end menu
38686
38687 @node Retrieving Descriptions
38688 @section Retrieving Descriptions
38689
38690 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
38691 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
38692 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
38693 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
38694 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
38695 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
38696 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
38697 Format}.
38698
38699 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
38700 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
38701 specify a file are:
38702
38703 @table @code
38704 @cindex set tdesc filename
38705 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
38706 Read the target description from @var{path}.
38707
38708 @cindex unset tdesc filename
38709 @item unset tdesc filename
38710 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
38711 will use the description supplied by the current target.
38712
38713 @cindex show tdesc filename
38714 @item show tdesc filename
38715 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
38716 @end table
38717
38718
38719 @node Target Description Format
38720 @section Target Description Format
38721 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
38722
38723 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
38724 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
38725 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
38726 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
38727 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
38728 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
38729 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
38730
38731 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
38732 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
38733 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
38734 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
38735 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
38736
38737 Here is a simple target description:
38738
38739 @smallexample
38740 <target version="1.0">
38741 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
38742 </target>
38743 @end smallexample
38744
38745 @noindent
38746 This minimal description only says that the target uses
38747 the x86-64 architecture.
38748
38749 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
38750 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
38751 are explained further below.
38752
38753 @smallexample
38754 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38755 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
38756 <target version="1.0">
38757 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
38758 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
38759 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
38760 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
38761 </target>
38762 @end smallexample
38763
38764 @noindent
38765 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
38766 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
38767 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
38768 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
38769 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
38770 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
38771 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
38772 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
38773 the version mismatch.
38774
38775 @subsection Inclusion
38776 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
38777 @cindex XInclude
38778 @ifnotinfo
38779 @cindex <xi:include>
38780 @end ifnotinfo
38781
38782 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
38783 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
38784 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
38785 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
38786 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
38787
38788 @smallexample
38789 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
38790 @end smallexample
38791
38792 @noindent
38793 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
38794 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
38795 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
38796 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
38797 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
38798 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
38799 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
38800 original description.
38801
38802 @subsection Architecture
38803 @cindex <architecture>
38804
38805 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
38806
38807 @smallexample
38808 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
38809 @end smallexample
38810
38811 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
38812 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
38813
38814 @subsection OS ABI
38815 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
38816
38817 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
38818 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
38819
38820 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
38821
38822 @smallexample
38823 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
38824 @end smallexample
38825
38826 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
38827 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
38828
38829 @subsection Compatible Architecture
38830 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
38831
38832 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
38833 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
38834
38835 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
38836
38837 @smallexample
38838 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
38839 @end smallexample
38840
38841 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
38842 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
38843
38844 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
38845 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
38846 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
38847 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
38848 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
38849 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
38850 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
38851
38852 @smallexample
38853 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
38854 <compatible>spu</compatible>
38855 @end smallexample
38856
38857 @subsection Features
38858 @cindex <feature>
38859
38860 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
38861 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
38862 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
38863 has this form:
38864
38865 @smallexample
38866 <feature name="@var{name}">
38867 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
38868 @var{reg}@dots{}
38869 </feature>
38870 @end smallexample
38871
38872 @noindent
38873 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
38874 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
38875 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
38876 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
38877
38878 @subsection Types
38879
38880 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
38881 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
38882 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
38883 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
38884 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
38885
38886 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
38887 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
38888 Types must be defined before they are used.
38889
38890 @cindex <vector>
38891 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
38892 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
38893 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
38894 @var{count}:
38895
38896 @smallexample
38897 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
38898 @end smallexample
38899
38900 @cindex <union>
38901 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
38902 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
38903 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
38904 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
38905
38906 @smallexample
38907 <union id="@var{id}">
38908 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
38909 @dots{}
38910 </union>
38911 @end smallexample
38912
38913 @cindex <struct>
38914 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
38915 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
38916 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
38917 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
38918 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
38919 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
38920 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
38921 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
38922
38923 @smallexample
38924 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
38925 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
38926 @dots{}
38927 </struct>
38928 @end smallexample
38929
38930 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
38931 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
38932
38933 @smallexample
38934 <struct id="@var{id}">
38935 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
38936 @dots{}
38937 </struct>
38938 @end smallexample
38939
38940 @cindex <flags>
38941 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
38942 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
38943 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
38944 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
38945 are supported.
38946
38947 @smallexample
38948 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
38949 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
38950 @dots{}
38951 </flags>
38952 @end smallexample
38953
38954 @subsection Registers
38955 @cindex <reg>
38956
38957 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
38958
38959 @smallexample
38960 <reg name="@var{name}"
38961 bitsize="@var{size}"
38962 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
38963 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
38964 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
38965 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
38966 @end smallexample
38967
38968 @noindent
38969 The components are as follows:
38970
38971 @table @var
38972
38973 @item name
38974 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
38975
38976 @item bitsize
38977 The register's size, in bits.
38978
38979 @item regnum
38980 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
38981 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
38982 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
38983 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
38984 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
38985 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
38986 in order of increasing register number.
38987
38988 @item save-restore
38989 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
38990 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
38991 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
38992 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
38993 ABI.
38994
38995 @item type
38996 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
38997 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
38998 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
38999 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
39000 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
39001 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
39002
39003 @item group
39004 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
39005 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
39006 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
39007 in @code{info registers}.
39008
39009 @end table
39010
39011 @node Predefined Target Types
39012 @section Predefined Target Types
39013 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
39014
39015 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
39016 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
39017 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
39018 types. The currently supported types are:
39019
39020 @table @code
39021
39022 @item int8
39023 @itemx int16
39024 @itemx int32
39025 @itemx int64
39026 @itemx int128
39027 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
39028
39029 @item uint8
39030 @itemx uint16
39031 @itemx uint32
39032 @itemx uint64
39033 @itemx uint128
39034 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
39035
39036 @item code_ptr
39037 @itemx data_ptr
39038 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
39039 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
39040 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
39041 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
39042 may be marked as data pointers.
39043
39044 @item ieee_single
39045 Single precision IEEE floating point.
39046
39047 @item ieee_double
39048 Double precision IEEE floating point.
39049
39050 @item arm_fpa_ext
39051 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
39052
39053 @item i387_ext
39054 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
39055
39056 @item i386_eflags
39057 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
39058
39059 @item i386_mxcsr
39060 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
39061
39062 @end table
39063
39064 @node Standard Target Features
39065 @section Standard Target Features
39066 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
39067
39068 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
39069 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
39070 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
39071 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
39072 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
39073 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
39074 can recognize them.
39075
39076 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
39077 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
39078 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
39079 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
39080 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
39081 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
39082 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
39083 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
39084
39085 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
39086 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
39087 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
39088
39089 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
39090 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
39091 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
39092 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
39093
39094 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
39095 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
39096 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
39097
39098 @menu
39099 * AArch64 Features::
39100 * ARM Features::
39101 * i386 Features::
39102 * MicroBlaze Features::
39103 * MIPS Features::
39104 * M68K Features::
39105 * Nios II Features::
39106 * PowerPC Features::
39107 * S/390 and System z Features::
39108 * TIC6x Features::
39109 @end menu
39110
39111
39112 @node AArch64 Features
39113 @subsection AArch64 Features
39114 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
39115
39116 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
39117 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
39118 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39119
39120 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
39121 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
39122 and @samp{fpcr}.
39123
39124 @node ARM Features
39125 @subsection ARM Features
39126 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
39127
39128 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
39129 ARM targets.
39130 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
39131 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39132
39133 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
39134 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
39135 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
39136 and @samp{xpsr}.
39137
39138 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
39139 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
39140
39141 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
39142 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
39143 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
39144 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
39145
39146 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
39147 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
39148 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
39149 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
39150 halves of the double-precision registers.
39151
39152 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
39153 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
39154 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
39155 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
39156 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
39157 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
39158
39159 @node i386 Features
39160 @subsection i386 Features
39161 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
39162
39163 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
39164 targets. It should describe the following registers:
39165
39166 @itemize @minus
39167 @item
39168 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
39169 @item
39170 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
39171 @item
39172 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
39173 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
39174 @item
39175 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
39176 @item
39177 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
39178 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
39179 @end itemize
39180
39181 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
39182
39183 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
39184 describe registers:
39185
39186 @itemize @minus
39187 @item
39188 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
39189 @item
39190 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
39191 @item
39192 @samp{mxcsr}
39193 @end itemize
39194
39195 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
39196 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
39197 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
39198
39199 @itemize @minus
39200 @item
39201 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
39202 @item
39203 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
39204 @end itemize
39205
39206 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel(R)
39207 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
39208
39209 @itemize @minus
39210 @item
39211 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
39212 @item
39213 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
39214 @end itemize
39215
39216 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
39217 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
39218
39219 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
39220 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
39221 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
39222
39223 @itemize @minus
39224 @item
39225 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39226 @end itemize
39227
39228 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
39229
39230 @itemize @minus
39231 @item
39232 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39233 @end itemize
39234
39235 It should
39236 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
39237
39238 @itemize @minus
39239 @item
39240 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
39241 @item
39242 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
39243 @end itemize
39244
39245 It should
39246 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
39247
39248 @itemize @minus
39249 @item
39250 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39251 @end itemize
39252
39253 @node MicroBlaze Features
39254 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
39255 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
39256
39257 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
39258 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
39259 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
39260 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
39261 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
39262
39263 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
39264 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
39265
39266 @node MIPS Features
39267 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
39268 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
39269
39270 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
39271 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
39272 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
39273 on the target.
39274
39275 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
39276 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
39277 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39278
39279 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
39280 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
39281 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
39282 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39283
39284 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
39285 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
39286 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
39287 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39288
39289 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
39290 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
39291 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
39292
39293 @node M68K Features
39294 @subsection M68K Features
39295 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
39296
39297 @table @code
39298 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
39299 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
39300 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
39301 One of those features must be always present.
39302 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
39303 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
39304 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
39305 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
39306
39307 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
39308 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
39309 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
39310 @samp{fpiaddr}.
39311 @end table
39312
39313 @node Nios II Features
39314 @subsection Nios II Features
39315 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
39316
39317 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
39318 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
39319 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
39320 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
39321 @samp{mpuacc}).
39322
39323 @node PowerPC Features
39324 @subsection PowerPC Features
39325 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
39326
39327 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
39328 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
39329 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
39330 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
39331
39332 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
39333 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
39334
39335 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
39336 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
39337 and @samp{vrsave}.
39338
39339 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
39340 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
39341 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
39342 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
39343 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
39344 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
39345
39346 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
39347 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
39348 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
39349 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
39350 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
39351 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
39352 user.
39353
39354 @node S/390 and System z Features
39355 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
39356 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
39357 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
39358
39359 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
39360 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
39361 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
39362 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
39363 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
39364 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
39365 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
39366 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
39367 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
39368
39369 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
39370 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
39371 @samp{fpc}.
39372
39373 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
39374 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
39375
39376 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
39377 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
39378 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
39379 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
39380 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
39381 32-bit wide.
39382
39383 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
39384 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
39385 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
39386
39387 @node TIC6x Features
39388 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
39389 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
39390 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
39391 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
39392 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
39393 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
39394
39395 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
39396 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
39397 through @samp{B31}.
39398
39399 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
39400 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
39401
39402 @node Operating System Information
39403 @appendix Operating System Information
39404 @cindex operating system information
39405
39406 @menu
39407 * Process list::
39408 @end menu
39409
39410 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
39411 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
39412 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
39413 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
39414 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
39415 on a different aspect of target.
39416
39417 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
39418 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
39419 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
39420 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
39421
39422 @node Process list
39423 @appendixsection Process list
39424 @cindex operating system information, process list
39425
39426 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
39427 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
39428 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
39429 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
39430
39431 An example document is:
39432
39433 @smallexample
39434 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39435 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
39436 <osdata type="processes">
39437 <item>
39438 <column name="pid">1</column>
39439 <column name="user">root</column>
39440 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
39441 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
39442 </item>
39443 </osdata>
39444 @end smallexample
39445
39446 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
39447 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
39448 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
39449 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
39450 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
39451 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
39452 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
39453
39454 @node Trace File Format
39455 @appendix Trace File Format
39456 @cindex trace file format
39457
39458 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
39459 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
39460
39461 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
39462 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
39463 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
39464 in the future.
39465
39466 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
39467 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
39468 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
39469 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
39470 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
39471 of this section.
39472
39473 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
39474
39475 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
39476 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
39477 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
39478 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
39479 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
39480 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
39481 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
39482 endianness.
39483
39484 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
39485
39486 @table @code
39487 @item R @var{bytes}
39488 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
39489 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
39490 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
39491 hexadecimal encoding.
39492
39493 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
39494 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
39495 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
39496 @var{length} bytes.
39497
39498 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
39499 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
39500 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
39501
39502 @end table
39503
39504 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
39505 of blocks.
39506
39507 @node Index Section Format
39508 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
39509 @cindex .gdb_index section format
39510 @cindex index section format
39511
39512 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
39513 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
39514 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
39515 description.
39516
39517 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
39518 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
39519 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
39520 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
39521 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
39522 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
39523
39524 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
39525
39526 @enumerate
39527 @item
39528 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
39529 unless otherwise noted:
39530
39531 @enumerate
39532 @item
39533 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
39534 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
39535 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
39536 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
39537 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
39538 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
39539 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
39540
39541 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
39542 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
39543 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
39544 currently not flagged as deprecated.
39545
39546 @item
39547 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
39548
39549 @item
39550 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
39551 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
39552 to the next offset.
39553
39554 @item
39555 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
39556
39557 @item
39558 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
39559
39560 @item
39561 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
39562 @end enumerate
39563
39564 @item
39565 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
39566 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
39567 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
39568 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
39569 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
39570 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
39571 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
39572 CU indices.
39573
39574 @item
39575 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
39576 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
39577 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
39578 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
39579
39580 @item
39581 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
39582 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
39583
39584 @enumerate
39585 @item
39586 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
39587
39588 @item
39589 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
39590 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
39591
39592 @item
39593 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
39594 @end enumerate
39595
39596 @item
39597 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
39598 the hash table is always a power of 2.
39599
39600 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
39601 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
39602 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
39603 constant pool.
39604
39605 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
39606 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
39607 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
39608
39609 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
39610 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
39611 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
39612 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
39613 index version:
39614
39615 @table @asis
39616 @item Version 4
39617 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
39618
39619 @item Versions 5 to 7
39620 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
39621 @end table
39622
39623 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
39624
39625 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
39626 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
39627 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
39628 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
39629 collision.
39630
39631 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
39632 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
39633 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
39634 the code.
39635
39636 @item
39637 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
39638 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
39639 strings.
39640
39641 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
39642 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
39643 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
39644 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
39645 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
39646 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
39647
39648 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
39649 @end enumerate
39650
39651 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
39652 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
39653 CU index+attributes value for each use.
39654
39655 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
39656 (bit 0 = LSB):
39657
39658 @table @asis
39659
39660 @item Bits 0-23
39661 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
39662 @item Bits 24-27
39663 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
39664 @item Bits 28-30
39665 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
39666
39667 @table @asis
39668 @item 0
39669 This value is reserved and should not be used.
39670 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
39671 with previous versions of the index.
39672 @item 1
39673 The symbol is a type.
39674 @item 2
39675 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
39676 @item 3
39677 The symbol is a function.
39678 @item 4
39679 Any other kind of symbol.
39680 @item 5,6,7
39681 These values are reserved.
39682 @end table
39683
39684 @item Bit 31
39685 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
39686
39687 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
39688 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
39689 @value{GDBN} sources.
39690
39691 @end table
39692
39693 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
39694 global/static attributes in the index.
39695
39696 @smallexample
39697 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
39698 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
39699 switch (die->tag)
39700 @{
39701 case DW_TAG_typedef:
39702 case DW_TAG_base_type:
39703 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
39704 kind = TYPE;
39705 is_static = 1;
39706 break;
39707 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
39708 kind = VARIABLE;
39709 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
39710 break;
39711 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
39712 kind = FUNCTION;
39713 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
39714 break;
39715 case DW_TAG_constant:
39716 kind = VARIABLE;
39717 is_static = ! is_external;
39718 break;
39719 case DW_TAG_variable:
39720 kind = VARIABLE;
39721 is_static = ! is_external;
39722 break;
39723 case DW_TAG_namespace:
39724 kind = TYPE;
39725 is_static = 0;
39726 break;
39727 case DW_TAG_class_type:
39728 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
39729 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
39730 case DW_TAG_union_type:
39731 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
39732 kind = TYPE;
39733 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
39734 break;
39735 default:
39736 assert (0);
39737 @}
39738 @end smallexample
39739
39740 @node Man Pages
39741 @appendix Manual pages
39742 @cindex Man pages
39743
39744 @menu
39745 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
39746 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
39747 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
39748 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
39749 @end menu
39750
39751 @node gdb man
39752 @heading gdb man
39753
39754 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
39755
39756 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
39757 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
39758 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
39759 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
39760 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
39761 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
39762 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
39763 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
39764 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
39765 @c man end
39766
39767 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
39768 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
39769 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
39770 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
39771
39772 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
39773 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
39774
39775 @itemize @bullet
39776 @item
39777 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
39778
39779 @item
39780 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
39781
39782 @item
39783 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
39784
39785 @item
39786 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
39787 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
39788 @end itemize
39789
39790 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
39791 Modula-2.
39792
39793 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
39794 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
39795 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
39796 by using the command @code{help}.
39797
39798 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
39799 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
39800 executable program as the argument:
39801
39802 @smallexample
39803 gdb program
39804 @end smallexample
39805
39806 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
39807
39808 @smallexample
39809 gdb program core
39810 @end smallexample
39811
39812 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
39813 to debug a running process:
39814
39815 @smallexample
39816 gdb program 1234
39817 gdb -p 1234
39818 @end smallexample
39819
39820 @noindent
39821 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
39822 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
39823 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
39824
39825 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
39826
39827 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
39828 @table @env
39829 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
39830 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
39831
39832 @item run [@var{arglist}]
39833 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
39834
39835 @item bt
39836 Backtrace: display the program stack.
39837
39838 @item print @var{expr}
39839 Display the value of an expression.
39840
39841 @item c
39842 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
39843
39844 @item next
39845 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
39846 function calls in the line.
39847
39848 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
39849 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
39850
39851 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
39852 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
39853
39854 @item step
39855 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
39856 function calls in the line.
39857
39858 @item help [@var{name}]
39859 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
39860 about using @value{GDBN}.
39861
39862 @item quit
39863 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
39864 @end table
39865
39866 @ifset man
39867 For full details on @value{GDBN},
39868 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
39869 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
39870 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
39871 @end ifset
39872 @c man end
39873
39874 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
39875 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
39876 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
39877 encountered with no
39878 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
39879 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
39880 Many options have
39881 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
39882 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
39883 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
39884 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
39885 more usual convention.)
39886
39887 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
39888 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
39889 option is used.
39890
39891 @table @env
39892 @item -help
39893 @itemx -h
39894 List all options, with brief explanations.
39895
39896 @item -symbols=@var{file}
39897 @itemx -s @var{file}
39898 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
39899
39900 @item -write
39901 Enable writing into executable and core files.
39902
39903 @item -exec=@var{file}
39904 @itemx -e @var{file}
39905 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
39906 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
39907 dump.
39908
39909 @item -se=@var{file}
39910 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
39911 file.
39912
39913 @item -core=@var{file}
39914 @itemx -c @var{file}
39915 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
39916
39917 @item -command=@var{file}
39918 @itemx -x @var{file}
39919 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
39920
39921 @item -ex @var{command}
39922 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
39923
39924 @item -directory=@var{directory}
39925 @itemx -d @var{directory}
39926 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
39927
39928 @item -nh
39929 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
39930
39931 @item -nx
39932 @itemx -n
39933 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
39934
39935 @item -quiet
39936 @itemx -q
39937 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
39938 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
39939
39940 @item -batch
39941 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
39942 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
39943 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
39944 commands in the command files.
39945
39946 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
39947 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
39948 more useful, the message
39949
39950 @smallexample
39951 Program exited normally.
39952 @end smallexample
39953
39954 @noindent
39955 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
39956 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
39957
39958 @item -cd=@var{directory}
39959 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
39960 instead of the current directory.
39961
39962 @item -fullname
39963 @itemx -f
39964 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
39965 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
39966 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
39967 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
39968 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
39969 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
39970 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
39971 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
39972
39973 @item -b @var{bps}
39974 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
39975 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
39976
39977 @item -tty=@var{device}
39978 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
39979 @end table
39980 @c man end
39981
39982 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
39983 @ifset man
39984 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
39985 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
39986 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
39987
39988 @smallexample
39989 info gdb
39990 @end smallexample
39991
39992 @noindent
39993 should give you access to the complete manual.
39994
39995 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
39996 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
39997 @end ifset
39998 @c man end
39999
40000 @node gdbserver man
40001 @heading gdbserver man
40002
40003 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
40004 @format
40005 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
40006 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
40007
40008 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40009
40010 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40011 @c man end
40012 @end format
40013
40014 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
40015 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
40016 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
40017
40018 @ifclear man
40019 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
40020 @end ifclear
40021 @ifset man
40022 Usage (server (target) side):
40023 @end ifset
40024
40025 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
40026 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
40027 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
40028 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
40029
40030 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
40031 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
40032 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
40033
40034 @smallexample
40035 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
40036 @end smallexample
40037
40038 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
40039
40040 @smallexample
40041 @ifset man
40042 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
40043 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
40044 @end ifset
40045 @ifclear man
40046 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
40047 @end ifclear
40048 @end smallexample
40049
40050 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
40051 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
40052 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
40053
40054 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
40055
40056 @smallexample
40057 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
40058 @end smallexample
40059
40060 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
40061 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
40062 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
40063 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
40064 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
40065 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
40066 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
40067 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
40068 print an error message and exit.
40069
40070 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
40071 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
40072
40073 @smallexample
40074 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40075 @end smallexample
40076
40077 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40078 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40079
40080 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40081 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
40082 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
40083 the program you want to debug.
40084
40085 @smallexample
40086 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40087 @end smallexample
40088
40089 @ifclear man
40090 @subheading Usage (host side)
40091 @end ifclear
40092 @ifset man
40093 Usage (host side):
40094 @end ifset
40095
40096 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
40097 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
40098 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
40099 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
40100 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
40101 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
40102 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
40103 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
40104 descriptor. For example:
40105
40106 @smallexample
40107 @ifset man
40108 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
40109 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
40110 @end ifset
40111 @ifclear man
40112 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
40113 @end ifclear
40114 @end smallexample
40115
40116 @noindent
40117 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
40118
40119 @smallexample
40120 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
40121 @end smallexample
40122
40123 @noindent
40124 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
40125 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
40126 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
40127 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
40128 `Connection refused'.
40129
40130 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
40131 described in
40132 @ifset man
40133 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
40134 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
40135 @end ifset
40136 @ifclear man
40137 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
40138 @end ifclear
40139 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
40140
40141 @smallexample
40142 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
40143 @end smallexample
40144
40145 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
40146 case.
40147 @c man end
40148
40149 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
40150 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
40151
40152 @itemize @bullet
40153
40154 @item
40155 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
40156
40157 @smallexample
40158 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
40159 @end smallexample
40160
40161 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
40162 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
40163 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
40164 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
40165 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
40166 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
40167 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40168
40169 @item
40170 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
40171 program:
40172
40173 @smallexample
40174 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40175 @end smallexample
40176
40177 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
40178 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
40179 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
40180 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40181
40182 @item
40183 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
40184
40185 @smallexample
40186 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40187 @end smallexample
40188
40189 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
40190 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
40191 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
40192 debug several processes in the same session.
40193 @end itemize
40194
40195 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
40196
40197 @table @env
40198
40199 @item --help
40200 List all options, with brief explanations.
40201
40202 @item --version
40203 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
40204
40205 @item --attach
40206 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
40207
40208 @smallexample
40209 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40210 @end smallexample
40211
40212 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40213 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40214
40215 @item --multi
40216 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40217 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
40218 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
40219 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
40220
40221 @smallexample
40222 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40223 @end smallexample
40224
40225 @item --debug
40226 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
40227 process.
40228 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40229 the developers.
40230
40231 @item --remote-debug
40232 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
40233 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
40234 the developers.
40235
40236 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
40237 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
40238 of debugging output.
40239 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
40240
40241 @item --wrapper
40242 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
40243 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
40244 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
40245 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
40246
40247 @item --once
40248 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
40249 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
40250 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
40251 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
40252
40253 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
40254
40255 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
40256 @c QDisableRandomization.
40257
40258 @end table
40259 @c man end
40260
40261 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
40262 @ifset man
40263 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40264 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40265 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40266
40267 @smallexample
40268 info gdb
40269 @end smallexample
40270
40271 should give you access to the complete manual.
40272
40273 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40274 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40275 @end ifset
40276 @c man end
40277
40278 @node gcore man
40279 @heading gcore
40280
40281 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
40282
40283 @format
40284 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
40285 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
40286 @c man end
40287 @end format
40288
40289 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
40290 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
40291 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
40292 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
40293 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
40294 running without any change.
40295 @c man end
40296
40297 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
40298 @table @env
40299 @item -o @var{filename}
40300 The optional argument
40301 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
40302 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
40303 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
40304 @end table
40305 @c man end
40306
40307 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
40308 @ifset man
40309 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40310 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40311 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40312
40313 @smallexample
40314 info gdb
40315 @end smallexample
40316
40317 @noindent
40318 should give you access to the complete manual.
40319
40320 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40321 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40322 @end ifset
40323 @c man end
40324
40325 @node gdbinit man
40326 @heading gdbinit
40327
40328 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
40329
40330 @format
40331 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
40332 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40333 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40334 @end ifset
40335
40336 ~/.gdbinit
40337
40338 ./.gdbinit
40339 @c man end
40340 @end format
40341
40342 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
40343 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
40344 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
40345 described in
40346 @ifset man
40347 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
40348 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
40349 @end ifset
40350 @ifclear man
40351 @ref{Sequences}.
40352 @end ifclear
40353
40354 Please read more in
40355 @ifset man
40356 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
40357 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
40358 @end ifset
40359 @ifclear man
40360 @ref{Startup}.
40361 @end ifclear
40362
40363 @table @env
40364 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40365 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
40366 @end ifset
40367 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
40368 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
40369 @end ifclear
40370 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40371 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
40372 See more in
40373 @ifset man
40374 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
40375 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
40376 @end ifset
40377 @ifclear man
40378 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
40379 @end ifclear
40380
40381 @item ~/.gdbinit
40382 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
40383 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
40384
40385 @item ./.gdbinit
40386 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
40387 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
40388 See more in
40389 @ifset man
40390 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
40391 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
40392 @end ifset
40393 @ifclear man
40394 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
40395 @end ifclear
40396 @end table
40397 @c man end
40398
40399 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
40400 @ifset man
40401 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
40402
40403 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40404 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40405 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40406
40407 @smallexample
40408 info gdb
40409 @end smallexample
40410
40411 should give you access to the complete manual.
40412
40413 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40414 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40415 @end ifset
40416 @c man end
40417
40418 @include gpl.texi
40419
40420 @node GNU Free Documentation License
40421 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
40422 @include fdl.texi
40423
40424 @node Concept Index
40425 @unnumbered Concept Index
40426
40427 @printindex cp
40428
40429 @node Command and Variable Index
40430 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
40431
40432 @printindex fn
40433
40434 @tex
40435 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
40436 % meantime:
40437 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
40438 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
40439 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
40440 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
40441 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
40442 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
40443 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
40444 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
40445 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
40446 \page\colophon
40447 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
40448 @end tex
40449
40450 @bye
This page took 1.05189 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.